8691330-Beechcraft Bonanza A36 Maintenance Manual
8691330-Beechcraft Bonanza A36 Maintenance Manual
8691330-Beechcraft Bonanza A36 Maintenance Manual
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
Maintenance Nlanual
NOTE
The export of these commodities, technology or software are subject to the US Export
Administration Regulations. Diversion contrary to U.S. law is prohibited. For guidance on export
control requirements, contact the Commerce Department’s Bureau of Export Administration at 202-
482-4811 or at www.bxa.doc.gov.
Ry~heon Imb´•lnO~iM1I
General Aviation
Aircraft Company GAMA Manufacturers Association
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTEr\jiiNCE MANUAL
RECORD OF REVISIONS
When a revision is inserted, the revision number, the date the revision is inserted into the manual, and the initials of
the person(s) inserting the revision should be recorded on this page.
A26 11/18/04
A27 5/27/05
TP
A28 12/9/05
Page 1
Sep 30/04
Ray~heon nircralt Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
A28
Basic publications are assigned a part number which appears on the title page with the date of the issue. Subsequent revisions are identified by the addition of a
revision code after the part number. Al after a part number denotes the first revision to the basic publication, A2 the second, etc. Occasionally, it is necessary to
completely reissue and reprint a publication for the purpose of obsoleting a previous issue and outstanding revisions thereto. As these replacement reissues are made.
the code will also change to the next successive letter of the alphabet at each issue. For example, B for the first reissue, C for the second, etc.
When ordering a handbook, give the basic number, and the reissue code when applicable, if a complete up-to-date publicationis desired. Should only revision
pages
be required, give the basic number and revision code for the particular set of revision pages you desire.
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
A28
Raytt~eon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: Insert this Record of Temporary Revisions after the Log of Temporary Revisions page(s).
Page f
Sep 30/04
aevpeeen Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENAN~E jV1ANUAL
Page 2
Sep 30/04
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAli;jiENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: Insert this Log of Temporary Revisions after the Record of Revisions page. Previous Log of Temporary
Revisions may be discarded. Update the Record of Temporary Revisions page(s) as required.
Page 1
Sep 30/04
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Page 2
Sep 30/04
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The chapters which have been revised or added are listed below with the Highlights of each change. Remove the
affected pages and insert this A28 Revision in accordance with the attached Instruction Page. Enter the revision
number and the date inserted on the Record of Revisions page of this manual. The Highlights Page may be retained
with the manual for future reference.
HIGHLIGHTS
ChapterlSection Description
Introduction Revised to include reference of G36 Maintenance Manual Supplement and associated
publications. Revised Chart i to reflect addition of Supplement.
91-00-00 Revised Chart 1 to include new consumable materials.
Page 1
A28 Aug 31/05
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
INSTRUCTIONS
for
REVISION 36-590001-9A28
REMOVE INSERT
PAGE CHAPTER PAGE CHAPTER DATED
Page 1 of 1
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Page
Title Aug 31/05
Logo Page
"A" Page A28
"B" Page A28
"C" Page A28
NOTE The chapter List of Effective Pages is located in the front of each chapter.
A28
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
INTRODUCTION
NOTE: Neither reissues nor revisions are automatically provided to the holder of this manual. For information on
how to obtain reissues or revisions applicable to this manual, refer to the latest revision of the Raytheon
Additional publications are listed in the current Publications Price List CD-ROM
(P/N 994-32808). For
Information on thesepublications contact the Technical Manual Distributions Center (TMDC) at
1-800-796-2665, fax (316) 676-4824, E-mail [email protected] or visit our web site at http:ll
pubs. raytheonaircraft.com.
The Bonanza Series Maintenance Manual is prepared in accordance with the GAMA
(General Aviation
Manufacturers Association) Specification No. 2 format. It also meets the intent of the
requirements of the ATA
Specification 1 00 (Air Transport Association of America) with respect to the arrangement and content of the System/
Chapters within the designated chapter-numbering system. This maintenance manual is supplemented by the
following publications:
NOTE: It shall be the responsibility of the owner/operator to ensure that the latest revision of publications referenced
in this handbook are utilized during operation, servicing, and maintenance of the airplane.
The Bonanza Model G36 Electrical Wiring Diagram Manual, PIN 36-590001-13
The Bonanza Model G36 Avionics W~ring Diagram Manual, P/N 36-590001-15
The Bonanza 33, 35 and 36 Series Continuing Care Inspection Guide, P/N 98-36711
NOTE: Raytheon Aircraft Company expressly reserves the right to supersede, cancel and/or dedare obsolete any
parts, part numbers, kits, or publications that may be referenced in this manual without prior notice.
Since a variety of avionic components and equipment is available and because avionic manufacturers normally
wide
supply parts and servicing manuals with each set/component, the avionic publications are not included in the
Publications Price List. The manufacturer of the equipment should be contacted when additional parts or servicing
information is required.
WARNING: Use only parts obtained from sources approved by Raytheon Aircraft Company, in connection
with the maintenance and repair of Raytheon Aircraft Company airplanes.
Genuine Raytheon Aircraft Company parts are produced and inspected under rigorous
procedures to insure airworthiness and suitability for use in Raytheon Aircraft Company
airplane applications. Parts purchased from sources other than those approved by Raytheon
Aircraft Company, even though outwardly identical in appearance, may not have had the
required tests and inspections performed, may be different in fabrication techniques and
materials, and may be dangerous when installed in an airplane.
Salvaged airplane parts, reworked parts obtained from sources not approved by the Raytheon
Aircraft Company or parts, components or structural assemblies, the service history of which
is unknown or cannot be authenticated, may have been subjected to unacceptable stresses or
temperatures or have other hidden damage, not discernible through routine visual or usual
nondestructive testing techniques. This may render the part, component or structural
assembly, even though originally manufactured by the Raytheon Aircraft Company, unsuitable
and unsafe for airplane use.
Raytheon Aircraft Company expressly disclaims any responsibility for malfunctions, failures,
damage or injury caused by use of parts not approved by the Raytheon Aircraft Company.
CORRESPONDENCE
If a question should arise concerning the care of you; airplane, it is important to include the airplane serial number
in any correspondence. The serial number appears on the model designation placard. Refer to Chapter 11-00-00
for placard location.
The content of this publication is organized into four levels. The four levels are:
GROUP Identified by different colored divider tabs. These are the primary divisions of the manual that enable broad
separation of content. Typical of this division is the separation between Airframe Systems and the Power Plant.
SYSTEM/CHAPTER The various groups are broken down into major systems such as Environmental Systems,
Electrical Power, Landing Gear, etc. The systems are arranged more or less alphabetically rather than by
precedence or importance. They are assigned a number, which becomes the first element of the standardized
numberi ng system. Thus, the element 28 of the number 28-00-00 refers to the chapter FU EL. Everyth ing concerning
the fuel system will be covered in this chapter.
SUBSYSTEM/SECTION The major systems/chapters of an airplane are broken down into subsystems. These
subsystems identified by the second element of the standard numbering system. The element 40 of the number
are
28-40-00 concerns itself with the indicating section of the fuel system.
2
Aug 31/05Page INTRODUCTION us
Rallheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
APPLICATION
Any publication conforming to the GAMA or ATA format will use the same basic numbering system. Thus, whether
the manual is Bonanza Series Maintenance Manual or a Bonanza Series Wiring Diagram Manual, the person
wishing information concerning the indicationportion of the fuel system, would refer to the System/Chapter Tab
28 FUEL. The Table of Contents in the front of Chapter 28 provides a list of subsystems and sections covered in I
this chapter. For example, the fuel system chapter with a full index could contain the following:
28 FUEL
28-00-00 General
The material within thechapter is arranged in an ascending, numerical sequence. The System/Chapter-Subsystem-
Section numbers and the page numbers are located at the lower outside corner of each page. A Subsystem may
not be included in a particular systemlchapter if it is not applicable to the airplane (e.g. The airplane does not have
a cooling or air conditioning system, then subsystem 21-50-d0 would not be included in Chapter 21).
TITLE PAGE
A Title page is located at the beginning of the manual and provides the part number, the chapters, and lists all aircraft
models pertaining to this manual and their respective serial numbers. Information throughout this manual is
applicable to all serial numbers listed on the title page except where specifically stated.
The List of Effective Revisions pages follow the Title page of the manual and lists the revisions currently effective
for the manual. The page numbers for these pages are alphabetically numbered starting with the upper case "A"
and are located at the lower outside corner of each page.
The Record of Revisions page follows the List of Effective Revisions pages. When a revision is inserted, the revision I
number, the date the revision is inserted into the manual, and the initials of the person(s) inserting the revision
should be recorded on this page.
3
nns INTRODUCTION Aug 31 05Page
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I The Log of Temporary Revisions page follows the Record of Revisions page. The Log of Temporary Revisions page
provides a history of each temporary revision, including the revision number which incorporated the temporary
revision into the manual.
I A Record of Temporary Revisions page follows the Record of Revisions page. When a temporary revision is inserted
or removed from this manual, the appropriate information should be recorded on this page.
Each chapter has a List of Effective Pages that is found at the begin of the chapter. The List of Effective Pages
I provides a list the issue or revision date of each page in the chapter.
TEMPORARY REVISIONS
Temporary revisions are issued to provide maintenance information in the interim between revisions. Each
temporary revision is issued by the chapter number to which it applies followed by a sequential number in the order
of publication (Temporary Revisions 12-1, 12-2, etc.). Temporary revisions are printed on yellow paper and are to
be placed in the maintenance manual in accordance with the instructions provided on each page included in the
revision. The information in the temporary revision will be included in the next revision of the manual.
REVISED TEXT
Any text that has been revised by the addition of new text by a change to the existing text, is denoted by a solid,
or
vertical revision bar adjacent to the affected text. For changes to single column text, the revision bar will be located
in the outside margin of the page. For changes to two column text, the revision bars will be located in the outside
and inside margins depending on which column has the change. Revision bars are not placed in the area between
two columns.
Revision bars are only shownon pages that have changes. Not all pages in a revision may have changes and
therefore some pages of a revision will not have change bars. Revision bars are only applicable to changes of the
specific revision the change(s) were made and subsequent revisions will not show these revision bars. The revision
number (e.g. A9) and revision date (e.g. Sep 27/84) are printed at the bottom of the page and indicated when the
latest changes were made to that page and what the revision number for the changes are. Revision bars are not
used to show punctuation, spelling, capitalization, andlor pagination changes unless the change will affect the
technical understanding of the text.
REVISED ILLUSTRATIONS
When an illustration is modified or a new illustration is added, it will be denoted by a solid, vertical revision bar
adjacent to the illustration. The revision bar is located in the outside margin of the page.
Aug 31105INTRODUCTION ua
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WARNING Brings attention to an operating procedure, inspection, repair or maintenance practices, which if
not correctly followed, could result in personal injury or loss of life.
CAUTION Brings attention to an operating procedure, inspection, repair or maintenance condition, which if not
strictly observed, could result in damage or destruction of equipment.
NOTE Brings attention to an operating procedure, inspection, repair or maintenance condition, which is
essential to highlight.
A note will be shown on the schematic diagram if the above conditions are different (e.g. NOTE Airplane shown
with power applied and entrance door open.).
Contacts on connectors that are identified with lower case letters will be shown by an underlined letter or a letter
with an asterisk (A*).
Airplanes operated for Air Taxi, or other than normal operation, and airplanes operated in humid tropics, cold and
damp climates, etc., may need more frequent inspections for wear, corrosion andlor lack of lubrication. Under these
adverse conditions, perform periodic inspections in compliance with this guide at more frequent intervals until the
owner or operator can set his own inspection periods based on the contingencies of field experience.
CAUTION: The recommended periods do not constitute a guarantee the item will reach the period without
malfunction as the aforementioned factors cannot be controlled by the manufacturer.
The SystemlChapter Index Guide (refer to Chart 1) is prepared in accordance with both ATA Specification No. 100
and GAMA Specification No. 2 for use with this maintenance manual and its applicable illustrated parts catalogs,
electrical wiring diagram manuals, avionics wiring diagram manuals, and maintenance manual supplements. The
guide provides a list of all system/chapters and subsystems that are applicable to this maintenance manual. The
following chapters are not applicable to this maintenance manual: 4, 26, 29, 37, 38, 49, 60, 70, 75, 76, 77, 78, 83
and 95.
5
nzs INTRODUCTION Aug 31/05Page
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
INTRODUCTION
8-00-00 General
10-00-00 General
6
Aug 3105Page INTRODUCTION A28
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEI~ICHAPTER
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
12 SERVICING
12-00-00 General
12-10-00 Rep\enishing
20-09-00 Corrosion
21 ENVIRONMENTAL SYSTEMS
21-50-00 Cooling
22 AUTO FLIGHT
22-14-00 Autopilot
A28
INTRODUCTION AUgPBjS~;:Page
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER-
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
23 COMMUNICATIONS
24 ELECTRICAL POWER
24-30-00 DC Generation
24-35-00 DC Generation
25 EQUIPMENTIFURNISHINGS
25-60-00 Emergency
8
Aug
31/05Page INTRODUCTION A28
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
27 FLIGHT CONTROLS
27-50-00 Flaps
27-70-00 Gust Lock and Damper
28 FUEL
28-00-00 General
28-10-00 Storage
28-20-00 Distribution
28-40-00 Indicating
28-41-00 Indicating
30-00-00 General
30-60-00 Propellers
31 INDICATINGIRECORDING SYSTEMS
31-00-00 General
9
A28 INTRODUCTION
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER-
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
32 LANDING GEAR
32-00-00 General
32-50-00 Steering
33 LIGHTS
33-20-00 Interior
33-40-00 Exterior
34 NAVIGATION
10
Aug 3105Page INTRODUCTION A28
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
35 OXYGEN
35-00-00 General
36 PNEUMATIC
36-00-00 General
39-00-00 General
51 STRUCTURES
51-00-00 General
52 DOORS
52-00-00 General
53 FUSELAGE
53-10-00 Fuselage
53-30-00 Plates/Skins
11
A28 INTRODUCTIONPage
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER-
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
55 STABILIZERS
55-00-00 General
55-40-00 Rudder
56 WINDOWS
56-00-00 General
57 WINGS
57-00-00 Wings
57-30-00 Plates/Skin
61 PROPELLERS
61-10-00 Propeller
61-20-00 Controlling
71 POWER PLANT
71-00-00 General
71-10-00 Cowling
12
Aug 31/05Page INTRODUCTION A28
Raylheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
72 ENGINE
72-00-00 General
74 IGNITION
74-00-00 General
74-20-00 Distribution
77 ENGINE INDICATING
77-00-00 General
77-11-00 Power
77-21-00 Temperature
77-22-00 Temperature
77-31-00 Analyzers
77-40-00 Integrated Engine Instrument Systems
79 OIL
79-00-00 General
80 STARTING
80-10-00 Cranking
13
A28 INTRODUCTION Aug 31/05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
SystemlChapter Index Guide
SYSTEMICHAPTER-
SUBSYSTEM- TITLE
SECTION
81 TURBINES
81-00-00 General
91 CHARTS
91-00-00 Charts
ENGINE
1 ’0-520 ENGINE
Service Parts Catalog, Form X-30040. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft Products Division, Post Office Box 90,
Mobile, Alabama 36601.
Maintenance and Overhaul Manual, Form X-30039. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft Products Division, Post
Office Box 90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
Operators Handbook, Form X-30041. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft Products Division, Post Office Box 90,
Mobile, Alabama 36601.
TSIO-520 ENGINE
Overhaul Manual for TSIO-520 Series Aircraft Engines, Form No. X-30042. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft
Products Division, Post Office Box 90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
Operators Manual for TSIO-520-U and -UB Engines, Form No. X-30044. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft
Products Division, Post Office Box 90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
10-550 ENGINE
Illustrated Parts Catalog, Form X-30569. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft Products Division, Post Office Box
90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
Overhaul Manual, Form X-30568. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft Products Division, Post Office Box 90,
Mobile, Alabama 36601.
Continued Aimorthiness Maintenance and Operators Manual, Form X-30565. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft
Products Division, Post Office Box 90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
TURBOCHARGER
Overhaul Manual and Parts Catalog, Form No. X-30055. Teledyne Continental Motors Aircraft Products Division,
Post Office Box 90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
Page
guA41
31105 INTRODUCTION n2s
RBYtheoll Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUEL INJECTION
Overhaul Manual and Parts Catalog, Form No. X-30052. Teledyne Continental Motors Corporation, Aircraft
Products Division, Post Office Box 90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
PROPELLER
Overhaul Manual and Parts Catalog Manual No. 720415, McCauley Industrial Corporation, Dayton, Ohio.
Hartzell Propeller Owner’s Manual, 115H, or Overhaul Manual No. 113B, Hartzell Propeller, Inc., Piqua, Ohio.
Service Manual with overhaul and parts for McCauley 3A32C406-X propellers, Manual No. 761001 or McCauley
propeller Operators Manual No. N1PC-11, McCauley Accessory Division, Cessna Aircraft Company, 1840 Howell
Ave, Dayton, Ohio 45417.
PROPELLER GOVERNOR
McCauley Service Manual No. 78041 for the 35-380088-3 Propeller Governor, 3535 McCauley Drive, Vandalia,
Ohio 45377.
Overhaul Manual with Parts List Bulletin No. 33080 for the 35-380088-1 Propeller Govemor, Woodward Governor
Company, Rockford, Illinois.
MAGNETOS
Overhaul Instructions for Bendix S-1200 Series Magnetos, Form L-609. Scintilia Division, Bendix Aviation
Corporation, Sidney, New York.
Service Parts List for Bendix S-1200 Series Magnetos, Form L-608. Scintilia Division, Bendix Aviation Corporation,
Sidney, New York.
Installation, Maintenance and Operation Instructions, S6RN-201 and S6RN-205 Magnetos, Form L-526. Scintilia
Division, Bendix Aviation Corporation, Sidney, New York.
Overhaul Instructions, 5-600 Series Magnetos, Form L-551. Scintilia Division, Bendix Aviation Corporation, Sidney,
New York.
Service Parts List, S-600 Series Magnetos, Form L-552-1. Scintilia Division, Bendix Aviation Corporation, Sidney,
New York.
420016200 Series Aircraft Magnetos Maintenance and Overhaul Instructions, Form No. 1037-A. Slick Electro, Inc.,
Rockford, Illinois 61101.
F-1100 Master Service Manual, Form L-1363 (rev. B), 4300/6300 Series Slick Magnetos. Unison Industries, 7575
Baymeadows Way, Jacksonville, FL 32256.
STARTING MOTOR
Equipment List, Servj_ce Parts and Technical Data OE-A1, Parts and Equipment Section Service Department,
Toledo, Ohio 43694.
VOLTAGE REGULATOR
Voltage Regulator 28 volt (Alternate), P/N B-00-387-1, Lamar Inc., 71 Indel Ave., P.O. Box 251, Rancocas, NJ
08073.
15
n2a INTRODUCTION Aug 31 05Page
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ALTERNATOR
Equipment List, Service Parts and Technical Data OE-A1, Prestolite Service Department, Parts and Equipment
Section, Toledo, Ohio 43601.
Service and Overhaul Instructions for Continental P/N 642056A1 or 642051 Alternator, Publication No. X-30531,
Teledyne Continental Motors, Aircraft Products Division, Post Office Box 90, Mobile, Alabama 36601.
AUTOPILOT
King KFC-200 Installation Manual No. 006-0203-00 for Models F33C, F33A, A36 and A36TC or No. 006-0201-00
for Model V35B,King Radio Corporation, 400 N. Rogers Road, Olathe, Kansas 66061.
Edo-Aire Mitchell Service and Overhaul Manual for Century III P/N 68854 or Century IV P/N 68S89, P.O. Box 610,
Mineral Wells, Texas 76067.
STROBE LIGHT
Overhaul Manual with Illustrated Parts List (60-1750-3 Power Supply), Publication Number: 33-40-58; Grimes Div.
of Midland Ross Corp., 515 North Russel Street, Urbana, Ohio 43078.
Model 508 Compressor, Abacus International, P.O. Box 327, Dallas, Texas 75221.
FLIGHT CONTROLS
Edo-Aire Mitchell, Automatic Flight Control Systems, AK563 Bulletin No. 686 or AK669 Bulletin No. 798, EDO-AIRE
MITCHELL, P.O. Box 610, Mineral Wells, Texas 76067.
BATTERY
Service Manual, Publication Number GSM-1277, Teledyne Battery Products, P.O. Box 431, 840 W. Brockton Ave.
Redlands, CA 92373.
Service Manual CB12-9, for Concorde Aircraft Battery, Concorde Battery Corp., 2009 San Bernadino Rd., West
Covina, CA 01790.
RADAR
WeatherScout Digital Weather Radar System, System description and Installation Manual, Publication Number:
168023100, R.C.A., Avionics Systems, 8500 Balboa Blvd., Van Nuys, CA 91409.
16
Aug
31/05Page INTRODUCTION nzs
Raytheon AiKraft C6mpany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Garmin G1000TM, Cockpit Reference Guide for the Beechcraft A36/G36, Publication Number: 190-00525-00 01,
Garmin Internationa\, Inc., 1200 E151S’ Street, Olathe, KS 66062 USA.
98-35012 Servicing Maintenance Instructions and Illustrated Parts Breakdown for the Main Wheel, Nose Wheel and
Brake Assembly.
32-31-24 Maintenance Information and Illustrated Parts Breakdown for EM 27-8 Landing Gear Motor.
17
nzs INTRODUCTION Aug 31 05Page
C H A PT E R
TIME LIMITS/
MAINTENANCE
CH EC KS
RayMheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
5-10-00
Power Plant
Flaps and Flight Controls ........4
Fuel System
Instruments
Electrical System
Miscellaneous
W~ngs. ..6
5-20-00
1
A27
5-CONTENTS Mar 31/05Page
Rlytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
5-50-00
Page
2;H~t, 5-CONTENTS anr
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1
A27 5-LOEP Mar 31 05Page
Rayrheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The first overhaul replacement must be performed not later than the recommended period. The condition
or of the
item at the end of the first period can be used as a criterion for determining subsequent periods applicable to the
individual airplane or fleet operation, provided the operator has an approved monitoring system.
The time periods for inspections noted in this manual are based on average usage and average environmental
conditions.
NOTE: The recommended periods do not constitute a guarantee the item will reach the period without malfunction
as the aforementioned factors cannot be controlled by the manufacturer.
WARNING: Prior to performing maintenance on an engine or the Airframe, ALWAYS pull the starter control
circuit breakers and the Landing Gear circuit breaker. This will remove power to the starter
control as well as the igniter power relay and Landing Gear Control relay.
Airplanes operated for Air Taxi, or other than normal operation, and airplanes operated in humid tropics, or cold and
damp climates, etc., may need more frequent inspections for wear, corrosion and/or lack of lubrication. In these
areas, periodic inspections should be performed until the operator can set his own inspection periods based on
experience.
NOTE: The date noted on the STANDARD AIRWORTHINESS CERTIFICATE, FAA Form No. 8100-2, which is
issued with each airplane,
new is to be used as the basis for all TBO or replacement components listed in
NOTE: All items not listed are replaced On condition. On condition items are to be overhauled
to be overhauled or
or replaced if
inspection a potentially unsafe or unserviceable condition, if they are worn,
reveals
inoperative, inaccurate, intermittent and not repairable through normal maintenance. Primarily items that
are calender, cycle or hour limited are included in the following list.
LANDING GEAR
overhaul.)
Nose Gear Retract Rod Rod-Ends (All) 2,000 hours
POWER PLANT
NOTE: A TBO (time between overhaul) recommendation is in no way to be construed as a warranty or engine life
proration basis. The TBO recommendation is based on the projected time for most advantageous initial
overhaul. The individual operator’s experience may indicate a departure in either direction from the
recommended TBO for the particular operation.
Page
raM2
31/05 5-1 0-00 A27
Raylheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Alternator On condition.
subsequent
Air Pressure Pump Airborne Pumps refer to Airborne Replacement
Schedule SI 300-17 or subsequent. See Supplier Data
CAUTION at the end of this Chapter.
Aero Accessories Pump, Part Number AA442CW,
Replace at 500 hours time-of-operation.
Aero Accessories Pumps, Part Number AA216CW or
AA3216CW, Replace at 1,200 hours time-of-operation.
Engine Air Filter Clean every 50 hours of operation (10 times max.).
Replace every 500 hours or 1 year, whichever occurs
first.
Magneto (Bendix 8 Teledyne Continental Motors Engine overhaul or every four years, whichever comes
Slick Magnetos (Unison Industries) Refer to Slick Aircraft Products Maintenance Manual (P/N
L-1363) and Slick Service Bulletin SB2-80C. t
3
nlr 5-1 0-00Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUEL SYSTEM
Fuel Cell Reservoir Kit (If installed) Replace foam insert every 10 years.
INSTRUMENTS
Rate-Of-Climb On condition.
Tachometer On condition.
Clock On condition.
Page
ralN4
31105 5-~ 0-00 A27
RBYtbeon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
INSTRUMENTS (Continued)
Flap Position Indicator On condition.
Pressure System Filter (In-line and Intake) Refer to Parker-Hannifin Airborne Service Letter 59 or
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Battery (Emergency Locator Transmitter) Replace at 50% of useful life las stated on the battery) or
MISCELLANEOUS
Oxygen Cylinder (Lightweight 3HT Type) Hydrostatically test every 3 years. Replace every 24
years or 4,380 refills (ICC regulation), whichever occurs
first.
Oxygen Cylinder (Standard Weight 3AA Type) Hydrostatically test every 5 years.
5
A27 5-~ 0-00 Mar 31 05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Campany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WINGS
CAUTIONs After removing wing attach nuts for any reason, always install new wing attach nuts. Do not reuse
existing nuts.
*Supplier Data on this item maychange without notice. Users of this manual should refer to the Parker
Hannifin website (www.parker.com/airborne) for the latest information.
Page
raM6
31105 5-~ 0-00 A27
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Lock the brakes and operate the engine at near takeoff power. Tum the deicer systems switch ON and observe
the ammeter for at least 3 minutes. If the ammeter needle does not indicate amperage (reference ELECTRIC
PROPELLER DEICING in Chapter 30-60-00 for proper amperage) for 90 seconds at 90 second intervals, refer
to the troubleshooting chart for the probable sources of trouble.
WARNING: Before moving propeller, make certain that ignition switch is OFF and that engine has cooled
completely. There is always some danger of a cylinder firing when propeller is moved.
CAUTION: While following the instructions of Step b., move the propeller back and forth to prevent arcing between
the brushes and slip ring.
b. With the engine shut off, tum the deicer switch ON and feel the deicer boots on the propeller for the proper
sequence of heater operation. The presence of local hot spots indicates service damage to the deicer heaters,
which should be repaired before more serious damage develops.
c. Remove the spinner and open all access doors pertaining to the wiring and components of the deicer system.
Turn the deicer switch ON and station an assistant in the cockpit to observe the system ammeter. Flex all
accessible wiring, particularly the lead straps, leads from the slip ring assembly, and the firewall electrical
connectors and their wiring. Any movement of the ammeter, other than the cycling flicker that occurs at 90
second intervals, indicates a short or open circuit that must be located and corrected.
d. To extend the life of the lead strap between the hub clamp and clip, reposition the bend in the strap at a point
at least 112 inch from the existing location of the bend.
e. Check for damaged brush rods or springs and for worn or damaged brushes.
WARNING: Before moving propeller, make certain that ignition switch is OFF and that engine has cooled
completely. There is always some danger of a cylinder firing when a propeller is moved.
b. Check all clamps, clips, mountings, electrical connections and connectors for tightness and electrical
soundness. Check also for loose, broken or missing safety wire.
c. Closely check the deicer boots for wrinkles, loose or torn areas, particularly around the outboard end and at the
point where the strap passes under the hub clamp. Look for abrasion or cuts along the leading edge of the flat
or thrust face. If the heater wires are exposed in damaged areas or if the rubber is found to be tacky, swollen or
deteriorated las from contact with oil or solvent fluids), replace the damaged deicer boot.
d. Check that the hub clamps are tight. Inspect for cracks or other damage. Check to see that the cushioning
material is not missing or damaged in the area under the hub clamp or on the edge of the spinner dome.
Manually operate the propeller from "high pitch" to "low pitch" while checking that the deicer lead straps do not
come under tension.
e. Check the slip rings for gouges, roughened surfaces, cracks, burned or discolored areas, and for deposits of oil,
grease or dirt. Clean greasy or contaminated slip rings with CRC-2-26 solvent (23, Chart 1, 91-00-00). After such
a cleaning, allow a run-in time of 5 hours of engine operation before turning on the deicer system.
f. If uneven wear or wobble is detected, check the alignment of the slip rings to the prop shaft with a dial indicator.
While turning the prop to check the slip ring alignment, push in on the prop to eliminate play in the propeller
thrust bearing. If the run out over 360" of rotation is over 0.005 inch or if over any 4-inch are it exceeds 0.002
inch, refer to the paragraph on SLIP RING ALIGNMENT in Chapter 30-60-00.
g. Examine the brush mounting bracket and housing for cracks, deformation, or other indications of damage. Make
sure that connections are tight and that the leads are not chafed or binding.
to the proper position. If the brushes ride BOTH high and low with respect to the slip rings in 360" of rotation,
the slip ring assembly is eccentrically mounted and the spinner bulkhead must be replaced. For the correct
angular location of the brushes to the slip ring, refer to the illustrations in Chapter 30-60-00.
i. Check for proper spacing between the brush block and slip rings as indicated in DEICER BRUSH
REPLACEMENT, Chapter 30-60-00. If this distance is not within the specified limits, loosen the mounting
screws and reposition them in the elongated holes until the block is properly positioned. If necessary, add shims
between the thrust bearing plate and mounting bracket until the brush block is properly located.
CAUTION: While following the instructions of Step k., move the propeller back and forth to prevent arcing between
the brushes and slip ring.
k. With the deicer system operating and a man in the cockpit observing the ammeter, visually inspect and
physically flex the wiring from the brush blocks to each component of the deicer system and to the aircraft power
supply. Movement of the ammeter needle (other than the cycling that occurs when the timer switches at
90-second intervals) indicate loose or broken wiring in the area under examination at the moment. In such
instances, continue to flex the wiring in the area that first indicated trouble while checking the continuity through
the individual wires of the affected harness until the source of trouble is located. Use the wiring diagram to trace
the circuitry of the deicer system.
a. Visually inspect oil leaks, exhaust system leaks and general condition.
50 HOURS
a. Visually inspect oil leaks, exhaust system leaks and general condition.
100 HOURS
a. Remove compressor inlet duct assembly. Inspect the compressor wheel for nicks, cracks or broken blades. Turn
wheelby hand and feel for excess bearing drag or wheel rubbing against housing. Reinstall air inlet duct.
b. Check the oil inlet and outlet ports in center housing for leaks, and the turbine heat blanket for condition and
security.
c. Check for any interference with linkage between the bypass valve (wastegate) and actuator, its general
condition and security.
d. Inspect all exhaust system components for worn or damaged areas, loose clamps, cracks and leaks.
e. Inspect lubrication system components for worn or damaged areas, loose clamps and leaks. Special attention
should be given to the ducts downstream (pressure side) of the compressor.
f. Inspect the fuel injection nozzle pressure reference manifold, for deteriorated hose, loose connections, leaks or
obstructions.
g. All fluid power lines should be checked for leaks and security.
h. The compressor discharge reference line from the throttle air valve to the controller should be opened and
inspected for oil leakage from the controller. Any leakage is cause for replacement of the controller.
3
5-20-00
Ray~heon AiKraft company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1. 50 Hours Rudder pedal Check for cracks. If cracks are found, contact the
bellcrank Technical Support Department of
support Raytheon. Aircraft Company.
assembly
2. 50 Hours Elevator to Check screw holes If hole diameter is more than 0.194
Elevator (4 per elevator) for inch, ream hole to 0.208 0.002 inch
torque fitting proper hole diameter. diameter and install NAS 2903-4 or
Page
45-20-00 A26
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
bolts
Elevator push- I Check for straightness Replace if bent or worn smaller than
rods to and wear. 0.370 inch diameter.
elevator
torque fitting
bolt
5. 50 Hours Upper and Inspect tor cracks, Replace if any of noted conditions
middle rudder corrosion and excessive exist.
hinges wear.
6. 50 Hours Elevator hinge I Check bearing for Replace if noted conditions exist.
joint looseness and bearing
bracket for cracks,
corrosion and excessive
wear.
corroded.
5
A26 5-20-00
Raytheon Aircraft Campany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
8. 50 Hours Trim Tab Check for cracks. Replace if noted conditions exist.
9. 50 Hours Elevator Check for cracks, If cracks are found, contact the
especially between TechnicalSupport Department of
outboard hinge and Raytheon Aircraft
Company for
elevator balance horn. repair.
10. 50 Hours Trim tab Check straightness. Replace if bent.
push rod
assemblies
11. 50 Hours Trim tab Check output shaft for Replace if bent.
´•I actuator Istraightness.
Check actuator Check attach bolts for proper torque.
installation for
looseness.
12. 50 Hours Elevator Check pushrod If more than 0.379 inch, press out
bellcrank mounting hole for existing bushing and press in one
proper diameter. BS105740X-XC0958 bushing and
drill 0.377 rt 0.002-inch diameter
hole through bushing.
13. 50 Hours Bolt (elevator Check for straightness Replace if bent or worn smaller than
pushrod to and wear. 0.370 inch.
bellcrank)
14. 50 Hours Inboard Check for cracks. Check Replace if noted condition exists.
elevatorhinge hinge bearingsfor
casting looseness.
The owner or operator is responsible for maintaining the airplane in airworthy condition, including compliance
an
with all applicable Airworthiness Directives as specified in Part 39 of Title 14 Code of Federal
Regulations (14 CFR).
It is further the responsibility of the owner or operator to ensure that the airplane is inspected in conformity with the
requirements covered in 14 CFR Parts 43 and 91. These 14 CFR Parts cover the requirements concerning the
Inspection Guide. This Inspection Guide is not intended to be all inclusive, for no such guide can replace the good
judgement of a certified airframe and power plant mechanic in the performance of his duties. As the one primarily´•
responsible for the airworthiness of the airplane, the owner or operator should select only qualified personnel to
maintain the airplane.
Airplanes delivered from the factory after August 1, 2001 will use the Factory Aircraft Comprehensive Tracking
System (FACTS) which becomes the factory computerized maintenance tracking and forecasting system for the
Model A36/B36TC series airplanes. The FACTS program for the Model A36/B36TC adheres to the guidelines
established in this chapter of the maintenance manual. The Raytheon Aircraft approved inspection program
contained in this chapter, and within the Raytheon factory computerized maintenance inspection program (FACTS),
is specifically for the Model A36/B36TC series airplanes. Any variation to the inspection program must be approved
in writing by the FAA Flight Standards District Office (FSDO), or Ain~vorthineSs Authority. The FACTS program meets
the requirement of both 14 CFR 91 and 14 CFR 135.
The time periods for the inspections noted in this schedule are based on normal usage under average environmental
conditions. Airplanes operated in humid tropics, or in cold, damp climates, etc., may need more frequent inspections
for wear, corrosion, lubrication, and/or lack of maintenance. Under these adverse conditions, perform periodic
inspections in compliance with this guide at more frequent intervals until the owner or operator can set his own
inspection periods based on the contingencies of field experience.
NOTE: The required periods do not constitute a guarantee that the item will reach the period without malfunction,
as the aforementioned factors cannot be controlled by the manufacturer.
This inspection program, in accordance with 14 CFR Parts 43 and 91, consists of, but is not limited to,
inspection items listed in this Inspection Guide, any applicable Airworthiness Directives issued against the
airframe or any equipment installed therein and conformity to Type Certificate Data Sheet as applicable.
Material contained in this guide, including the inspection intervals, may be changed at any time by the owner/
operator, with prior notification and approval of the local FAA General Aviation District Office, when warranted by
service experience or engineering recommendations. Information contained herein is applicable to all Bonanza
series airplanes covered in this maintenance manual except where differences are indicated by serial effectivity.
While the Inspection Guide may be used as an outline, detailed information of the many systems and components
in the airplane will be found in the various sections of this maintenance manual and the pertinent supplier
publications. It is also recommended that reference be made to the applicable maintenance handbooks, service
instructions, Raytheon Aircraft service bulletins, applicable FAA regulations and publications, and supplier bulletins
and specifications for torque values, clearances, settings, tolerances, and other requirements. In the final analysis,
it is the responsibility of the owner/operator to ensure that the airframe and power plant mechanic inspecting the
airplane has access to the previously noted documents as well as to this Inspection Guide.
NOTE: Any time an airplane is repainted or touched up, inspect all placards and decals to assure that they are not
covered with paint, are easily readable, and are securely attached. Replace any placards that have been
inadvertently defaced or removed.
In addition to the inspections prescribed by this schedule, the altimeter system and all ATC transponders
MUST be tested and inspected at 24-month intervals in compliance with the requirements specified in 14
CFR Parts 91.411, and 91.413.
A complete inspection of the airplane must be accomplished within each 12-month period for compliance with the
Title 14 Code of Federal Regulations. The time periods for inspections stated in this inspection guide should NEVER
be exceeded by more than 10 hours, and then only if the additional time is required to reach a place where the
inspection can be satisfactorily accomplished. However, the additional time used must be deducted from the next
inspection time. If 10 hours were used to reach the inspection facility, the next inspection would be due in 90 hours
for the next 100-hour inspection with no extension allowed.
7
PiZS 5-20-00
Ralfheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
An airplane must receive a complete (100-hour, annual, or complete continuing care inspection) inspection every
12 months regardless of the hours flown. The inspections completed during a 12-month period can be deleted from
the items to be inspected. Rubber goods such as fuel lines are recommended to be changed at five year periods
regardless of airplane time.
NOTE: Additional publications are listed in the current Publications Price List CD ROM
(P/N 994-32808). For
information on these
publications contact the Technical Manual Distribution Center (TMDC) at
1-800-796-2665, fax (316) 676-4824, E-mail TMDCQrac.ray.com or visit our web site at http:~
raytheonaircraft.com.
NOTE: All electrical systems operational inspections are to be made using an external power source capable of
delivering and maintaining 28.25 0.25 vdc.
Raytheon Aircraft Company issues service information for the benefit of owners and operators in the form of two
classes of Service Bulletins. MANDATORY
(Red Border) Service Bulletins
are changes, inspections or
modifications that could affect safety. The
factory considers compliance with these Service Bulletins mandatory.
OPTIONAL (No Border) Service Bulletins cover changes, modifications, improvements or inspections which may
benefit the owner. Due to the wide range of information covered by the OPTIONAL Service Bulletin, each owner or
operator is responsible for conducting a thorough review of each OPTIONAL Service Bulletin to determine if
compliance is required based on the applicability of the OPTIONAL Service Bulletin to his particular set of operating
conditions. It is the responsibility of the owner or operator to ensure that all Raytheon Aircraft Service Bulletins which
are pertinent to his particular operation -are complied with.
NOTE: Model E33C and F33C airplanes being spun MUST also have the AEROBATIC INSPECTION at 50 hours.
WARNING: During the performance of this inspection the airplane will be placed on three-point jacks.
Ensure the landing gear isdown and locked before removing the airplane from the jacks.
1. STARTER Check for proper operation, unusual noise and dragging. Check starter
energized light (if installed)and/or load meter to ensure starter disengagement when
starter switch is released.
2. FUEL FLOW Check for proper fuel pressure limits and fluctuations. Refer to Chapter
71-00-00 for fuel system setup.
6. INSTRUMENT AIR SYSTEM Check for proper operation and output pressure.
7. STANDBY INSTRUMENT AIR (If installed) Check for proper operation. Check
plumbing and wiring for security and condition. Refer to AFM Supplement
36-590006-23.
3. PROPELLER OPERATION Cycle propeller and check for proper rpm drop and
smoothness of operation.
9. PROPELLER DEICER Check for proper operation and amperage drawn on ammeter.
10. OIL PRESSURE AND TEMPERATURE Check for proper pressure, temperature limits
and unusual fluctuations.
11. MAGNETOS Check the performance of the magneto as outlined under the heading
NORMAL PROCEDURES in the appropriate Pilot’s Operating Handbook.
14. HEATING AND VENTILATING SYSTEM Check for proper operation, heat and airflow
output. Check controls for freedom of movement.
15. FIREWALL SHUTOFF VALVE Check for proper operation and freedom of movement.
16. IDLE RPM AND MIXTURE SETTINGS Check for both proper rpm and mixture
settings. Check controls for freedom of operation.
17. IDLE CUT-OFF Check for proper operation and freedom of movement.
9
5-20-00
RayNReon nircra)t tompany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
20. FUEL QUANTITY GAGES Check for proper operation and unusual fluctuations.
21. AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP Check pump for proper operation, unusual noise and
fluctuations.
22. FUEL TANK SELECTOR Check for proper placarding, proper operation and feel for
positive detent.
23. ALL LIGHTS Check for condition, attachment, cracked or broken lenses. Check
switches, knobs and circuit breakers for looseness and operation.
24. STALL WARNING SYSTEM Check for proper operation and heating of the unit.
25. RADIO OPERATION Check for proper operation, security of switches and knobs.
26. FLAPS Check for noisy operation, full travel and proper indication.
27. PITOT HEAT Check for amperage drawn on ammeter and for proper heating of the
unit.
29. BRAKES Check for condition and wear, ease of operation and proper release of the
parking brake. Check for unusual brake chatter.
30. EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER Check for proper operation. Tune radio to
121.5 MHz on VHF or 243 MHz on UHF, then turn ELT switch to ON and monitor for
one signal. Turn ELT switch OFF, then place in ARM position. Ensure that the ELT is
armed when the airplane is returned to service.
31. AIR-CONDITIONER Operate the air conditioner and verify that the retractable
condenser moves to the ground extended position when turned on and returns to the
retracted position when turned off. Check for proper operation and unusual noise.
32. OXYG EN SYSTEM Functionally check the oxygen system for proper operation. Check
the oxygen bottle shutoff valve for proper operation.
33. SWITCHES, CIRCUIT BREAKERS Check for proper operationl
34. FLIGHT CONTROLS, TRIM CONTROLS AND TRIM INDICATOR Check freedom of
movement and proper operation through full travel with and without flaps extended.
Check electric trim controls for operation.
B. POWERPLANT
1. NACELLE SKIN Check for deformation and obvious damage or cracks. Check for
loose or missing rivets.
2. NACELLE STRUCTURE Check for cracks and deformation. Check for loose or
Sep 5-20-00
Raylheon nirclaft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
5. SPARK PLUGS Clean, inspect, regap, test and replace as necessary. Tighten spark
plugs to proper torque and check ignition harness condition and for proper attachment.
6. COMPRESSION Perform differential compression test.
7. BATTERY Inspect for clean, tight connections and add distilled water to maintain a
level of 3/8-inch above top of separators. Inspect the vents and overflow tube for
obstructions. Check for security and proper attachment. Check for corrosion. Make
certain the battery is clean. Water or dirt on battery surface can cause the battery to
discharge.
8. PLUMBING Inspect plumbing and associated accessories for condition (such as
cracks and fraying) and attachment. Check plumbing clearance and secure against
possible chafing.
9. BRAKE FLUID RESERVOIR Check reservoir for securifl, open vent, proper fluid level
and for leaks.
10. ENGINE OIL TANK OR SUMP Check for cracks, leaks, proper fluid level, deformation
and security.
11. CRANKCASE Check security of crankcase-thru bolts. Inspect the dipstick tabs for
security and that the tabs are not bent.
12. OIL SUMP DRAINS AND SCREENS Clean screens, check for holes in the screens
and for obstructions. Check for metal particles
or foreign matter on screens and filters.
13. OIL COOLER Check oil cooler, lines and fittings for condition, security, chafing and
leaks.
14. PROPELLER AND MOUNTING BOLTS Check for condition and security. Check the
tip of the blades for evidence of
lightning strikes. If there is evidence of lightning strikes,
consult the propeller manufacturer, the engine manufacturer and Raytheon Aircraft
Company. Inspect the blades for cracks, dents, nicks, scratches, erosion, corrosion,
security and movement in the hub.
15. PROPELLER SPINNER Check for deformation, security and cracks.
16. PROPELLER HUB Check for cracks, excessively leaking seals and condition.
17. ALTERNATOR Check for condition and attachment. Check wiring for proper
attachment and possible chafing. Check for unusual noise.
18. ALTERNATOR (Prestolite or Delco Remy only) Remove and disassemble the
alternator necessary to inspect the rotor shaft bearings for condition and replace
as if
necessary. Refer to Service Instructions No. 0546-359 Rev II or subsequent.
19. STARTER Check for condition, attachment and chafed or loose wires.
21. MAGNETOS Check contact for proper clearance. Points with deep pits or
points
excessively burned areas must be discarded. Inspect the cam follower felt pad for
proper lubrication and clean the compartment with a clean, dry cloth. Check ignition
harness for proper connection, security and fraying. Check timing.
22. MAGNETO PRESSURIZATION FILTER Check for condition, cleanliness and
security.
23. CYLINDERS AND BAFFLES Check cylinders and exhaust manifold for obvious leaks,
security and cracks, check baffles for cracks and security. Check cylinders for broken
cooling fins and loose or missing base nuts.
24. EXHAUST SYSTEM Check for deformation, security, cracks, leaks, loose or missing
nuts and clamps. Check for thin wall condition which may occur due to normal internal
erosion on stacks which have long service time.
25. FIREWALL Check for wrinkles, damage or cracks. Check all electrical and control
access holes for proper sealing.
26. HOSE AND DUCTS Check all fuel, oil and air hose or duct for leakage, cracks,
deterioration and damage. Check fittings for security.
27. ENG INE ACCESSORIES Check for condition, security and leaks. Check wiring, hoses
and tubes for chafing, security and leaks.
28. ENGINE MOUNTS Check for cracks, corrosion and security. Inspect rubber cushions,
mount bolts and nuts, and grounding straps for condition and security.
29. CABIN HEATER SYSTEM Check for cracks, distortion, corrosion, leaks and
obstructions per Chapter 21-40-00.
30. PROPELLER GOVERNOR Check for leaks and corrosion and control arm for
security.
31. ENGINE CONTROLS Check controls and associated equipment for condition,
attachment, alignment and rigging. Remove cable connection bolts and check for ~wear
each 300 hours.
33. ELECTRICAL WIRING AND EQUIPMENT Inspect electrical wiring and associated
equipment and accessories for fraying and attachment.
34. ALL DRAINS AND PLUGS Check for condition, security and obstructions. Check for
leaks and correct tightness.
35. PRESSURE PUMP INTAKE FILTER Refer to Parker-Hannifin Airborne Service Letter
59 or subsequent. Refer to Chapter 5-10-00 for additional information.
37. INDUCTION AIR FILTER Check for condition, cleanliness and security.
38. INDUCTION SYSTEM AND ALTERNATE AIR Check hot and cold flexible air ducts for
delamination of the inner lining. Check the alternate air valve for blockage, security,
cracks, operation and wear.
39. FUEL INJECTION CONTROL VALVE Clean the screen and check for damage. Install
screen and check for leaks.
40. FUEL INJECTION SYSTEM Inspect all fuel injection components, lines and fittings for
evidence of fuel leaks, fraying and cracking.
41. FUEL RETURN LINE (EA-11 thru EA-439) Check for chafing against the wastegate
seal drain line, particularly in the area approximately six inches from the fire wall
bulkhead fitting of the fuel return line.
a. Check for service damage to the deicer heaters, brush rods, springs and brushes.
Check for attachment and security.
b. Check the lead strap and all other clamps, connectors and wiring for electrical
soundness, security and attachment.
c. Check the slip rings for roughness, cracks, burned or discolored areas and for
deposits of oil, grease or dirt. Check for security and attachment of all components.
d. Check deicer boots for wrinkles, loose or tom areas.
a. Inspect the system for oil leaks, exhaust system leaks, cracks and attachment.
b. Inspect the compressor wheel for nicks, cracks or broken blades and freedom of
movement.
c. Inspect the bypass valve (wastegate) for proper operation and inspect all linkage for
interference, condition, security and attachment.
d. Inspect all exhaust system components for worn or damaged areas, loose clamps,
cracks and leaks.
e. Inspect lubrication system components for worn or damaged areas, loose clamps,
cracks and leaks.
f. Inspect the upper deck pressure reference lines and the fuel injection reference
manifold for loose connections, leaks and possible chafing.
g. Check and calibrate the turbine inlet temperature indicator in accordance with
Chapter 77-00-00.
h. Check manifold pressure controller linkage for wear.
44. ENGINE BAFFLE SEALS Inspect for security and condition at each 100-hour or
45. FILTERS Inspect pressure system in-line filter for condition, cleanliness and security.
Refer to Parker-Hannifin Airbome Service Letter 59 or subsequent. Refer to Chapter
5-10-00 for additional information.
13
A26 5-20-00
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
46. PRESSURE PUMP (Airborne)- Inspect as required by Parker Hannifin Service Letter
43A or Refer to Chapter 5-10-00 for additional information.
subsequent.
PRESSURE PUMP (Aero Accessories Pumps, Part Number AA216CW or AA3216CW)
Initially inspect at 600 hours time-in-service in accordance with Aero Accessories
Service Letter No. 004 and thereafter as directed by the Service Letter. Refer to Chapter
5-10-00 for additional information.
1. SKIN Inspect skins for deformation, cracks and loose or missing rivets. If damage is
found, check adjacent structure.
2. STRUCTURE Check for cracks and deformation. Check for loose or missing rivets and
concealed damage.
3. CABLES, PULLEYS AND TURNBUCKLES Check the flight control components,
cables and pulleys. Replace control system components (pushrods, turnbuckles, end
fittings, castings, etc.) that have bulges, splits, bends, or cracks. Check control cables,
pulleys, and associated equipment for condition, attachment, alignment, clearance and
proper operation. Replace cables that have more than 3 broken strands in any 3-foot
length of cable or evidence of corrosion. Check cables for proper tension.
NOTE: It is important to operate controls through their full range so that the cables move away
from pulleys and all portions of the cables are exposed for inspection.
4. LANDING GEAR GEARBOX AND ACTUATING LINKAGE Check for leakage, wear,
condition and attachment. Check for unusual noise. Remove oil filler plug and check oil
levelby engaging and turning the emergency hand crank 1/2 turn to’deiermine that oil
isbeing picked up on the worm gear. The oil level should be maintained no more than
necessary to cover 1/2 of the diameter of the worm gear. Install oil filler plug.
5. FLAP MOTOR AND SHAFTS Check for condition, security arid wear at all points.
Check drive shaft housing for and check jam nuts for tightness.
security
6. AUXILIARY FUEL PUMP AND FUEL LINES Check for condition, security and leaks.
Check lines for signs of chafing or cracks.
7. BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER AND PARKING BRAKE VALVE Check for condition,
security and leaks. Check lines for signs of chafing or cracks.
8. RUDDER PEDALS Check for freedom of movement. Check cables, push/pull rods,
bellcranks, pulleys, turnbuckles and fair leads for proper routing, condition and security.
Check rudder pedal fore and aft positions for wear. Check locks and pins to ensure
positive lock.
NOTE: It is important to operate controls through their full range so that the cables move away
from pulleys and all portions of the cables are exposed for inspection...
9. CONTROL COLUMN, TRIM CONTROL AND INDICATOR (Electric and Manual)
Check for freedom of movement. Inspect pulleys, sprockets, bearings, actuators, chains
and tumbuckles for condition, security and operation. Check trim indicator for proper
indication.
Sep 5-20-00
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
10. ENGINE CONTROLS Check for ease of operation through full travel. Check friction
locks for proper operation.
11. ELECTRICAL WIRING AND EQUIPMENT Check for condition, security and signs of
chafing.
12. PLUMBING Check all plumbing and connections for security, leakage and general
condition
13. WINDOWS AND DOORS Inspect windows for scratches, crazing and general
condition. Inspect doors for
security of attachment. Check latching mechanism for
proper engagement and ease of operation. Check that rotation of the interior door
handle without depressing the handle lock release button does not unlatch the door.
14. INSTRUMENTS AND INSTRUMENT PANEL Inspect instrument panel, sub panels,
placards and instruments for condition and attachment. Check all knobs for security.
Inspect shock mounts and ground straps for cracks and security.
15. SEATS, SEAT BELTS AND SHOULDER HARNESSES Inspect cabin seats, seat belts
and shoulder harnesses for proper operation, condition and security of attachment.
Inspect floorboards for condition and seat attachment. Check for operation of the seat
stops.
16. OXYGEN SYSTEM Check condition of the oxygen system and check the oxygen
masks for cleanliness and stowage.
17. VENTILATING SYSTEM Check all fresh air and heat outlet vents for proper movement
and operation.
18. FUEL SELECTOR VALVE Inspect for leakage, security, freedom of movement, proper
detent feel and condition. Clean strainer and check for condition. Check for proper
placarding.
19. EMERGENCY EXIT HATCH Check emergency release handle and latch assembly for
proper operation. Check that the hatch moves out freely. Check the complete latch
assembly for condition and all moving parts for proper operation. With the hatch
installed, check for proper latching and seal. Safety the emergency exit with 0.020
inch-diameter copper wire after opening.
20. STATIC SYSTEM Check and drain water from the static lines.
21. CABIN AIR BLOWER Check for condition, mounting security and wear at all points.
22. FUEL STRAINER Drain and clean. On fuel cells with foam inserts, check for brown
foam material. Refer to Safety Communique No. 67 and Service Bulletin No. 2109.
23. CONTROL COLUMN (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389 and After)
Inspect the control column U-joint roll pinb and ensure they are not backing out.
D. WINGS AND CARRY-THROUGH STRUCTURE MECH INSP
LH RH
1. SKIN Check for deformation and obvious damage. Check for cracks, loose or missing
rivets. If damage is found, check adjacent structure. Check for indications of hard
15
.5-20-00
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LH RH
2. STR UCTURE Check for cracks, deformation and concealed damage. Check for loose
or missing rivets. Refer to Chapter 53-10-00 of this Maintenance Manual for inspections
for fuselage web cracks at the fuselage/wing spar carry through area.
3. ACCESS DOORS AND PANELS Inspect for cracks, proper fit and attachment.
NOTE: It is important to operate controls through their full range so that the cables move away
from pulleys and all portions of the cables are exposed for inspection.
5. AILERONS Check for condition and Check for cracks, loose or missing rivets
security.
and freedom of movement. Check hinge bearings and brackets for condition, push/pull
rods for security and rod ends for corrosion.
6. FUEL CELLS, CAPS AND VENTS Inspect fuel cells, caps and vent lines. Refer to
28. Refer to Service Instruction Number 0632-280.
Chapter
7. PLUMBING Check for leakage, chafing, condition and security.
8. ELECTRICAL WIRING AND EQUIPMENT Inspect for chafing, damage, security and
attachment.
9. FLAP LIMIT SWITCHES Check for condition, security and freedom of operation.
10. FLAPS AND ACTUATORS Check for condition, security, binding or chafing of actuator
drive shafts. Check skin and structure for cracks, loose or missing rivets. Check
flap
roller bearings and tracks for condition. Check stop area for condition and damage.
13. WING SPAR CAP Inspect the wing spar cap for corrosion. Refer to Chapter 57. See
Service Bulletin 2538.
14. WING BOLTS Checkwing bolts for proper torque at the first 100-hour inspection and
at the first 1 GO-hour inspection after each reinstallation of the wing attach bolts. Refer to
Chapter 57 of this maintenance manual for wing bolt, nut and fitting inspection criterion
and frequency.
15. RADAR ANTENNA COVER Check the fiberglass for security, attachment and cracks.
16. FUEL VENTS AND AIR INLETS, PITOT TUBE AND STALL WARNING VANE Check
for condition and obstruction.
17. Perform the INSPECTION OF FUEL CELL FLAPPER VALVE procedure. Refer to
Chapter 28-10-00.
1. WHEEL AND TIRE Check wheel for cracks and tire for wear, damage and proper
inflation. Check wheel bearings for condition and wear.
2. LANDING GEAR STRUT Inspect the shock strut and components for cracks,
attachment, proper inflation and evidence of leakage.
3. ACTUATING LINKAGE Check for wear at attach points. Check for cracks and
security.
4. GEAR DOORS AND LINKAGE Check doors for damage and cracks to the structure
and skins. Check linkage for wear and cracks at the attach points. Check for condition
and security.
5. NOSE GEAR STEERING LINKAGE Inspect linkage for tightness, condition and
security. Inspect linkage boots for condition.
6. SHIMMY DAMPER Check for condition and attachment. Check attach points for
cracks. Check fluid level per Chapter 12-20-00.
7. STRUT FLUID LEVEL Check and maintain the proper fluid level in the strut as outlined
in Chapter 12-20-00.
8. STRUT AND A-FRAME HINGE BOLTS Inspect for corrosion and security of
attachment.
9. STATIC CABL~ (If installed) Inspect for condition, proper clearances and attachment.
10. VISUAL INDICATOR Check for condition.
11. NOSE LANDING GEAR DRAG BRACE (P/N 002-820016-31, P/N 002-820018-3, or
with Kit 35-4012-1 Installed) Check that the two drag brace bracket attachment bolts
(Item 22, Figure 4, Chapter 32-20-00) are secure. Check drag brace assembly for shear
stress, wear and corrosion. At 2,000 hours, remove and inspect the two bracket
attachment bolts. Replace all hardware with evidence of shear stress, wear and/or
corrosion.
12. NOSE LANDING GEAR RETRACT ROD ROD-ENDS Check the retract rod rod-ends
for signs of cracking, sheer stress, wear and corrosion.
LH RH
1. BRAKES, LINES, LINING AND DISCS Check for condition, wear and security. Check
lines for chafing and signs of leakage or cracks. Check discs for wear or warping. Check
brake discs for cracks.
2. WHEELS AND TIRES Check wheels for cracks and tires for wear, damage, condition
and proper inflation. Check wheel bearings for condition and wear.
3. ACTUATOR GEARBOX, MOTOR AND SWITCHES Check for leakage, condition and
security.
4. LANDING GEAR STRUTS Inspect the shock struts and components for cracks,
attachment, corrosion, proper inflation and evidence of leakage.
17
n,s 5-20-00
RayNheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LH RH
5. ACTUATING LINKAGE Check for wear and cracks at attach points. Check for
condition and security.
6. GEAR DOORS AND LINKAGE Check doors for damage and cracks to the structure
and skins. Check linkage for and cracks at the attach points. Check for condition
wear
and security. Determine that ail clevis retaining pins are in place and secured with cotter
pins.
7. STRUT FLUID LEVEL Check and maintain the proper hydraulic fluid level in the struts
as outlined in Chapter 12-20-00.
8. STRUT AND A-FRAME HINGE BOLTS Inspect for corrosion and security of
attachment.
CAUTION: Since the battery voltage is not sufficient to properly cycle the landing gear for this
inspection, use only an extemal power source capable of delivering and maintaining
28.25 0.25 vdc to the airplane’s electrical system throughout the extension and
retraction cycles when performing the landing gear retraction inspection. Refer to
Chapter 32 for more specific information on the following items.
1. DOORS Check operation, fit and fair. Check for unusual noise.
2. POSITION LIGHTS Check for security, adjustment and wiring for breaks, condition of
insulation, loose connections and proper indication.
3. WARNING HORN Check for proper operation.
4. UPLOCK CABLE TENSION Check uplock cable mechanism for condition and
security. Check uplock cable for proper tension and for possible fraying.
5. EMERGENCY EXTENSION Check system for freedom of operation. Check for
unusual noise. With thespar cover installed, check for proper engagement of the
emergency extension handle and proper system operation.
6. DOWNLOCK TENSION Check for proper deflection force on the main gear knee
joints.
7. UPLOCK ROLLERS Check condition and clearance of uplock rollers and lubricate as
Page
185-20-00 A26
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LH RH
10. GENERAL OPERATION Place the airplane on jacks and cycle the landing gear while
checking to ascertain that the position light switches operate in conjunction with the
landing gear position. Check the condition and operation of the complete landing gear
system.
11. DYNAMIC BRAKING ACTION Verify proper operation of dynamic brake relay.
12. ASSIST STEP (If Installed) Inspect the retractable step for cable and safety link
condition, proper adjustment and operation. Check fixed link condition, proper
adjustment and operation. Check fixed steps for security.
H. NOSE GEAR OPERATION MECH INSP
CAUTION: Since the battery voltage is not sufficient to properly cycle the landing gear for this
inspection, only an external power source capable of delivering and maintaining
use
28.25;t 0.25 vde to the airplane’s electrical system throughout the extension and
retraction cycles when performing the landing gear retraction inspection. Refer to
Chapter 32 for more specific information on the following items.
1. DOORS Check operation, fit and fair. Check for unusual noise.
2. NOSE GEAR UP TENSION Check the up tension on the nose gearas indicated in
RIGGING THE LANDING GEAR in Chapter 32-30-00.
3. DOWNLOCK TENSION Check the downlock tension on the nose gear as indicated in
RIGGING THE LANDING GEAR in 32-30-00.
4. GENERAL OPERATION Place the airplane on jacks and cycle the landing gear while
checking to ascertain that theposition light switches operate in conjunction with the
landing gear position. Check the condition and operation of the complete landing gear
system.
5. VISUAL INDICATOR Inspect for proper adjustment and operation.
6. NOSE GEAR STEERING Check for condition and security.
I. REAR FUSELAGE AND EMPENNAGE
1. SKIN Check for deformation, cracks and obvious damage. Check for loose or missing
rivets. Ifdamage is found, check adjacent structure.
2. INTERNAL FUSELAGE STRUCTURE Check for cracks and deformation. Check for
loose or missing rivets. Check bulkheads, door posts, stringers and doublers for
corrosion, cracks and buckles.
3. STRUCTURE Inspect the two most aft bulkheads for cracks, distortion, loose rivets or
other obvious damage.
19
A26 5-20-00
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: It is important to operate controls through their full range so that the cables move away
from pulleys and all portions of the cables are exposed for inspection.
5. CONTROL SURFACES Check for deformation, cracks and security. Check for loose
or missing rivets. Check for freedom of movement. Check for security of hinges and
bond cables. Check the inboard elevator hinge casting ton the aft bulkhead) for cracks
in mounting~bolt holes.
6. TRIM TABS AND ACTUATORS Check for security and wear. Check free
play per
Chapter.27-30-00. Check hinges and trim tab actuators for security and wear. Check.
trim tabs for cracks and control rods for-attachment. Lubricate trim tab hinges per
Chapter 12-20-00.
b. Check that the ruddervator trim tab and hinge pin are correctly mated. Refer to
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB INSTALLATION, Chapter 27-21-00.
c. Check for cracks on the trim tab hinge support channel.
d. Check the stabilizer front and rear spar attach points for cracks and looseness.
13. RUDDER FORWARD SPAR (CE-748, CE-n2 thru CE-1425; CJ-149 thru CJ-179;
E-llll, E-1241 thru E-2518; EA-11 thru EA-500 and airplanes that have not installed
Kit 33-6001-1 Refer to Service Bulletin No. 2333 every 500 flight hours or annually.
14. RUDDER FORWARD SPAR (CE-1426 and After; CJ-180 and After; E-2519 and After;
I I EA-501 and After and airplanes that have installed Kit 33-6001-1 Open inspection
covers adjacentto the upper and center hinges. Inspect ribs, spar, hinges and all rudder
components in area of the hinges for attachment security, cracks and general condition
using a flashlight and mirror. Install covers.
J.GENERAL
Page
peS02
30/04 5-20-00 nze
Ra~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
3. Inspect all placards to ensure that they are easily readable and securely attached.
4. Ensure that all Airworthiness Directives, Raytheon Aircraft Service Bulletins and I I
previously issued Service Instructions are reviewed and complied with as required.
5. For a complete or annual inspection of the airplane, all items on the airplane that are
noted in this guide should be inspected.
21
pas 5-20-00Page
RaytheOn AiKraft Campany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
This subchapter is assembled in chart form to allow a technician to perform checks for damage after operating the
airplane in conditions which could require unscheduled maintenance. Specific conditions, such as lightning strikes,
turbulent air penetration or hard landings, etc., are included. Inspection instructions are included for each of the
conditions listed.
WARNING: During the performance of these inspections the airplane could be placed on three-point jacks.
Ensure the landing gear is down and locked before removing the airplane from the jacks.
Propeller Governor The propeller governors should be overhauled After sudden engine stoppage.
or replaced as instructed in the manufacturer’s
manuals.
Nose Landing Gear Shock Clean off and wipe dry exposed polished Routine.
Strut surfaces.
Alternate Air Door Ensure door is sealed around all edges and Routine.
there is adequate spring tension on the door.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging the barometric sensor, disconnect the autopilot sensor line prior to applying
reverse air pressure to the pitot and static lines.
Pitot and Static Lines Check for obstructions by applying reverse air 200 hours or as required.
pressure (not to exceed 20 psi) to the ends of
the pitot and static lines with them
disconnected from the instruments.
Floor Structure Check structure under the floor for corrosion At a scheduled inspection.
by removing a floor panel and inspection the
structure, especially the channel sections.
Aft Cabin Remove aft cabin access covers and inspect At a scheduled inspection.
for corrosion, especially aft of bulkhead points.
Wing Remove wing and center section access At a scheduled inspection.
covers and check forcorrosion.
Empennage Remove all fuselage access covers and check At a scheduled inspection.
for corrosion.
1
n2e .5-50-00Page
Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINIENANCE MANUAL
Wing Check torque of the wing attach bolts. After the first 100 hours and at the
first 100 hours after adjustment of
the wing.
LANDING GEAR
d. Wheel Wells Clean foreign material (dirt, etc.) from wheel As required.
wells. Inspect supports between main and aft
spars in upper wheel well and the lift leg attach
bracket at the main spar for deformation,
cracks, etc.
Page
25-50-00 AZS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i
e. Actuator Linkage Check for excessive play, safety and security. I Every 100 hours.
f. Shimmy Damper Inspect for condition and attachment. Every 100 hours. I I
INSPECTION AFTER HARD LANDING I I
Perform the following: As applicable. I I
NOTE: This inspection should be carried out after
a landing hard airplane and before the
as ready is certified for
further flight. The inspections are conducted at two levels. The first level consists of determining if any
external damage has occurred and looking for evidence of internal structural failure. The second level is
concerned with a more detailed inspection of any damaged areas which were indicated in the findings of
the first level inspection. If it is determined by the first level inspection that there is no damage to the
airplane, it is not necessary to proceed to the second level inspection.
WARNING: Even though wrinkles in the wing or fuselage skin surface may be slight enough to be
considered negligible,
as a close inspection of the internal supporting structure may reveal
serious damage.
FIRST LEVEL INSPECTION Prior to next flight.
General Appearance Determine that the airframe components
(wings, fuselage and empennage) are in their
normal configuration.
I
wear,
the tread, bottoming out or folding over the
sidewalls.
2. Checkthewheels (rims)forflatspotsor
cracked castings. I
3. shock struts and attachment
for cracks.Check lugs
I
4. Inspect hydraulic brake lines for leaks.
5. Inspectnosedrag legsandgeardoor
retract linkage for damage.
i
5-so-oo
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
7. Inspect around
landing
I .stnioph
area
catta gear
7. Inspectwheelwell structurefordamage or
Page
45-50-00
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
5. Removeand replaceormagnafluxthe
landing gear attach bolts, check bolt holes
for cracks or elongation.
6. Remove and replace or magnaflux drag
link bolts and supports.
5
nae 5-so-ooPage
Ral~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENAN~E MANUAL
REPAIR OF DAMAGE
Due to the variety and degree damage which may be involved, the best repair of replacement
of structural
procedure must be based on the findings airplane. If the hard landing inspection indicates that
of the individual
serious structural damage has occurred, contact Raytheon Technical Support, Raytheon Aircraft Company,
Wichita, KS 67201 for assistance.
Followingahardlanding inspection, an entry covering the extent of inspection, the damage and the repair (if
applicable) must be noted in the airplane permanent records.
6
egaP. 5-50-00
Sep 30/04 A26
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
inspection that there is no damage to the airplane, it is not necessary to proceed to the second level
inspection.
FIRST LEVEL INSPECTION Prior to next flight.
WARNING: Even though wrinkles in the wing or fuselage skin surface may be slight enough to be
considered negligible,
as a close inspection of the internal supporting structure may reveal
serious damage.
General Appearance Determine that the airframe components
(wings, fuselage and empennage) are in their
normal configuration.
Wing Carry-thru Structure 1. Inspect the external skin surface for
cracks, abnormal stress wrinkles and
loose or missing rivets.
4. Inspectenginecontrol cablesforsmooth
operation and check plumbing and wiring
for security and attachment.
5. Inspectstructure inwheelwellfordamage
or cracks.
7
5-50-00 SepPa~g&bi:Page
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
2. Inspectwing attachmentfittingsfor
cracks.
2. Checktheempennage surfacesfor
damage and free movement.
damage.
3. Operational test plumbing and wiring.
3. Operationaltestthe plumbingandwiring,
flap actuator, aileron and tab control
cables and pulley mounting.
9
5-50-00 Sep 30104Page
Rayrheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE ~IANUAL
REPAIR OF DAMAGE
Following a turbulent air inspection, an entry covering the extent of inspection, the damage and the repair (if
applicable) must be noted in the permanent records.
11
s-so-oo
C H A PT E R
DIMENSIONS
AND AREAS
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 6
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION i
SUBJECT SUBJECT i PAGE
"END"
6EFFECTIVTTY/CONTENTS
Paacl
Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
26’8"
8’3"
6’5" P~ lr~
33’6"
O o
’OPTIONAL RADAR
12’2"
7’ DIA
9’7" 1 rii.toi.ic
6-00-00
Pagel
A5 Feb 18/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
76’5
T
6’7"
cn
c:e
j 7’7"
33’6"
O I h\ o
’OPTIONAL RADAR
10’6"
7’ DIA
9’7"--------1
s-00-00
Page2
Oct 10/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
26’8"
23 .CI~S ra 8’J"
6’7"
1_L!
L 7.5.. MINIMVMCL~RPINCE
33’6"
WING AREA:
181.0 SO.FT.
O I M /H\I o
12’2"
7’
9’7
r as´•
6.a’
7.5" MINIMUM CLEARANCE, 9.5’’ E-1946. E-2104. E-2111 AND 4FTER -a,
33’6"-
Ss t
t ~k
*OPTIONAL RADAR
12’2"
t t
t9’7" A36607- 33
M~-OO
Page3
A6 Oc17/83
BONANZA SERIES
MAlNTENANCE MANUAL
29.5
27 FT;G´•INi’
~I le FT;5 IN.
6Fr.’61N.
a
2.5"
33 FT. 6 IN.
VERTICAL
STABIUZER
’OPTIONAL RADAR
12 FT. 2 IN.
80 IN. DIA.
9 FT. 7 IN.
A36TC-607-20
2.5’
37 FT. 10IN.
t
Jg t THE FIXED TAB IS REPLACED BY A
CONTAOLLABLE TAB ON LEFT AILERON
AT SERIALS EA320. EA-389 AND
g
AFTER
VERTICAL
STABILIZER
12 FT. 2 IN.t
29.5
8 FT. 5 IN.
6-OM)O
Page5
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFI
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Yi( /I ~04.90
1_1 I I I ._Lu I 11 1_1_1 1 1111
w.L.
88;1
79.362~-
201.00
246.30
233.50
I m!lu
256.90 297.00
VERTICAL STABILIZER
272.000
251.606
3.500
i~26-----
i i
15.250 I I I
38.4032
25.500
36~1J
36.900 23.06
46.000 1311
ss.25o~\-( I I 0.000
7525
72.500
175.837 ~48.815
/W 23.881
iTi
191.00 162563 136.188
imll
WING
U
108981 80.b47 53.d00 1
122.750 94.864 45.000
336036
36.030
6-00-00
Page 6
Jan 20/82 A4
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MANmNANCE MANUAL
33.345
82.53~W.L
88.1
I,,!,
246.30
207.00 233.50 256.90 297.00
4.50
1815
39.50
12125 23~25
68.00
58.50
83.090
100.00
I17.87 152.250
170.00 FUSELAGE
112138 131.00 179.00
CL OF AIRPLANE
M REAR SP
36.15
3.900
I
191.00 162.563 136.1 88
WING
U
108.281 80.b47 53.d00 I
175.294 122.150 94.864 45.000 Ireo~r
36.030
s;ot-0o
Page 7
A4 Jan 20/82
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
148.15
68.00 100.00
1(B~rs 14Gm
I’55.00 179.00 207.00 233.50
23.345 48.50 257.606
j/
272.00
8.25 31.172
-10.00
100.00
O.dOO ’9.25
39.OF 58.00 83.00 ~12.138
ibm 170.00
NSELAGE
1.245
39.375
31.75
83´•547 66.00 53.00
188~5 122.75 103.641
ll.m
r23.881
175.281 1303
1191" 91091
Islm
272.00
257.606
3.50
162’.563 1 I ~-C I I 1 7
136.188
108.281
80.047
MODELS F33A, F33C, V35B, A36, A36TC 15.00
23.81
36.15
WING I I 1 ~36.90
31.75
55.25
103.M1 83.Y7 66.00 53-00 39.375( 23.p81
1"8875 1P75 47.00
198.Wa (7528( 113.172 94.094 73.00
2((.11 ~36.188 66.55-- .525
162.563
HORIZOHTAL STABIUZER
~iY
162.563
136.188
108.28(
80.047
38d03-8
45.00
MODEL B36TC 23.81
&0090 "END"
PageB
Jan 20/82 A4
CHAPTER
LIFTING AND
SHORING
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES ~iAINiEi\lANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
7-00-00
Jacking ..........1
Main Wheel Jacking
Hoisting ......3
1
7-CONTENTS Sep 30/03Page
RBYtheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
f
A24 7-LOEP Sep 30/03Page
RBythdMI Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
JACKING
I WbRNING)
WARNING
The landing gear struts do not incorporate internal stops. When the airplane is on jacks, do I
not attempt to remove the torque knees, the torque knee pins or the bolt connecting the
torque I<nees without first deflating the shock absorber assembly and supporting the gear.
The torque knees provide the extension stop for the lower shock absorber assembly. When
they are disconnected, the cylinder is free to slide out of the upper assembly.
I CAUTION 1
Jacking the landing gear should only be accomplished within an enclosed building or hangar.
Should it become necessary to jack the airplane in the open, no more than one jack point should I
be utilized at a time. For safety of personnel and the airplane, wind velocity in any direction must be
considered prior to jacking the airplane.
a a
E~09B
991 656AA
1
pas 7-00-00 Sep 30/03Page
Rayfheen nircraff Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I A three point jack is used to lift the airplane off the ground (Ref. Figure 1). Each
jack pad is identified and located
on the underside of the fuselage. One jack pad is located on each of the lower wing-to-fuselage attachment fittings
along the front spar. The rear jack fitting consists of an eye bolt that is screwed completely into the airplane.
I WARNING
W6~RNING)
Be sure jack point safety is in place and secured to prevent the airplane from nosing
the rear
over. As an additional
precaution against nosing over, attach, but not suspend, a weight of
approximately 200 pounds to the aft tie-down lug.
When one wing is to be removed, a stand should be placed under the opposite wing and the tail to counteract the
resulting unbalanced condition of the airplane.
I cnlmou
CAUTION I
Do not walk on the wing walk with the airplane on the main wheeljack.
I The main wheel jack adapter P/N 35-590006, is supplied as optional equipment (Ref. Figure 2). Before raising the
airplane, be sure the shock strut is properly inflated to the correct height. If the strut is not inflated to the
I recommended height, it will be impossible to insert the jack adapter into the main wheel axle. A scissor type jack is
recommended for individual wheel jacking.
E~Yose
941657AA
CAUTION I
I cnvTloN
When lowering the airplane, caution should be exercised to prevent the shock strut from becoming
compressed and forcing the landing gear door against the jack adapter.
HOISTING
a. Install the hoisting sling fitting, P/N 35-590067, at each upper forward wing attach bolt location using bolts
of the proper length with 5/8-18UNF threads.
b. Attach the hoisting sling assembly, P/N 35-590064-1, to the hoisting sling fittings (Ref. Figure 3).
NOTE
Adjust the strap assembly to keep the airplane in a level or slightly nose down attitude.
e. As an added precaution, a stand may be installed under the tail of the airplane.
I CAUTION I
A spreader must be used above the cabin to prevent damaging the door moulding and window
frame.
If the airplane must be hoisted and the hoisting sling assembly, P/N 35-590064-1, is not available, remove the
cabin door, the left front window and the front seats. Attach a sling to the front wing spar in the fuselage and a line
to the hoist fitting on the engine.
3
~a4 7-00-00 Sep 30/03Page
Raytheon Airc~raft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
EF~07B
031473F(A
LEVE LING AN D
VV EIGHING
BEECHCRATT
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 8
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
8-00-00 1
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTERI
SECTION I
GENERAL 8-00-00
Maintenance Practices .....´•...i
l.......1
Leveling .........i
.......1
"END"
&EFFECTIVITV/CONTENTS
Pag´•l
M´•y 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
GENERAL- MAINTENANCE PRACTICES the center of a second phillips head screw directly below.
Suspending the plumb bob in a can of light engine oil will
LEI/ELING assist in stabilizing it.
To level theairplane longitudinally, attach a cord and plumb Lateral leveling is accomplished by removing the front seat(s)
bob to the phillips head screw, located beneath the rear and pladng a bubble level on the spar carry thru structure.
window on the left side of the airplane. Inflate or deflate the Deflate the tire or strut on the high side of the airplane to
nose gear shock strut as necessary to pass the cord through center the bubble.
"END"
800-00
Page 1
May 9/80
c HAPT E R
TOVVING AND
TAXIING
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENAN~E i\iiA~UAL
TABLF OF CONTFNTS
9-00-00
Towing
One Person Towing
Towing With a Tractor or Tug
Taxiing
"END"
9-CONTENTS
Page 1
Ale Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 9
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
O-EFFECTIVIN
Page 1
A16 Ocl 16I92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CAUTION
to the strut.
TOWING WITH A TRACTOR OR TUG
damage
To tow the airplane with a tractor or tug, attach the
NOTE
tow bar (P/N 45-590075) to the tow pins on the nose
gear lower torque knee. Always observe the turn
The top of the cabin door should not be limits of the nose gear when making turns. Turns
used as a handhold while entering or
geater than these limits can cause extensive damage
leaving the cabin. Always open the storm to the nose gear and shimmy damper. Also, exercise
window to relieve internal pressure when when the tow bar from the
care removing gear nose
closing the door. Never leave the cabin lower torque knee to prevent damage to the lubri-
door open on the ramp as wind gusts may cation fittings on the torque knee.
damage the door.
NOTE
ONE PERSON TOWING
Do not attempt to tow the airplane back-
TAXIING
One person can move the airplane easily on a
smooth and level surface with the tow bar (P/N The airplane must be taxied with the wing naps up,
36-590015) furnished with the airplane. Attach the tow and the engine cowl naps open. Turning may be
bar to the tow pins on the nose gear lower torque accomplished by the use of the nose wheel steering
knee and push or pull gently to move the airplane. mechanism.
"END"
9-00-00
Page 1
A16 Oct 16192
C H A PT E R
PARKING,
MOORING
STO RAG E j
RTN TO SVC.
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
10-00-00
Parking
Moo~ng................................................................................1
Normal Tie-down
Extended Storageand HighW~nd ..................1
ControlLock................................................................. ...........1
Storage
Flyable Storage -7 to 30 Days. ........._____ .........___..__
.2
Temporary Storage 30 to 90 Days .................3
Indefinite Storage
Preparation forService. .......5
1
~O-CONTENTS Mar 31/05Page
PaYMfaayl Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1
A27 1 O-LOEP Mar 31/05Page
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
PARKING
The brakes are set for parking by pulling out the parking brake control, then pressing the pilot’s brake pedals until
firm. Do not attempt to lock the parking brake by applying force to the parking brake handle; it controls a valve only
and cannot apply pressure to the brake master cylinders.
CA UTION: Do not set the parking brake control when the brakes are hot from severe use or during low temperature
when an accumulation of moisture may cause the brakes to freeze. An increase in outside air
temperature can build up excessive pressure in the system. In addition, the parking brake should be left
OFF and wheel chocks installed if the airplane is to be left unattended.
MOORING
This section is designedprovide guidelines which can be followed when mooring and securing Bonanza series
to
airplanes. Mooring procedures for normal tie-down operations as well as mooring for extended storage and high
wind conditions follow:
NORMAL TIE-DOWN
On Bonanza series airplanes, a tie-down lug is installed on each wing, and on the aft fuselage. The tie-downs should
be nylon or dacron ropes or chains with sufficient strength to restrain the airplane in high or gusty winds. Manila or
hemp ropes should never be used; The tie-downs should allow very little or no movement when tightened, too much
slack will allow the airplane to jerk against the tie-downs. When securing the tail section of the airplane, the tie-down
should have a slight slack so that the nose of the airplane will not be raised off the ground. In a strong headwind, a
tail tie-down that is too tight will increase the angle between the wing and the oncoming air. This creates an
additional lifting force, which causes more pressure to be placed on the wing tie-down ropes and anchors. Adequate
antislip knots such as bowlines or square knots should be used when securing the lines.
Securing operations should be planned so the airplane is tied down facing the prevailing wind, if the ground
attachment permits. Once the airplane has been positioned into the wind, the wheels should be checked fore and
aft. The flight control surfaces must then be secured to prevent banging against the stops. The controls should be
secured in position with control locks that are installed in the control column. When mooring, be sure to fasten all
doors and windows properly. Pitot-static tubes should be covered.
When mooring the Bonanza, the following method is recommended: Place chocks fore and aft of each main wheel.
Position a tail stand under the tail skid, adjusting the height of the stand to slightly compress the nose gear shock
strut. Run a line through each wing mooring lug, fastening each end to a ground point, one forward and one aft of
the wing. Run a line through the hole in the tail skid and anchor at the sides of the airplane approximately 5 feet from
the base of the stand. If a storm is anticipated, two lines may be secured to each main landing gear strut barrel near
the V-brace and also a line may be attached around the nose gear strut near the lower torque knee. It is
recommended that the airplane be tied down headed into the wind, with the control lock installed.
1
nz~ 10’00’00
Ral~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CONTROL LOCK
A control column lock pin is provided for the control column and the aileron control wheel. The lock pin secures both
the aileron control wheel and the elevator control. A cover isprovided on the control lock to cover the throttle control,
boost pump, and the propeller control. Install the control lock assembly in the following sequence:
a. Rotate the control wheel to the right and move the column forward so the hole in the bracket and the column
align to accept the pin.
b. Push the control column lock pin through the hole provided in the control column guide and into the control
column.
c. Ensure positive retention of the lock pin by placing the cover assembly over the throttle control, boost pump,
and the propeller control.
WARNING: Always completely remove the control lock assembly before engine start, taxiing, and flight.
STORAGE
The storage procedures listed are intended to protect the airplane from deterioration while it is not in use. The
primary objectives of these measures are to prevent corrosion and damage from exposure to the elements. Three
types of storage are considered:
c. INDEFINITE STORAGE.
a. MOORING- If the airplane cannot be placed in a hangar, install the control lock and tie the airplane down
securely at the three points provided. Do not use hemp or manila rope. It is recommended a tail support be used
to compress the nose strut and reduce the angle of attack of the wings. Attach a line to the nose gear.
b. ENGINE PREPARATION FOR STORAGE- Engines in airplanes that are flown only occasionally tend to exhibit
cylinder wall corrosion much more than engines that are flown frequently.
i. Check for correct oil level and add oil if necessary to bring level to full mark
2. Run engine at least five minutes at 1,200 to 1,500 rpm with oil and cylinder head temperatures in the normal
operating range.
WARNING: Before rotation of propeller blades, ascertain magneto switch is OFF, throttle in CLOSED
position and mixture control is in the IDLE CUT-OFF position. Always stand in the clear while
turning propeller.
c. DURING FLYABLE STORAGE- Each seven days during flyable storage, the propeller shall be rotated by hand.
After rotating the engine six revolutions, stop the propeller 60 to 120" from the position it was in.
Page
2~0-00-00 A27
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
d. FUEL CELLS- Fill to capacity to minimize fuel vapor and protect cell inner liners.
h. WINDSHIELD AND WINDOWS- Close all windows and window vents. It is recommended that covers be
installed over windshield and windows.
i. PREPARATION FOR SERVICE- Remove all tape, clean the airplane and give it
covers and a thorough
inspection, particularly wheel wells, flaps, and control openings.
1. If the eng ine has a total time of more than 25 hours and the oil consumption has stabilized, drain the break-in
oil after a ground warm-up and install oil per Teledyne Continental Motors Specification MHS-24C.
2. Preflightthe airplane.
a. MOORING-SeeFLYABLE STORAGE.
b. ENGINE PREPARATION FOR STORAGE- Operate engine (Preferably in Right) until oil temperature reaches
normal range. Drain oil supply from sump while engine is still warm and replace drain plug.
1. Fill the sump to the full mark on dipstick gage with corrosion preventive oil (3, Chart 1, 91-00-00), which
the
will mix with normal oil and provide protection against corrosion.
2. Remove the top spark plug and atomize spray preservative oil (4, Chart 1, 91-00-00) at room temperature,
through the upper spark plug hole of each cylinder with piston in the down position. Rotate crankshaft as
each pair of cylinders is sprayed. Stop crankshaft with no piston at top position, and thoroughly respray each
cylinder. Reinstall spark plugs.
3. Apply preservative to engine interior by spraying the above specified oil (approximately two ounces) through
the oil filler tube. Seal all engine openings exposed to the atmosphere using suitable plugs, or moisture
resistant tape, and attach red streamers at each point. Affix a tag to the propeller in a conspicious place with
the following notation; DO NOT TURN PROPELLER, ENGINE PRESERVED. Seal the propeller blade
spinner cutouts with tape.
c. FUEL CELLS- Fill to capacity to minimize fuel vapor and protect cell inner liners.
g. WINDSHIELD AND WINDOWS- Close all windows and window vents. It is recommended cover be installed
over windshield and windows.
3
A27 1 0-00-00 Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i. PREPARATION FOR SERVICE- Remove all covers, tape, and tags. Clean the airplane and thorough give it a
INDEFINITE STORAGE
a. MOORING-SeeFLYABLE STORAGE.
ENGINE PREPARATION FOR INDEFINITE STORAGE- Drain the engine oil and service with corrosion
I preventive
1.
oil
Immediately
exceed a
(3, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
2. It is recommended the propeller be removed and the engine removed from the airplane. The propeller shaft
should be coated with preservative oil (4, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and wrapped with moisture proof material and
tape.
NOTE: If engine is removed from the airplane, a tail mooring stand must be used.
1 3. Remove the top spark plug from each cylinder and spray thoroughly with corrosion preventive oil (3, Chart
1, 91-00-00), at a temperature range of 221 to 250"F.
4. Install protex plugs in each of the top spark plug holes, making sure that each plug is blue in color when
installed. Protect and support the spark plug leads with AN-4060~1 protectors.
5. Place a bag of desiccant in the exhaust pipes and seal openings with moisture resistant tape.
6. Seal cold air inlet to the heater muff with moisture resistant tape.
7. Seal engine breather by inserting a protex plug in the breather hose and clamping in place.
8. Wrap engine with moisture proof material and tape after desiccant bags have been installed.
9. Attach a red streamer to each place on the engine where bags of desiccant are placed. Either attach red
streamers outside of the sealed area with tape or to the inside of sealed area with safety wire to prevent
wicking of moisture into sealed area.
10. If the propeller has not been removed, affix a tag in a conspicuous place with the following notation: DO
NOT TURN PROPELLER- ENGINE PRESERVED.
c. DURING INDEFINITE STORAGE- The cylinder protex plugs shall be inspected weekly. The plugs should be
changed as soon as their color indicates unsafe conditions of storage. If the dehydrator plugs have changed
color in one-half or more of the cylinders, all desiccant material on the engine should be replaced.
I 1. The cylinder bores should be resprayed with corrosion preventive oil every six months or more frequently if
bore inspection indicates corrosion has started. Replace all desiccant and protex plugs. Before spraying,
the engine shall be inspected for corrosion as follows: Inspect the interior of at least one cylinder on the
engine through a spark plug hole. If cylinder shows start of-rust, spray cylinder with corrosion preventive oil
(3, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and turn prop over five or six times, then respray. Remove the rocker box cover from
the engine and inspect the valve mechanism.
d. PROPELLER- Coat blades with preservative oil and wrap with moisture proof material and tape. If propeller has
been removed, coat all parts with protective material to exclude dust, and then tape.
Page
42e,f 11 0-00-00 A27
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1. Flush, spray, or rub a thin coating of light engine oil on the inner liners of all fuel cells which have contained
gasoline.
2. After 24 hours, remove cells and store according to standard practices. Do not remove or handle fuel cells
until 24 hours after oil has been applied.
f. FLIGHT CONTROL SURFACES- Lubricate all flight control surface hinge pins, bearings, bellcranks, chains,
control rods and quadrants and coat lightly with corrosion preventive compound (5, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
h. PITOT TUBE- Apply a thin coating of grease (6, Chart 1, 91-00-00), and install cover.
i. WINDSHIELD AND WINDOWS- Close all windows and window vents and install covers over windshield and
windows.
j. LANDING GEAR- Coat the extended portion of the shock struts with light weight oil.
I. WING FLAP TRACKS AND ROLLERS- Coat with corrosion preventive compound. Place flaps in retracted
position.
n. INSTRUMENT PANEL- Cover with barrier material and secure with tape.
p. LANDING LIGHTS- Cover with barrier material and secure with tape.
q. STALL WARNING UNIT- Remove and store according to standard practices. Tape connections.
r. LOOSE TOOLS AND EQUIPMENT- Remove and store in a dry temperate room.
s. AIRFRAME- Cover static ports and all openings with barrier material and secure with tape to exclude rain, sun,
and foreign matter.
b. Remove all cylinder plugs and all paper, tape, and dehydrating agent used to preserve engine.
c. Drain corrosion preventive oil and reservice with recommended lubricating oil, per Teledyne Continental Motors
MHS-24C.
d. Reinstall the propeller if it was removed. Rotate propeller to clear excess preservative oil from the cylinders.
e. Install the spark plugs, battery, and rotate propeller by hand through all compressions of the engine check for
liquid lock. Reinstallcowling and start engine in the normal manner.
f. Give the airplane a thorough cleaning, visual inspection and test fly the airplane.
5
nlr 10’00’00
CHAPTER
PLACARDS AND
MAR KI NGS
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER PLACARDS
TABLF OF CONTFNTS
11-00-00
11-20-00
"END"
11-CONTENTS
Page 1
A16 Oct 16192
BEE6Hi=RAFf
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 11
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
11-EFFECTIVITY
Page 1
Ale Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
"END"
11-00-00
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
EXTERIOR PLACARDS AND MARKINGS followed by locationldescription of each. The placards which
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION follow areshown for location only and may or may not bear
identical information to the placards installed on the various
individual models. Note the specific information on the
Shown in this Chapter are exterior placards and markings, placards installed on each model to determine current
which are essential for good maintenance practices, information for that model.
IINSTALL
ILINK ROD
DOORIACK
BOLT; ATTACH POINrl
WITH
1"
LOCATED IN THE CENTER OF THE UNDERSIDE
OF THE FUSELAGE AT APPROXIMATELY FS 131.00
LOCATED ON THE OUTBOARD SIDE OF THE
ROOT RIB IN THE WHEEL WELL, VISIBLE
ABOVE THE INBOARD DOOR
-CAVTION-
TURN LIMTTS REACHED
WHEN RED LINES ALIGN
DO NOTEXCEED I r--
I
TOW IJACK PADI
L________1
IMPORTANT
INSTALL UPLOCK
CABLE ATTACH BOLT
WITH HEAD AFT
11-20-00
Page i
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENAhjCE MANUAL
ASSEMBLY AND FILL WITH HYDRAULIC OIL I I YLIIU*I vKnc´•1IOWr, ILOWL* crm rr,m rO I I 1Ulm.fUln U.´•.M
CONFORMING TO INS~RVCTION MANUAL I IOlIILICl I,lnto´•l, YNIII*ODI11ON- I IIUWIO1*t*r~DTCDIDtlO´•´•C´•
SPECIFICATIONS. SLOWLY EY~ND STR~r I I LL 011CINN0111DDtD WI1W ITIU1IXnND(D I I WARNING
FROM BLOCKED POSITION AND REPLACE ~tlllCt VILY( IODI lrr~ DrIllII V´•LVICOII I I rrwru*rnul´•r~
~ND COY)LIIII~ COYIIII) Il´•U1 10 Itltll(
VALVE BODY ~SSEYBLY. DEPRESS VALVE
IXCtl(´•LIIYDOIL
CORE AND COMPLETELY COMPRESS
S~RLIT TO RELEASE U(CESS AIR AND OIL. I I *n~u ´•n~wr ur* rxcm rot RII1 H)tl *K)
mTH AIRPLANE EMPTY UCEPT FOR FULL 011 IINI ITIUT INRlnD 10 1 INCI(B Or mTOW
LOCATED ON THE RIGHT MAIN
FUEL AND OIL KEEP STRUT INFLATED T03n I IIwowlm
INCHES OF PISTON SHOWING. LANDING GEAR STRUT
WARNING
RELEASE AIR IN STRUT BEFORE WARNING
DlsAssEueuNo I ’auY ill ill rIlul awwr DIIIIWI1II1G
UWlm.UPnU*rULNLUOa
I~LL*Y T´•CIU U UDOI´•IIT*
C9101~42
11-20-00
Page 2
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTICE
WING BOLTS ARE LUBRICATED
SEE MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FOR CORRECT TOROUE VALUES
r
i
EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER SWITCH EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER
I SWITCH
O O
FOR AVIATION EMERGENCY USEONLY. FOR AVIATION EMERGENCY USE ONLY.
UNLICENSED OPERATION UNLAWFUL. I UNLICENSED OPERATION UNLAWFUL.
OPERATION IN VIOLATION OF FCC I OPERATION IN VIOLATION OF FCC
RULES SUBJECT TO FINE OR LICENSE I RULES SUBJECT TO FINE OR LICENSE
REVOCATION. REVOCATION.
L________----------l L__________________I
LOCATED ON THE RIGHT SIDE OF THE FUSELAGE LOCATED ON THE RIGHT SIDE OF THE FUSELAGE
FORWARD AND BELOW THE STABILIZER FORWARD AND BELOW THE STABILIZER ON
ON AIRPLANES: EA-1 AND EA-2; CE-748, CE-772 AIRPLANES: D-10197 THRU D-10346; EA-3 THRU
THRU CE-828; E-llll, E-1241 THRU EA-80; E-1407 THRU E-1686: CE-829 THRU
E-1406, D-10097, D-10120 THRU D-10196 AND CE-905 AND CJ-150 THRU CJ-155 EXCEPT
AIRPLANES WITH KITS 101-3046 OR
CJ-149 EXCEPT AIRPLANES WITH
101-3127 INSTALLED.
KITS 101-3046 OR 101-3127 INSTALLED.
r-----------------I
EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER
-1
SWITCH I SWITCH
FOR AVIATION EMERGENCY USE ONLY. I I FOR AVIATION EMERGENCY USE ONLY.
UNLICENSED OPERATION UNLAWFUL. I UNLICENSED OPERATION UNLAWFUL.
OPERATION IN VIOLATION OF FCC I I OPERATION IN VIOLATION OF FCC
RULES SUBJECT TO FINE OR LICENSE i I RULES SUBJEdT TO FINE OR LICENSE
REVOCATION. i I REVOCATION.
L____-__-----__---J L _ _ __ __
_´•_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _
_I
LOCATED ON THE RIGHT SIDE OF THE FUSELAGE LOCATED ON THE RIGHT SIDE OF THE
FORWARD AND BELOW THE STABILIZER FUSELAGE FORWARD AND BELOW THE STABILIZER
ON AIRPLANES D;10347 AND AFTER; ON AIRPLANES: E-2148 THRU E-2423; EA-412
EA-81 THRU EA-411: E-1687 THRU E-2147, THRU EA-479, CE-1033 THRU CE-1240 AND
CE-906 THRU CE-1032 AND AIRPLANES WITH CJ-156 THRU CJ-ljS EXCEPT AIRPLANES
KIT NO. 101-3046 EXCEPT AIRPLANES WITH WITH KITS 101-3046 OR 101-3127 INSTALLED.
KIT NO. 101-3127 INSTALLED. C9200973
11-20-00
Page 3
Ai6 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
NIAINTENANCE WIANUAL
r---------------------------- r-----------------------------1
EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER I EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER
SWITCH I SWITCH
ARMEDI
TEST ARM XMIT ON
RESET
O i
FOR AVIATION EMERGENCY USE ONLY. FOR AVIATION EMERGENCY USE ONLY.
UNLICENSED OPERATION UNLAWFUL. I UNLICENSED OPERATION UNLAWFUL.
OPERATION IN VIOLATION OF FCC I OPERATION IN VIOLATION OF FCC
RULES SUBJECT TO FINE OR LICENSE I i RULES SUBJECT TO FINE OR LICENSE
REVOCATION. REVOCATION.
L t--______________~
LOCATED ON THE RIGHT SIDE OF THE FUSELAGE LOCATED ON THE RIGHT SIDE OF THE FUSELAGE
FORWARD AND BELOW THE STABILIZER ON FORWARD AND BELOW THE STABILIZER ON
AIRPLANES: CE-1241 THRU CE-1646; E-2424 AIRPLANES: CE-1647 AND AFTER; E-2694
THRU E-2693 AND EA-480 THRU EA-530 AND AFTER; EA-531 AND AFTER AND
EXCEPT AIRPLANES WITH KIT 101-3127 AIRPLANES WITH KIT 101-3127 INSTALLED.
INSTALLED.
I
r r
AVGAS ONLY AVGAS ONLY
BE"
GRADE GRADE GRADE GRADE
11-20-00
Page 4
Oct16/92 A?6
Lj
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUEL
AVIATION GASOLINE
GRADE 100LL or 100
CAUTION
DO NOT INSERT FUEL NOZZLE
MORE THAN 3" INTO TANK
11-20-00
Page 5
A16
Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
EXTERNAL
POWER
THE MODEL DESIGNATION 24 VOLT
PLACARD IS LOCATED ON THE
RIGHT SIDE OF THE FUSELAGE
ADJACENT TO THE INBOARD END LOCATED ON THE RIGHT SIDE OF THE
T-----o~-----!
USE SAE 50 ABOVE 40" F
I USE I
SAE 30 BELOW 40" F
I
I
TNos~l r---~
L -I NO HANDLE
L,,, I
INBOARD END LEFT FLAP. JUST OUTBOARD
ON TOP SURFACE NEAR OUTBOARD
WALKWAY ON RIGHT FLAP, 4 INCHES
END OF EACH HORIZONTAL
OUTBOARD OF FUSELAGE NEAR WING LEADING EDGE.
STABILIZER.
C9200972
"END"
11-20-00
Page 6
Oct 16/92 A16
C H A PT E R
SERVICING
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
12-00-00
12-10-00
12-20-00
Shock Struts
Shimmy Damper
Propeller Blade Maintenance ......3
Induction Air Filter
Spark Plugs.
Roton Locks
Cleaning and Waxing the Airplane Finish .3
1
nzr 12-CONTENTS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJEC T PA GE
Page
~2-CONTENTS nzr
Raylheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 12-SERVICING
7 Oct 7/83
8 May 9180
S,10,andlOA Aug29/85
11 Oct 7/83
22 Aug 29/85
1
A27 2-LOEP Mar 31/05Page
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
"END"
12M)M)´•
Page 1
May 9/80
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CAUTION: Any time the fuel system is drained or a fuel cell is empty for any reason, air may enter the system. If
the possibility that air has entered the system does exist, start and operate the engine on the ground
until all air is removed from the system. Operate the engine forseveral minutes on each tank untilproper
engine operation is assured. Refer to the Pilot’s Operating Handbook and Airplane Flight Manual before
starting and operating the engine.
Either the 44-gallon-usable (50-gallon-capacity) standard fuel system or the 74-gallon-usable (80-gallon-capacity)
optional fuel system is available for all Bonanzas except EA-242, EA-273 and After. At serials EA-242, EA-273 and
After, (B36TC) a 102-gallon-usable (1 08-gallon-capacity) fuel system is standard. The fuel system consists of
rubber cells in the leading edge of the wings. A visual measuring tab in each cell (except EA-242, EA-273 and After)
is attached to the filler neck of the 44-gallon system. The bottom of the tab indicates 27 gallons of usable fuel and
the detent indicates 32 gallons of usable fuel in the tanks. At serials EA-242, EA-273 and After, a float-type sight
gage is installed in the fuel system. This gage will indicate a partial load of 25, 30 or 35 gallons of fuel in its respective
wing. When the gage is indicating in the black zone, do not use the gage. On all airplanes except CJ-149 and After,
each wing contains a baffled main fuel cell which provides an uninterrupted flow of fuel to the engine.
When filling the airplane fuel cells, always observe the following:
a. The airplane is designed for operation on grade (green) or 100LL grade (blue) aviation gasoline (1,
100/130
Chart 1, 91-00-00). If these fuels are not available, 1 15/145 grade (purple) may be used.
c. Do not fill fuel cells near open flame or within 100 feet of any open energized electrical equipment capable of
producing sparks.
NOTE: Care should be exercised while filling the fuel cell to prevent scratching, denting, or otherwise damaging the
surface or leading edge of the wing. Do not allow the fuel nozzle to contact the rubber fuel cell.
The three snap-type drains should be opened daily to purge any condensed water vapor from the system. (EA-242,
EA-273 and After have push-type drains which require the preflight drain tool. Refer to Chapter 12-20-00, SPECIAL
TOOLS.) Each fuel cell drain is located on the bottom of the wing, just outboard of the root. The system low spot I
drain at the bottom of the fuel selector valve is accessible through a door inboard of the left wing root.
CAUTION: After defueling or fuel cell replacement, operate the engine on each fuel tank with the airplane on the
ground to ensure that all air has been purged from the fuel cells and the fuel lines to the engine.
an uninterrupted supply of fuel to the engine during slow rolls, uncoordinated maneuvers, fast tums, slips, etc. in
either the 25-gal. (22-gal. usable) or 40-gal. (37-gal. usable) fuel cells. An extra long tube extends into the sponge
area to allow use of the fuel contained in the sponge-filled reservoir.
1
nn7 12’10’00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Most fuel injection system malfunctions can be attributed to contaminated fuel. Inspecting and cleaning the fuel
strainers should be considered to be of the utmost importance as a regular part of preventive maintenance.
Normally the fuel strainers should be inspected and cleaned every 100 hours. However, the strainers should be
inspected and cleaned at more frequent intervals in response to severe conditions of service, unknown fuel handling
practices, and operation in areas of excessive sand or dust.
OIL SYSTEM
The airplane is equipped with a wet sump oil system with a capacity of 12 quarts of oil. The oil filler cap is accessible
through an access door in the left engine cowling.
To drain the engine sump, remove the right hand access plate and unscrew the sump drain plug in the lower right
hand side of the engine crankcase. An oil drain trough, furnished with each airplane is used to convey the oil through
the bottom of the engine cowl prior to D-10364; CE-922; CJ-156; E-1752 and EA-129. At D-10364 and After; CE-922
and After; CJ-156 and After; E-1752 and After and EA-129 and After, a quick attach, snap-type fuel/oil drain adapter
and approximately 18 inches of hose will be used to drain the oil sump. Refer to Chapter 12-20-00, SPECIAL
TOOLS.
Under normal operating conditions, the recommended number of operating hours between oil
changes is 100 hours.
The oil filter should be removed and replaced at each oil
change. When operating under adverse weather conditions
or continuous high power settings, the oil should be changed more frequently. Before draining the oil, run up the
engine until the oil reaches operating temperature to assure complete draining of the oil. Oil grades, (2, Chart 1,
91-00-00) are’general recommendations only, and will vary with individual circumstances. Check oil~inlet
temperature during flight in determining use of the correct grade of oil. Inlet temperatures consistently near the
maximum allowable indicates a heavier oil is needed. The new airplane is delivered with corrosion preventative
compound (3, Chart 1, 91-00-00) in the engine. This is a corrosion-preventive oil and should be removed at 20 hours
of operation, but no later than 25 hours of operation. If the corrosion preventative compound is not removed at the
proper time, varnish may form in the engine. Oil conforming to mineral oil may be added to the corrosion preventative
compound as necessary. After removing the corrosion preventative compound, refill with mineral oil, which should
be used until oil consumption has stabilized (until after engine break-in). After the break-in period, use an ashless
dispersant (AD) aviation grade oil in the heaviest weight that will give satisfactory starting. Above 40"F (4.4"C), SAE
50 viscosity should be used; below 40"F (4.4"C), SAE 30 is recommended. Any aviation grade engine oil which
meets Continental Motors Corporation Specification MHS-24B is acceptable for use.
CAUTION: If metal contamination of the oil system is detected and the cause is corrected, the oil cooler should be
replaced. In addition, flush out the system through the interconnected oil system plumbing and replace
or clean any other accessories that will remain with the engine.
OIL FILTER REMOVAL
a. Gain access to the engine oil filter by opening the LH engine cowl access door.
Page
2-~ 0-00 n2-r
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Clean and lubricate the new filter gasket with engine oil.
b. Position the new filter on the engine mounting adapter and tighten the filter to a torque of 18 to 20 ft-lbs. If a
torque wrench is not available, tighten the filter with a suitable wrench for three-quarters to one full turn after
gasket contact
Servicing the air conditioning system consists of periodically checking the refrigerant level, checking compressor oil
level, checking the compressor belt tension, and changing the system air filter. Recharge the system as outlined
under CHARGING THE AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM whenever the refrigerant level is low, air has entered the
system, or components carrying refrigerant are replaced. Refrigerant leaks may be detected by inspection with a
flameless leak detector. When working on a refrigerant air cooling system, observe the following special servicing
precautions:
WARNING: A face shield should be worn when performing maintenance on the lines because refrigerant
coming in contact with the eyes can cause loss of sight.
Do not smoke when servicing the system with refrigerant because it converts to a highly toxic
gas when exposed to an open flame.
a. Due to the air quality control regulations enacted in the United States, R-12 refrigerant cannot be vented into
the atmosphere. When performing maintenance on the air-conditioning system where R-12 can escape from
the system, evacuate the system with only a recovery or recycle servicing unit that will salvage the refrigerant.
b. The air-conditioning system is a high pressure system. Before disconnecting a refrigerant line, the system must
be discharged with a recovery servicing unit. Purge the entire system to a 125-micron level.
WARNING: A face shield should be worn when performing maintenance on the lines because refrigerant
coming in contact with the eyes can cause loss of sight.
Do not smoke when servicing the system with refrigerant because it converts to a highly toxic
gas when exposed to an open flame.
The servicing points for discharging the system are located under the copilot’s seat.
a. Connect a service unit that recycles the refrigerant to the service valves and open the low pressure valve.
b. When the pressure is depleted, open the pressure valve and operate the vacuum pump to completely remove
c. After the system is depressurized, perform the CHECKING COMPRESSOR OIL LEVEL procedures. I
n27 Maj);~;b:
RayMheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
To purge the system, connect a recycle servicing unit to the low pressure side of the air conditioning system (located
under the copilot’s seat). Purge the entire system with the vacuum pump operating at the 125-micron level. Refer to
the Chapter 21-50-00, AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM SCHEMACTIC illustration in the Maintenance Practices
section.
WARNING: A face shield should be worn when performing maintenance on the lines because refrigerant
coming in contact with the eyes can cause loss of sight.
Do not smoke when servicing the system with refrigerant because it converts to a highly toxic
gas when exposed to an open flame.
The servicing points for charging the system are located under the copilot’s seat.
a. For airplane serials prior to CE-1792; E-2945 and EA-579 use refrigerant R-12 (7, Chart 1, 91-00-00). For
airplane serials CE-1792 and After; E-2945 and After; and EA-579 and After, use refrigerant R-134a (64, Chart
1, 91-00-00). Other refrigerants, particularly those containing methyl chloride, will cause rapid deterioration of
the aluminum compressor components.
b. Connect the recycle/recovery service unit to the air conditioning system service ports located under the copilot’s
seat. If the system contains a partial charge, evacuate all refrigerant prior to charging.
c. Perform the compressor oil level check procedures provided in this chapter to determine if additional refrigerant
oil is required.
CAUTIOIV: Do not over charge the air conditioning system. A full charge is 2.4 pounds of refrigerant. Failure to
comply could result in damage to the air-conditioning system.
d. Add an initial charge of 1 pound of refrigerant to the air conditioning system and any additional refrigerant oil
required.
e. Start the engine in accordance with the applicable Pilot’s Operating Handbook and run the air conditioning
system.
CAUTIOEI: Never add liquid refrigerant to the air conditioning system while the compressor is running. Refrigerant
added while the compressor is operating must be in vapor form.
NOTE: Charging the air conditioning system through observation of the sight glass (bubbles disappearing) requires
the temperature to be above 75"F (23.9"C). Charging the air conditioning system, through observation of
the sight glass, is not recommended at ambient temperatures below 75"F (23.9"C). At temperatures below
75"F (23.9"C) the refrigerant should be measured into the air conditioning system.
f. If the ambient temperature is above 75"F(23.9"C), slowly add vapor refrigerant into the air conditioning system
sight glass
until the (no bubbles). If the ambient temperature is below 75"F (23.9"C), measure 1.4
is clear
pounds vapor refrigerant
of into the system making the total charge 2.4 pounds.
4
Mar 31/05Page All
Rayseon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The air conditioner compressor oil level should be checked by a qualified air conditioner service man if the
refrigerant charge is lost (evidenced by oil loss). For airplane serials prior to CE-1792; E-2945 and EA-579, the air
conditioner system requires 4 to 5 ounces of 500-viscosity oil (8, Chart 1,91-00-00). For airplane serials CE-1792
and After; E-2945 and After and EA-579 and After, the air conditioner system requires 4 to 5 ounces of Ester Oil (65,
Chart 1, 91-00-00).
a. Fabricate a dipstick by bending a wire to a 90" angle so that 1 1/2 inches of the wire will insert into the
compressor.
b. Paint the dipstick with a fiat black paint. Allow sufficient time for the paint to dry.
d. Relieve the air conditioner system pressure by evacuating the system with a recycle servicing unit.
e. After the system pressure is relieved, remove the oil filler plug.
f. Insert the dipstick through the oil filler port, slowly rotate the clutch shaft until the dipstick will insert to the bottom
of the compressor.
g. Withdraw the dipstick; oil should register on the dipstick at 5/8 inch below the filler port. Add oil as necessary to
maintain this measurement.
h. Install the oil filler plug with O-ring and secure plug.
NOTE: Make sure that the O-ring is not twisted and that dirt or particles are NOT ON the O-ring seat. The plug
should be snug. Do not overtighten the plug.
j. Check the area around the filler plug for leaks. If leaks exist, do not overtighten the filler plug. Remove the plug
as noted in Step e. and install a new O-ring after depressurizing the system with a recycle servicing unit. Secure
the plug and recharge the system as noted in Step h. and Step i..
BRAKE SYSTEM
The hydraulic brakes are self-compensating and require no adjustment. Linings should be checked for small nicks
orsharp edges which could damage the brake discs. Worn, dished or distorted brake discs should be replaced. The
brake fluid is supplied to the brake system from the reservoir tank located in the engine accessory section and is
accessible by raising the right side of the engine cowl. The reservoir should be filled to within 1 112 inches of the top
and a visible fluid level maintained on the dipstick at all times. Use only hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00) in the
brake system. Ensure that no dirt or foreign matter is allowed to enter the brake system.
5
nn-I 12’10’00
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
In general, the oxygen system on the Bonanzas may be serviced in accordance with FAA AC43.13-1A.
COMPRESSOR
ENGINE
FIREWALL
.r"
o
COMPFIESS6R FUSE
(NOT APPLICABLE TO
E-2104, E-2111 AND
OIL
b/\o ENGINE
FILLER
AFTER; EA320, BAFFLE
EA440 AND AFTEA) PLUG L~ ---I I I
55-425-1
Servicing Compressor
Figure 1
The following procedures should be followed prior to, and during the oxygen servicing operation:
b. Make sure that no fueling or other flammable fluid servicing is in process when servicing the oxygen system.
c. Ground the servicing equipment and the system to be serviced before connecting the filler adapter.
WARNING: Do not use oxygen intended for medical purposes, or such industrial uses as welding. Such
oxygen may contain excessive moisture that could freeze up the valves and lines of the oxygen
system.
d. Open the cylinder shutoff valve and slowly fill the system to 1,850 50 psi at 70"F (21.1"C), ambient
temperature. This pressure may be increased an additional 3.5 psi for each degree of increase in temperature;
similarly, for each degree of drop in temperature, reduce the pressure for the cylinder by 3.5 psi.
e. Close the shutoff valve, disconnect the supply cylinder, and replace the filler valve cap.
Page
raM6
31105 12-~ 0-00 A27
Ral~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
OXYGEN SYSTEM SERVICING (ALL AIRPLANES EXCEPT E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 AND AFTER; EA-320, I
EA-389 AND AFTER)
Observe the guidelines under the heading OXYGEN SYSTEM in this Chapter and service the system as follows:
a. Remove the access opening over the oxygen cylinder shutoff valve and check that the valve is off.
b. Slide the copilot’s seat to the rear until the filler valve is clear, then remove the cap from the filler valve and
connect the supply cylinder to the filler valve.
d. Open the valve on the charging cylinder and slowly fill the airplane cylinder.
g. Disconnect the supply cylinder and replace the filler valve cap
OXYGEN SYSTEM SERVICING (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 AND AFTER; EA-389 THRU EA-439)
Observe the guidelines under the heading OXYGEN SYSTEM in this Chapter and service the system as follows:
a. Check that the oxygen system is turned off. (Check the push-pull knob.)
b. Slide the copilot’s seat to the rear until the filler valve is accessible.
c. Remove the filler valve cap and connect the supply cylinder.
d. Open the valve on the supply cylinder and slowly fill the system.
e. Close the valve on the supply cylinder and disconnect the supply cylinder.
a. Locate and remove the access panel on the top of the left wing, outboard of WS 66, and aft of the front spar.
b. Remove the cap from the filler opening and connect the supply cylinder to the filler opening.
c. Open the charging cylinder valve and slowly fill the airplane cylinder(s).
d. Afterfilling the airplane cylinder(s), close the supply cylinder shutoff valve, disconnect the supply cylinder, and
7
AZ7
~2-10-00 Rna~a3;J,eo:Page
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Maintaining proper tire inflation will minimize tread wear and power operation.
aid in preventing tire rupture caused from running over sharp
stones and ruts. When inflating tires, visually inspect for cuts,
cracks, breaks, and tread wear. The pressure of a CAUTION
serviceable tire that is fully inflated should not drop more than
4 percent over a 24-hour period. The battery may be damaged if exposed to
NOTE
BA ~TERY
Oil and other hydrocarbons spilled on tires not
only weaken the rubber but may cause it to swell. A 24-volt, 1 10 ampere hour Teledyne Battery Products lead-
Avoid spilling oil, fuel or solvents on tires and acid battery is provided for operation of the electrical system.
clean off any accidental spillage as soon as
possible. The battery is located on the right side of the engine
compartment, just forward of the firewail. The battery is
accessible for servicing by raising the right engine cowl door
CAUTION and removing the battery box cover.
Beech Aircraft Corporation cannot recommend The fluid level of thebattery should be checked every 25
the use of recapped tires. Recapped tires have a hours and maintained 3/8 inch above the top of the
tendency to swell as a result of the increased separators. Add only distilled water to maintain the specific
temperature generated during takeoff. Increased gravity of between 1.275 and 1.295.
tire size can proper function of the
jeopardize
landing gear retract system, with the possibility
of damage to the landing gear doors and retract NOTE
mechanism.
Do not overfill the battery. When the battery cells
are overfilled, water and acid will spill on the
EXTERNAL POWER lower portions of the engine accessory section
and lower fuselage.
An extemal power unit with a negative ground may be used
to supply power for ground checks, starting and battery
charging. The power unit may be connected directly to the For further servicing information, detailed instructions are
battery or to an optional external power receptacle, located furnished with each battery from Teledyne Battery Products.
on the lower engine cowling. The receptacle is designed for
12-20-00
Page 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
RIIAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE CAUTION
Because the deicer boots are made of soft If a bottle containing compressed air or
flexible stock, care must be exercised nitrogen under extremely high pressure is
against dragging gasoline hoses over them used, care should be taken not to overin-
or resting ladders or platforms against the flate the strut. A pressure regulator must
surface of the boots. be used with high pressure bottled air or
nitrogen.
SHOCK STRUTS
Remove all foreign material from the exposed piston
area of the shock struts with a cloth moistened with
~o check the fluid level and fill the strut, jack the air-
plane, remove the valve cap and depress the valve hydraulic fluid.
core to release the air pressure from the strut.
SHIIMMY DAMP~R
WARNING
To check the fluid level in the shimmy damper, insert
a wire of approximately 1/16-inch diameter
through
The strut should be deflated before
the hole in the disc at the end of the piston rod until
removal of the valve body or excessive it touches the bottom of the hole in the floating piston.
pressure may result in personal injury or
Mark the wire, remove and measure the depth of
property damage. insertion. Inserting the wire in the hole of the floating
piston, rather than letting it rest against the face of
Compress and block the strut 1/4-inch from the fully the piston, will give a more accurate check.
compressed position. Remove the valve body
assembly and fill with MIL-H-5606 hydraulic fluid (9, NOTE
Chart 1, 91-00-00). After filling the strut, slowly extend
the strut from the blocked position and replace the To determine if the wire is inserted in the
valve body assembly. Completely cori~press the strut hole of the floating piston, insert the wire
to release excess air and oil, then reinstall the valve several times, noting each insertion depth.
core.
When the wire is correctly inserted, the
length will be approximately 1M-inch
CAUTION greater.
Do not inflate the struts with the airplane When the shimmy damper is full, the insertion depth
on jacks since sudden extension or over- is 2-3/16 inches. The empty reading is 3-1/16 inches.
inflation of the strut may cause internal If the wire enters the piston rod over 2-3/8 inches,
damage to the strut. hydraulic fluid should be added. When hydraulic fluid
is needed, remove the shimmy damper and add
With the airplane resting on the ground and the fuel MIL-H-5606 hydrau;..e fluid (9, Chart 1, 12-20-00) as
cells full, inflate the nose strut with dry air or nitrogen follows:
until 3-1/2 inches of piston is exposed. On airplane
serials CE-980 and after, CJ-156 and after, D-10,397 a. Secure the shimmy damper in a fixed
and after, E-1,970 and after, and EA-273 and after, position with the clevis end down.
inflate the nose gear strut until 5 inches of the strut
piston is exposed. Rock the airplane gently to pre- b. Remove the cotter pin, washer, and spring,
vent possible binding of the piston in the barrel when from the piston rod. Remove with care as the spring
inflating. is compressed.
12-20-00
Page 2
Jun 20/91 A14
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
j, Release the 6-32 rod and remove c. Remove the retaining ring.
it from the floating piston.
d. Relax pressure on the spring guide
k. Reinstall the shimmy damper. and counterbalance spring slowly until the
spring is fully extended.
PROPELLER BLADE MAINTENANCE
e. Remove the lock from the fixture
Due to the high stresses to which and remove the spring guide, counterbal-
propeller blades are subjected, their ance spring and spring guide tube.
careful maintenance is vitally important,
particularly on the leading edge of each f.
Apply a small quantity of grease
blade from the tip inboard to just beyond to completely extended thrust screw
the
the 33-inch station. All nicks and (see Figure 1).
scratches must be repaired before the
airplane is flown. Nicks and scratches set g. Reassemble the lock. For service
up concentrations of stress wh i ch can other than lubrication, return the Roton
exceed the strength of the blade material; lock to the manufacturer.
the result will be a crack and premature
failure of the blade. The method and lim- CLEANLNG AND WAXING THE AIRPLANE
its for this type of repair, as outlined FINISH
in the applicable Propeller Handbook,
should be followed carefully. Prior to cleaning the exterior, cover the
wheels, making certain the brake discs are
INDUCTION ~IR FILTER cove redattach p i tot cover securely;
install plugs in or mask off all other
The induction air filter should be cleaned openings. Be particularly careful to mask
periodically and replaced every 5‘00 hours off both static air buttons before washing
of service. Clean the´•filter as described or waxing.
in the manufacturer’s instructions on the
filter.
12-20-00
Page 3
A12 Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
RETAINING RING
FULLY EXTENDED
-I-
SPRING GUIDE
Roton Lock
Figure 1
The urethane paint finish cleans easily the finish a yellowed appearance. The old
with a sponge and mild detergent solution. wax should be removed before a new coat
Rinse with clear water. A clean whi te i s appl i ed.
cloth, saturated with either MEK (31,
Chart i, 91-00-00) or toluol (19, Chart Airplanes’with aluminum skin surfaces may
1, 91-00-00) may be used to remove accu- be polished to a high gloss with any war-
mulations of oil or grease, and dried ranted aluminum polish. Soft clean cloths
insects. Flush the surface with plenty of or a chamois should be used to prevent
cool water to remove all trades of soap scratching the aluminum when cleaning and
and dry with a chamois to prevent water polishing.
marks.
CLEANING PLASTIC WINDOWS
CAUTION
CAUTION
When washing the airplane with
mild soap and water, use special Do not use an ice scraper to
care to avoid washing away grease remove ice windows because
from
from any lubricated
area. After this practice may cause scratches
washing with solvent in the wheel to the window surface: To avoid
well areas, lubricate all lubri- scratches, any clean-Ing of the
cation points. Premature wear of winddws should bedone with care.
lubricated surfaces may result if
the above precautions are not A commercial cleaning compound made spe-
taken. cifically for acrylic plastic windows may
be used. When using a commercial cleaner,
For better protection, a non-abrasive wax follow the instructions on the container.
may be used on airplanes exposed to cor- If a commercial cleaner is not available,
rosSve atmospheres with moisture the´•following instruc~ions should be fol-
condensation. lowed:
12-20-00
Page 5
A12 Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SEAIES
MAIMENANCE MANUAL
CHART 1
SERVICING
Check
Engine Oil Level Access door on See Consumable Preflight
upper cowl (1) Materials Chart
Battery Water RH rear side of Distilled Water 25 hrs.
engine compartment(l)
Ar Conditioner See Chapter 21 for location Suniso No. 5GS or As required
Compressor Oil Level and special instructions Texaco WF 100
500 d~i
Air Conditioner See Chapter 21 for location Refn’geran~ No. 12 As required
Refrigerant and special instructions
Magneto Pressure- Between Magnetos 50 hrs.
bation Air Filter
Change
Engine Oil Lower rear side of See Consumable 100 hrs.
engine (1) Materials Chart
Engine Oil n~ter Left rear side of 100 hrs.
engine (1)
Clean
induction Air Filter Fuselage nose section Clean as described 50 hrs.
9rill (1) on the filter
Fuel Injection Control Fuel injection control Clean with solvent and 100 hrs.
Valve Screen valve on the lower side blow dry with air
of the engine (1) pressure
Fuel Selector Valve Fuel selector valve Clean with solvent and 100 hrs.
Strainer inboard left wing mot (1) blow dry with air
pressure
Pressure Pump Intake Rear engine baffle (1) Replace 300 hours or
Filter on condition
Drain
Fuel Sump Drain Inboard left wing root (1) Preflight
Fuel Cell Drains Under both wings (2) Preflight
Static Drain Behind the ah upholstery 50 hrs.
panel (1)
Replace
Induction Air Rite~ Fuselage nose-section 500 hrs. or
12´•20-00
Pages
Sep 27/84 A9
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MA\MENANCE
CHART 1
SERVIC1NG (CONT*D)
Service
Brake Fluid Reservoir Upper forward side of the MIL-H-S606 As required
RlewJI (1) hydraulic fluid
Oxygen Cylinder Under front seats (1) Mil-0-27210 aviator’s As required
except EA-320 breathing oxygen
EA-440 and after.
EA-320, EA-440
and after in
left wing (1)
Main and Nose Landing top of each strut (3) MIL-H-5606 As required
Gear Struts hydraulic fluid and or annually
dry compressed air
Shimmy Damper Nose landing gear (1) MIL-H-5606 As required
hydraulic fluid or annually
12-2000
Page 6A
A9 Sept 27:84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 2
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
c~
t L
DH N
36606-120
NOTES
1. The following details. (A thru T) constitute a lubrication servicing schedule. Major differences between model types relative to
lubrication points are l~e V-tail configuration, exclusively for the V35B. and the cargo doors provided only on the model A36. A36TC. 8
ass-re. ~k
2. Environmental conditions and operational application may dictate more frequent setvidng.
3. Landing gear components may require
lubrication every 25 or 50 hours. depending on operation.
4. MIL-G-81322 grease may be used in place of MIL-G-23827 grease in warm climates. however. in extremely cold climates
MIL-G-23827 grease should be used.
5. Care should be taken when using greases MIL-G-81322 and MIL-G-23827, since they contain synthetic lubricants which will
discolorpainted surfaces, and will soften rubber products.
38-M)4-(2I
12-20-00
Pager
A6 Oct f/83
3
BEECHCRAFT.
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
DETAIL A 35600´•12
IZI
~3
DETAIL B
INDEX LOCATION POINTS( LUBRICANT INTERVAL
NOSE LANDING GEAR
MlL-H-5608 AR
O Nose shook strut (1)
MlL-H-5606 AR
O Shimmy damper
100 hrs
O Nose gear torque knees (6) MIL-Gd1322
12-20´•00
Page 8
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
ys
1~3
DETAIL C
35604-(4
DETAIL O
35-604-~5
12-20-00
Page 9
All Aug 29/85
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
~3--t--1
DETAIL E
35604-18
Detail F applies only to sen’als E-ll11. 8-1241 and after; EA-1 and after.
II NOTE
Lubricate all internal moving parts of the
latching mechanism with Aeroshell 17,
as required.
DETAIL F
12-20-00
Page 10
Aug 29/85 All
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SEdrES:’
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
SAE 10W30
SAE 20 or 100 hrs
O Control column torque knees (6)
SAE 10W30
O
O
~IP cc:
DETAIL G
56a~-( ce
I-J- ~-o
ei
DETAIL GG
E-1946. D-2104, E-2111 AND AFTER. EA320, EA389 AND AFTER.
INDU( LOCATION POINTS( LUBRICANT INTERVAL
CONTROLCOLUMN
a, Wipe lull length of square shafts with MEK, these surfaces to remain dry and free of oil.
Remove one of the nonadjustable rollers (27-00~00). 11 it is a sealed roller with the seals intact, reinstall the roller
and make a maintenance record that the rollers are sealed and do not need lubrication. If the rollers are not sealed,
or the seals are not intact, they may be replaced with sealed rollers and a maintenance record made that the rollers
do not need iubrication. If the adjustable rollers are removed for lubrication or replacement, refer to Chapter 27~0-00
for adjustment.
36-604-1(7
12-20-00
Page 10A
All Aug:29/85
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES.
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
ICb NOTE
At series 0-10380 and after. CJ-156 and
after. CE-960 and after. 6-1666 and
after. EA-249 and after. sealed bearings
were installed and no lubrication is
required.
DETAIL H
12-20M)
Page 11
A6
Oc17/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SEdIES
´•~ANUAL
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
’!~zL’
DETAIL I
3560(-47.
DETAIL J
12-2(MO
Rage 12
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFF
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENAN~E MANUAL:
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
i>ETAIL K
3psoeso
DETAIL L
Detail L depicts the Bonanza 33 and 36 Series airplanes. The Bonanza 35 Series
does not incorporate Index 2.
AR
O "Elevator trim tab actuator (2) MIL-G-23827
12-2(H)O
Rage 13
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANBE ’MANUA~
CHART 2 (ConPd)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
DETAIL M
35604-51
~3
~ETAIL N
12-20-00
Rage 14
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SEAIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL,
CHART 2 (Conrd)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
~i"
BL.~
O
DETAIL O
35-604-53
12-20-00
Rage 15
A6 Oct7/83
BEECHCRAFf
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENAN~E- MANUAL
CHART 2 (Cont~d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
DETAIL P
n9
´•Lubricate the aileron pushjpull rod ends tin place) at
100 hr intervals using SAE 20 or 10W30 oil. or remove
the aileron push/pull rod assembly and clean 6
lubricate rod ends using MILG-23827 grease. Rotate
the rod end eye balls to assure adequate lubrication
coverage. Check aileron rigging aRer reinstallation of
the rod end assembly.
M116-23827 or
O ~ileron push/pull rods ends (4) SAE 20 or SAE 10W30 100 hn
W-LBM) Prefened.
~t Aileron trim tab hinge (1) LPS-1. CRC 3-36. 100 hrs
WO-40
W-L-800 Preferred.
Aileron trim tab push-pull linkage (5) LPS-1. CRC 3-38. 100 hrs
WD-40
12-20-00
Page 16
Oct 7/83 A6
BEECHCRAFI
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL;
CHART 2 (Cont~d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
3
q O
DETAIL Q
35-604-55
-i DETAIL R
12-20-00
Rage 17
A6 Oct7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
’MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 2 (Cont’d)
LUBRICATION SCHEDULE
3.j
DETAIL S
jl:I 2
ii!i 0!
t7~
´•ii
ii
i i
DETA;IL T
INDEX LOCATION POINTS( LUBRICANT INTERVAL
ELEVATOR CONTROL
12-211-88
Rage 18
Oct7/83 A6
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
0.
50-590014
TS1222-5
50-590012
TS1222-3
TS1222-4
T51222-8
50-590013
TS1171-1
TS1171-10 TS1176-10 TS1171-2
TS1176-1
TS1176-2
12-20-00
Page 19
Jan 18/84
A8
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
50-590012
TS1 222-5
TS1222-4
TS1 222-8
50-590013
TS1171-1
TS1176-1
50-590012
TS1222-5
TS1 222-4
TS1222-8
TS1171-1
TS11761 1- ‘V
50-590013
35-590064-1
35-5900~ HOISTING SLING ASSEMBLY
MAIN WHEEL JACK ADAPTER
MODEL 300
SERVICE JACK 35-590009
THROTTLE RETAINING NUT WRENCH 36-17-22
MAX. CAPACITY 5000 LBS
12-20-00
Page 20
Jan 18/84
A8
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SPECIAL TOOLS
35-590087
DIFFERENTIAL MECHANISM
USED ON THE BONANZA 35 SERIES AIRPLANES
ONLY
810-5 35660040 LH
810-5 35660040-1 RH
ELEVATOR CHECK FIXTURE
USED ON MODEL SERIALS D-10097,
D-10120 AND AFTER
810-3 35660040 LH
8
810-3 35660040-1 RH
ELEVATOR CHECK FIXTURE
USED ON MODEL SERIALS CE-748, CE-772 35-590087-9 STOP
AND AFTER; CJ-149 AND AFTER; E-llll, USED WITH 35-590087 ASSEMBLY WHEN
E-1241 AND AFTER; AND EA-1 AND AFTER
RIGGING THE MODEL SERIALS D-10097,
D-10120 AND AFTER
810 35660043-2
TRIM TAB JIG 36-590015-1
TOW BAR
35-590021
TAIL TIE-DOWN SUPPORT ASSEMBLY
810 33524000
RUDDER CHECK FIXTURE
45-590074-7
810-1 50590091
LANDING GEAR TENSION GAGE
AILERON TRAVEL GAGE
36-17-16
12-20-00
Page 21
As
Jan 18184
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
3617-17
001
"END"
12-20-00
Page 22
Aug 29/85 Atl
CHAPTER
STANDARD
PRACTICES
(AIRFRAME)
Raydheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
20-00-00
20´•01 -00
Torque Wrenches
20-02-00
20-03-00
Electrical
Bonding Examples. ......6
1
*26 50-CONTENTS
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
Aluminum ElectricalBonding 7.
20-04-00
20-05-00
Bearing Removal
Mechanical Press 1
20-06-00
SUBJECT PAGE
20-07-00
Self-Locking Nuts
Slotted, Steel Locknuts (Prevailing TorqueType). ................._
.........1
Lockwire and Cotter Pin Requirements. .................1
Locking Devices- Maintenance Practices ................1
Lockwire Installation Procedures ........._......._
...1
Lockwire Hole Alignment. .........4
Lockwire Twisting
Cotter Pin Installation
20-0&00
Urethane Paints
Urethane Paint Repair Procedures. .4
Painting Magnesium
Paint Removal fromMagnesium Surfaces ............6
Special Procedures
Propeller Blades. i
3
I, 50-CONTENTS ,.~Page
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
20-0900
Corrosion- Description
Galvanic Corrosion
Recommended Materials 3
Corrosion- Maintenance Practices 4
Corrosion Control
Corrosion Protection ..............4
Aluminum Corrosion Removal 4
Page
2OICONTENTS A26
RaytLeOn AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1
A26 20-LOEP Sep 30/04Page
Ral~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I WARNING
W~RNING)
Any maintenance requiring the disconnection and reconnection of flight control cables,
plumbing, electrical connectors or wiring requires identification of each side of the compo-
nent being disconnected to facilitate correct reassembly. At or prior to disassembly, com-
ponents should be color coded, tagged or properly identified in a way that it will be obvious
how to correctly reconnect the components. After reconnection of any component, remove
all identification tags. Check all associated systems for correct function prior to returning
the airplane to service.
This chapter describes practices used in maintaining the airplane in an airworthy condi-
the standard maintenance
tion. The information in this
chapter is applicable during maintenance in several chapters of this maintenance
manual. Maintenance procedures in a particular chapter supersede the general information in this chapter.
The information is broken down in several unit/subjects. The following is a list of the information contained in each
chapter.
This unit/subject contains the general information for installation of torqued fasteners. It has information on the use
of torque adapters and torque charts showing the torque of different types of nuts and bolts.
This unit/subject contains the general information for maintenance of components that are subject to electrostatic
damage. Information is included for electrostatic free workstations, symbols, packaging requirements, storage and
transit requirements, static charge buildup and humidity and dust effects.
This unit/subject contains the general information for installation of electrical wiring grounding, tube grounding and
electrical power returns.
This unit/subject contains the general information for maintenance and inspection of control cables and pulleys.
Thisunit/subject contains the general information for installation and removal of bearings. The removal is described
by theuse of the hydraulic and mechanical press method. The installation is described by use of the retaining com-
This unit/subject contains the general information for maintenance of hoses, tubing and fittings. Components are not
identified, but the information is basic and applies to most applications.
nu 20-00-00
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
This unit/subject contains the general information for the installation of cotter pins, lockwire, tab and cup type key-
washers, retaining rings and turnbuckle locking clips.
This unit/subject contains the general information for maintenance of the finishes used on the airplane and paint
removal and application.
This unit/subject contains the general information for the control, treatment and removal of corrosion.
Nov 20-00-00
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TOROUE WRENCHES
Formula for increased effective length:
(FIGURES 1 AND 2)
Y 135 x 10 1350 117.39
Threads of nuts and bolts to be torqued must be
10 1.5 11.5
clean and free of all lubricants unless otherwise
specified. The loss of normal friction by contamina-
y 117 inch-lbs.
tion may result in overtorquing.
NOTE
Formula for decreased effective length:
Torque wrenches should be exercised
before they are used.
Y 135 x 10 1350 158.82
A measurable torque may be required 10 -1.5 8.5
to initiate the turning of some locknuts.
This initial torque must then be added Y 159 inch-lbs.
to the desired torque to attain the
20-01-00
Page 1
A14 Jun 20/91,
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
2000-017-01
(LB)
TORQUE
(IN-LBS.)
90’
OTAL LENGTH
2000-017-02
CHART 1
FINE THREAD SERIES, CLASS 3, CADMIUM PLATED
AND NONLUBRICATED (EXCEPT AS NOTED)
*This is a coarse thread (.1640-32) with recommended torque limits of 9-11 inch-pounds and a maximum
allowable tightening torque of 14 inch-pounds.
BT03021
20-01-00
Page 4
Jun 20/91 A14
QeechcraR
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 2
TORQUING COARSE THREADED BOLTS LOADED IN SMEAR
The above values apply to Class 3 threads, cadmium plated and nonlubricated.
8T03022
20-01-00
Page 5
A14 Jun 20/91
Ci3~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE SENSITIVITY static charge, while materials at the bottom of the
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION list are capable of producing a similar negative elec-
trostatic charge. Items of dissimilar polarity provide
Some types of electronic components are easily the greatest potential for electrostatic discharge.
damaged by electrostatic discharge (ESD), and Numeric values have not been assigned to the
require special handling and storage procedures, listed materials, as static charge levels are not
ESD is a release of stored electrostatic charge
constant, and will vary with ambient conditions. A
which has been generated by actions such as con-
greater possibility of ESD exists when the positions
tact, rubbing, or separating of materials. A charge of listed items in Table 1 are farther apart. For
this type can damage electrical and electronic
example, an individual using his/her hands to pick
equipment installed in the airplane. In some
up a PVC pipe has more potential for producing
instances, the damage may not be immediate, but
ESD than does an aluminum part contacting a steel
progressive. Components and items of equipment
that can be damaged by electrostatic discharge are cart.
considered to be electrostatic discharge sensitive Table 2 identifies some typical electrostatic charge
(ESDS). Electronic components that are considered levels and the actions that can produce the electro-
to be electrostatic discharge sensitive include inte-
static charge.
grated circuits, transistors and diodes, monolithic
and hybrid microelectronics, MOS capacitors, thin
film resistors, and piezoelectric crystals. Any circuit ELECTROSTA TIC DISCHARGE SENSITIVITY
or piece of equipment containing ESDS compo- CLASSIFICATION
nents is subject to ESD damage if certain handling
precautions are not observed. Three levels of sensitivity classification are estab-
lished for electrostatic discharge sensitivity devices.
Personnel who remove, inspect, test or install Classification is used to aid the manufacturer or
instruments and equipment containing ESDS com- supplier providing packaging
in and
handling
ponents must be aware of the possibility of ESD
requirements that protect the ESD sensitive item,
damage, and should handle ESDS components in device or component through all phases of handling
accordance with procedures covered in this chap- and packaging of the device during its service life.
ter. Proper procedures and policies for the handling
The three classes of ESD sensitivity are as follows:
of ESDS components and equipment should be
adhered to for the following reasons: Class 1 Sensitivity range is from 0 to 1,999 volts.
20-02-00
Page 1
A14 Jun 20/91
CiZ)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE 1
MATERIAL POLARITY
CHARGE
MATERIALS (Relative Magnitude
and Polarity)
Air Positive
Human Hands Positive
Asbestos Positive
Rabbit Fur Positive
Glass Positive
Mica Positive
Human Hair Positive
Nylon Positive
Wool Positive
Fur Positive
Lead Positive
Silk Positive
Aluminum Positive
Paper Positive
Cotton --Neutral--
Steel Negative
Wood Negative
Amber Negative
Sealing Wax Negative
Hard Rubber Negative
Nickel, Copper Negative
Brass, Silver Negative
Gold, Platinum Negative
Sulfur Negative
Acetate, Rayon Negative
Polyester Negative
Celluloid/ Negative
Orlon/ Negative
Saran/ Negative
Polyurethane Negative
Polyethylene -Negative
Polypropylene Negative
PVC (Vinyl) Negative
KEL-F (CTFE) Negative
SILICON Negative
TEFLON/ Negative
BT01030
20-02-00
Page 2
Jun 20/91 A14
C~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE 2
charge on the covers before touching c. Do not use pressure air nozzles to remove
a printed circuit board. Store the cov- dust from ESDS printedcircuit boards. Rapid move-
ers a safe distance from the work ment of air, combined with airborne dust particles,
area. can create an electrostatic charge that will destroy
ESDS components.
a. When using test equipment, discharge all test d. Always wear a grounding wrist strap when
leads to ground prior to connection to the ESDS cir- opening any ESD protective package.
cult under test, e. Avoid touching circuit components or connec-
b. Use
a portable static control work station
tor pins when handling ESDS components or equip-
when me"t.
removing ESDS circuit boards´•from card
cages and enclosures at the airplane. Never place any ESDS component, before or
f.
20-02-00
Page 3
A14 Jun 20/91
~-)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
11 2 7
9 10~
1;1 1;1
STATIC CONTROLLED
1
WORK STATION
1
5. IONIZED AIR BLOWER ’10. SIGNESD CONTROLLED
WORK STATION
NOTE
NOTE
20-02-00
Page 4
Jun 20/91 A14
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1 2
i. ALLIGATOR CLIP TO
RELIABLE GROUND CONNECTION
2. SNUG-TO-SKIN PERSONNEL
WRIST STRAP
3. STATIC DISSIPATIVE
WORK SURFACE
npol4les
20-02-00
Page 5
A14 Jun 20/91
Ci~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
rated for use around ESDS components and equip- diverting, to ground, electrostatic charges on con-
Four basic techniques are employed in ESD control. Never wear a grounding wrist strap
These are: over clothing.
The strap must be in
contact with the wearer’s skin to ade-
a. MINIMIZE THE CHARGE BUILDUP Minimize quately dissipate any electrostatic
electrostatic charge buildup by using conductive or charge. Under certain conditions, per-
static dissipative flooring and static-dissipative work sonnet using a grounding wrist strap
surfaces. Wear leather shoes, cotton socks, and a may need to use a lotion-type skin
grounding ankle strap to dissipate body charge moisture enhancer to provide a low-
buildup. Wear cotton clothing instead of wool or resistance connection between the
synthetics. Use an ionized air blower to dissipate wrist and the wrist strap.
charges from nonconductive items.
b. DRAIN OFF THE CHARGE TO GROUND The a´• GROUNDING WRIST STRAP Each person
that handles ESDS components and equipment
human body is a good electrical conductor and for
must wear a grounding wrist strap to dissipate bod-
that reason electrostatic charges
body can
on the
be dissipated by skin contact with a grounding ily electrostatic charges. The wrist strap must fit
firm against the skin and release quickly in case of
device such as a wrist or ankle strap. Always wear
an emergency. The wrist strap incorporates a 1
a grounding wrist strap when opening ESD contain-
20-02-00
Page 6
Jun 20/91 A14
Ci~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
e. IONIZED AIR BLOWER The ionized air static-sensitive components and equipment are
blower provides a constant flow of positive and removed from a static control work station, they
negative ions over the work station surface to neu- must be packaged in containers that provide at
tralize electrostatic charges on nonconductive least as much protection as that provided by the
materials in the air flow path. The use of an ionized work station. Conductive boxes, kit trays, and simi-
air blower, in combination with a static control work lar types of approved containers provide complete
station, provides additional protection for ESDS ESD protection to ESDS components and equip-
components and equipment. Since it is not always ment while in transit.
possible to eliminate all static charge accumulators h. GROUNDING HEEL STRAP A grounding
(styrofoam, plastic, etc.) from a work area, the ion- heel strap can provide additional ESD protection.
ized air blower is used to provide additional protec-
The heel strap makes contact with the wearer’s
tion by flooding the work area with balanced nega- skin at the ankle, and extends to the bottom of foot-
tive/positive ionized air. Static charge accumulators wear to make contact with conductive mat or con-
a
should always be kept away from static-free areas,
ductive flooring. The grounding heel strap can be
but inadvertent static is hard to control, especially
used in combination with a grounding wrist strap to
when developed by such common items as cloth-
provide maximum ESD protection.
ing, footwear, combs, and pens. An ionized air
blower will help control some of this inadvertent i.ANTISTATIC/CONDUCTIVE CLOTHING
buildup. Many types of clothing generate electrostatic
CAUTION
20-02-00
Page 7
A14 Jun 20/91
Cil)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
charges. To
remove some of this buildup, work sta- case of emergency. The wrist strap incorporates a
tion personnel should wear outer garments that 1 megohm current-limiting resistor, in series with
help dissipate electrostatic charges. Cotton ranks the ground cord, to protect the wearer from electri-
among the best fabrics for antistatic protection. Do ,,I shock hazards.
not wear synthetic or wool fabrics around ESDS
devices, as these fabrics retain electrostatic b´• STATIC-DISSIPATIVE WORK SURFACE A
PORTABLE STATIC CONTROL static charges from conductive items when those
ily electrostatic charges. The wrist strap must fit work station should be maintained between 30 and
firm against the skin and should release quickly in 65 percent.
CAUTION
ELECTROSTATIC DISCHARGE
SENSITIVE ELECTRONIC DEVICES
SPECIAL HANDLING REQUIRED
AP014191
20-02-00
Page 8
Jun 20/91 414
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
r u
AP014193
ESDS Symbols
Figure 5
20-02-00
Page 9
A14 Jun 20/91
~eechcraft
´•BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Repair of ESDS circuit boards, including replace- ESD protective packaging requirements, unless oth-
ment of ESDS components, should be performed in erwise defined by specification, shall conform to the
a dust-free environment. following:
Class 1 Package in multi-layer conductive
PACKAGING OF ESDS COMPONENTS AND type bags consisting of an inner and outer
EQUIPMENT layer of antistatic (surface resistivity of 109 to
1014 ohms per square inch) or static dissipa-
All ESDS components and equipment require spe- tive (surface resistivity of 105 to 109 ohms per
cial ESD protective packaging. Seal all ESDS pack- square inch) material with a middle layer of
ages with an appropriate cautionary label as shown conductive material (surface resistivity of 10
in Figures 3 through 8. ohms or less).
Class 2 Package in a static dissipative mate-
rialpossessing a surface resistivity of 105 to
CAUTION i 109 ohms per square inch. Materials specified
for Class 1 may also be used.
Do not clips or staples
use when seal-
Class 3 Package in an antistatic material
ing any ESDS package.
possessing a surface resistivity of 109 to 1014
Do not use carbon-filled, conductive ohms per square inch.
bags.
Place all ESDS devices in approved static shielding
Remove ESDS components and equip-
containers before in shipper’s normal exte-
packing
ment from protective, static-shielded
rior containers. Use antistatic cushioning or fill
containers ONLY at a static control
materials. Do not use static generating materials,
work station after attaching a ground- such as polyethylene, styrofoam, or paper.
ing wrist strap and verifying that ESD
producing items are not on the static Antistatic packaging is generally pink or blue in
dissipative work surface. color. The material differs from common plastic in
CAUTION ATTENTION
HANDLING
(PREFERRED) PRECAUTIONS REQUIRED
CONTENTS
(ACCEPTABLE)
AP014192
20-02-00
Page 10
Jun 20/91 A14
Qeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
W
ATTENTION
CONTENTS
STATIC SENSITIVE
HANDLING
PRECAUTIONS REQUIRED
APOI*194
type of packaging DOES NOT provide static shield- are yellow on a black background or
ing, and is generally used to package instruction black on a yellow background.
sheets, data sheets, and other non-ESDS materials
prior to introduction into a static-free environment.
All non-ESDS Mark unit containers with the ESDS caution label on
items, that are to enter an ESD work
station, require repackaging in antistatic materials. the outside of the package. Mark exterior contain-
ers with an ESD caution label as shown in Figure 8.
Conductive static shielding packaging differs from
Apply marks directly to each ESDS printed circuit
antistatic packaging, in that it has the ability to
shield
board, assembly cover, equipment enclosure, or
devices, contained within, from external
access door that would expose ESDS devices, if
static charges. Conductive static shielding packag-
removed. Mark appropriately using decal transfer,
ing is available in the form of bags and rigid con-
tainers. stencil, silk screen, or any other method meeting
permanent legibility requirements.
MARKING OF ESDS COMPONENTS AND ESDS
Display symbols in a prominent package
EQUIPMENT location to alert allpersonnel to the presence of
ESDS devices and equipment. The ESDS symbol
All ESDS components and equipment should be
marked ESDS should be at least 1/4" in diameter. ESDS symbols
appropriately with an symbol as
that are attached to circuit boards should contrast
shown in Figure 5.
with the circuit board base color. Enclosures that
20-02-00
Page 11
Ai4 Jun 20/91
~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
STORAGE AND TRANSIT OF ESDS against ESD through appropriate handling at static
CAUTION
SENSITIVE ELECTRONIC DEVICES
DO NOT SHIP OR STORE NEAR STRONG
ELECTROSTATIC.ELECTROIAGNETIC.
WAGNETIC, OR RIDIOACTIYE FIELDS.
APO 14195
20-02-00
Page 12
Jun 20/91 A14
Ci~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
There are two basic types of electrical bonding; damaged as this has a tendency to
direct and indirect. Both are accomplished by using weaken the jumper and reduce its
mechanical methods to attach the electrical conduc- effectiveness. "Waggling"
the bonding
tors. Bolts, rivets, conductive laminates, flashing jumper to see if the end terminals are
and bonding jumpers are commonly used. tight is unacceptable as this may also
induce fatigue on the crimped portion
Whether direct or indirect, all electrical bonding of the bonding jumper.
must reflect high maintenance standards to main-
tain the electrical integrity. Many times, an ill- Indirect electricalbonding is also used to connect
prepared surface may initially provide sufficient the airplane wire harness shielding terminals to a
grounding properties, but experience a rapid deteri- ground. The tubular braiding attaches t~ the electri-
oration in when corrosion from contam- cal connectors with clamps and shields the airplane
conductivity
inants moisture appears on the bonding surface.
or
wi’e harness for its entire length.
All bonding surfaces should be free of primer or
coatings not compatible with electrical conductance. ELECTRICAL BONDING OF TUBES
This includes but is not limited to, all protective
films such as anodize, grease, oil, paint, All metallic tubes that carry petroleum products or
lacquer, or
other finishes with other fluids, including gases, must have a mechani-
high resistance properties. Once
the electrical
bonding surface is cleaned, and the cally secure connection to the ground plane for
static dissipation. Plumbing sections must be elec-
necessary protective coatings applied, the compo-
nent is installed and a resistance check is per-
trically bonded to each other to eliminate a potential
electrical charge on the individual segments. Conti-
formed to verify continuity of the electrical bond.
nuity between the plumbing segments is achieved
with electrical bonding clamps or jumpers. Electrical
DIRECT ELECTRICAL BONDING bonding clamps, used in some applications, have a
wire that contacts the plumbing on either side of the
Direct electrical bonds are frequently used for clamp, ensuring continuity across the joint.
metal-to-metal joints. Before assembly, the joints
are treated with a conductive film that prevents cor-
ELECTRICAL POWER RETURNS
rosion of the bonding surface. Most direct electrical
bonds involve the installation of components on alu- Electrical power returns should be direct with the
minum. shortest possible path from the operating equip-
20-03-00
Page 1
A14 Jun 20/91
C~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 1
RECOMMENDED MATERIALS
BT03019
ment to ground when practical. Current return leads are provided for reference only and are not specifi-
4 AWG larger should not be connected directly to
or cally required by Beech Aircraft Corporation. Any
the airplane structure, but should be connected to
product conforming to the specification may be
a electrical bonding stud attached to the structure.
used subject~to availability. The products included
This method prevents damage should a faulty con-
in these charts have been tested and approved for
nection induce high current flow through the con-
aviation usage by Beech Aircraft Corporation, by
´•nection. A maximum of four wire terminals may be
the vendor or compliance to the applicable specifi-
installed on an individual grounding stud. If two or
to an individual
cations. GENERIC OR LOCALLY MANUFACTURED
more wires are grounded stud, each
wire must form mechanically sound connection
a PRODUCTS WHICH CONFORM TO THE REQUIRE-
and meet applicable maximum resistance values. MENTS OF A SPECIFICATION MAY BE USED
Component case electrical bonding and current EVEN THOUGH NOT INCLUDED IN THE CHART.
return bonding are separate, with the connections Only the basic number of each specification is
made to separate ground studs. As a general rule listed. No attempt has been made to update the list-
and precaution, note the power return configuration
ing to the. latest revision. It is the responsibility of
before removal of a component, and ensure the
the technician or mechanic to determine the current
right configuration is used during installation.
revision ofapplicable specification prior to
the
20-03-00
Page 2
Jun 20/91 A14
~iS)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
2000-610-32
NOTE
Do not iron oxide NOTE
use emery cloth or
sandpaper. Use only aluminum oxide A stainless steel wire brush with a pilot
or silicon carbide sandpaper. may be used to clean small areas (Fig-
ure 1).
I -´•~´•´•I
WARNING
20-03-00
Page 3
A14 ´•Jun 20/91
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NUT
LOCK WASHER
WASHER
TERMINAL
(LIMIT TO 41
STRUCTURE
20M)-~IO-41
d. Keep the treated area wet with alodine for g. Seal around the edges of the electrical bond
approximately 3 to 5 minutes until a yellow color with conformal coat per MIL-I-46058 (3, Chart 1). If
develops. Should the alodine not change color, it is the assembly originally protected by primer,
was
an indication that the surface was not properly prime the assembly with primer (4, Chart 1) and
cleaned. reapply the original finish as required.
20-03-00
Page 4
Jun 20/91 A14
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 1
HARDWARE USED WITH GROUND STUDS
Structure Screw, bolt Plain Washer Washer Washer Lock Washer Lock Washer
Lock-Nut Nut A B C&D E F
MS35338 MS35338
BT03020
CLEAN TO BASE
USE CAD. PLATED STEEL SEAL AFTER METAL AREA 1-1/2
SCREW OR BOLT BELOW 330’ F. INSTALLATION DIAMETER OF
j-1/2DIAMETER TERMINAL
WASHER STEEL LIGHT CLEANED AREA
SERIES PLATED I LOCK-WASHER
BONDING
JUMPER
2000-610-33
20-03-00
Page 5
A14 Jun 20/91
Ci~echcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Remove all grease and oil from the electrical TYPICAL BLIND GROUND STUD
bonding surface with cleaner (6, Chart 1). (FIGURE 2)
b. Remove all paint or lacquer from the electrical
Installation of a typical blind ground stud may be
bonding surface with MEK (1, Chart 1).
accomplished as follows:
NOTE
NOTE
Use care not to remove any zinc or
Use MS35338 lock washers on all
cadmium plating from the steel sur-
bolted electrical bonding/grounding
faces.
connections. Their function is to
ensure a tight connection with plain or
c. Allow the electrical bonding surfaces time to
self-locking nuts under conditions
thoroughly dry. where thermal expansion of the screw
d. Install the component being electrically occur.
may
bonded.
The bond area must be refinished paint (cleaning of the upper and lower surfaces is
within 24 hours of bonding
to preserve
not required).
the integrity of the bond. If the bond b. Ensure the blind ground stud is of sufficient
involves a structural component, it size to distribute the current it will be subjected to.
must be fillet sealed at the edges or
seams with sealer (5, Chart 1) to pre- ORES STEEL OR TITANIUM ELECTRICAL
vent moisture from entering and dete- BONDING
riorating the electrical bonding sur- (FIGURE 3)
faces. Refer to Chapter 20-08-00 for
information on airplane finishes, a. Prepare the electrical bonding surfaces as
outlined under METAL SURFACE PREPARATION
STAINLESS STEEL AND TITANIUM SURFACES AND ELECTRICAL BONDING in this chapter.
b. Screw size: Use a No. 10 screw where edge
a. Remove all oil and grease from the electrical distance will A No. 8 No. 6
permit. or screw may be
bonding surface with cleaner solvent (6, Chart 1). substituted for the No. 10 screw if necessary to
b. Remove all lacquer from the electrical
paint or meet edge distance requirements. A Titanium or
bonding surface with MEK (1, Chart 1). CRES steel screw must be used.
c. Allow the electrical bonding surface to thor- c. Use a 1/4-inch diameter fastener for 100-amp
oughly dry, current returns.
20-03-00
Page 6
Jun 20/91 A14
~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ALUMINUM
STRUCTURE
WASHER (ALCLAD)
NOT USED WITH
PLATE NUT
SELF-LOCKING NUT
2000-610-35
(3R SELF-LOCKING
PLATE NUT
g. Use an MS21042L
self-locking nut, or a self- d. Use a 5/16-inch diameter fastener for 200-
locking nutplate (MS21047L or MS21069L) to retain
the screw.
amp current retLjrns.
20-03-00
Page 7
A14 Jun 20/91
’i3eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Use an MS35206 cad plated steel screw e. Use an MS21042L self-locking cad plated
below 3300 F.. steel nuts.
20-03-00
Page 8
Jun 20/91 A14
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CLEAN TAB TO
BASIC METAL AND
TAB WELDED OR SEAL AFTER
BRAZED TO TUBING INSTALLATION.
I __
I
I I
CLEAN TAB TO
BASIC METAL AND
SEAL AFTER
INSTALLATION.
2000-610-37
20-03-00
Page 9
A14 Jun 20/91
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LOCK WASHER F
LOCK NUT
TERMINAL
WASHER D (LIMIT TO 4)
STRUCTURE
WASHER A
t LOCK WASHER E
SCREW
2000-610-39
OR BOLT
20-03-00
Page 10
Jun 20/91 A14
Qeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TYPICAL GROUND STUD ELECTRICAL BONDING where thermal expansion of the screw
Accomplish electrical bonding of ground studs for d. Refer to Chart 2 for a listing of compatible
current returns as follows: hardware used with grounding studs.
c. Use a 5/16-inch diameter fastener for 200- b. Use an NAS1919M04S rivet to attach the
amp current returns. ground tab.
ITEM TO BE BONDED
THROUGH MOUNTING FEET
LOCK
WASHER
NOTE
2000-610-43
Electrical Bonding of Equipment Installed With Mounting Feet
Figure 9
20-03-00
Page 11
A14 Jun 20/91
~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
REFINISHED
AREA
MOUNTING LOCK
BA~E WAS~HER CLEANED
BONDING SHOCK AREA
STRAP MOUNT
NOTE
20-03-00
Page 12
Jun 20/91 A14
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
This airplane uses carbon steel control cables of multiple wire construction with the number of strands varying
according to the diameter of the cable. The carbon steel wire is helically twisted into strands and the strands wound
about other strands forming the flexible carbon steel cable.
RECOMMENDED MA TERIALS
The recommended materials listed in Chart 1 as meeting federal, military or vendor specifications are provided for
reference only and are not specifically required by Raytheon Aircraft Company. Any product conforming to the
specification may be used subject to availability. The products included in this chart have been tested and approved
for aviation usage by Raytheon Aircraft Company, by the vendor or by compliance to the applicable specifications.
GENERIC OR LOCALLY MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS WHICH CONFORM TO THE REQUIREMENTS OF A
SPECIFICATION MAY BE USED EVEN THOUGH NOT INCLUDED IN THE CHART. Only the basic number of
each specification is listed. No attempt has been made to update the listing to the latest revision. it is the
responsibility of the technician or mechanic to determine the current revision of the applicable specification prior to
usage of the product listed. This can be done by contacting the vendor of the product to be used.
Chart 1
RECOMMENDED MATERIALS
1
20-04-00 Mar 31/04Page
NayNmea Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WARNING: When inspecting control cables, always wear gloves to avoid injury from frayed or broken wires.
When a control cable is removed from the airplane, the cable should be dipped in
MIL-C-16173 corrosion preventive (2, Chart 1). Excess corrosion preventive may be removed by
wiping with a clean cloth.
a. Inspect the control cables for incorrect routing, fraying and twisting. Look for interference with adjacent airplane
structure, equipment, wiring, plumbing and other control cables.
NOTE: It is important to operate controls through their full range that cables away from pulleys and all
I
so move
b. Monitor control cable movement for freedom, looseness and full travel.
c. Visually inspect all swaged fittings for distortion, cracks or broken wires at the fitting.
d. Turnbuckles should have the proper thread exposure and be correctly safety wired.
1. Inspect the control cables near fairlead pulleys by passing a along the length of the cable. If
cloth a snag is
found, closely examine the cable to determine the extent of the damage (Ref. Figure 1).
2. Any suspect cable should be removed and placed in a loop position and checked for additional broken wires
(Ref. Figure 1).
NOTE: Individual broken wires are acceptable in primary and secondaty control cables at random locations
when there are no more than three broken wires on any three foot segment of cable.
The interior of all tumbuckles should be coated or filled with MIL-G-23827 grease (1, Chart 1) for
corrosion protection.
3. Inspect the control cables with broken wires for evidence of corrosion. If necessary, remove the control
cable, form it into a loop and check the center strand for corrosion. Replace any control cable that shows
evidence of corrosion.
Page
raM2
31/04 20-04-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTEN#NCE MANUAL
2000-610-6 1
Control cables should be stored straight or in a coil. When stored in coil form, the coil inside diameter should not be I
less than 150 times the control cable diameter, or bent in a radius of not less than 75 times the control cable
diameter. Coils should not be flattened, twisted or folded during storage. Storage requirements should apply until
the control cable is installed in its normalposition in the airplane. If only a part of the control cable is installed in an
assembly, control cable requirements apply to the uninstalled portion of the control cable.
3
A25 20-04-00 Mar 31/04Page
Raltheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: Control cable pulleys are installed along the control cables where a change of direction is needed.
a. Inspect all control cable pulleys for roughness, sharp edges and presence of foreign material embedded in the
b. Inspect all control cable pulley bearings for smooth rotation, freedom from flat spots and foreign material.
I d. Inspect the control cable pulley brackets and guards for damage, misalignment and looseness.
e. Control cable pulleys which turn for a short distance must be rotated periodically to provide a new bearing
surface for the control cable.
WEAR
MARK
c-=-.------n-~-
WEAR
MARK
.L=--i_
FROZEN BEARING NORMAL CONDITION
Page
ra31/04
M4 20-04-00 A25
Cil)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
BEARINGS DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION b. Place two supports on the hydraulic press
table under the bearing housing as shown in Figure
This chapter contains bearing installation and 1. The supports should be at least 1/2-inch thicker
removal information, than the width.
bearing
c. Center a bearing removal and installation tool
RECOMMENDED MATERIALS on the bearing outer race. The bearing and installa-
tion tool should be approximately 1/8-inch smaller
ihe recommended materials listed in Chart 1 as
than the outside diameter of the bearing outer race.
meeting federal, military or vendor specifications
are provided for reference only and are not specifi-
BT01240
20-05-00
Page 1’
A14 Jun 20/91
~-)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LOAD MUST BE
REMOVAL AND APPLIED TO OUTER
INSTALLATION TOOL BEARING RACE ONLY.
NUT
WASHER
SOCKET
HOUSING l~r BEARING
SUPPORT
HOUSING
SOCKET
BEARING WASHER
BOLT
Bearing Removal
Figure 1
d. Install a washer and bolt through one of the
sockets, through the center of the bea~ng, then t U´•,,,,(
through the opposite socket as shown in Figure 1.
When cleaning bearing surfaces, never
e. Install a washer and nut on the bolt threads. allow solvent to enter the bearing.
f. the nut the bolt until the pressure Never touch the bearing or bearing
Tighten on
20-05-00
Page 2
Jun 20/91 A14
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
OUTER
BEARING
RACE
HOUSING
.010 TO .030 ~.OIO-INCH
.025 R
~I .010 TO
.032 INCH
SUPPORT
INNER STAKE
BEARING
RACE
NOTE
2000-610-50
Bearing Staking
Figure 2
20-05-00
Page 4
Jun 20/91 A14
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
This chapter contains information to remove, maintain and install hose and tube assemblies and fittings. Although
all hoses and tubes may not be specifically identified herein, the basic maintenance practices normally apply. Any
handling and installation of individual system hoses, tubes and fittings is identified in the appropriate system chapter.
The majority of tube assemblies used in the airplane are aluminum or steel machine formed tubing assemblies.
Hoses are used in areas of the airplane where a flexible line is more suitable for installations and freedom of
movement is necessary.
1
20-06-00
RBYtheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANC~ ~ANUAL
Observe all WARNINGS, CAUTIONS and NOTES throughout this maintenance manual when performing
maintenance, repair or servicing on any fluid or pneumatic operated system.
CAUTION: Verify that systems which operate from fluids or pneumatics under pressure are fully depressurized
before opening or disconnecting a tubing or hose.
The following list of maintenance practices is provided as an aid for handling, removing, installing and repairing
tubing and hoses.
a. Cap or plug all disconnected tubing and hose assemblies and fittings immediately to prevent contamination of
the system.
b. Visually check for cleanliness, evidence of contamination and obstructions prior to reconnection of tube or hose
assemblies.
c. Any hose and tube assemblies that did not have protective covers installed must be cleaned and checked for
obstruction prior to installation.
d. When connecting tube assemblies, do not force the tube assembly to the installed position. If a mismatch
between the male and female fittings should result, see Figure 1 for the allowable mismatch.
f. The hose material must be compatible with the applicable system fluids. Substitution of a hose material that is
not compatible with the system fluid will contaminate the system.
a. Relieveallsystem pressure.
b. Disconnect both ends of the hose or tube assembly and immediately cap or plug the tube or hose ends and
fittings.
d. Remove the tube or hose assembly and tag identity both ends to aid in reinstallation.
NOTE: If a new hose assembly is to be installed, the hose assembly must be clean, the correct length, clear of
obstructions and material compatible with the system fluid.
a. Observe the maintenance practices outlined under the heading TUBE AND HOSE ASSEMBLIES AND
FITTINGS MAINTENANCE PRACTICES.
d. After torquing the B nuts, inspect the hose to ensure that the hose is not under tension and that no indication of I
twisting is present.
g. Inspect the hose for clearance to all structure. If inadequate clearance exists between the hose and structure,
protection must be provided for the hose to prevent damage from chafing.
NOTE: If a new tube assembly is to be installed, the tube assembly must be clean, the correct length, clear of
obstructions and manufactured of the correct material.
a. Observe the maintenance practices outlined under the heading TUBE AND HOSE ASSEMBLIES AND
FITTINGS MAINTENANCE PRACTICES.
b. Inspect the tube for damage, particularly at tube ends, fittings, and bends. Damaged Zube assemblies should be
replaced or repaired.
c. Make certain that the fittings are properly installed before connection of the tube assembly.
d. Check alignment and fit of the tube assembly as follows before installation:
1. Place the tube assembly in the proper position and tighten one coupling nut at one end of the tube assembly.
2. The opposite end of the tube must be within two degrees of parallel with the fitting (Ref. Figure 1).
3. The free tubing end must be aligned within 1/32 inch of the fitting per every 10 inches of tube length.
4. The free end of the tube must match the fitting cone lengthwise within 1/32 inch per every 10 inches of tube
length.
f. install the tube assembly on the fittings and tighten the B nuts to the torque values specified (Ref. Chart 1).
a. Lubricate the male threads of the fitting, backup ring and packing sparingly with the system fluid or petrolatum
(AN-P-51, Vaseline).
b. Install the nut (AN6289) on the fitting until the nut is clear of the thread relief.
e. Turn the nut down until the packing is pushed firmly against the lower threaded section of the fitting.
f. Install the fitting into the boss with the nut turning with the fitting until the packing contacts the boss.
A26 20-06-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g. Holding the nut with a wrench to prevent it from turning, rotate the fitting in an additional 1 112 turns. Position
the fitting in the proper direction by turning in no more than one additional turn.
h. Holding the fitting, turn the nut down tightly against the boss. Slight extrusion of the ring around the backup ring
is acceptable.
a. Lubricate the packing with the system fluid or petrolatum (AN-P-51, Vaseline).
c. Thread the fitting into the boss until it bottoms tightly on the boss.
2. Wrap the tape around the fitting in the direction of the threads. Wrap clockwise for right hand threaded
fittings. Wrap counterclockwise for left hand threaded fittings.
3. Apply tension to the tape to conform the tape to the shape of the threads.
4. The tape should overlap the previous wrap of tape up to one-half inch to seal pipe thread fittings up to two
inches in diameter.
I~ Thread the fitting into the boss and tighten until it bottoms tightly on the boss.
Sep 20-06-00
RayHheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
MAXIMUM
t ALLOWABLE
INCH PER
10 INCHES OF
t
TUBE LENGTH
MEASURE
MISMATCH WITH
MAXIMUMALLOWABLE
1/32 INCH PER
FREE END CLEAR
10 INCHES OF
II OF FITTING
TUBE LENGTH
MAXIMUM
2 DEG
i i
4
ALLOWABLE
1/32 INCH PER
10 INCHES OF
MAX TUBE LENGTH
Chart 1
Flared Fitting Torque Chart (In.-lbs)
Hose Tubing Aluminum Steel Aluminum Steel Oxygen Hose End
Size O.D. Tubing Tubing Tubing Tubing Line Fitting Fitting
(inches) Flare Flare Flareless Flareless (Aluminum)
Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max
-5 5/16 60 80 180 200 100 130 180 200 100 125 85 180
-6 3/8 75 125 270 300 100 130 270 300 100 250
-8 1/2 150 250 450 500 200 240 450 500 210 420
-10 5/8 200 350 700 800 360 400 700 800 300 480
-12 3/4 300 500 1100 1150 390 430 1100 1150 500 850
-16 1 500 700 1200 1400 600 900 1200 1400 700 1150
-20 11/4 600 900 1300 1450 600 900 1300 1450
-24 11/2 600 900 1350 1500 600 900 1350 1500
5
A26 20-06-00
RBytheMI Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TUBE OUTSIDE
DIAMETER (D)
BEND‘RADII IS MEASURED
TO TUBE CENTERLINE
TUBE CENTER
LINE
2000-610-64
Tube Bending
Figure 2
NOTE: Nicks and scratches not exceeding the following limitations may be repaired by polishing out the damaged
area, using fine gradeof emery cloth and oil. Finish polishing with crocus cloth and oil. Flush and clean all
grit from line assembly.
a. Replace steel tubes which have nicks or scratches deeper than 10% of tubing wall thickness.
b. Replace any aluminum tube which has nicks or scratches deeper than 20% of the tube wall thickness.
c. Replace any tubes which have dents deeper than 5% of the tube outside diameter.
Chart 2
Tubing Bending Limits
7
A26 20-06-00Page
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LOCKING DEVICES DESCRIPTION AND cent boss or casing. Never lockwire bushing to
OPERATION plug. Cotter pins should be installed so that the
head fits into the slot of the castellated nut and,
Except for specific instructions required to satisfy a unless otherwise specified, one end of the pin
certain application, the following procedures are
should be bent over the stud or bolt and the other
standard methods used to install various locking
end flat against the flat of the nut.
devices used in conjunction with bolts, screws and
nuts.
LOCKING DEVICES MAINTENANCE
Where self-locking nuts are used, the following pro- LOCKW/RE INSTALLA T/ON PROCEDURES
cedure applies:
(FIGURES 1 AND 2)
a. For self-locking nuts, note the torque neces-
not possible, replace the nut.After tightening the tends to tighten and keep a part locked in place,
nut to the recommended torque, the nut must not thus counteracting the natural tendency of the part
be loosened to permit insertion of a cotter pin. If the to loosen.
slot in the nut or lockwire hole in the bolt or screw
e. Lockwire must never be overstressed. It will
is not correctly aligned at the minimum torque value break under vibrations if twisted too tightly. The
given,the nut, screw or bolt should be further tight-
lockwire shall be pulled taut when being twisted, but
ened to the next alignment position, but the maxi-
shall have minimum tension, if any, when secured.
mum torque value given must not be exceeded.
Should alignment still be impossible without f. Lockwire ends must be bent toward the
exceeding the maximum torque, back off the nut engine, or structure, to avoid sharp or projecting
one-half turn and retorque. ends which might present a safety hazard or vibrate
in the air stream.
Lockwire and cotter pins must never be reused. All
lockwire and cotter pins must fit snugly into drilled 9´• Internal wiring must not cross over or obstruct
holes in the bolts and studs for locking purposes. a flow passage when an alternate method can be
20-07-00
Page 1
A14 Jun 20/91
Oeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g
CLOCKWISE DIRECTION
UNTIL THE WIRE IS CUT OFF EXCESS
TIGHT. WHEN TIGHTENED H TIWERIWCUTTERS
DIAGONAL
THE WIRE SHALL HAVE
APPROXIMATELY 7 TO 10
TWISTS PER INCH.
2000-604-18
20-07-00
Page 2
Jun 20/91 A14
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
20-07-00
Page 3
A14 Jun 20/91
Ci~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 1
COTTER PIN INFORMATION
BT01083
20-07-00
Page 4
Jun 20/91 A14
Qccchcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i. Cadmium plated cotter pins should not be c. External type rings must be expanded only
used in applications bringing them in contact with enough to allow installation without becoming bent.
fuel, hydraulic fluid or synthetic lubricants. d. After installation, ensure each retaining ring is
completely seated in its groove, without looseness
KEYWASHERS (TAB AND CUP TYPES) or distortion.
INSTALLA TION
TURNBUCKLE LOCK CLIP INSTALLATION
The terms keywasher, tabwasher and cupwasher (FIGURE 4)
are interchangeable.
Observe the following when installing new key- NOTE
washers, tabwashers and dupwashers: The turnbuckle barrel must be filled
with MIL-G-23827 grease before the
a. Always use new washers for each assembly,
threaded terminals are screwed into
b. Whenbending or setting the washer tabs, do the turnbuckle barrel.
not use sharp pointed tools. Use of such tools can
lead to subsequent failure of the locking tabs which,
Safety turnbuckles with lock clips as follows:
upon becoming detached, can cause extensive
damage. a. New lock clips must be used.
TO PROVIDE CLEARANCE
PRONG MAY BE CUT HERE
PRONG MUST BE OF
SUFFICIENT LENGTH
AS SHOWN.
PRONGS MUST BE OF
SUFFICIENT LENGTH
TO EXTEND 90’
BEYOND HOLE AS
SHOWN.
20-07-00
Page 5
A14 Jun 20/91
Qeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
HOOK LOOP
HOOK LIP
LOCKING CLIP
2000-610-47
20-07-00
Page 6
Jun 20/91 A14
C~)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
insert the end of the locking clip into the terminal turnbuckle barrel using fingers only. Do not use a
and turnbuckle barrel end until the "U" curved end tool to check the lock clip installation as the locking
of the locking clip is over the hole in the center of could be distorted.
clip
the turnbuckle barrel.
g. Repeat the previous steps for installation of
d. Press the locking clip in the hole in the center
the locking clip on the opposite end of the turn-
of the turnbuckle barrel to its full extent.
buckle barrel.
e. The curved end of the locking clip will latch in
the hole in in the center of the turnbuckle barrel. h´• Both locking clips may be inserted in the same
20-07-00
Page 7
A~4 Jun 20/91
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTE~ANCE MANUAL
The following cleaning, waxing, placarding and painting information provides finish care information needed to
maintain the airplane in an approved condition.
RECOMMENDED MATERIALS
The recommended materials listed in Chart 1 as meeting federal, military or vendor specifications are provided for
reference only and are not specifically required by Raytheon Aircraft Company. Any product conforming to the
specification may be used subject to availability. The products included in these charts have been tested and
approved for aviation usage by Raytheon Aircraft Company, by the vendor or compliance to the applicable I
specifications. GENERIC OR LOCALLY MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS WHICH CONFORM TO THE
REQUIREMENTS OF A SPECIFICATION MAY BE USED EVEN THOUGH NOT INCLUDED IN THE CHART. Only
the basic number of each specification is listed. No attempt has been made to update the listing to the latest revision.
It is the responsibility of the technician or mechanic to determine the current revision of the applicable specification
prior to usage of the product listed. This can be done by contacting the vendor of the product to be used.
Chart 1
Recommended Materials
1
A26 20-08-00
Ray~eon AiKraff company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Recommended Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT VENDOR
19. Urethane Paint 6160 Matterhorn White U.S. Paint, Lacquer and
Chemical Co.
St. Louis, MO
CAUTION Since paint films do not obtain a hard finish fora considerable time after drying, airplanes thathave been
recently painted should not be polished or waved until the finish has cured for at least 60 days.
a. Remove dust and dirt from painted surfaces with a cellulose sponge and cool tap water.
b. Remove oil and grease with a cloth dampened with cleaner (3, Chart 1).
CAUTION: When washing the airplane with mild soap and water, use special care to avoid washing away grease
from any lubricated area. After washing the wheel well areas with solvent, lubricate all lubrication points.
Premature wear of lubricated surfaces may result if these precautions are not observed.
c. Remove insects with a cellulose sponge and a mild Ivory or Lux soap and water solution.
CAUTION: Harsh soaps and detergents will damage the airplane finish.
e. Dry the cleaned surface thoroughly with a chamois to prevent water marks.
A good coat of wax will protect the airplane finish from the sun’s rays and protect the surface against oxidation. Any
good automotive polish or wax may be used.
PLACARD REPLACEMENT
Allplacards must be in place and legible. Whenever the airplane has been repainted or touched up after repairs,
replace any placard that has been defaced or is missing.
URETHANE PAINTS
NOTE: Any time the paint on the airplane is stripped for repainting, whether the repaint is to be on a localized area
of the airplane or on the entire airplane, a thorough inspection for possible hidden corrosion should be
conducted.
The need for an extremely hard finish for protection against sandblast during takeoff and landings led to the
development of urethane coatings for airplanes. Urethane paint dries to a high gloss and retains color much better
than standard finishes. It is unaffected by the chemicals in hydraulic fluids, deicer fluids and fuels and requires less
care and maintenance than standard finishes.
NOTE: After any painting repairs, inspect placards to ascertain that none have been covered with paint.
3
azs 20-08-00
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: The time normally required for urethane paint to cure must be extended at temperatures below 70"F. The
paint will not cure at temperatures below 60"F.
This airplane is finished with pretreatment (wash) primer, urethane primer and a top coat of urethane enamel. The
following procedures include cleaning, paint stripping, repaint preparation, priming, applying a urethane topcoat and
an alternate method for small repairs not requiring paint stripping. Careful observance of these procedures should
result in a smooth, hard, glossy finish with firm adhesion for maximum life.
NOTE: Precut stripe, numeral and letter patterns available through Modagrafics, 5300 Newport Dr., Rolling
I
are
CAUTION: DO NOT USE STRIPPER OFANY TYPE FOR REMOVING PAINT FROM FISERGLASS, NYLON OR
COMPOSITE SURFACES. Paint must be removed from these surfaces with fine sandpaper, using care
not to sand into the material. Never use aluminum foil to mask electrothermal windshields during
painting, for most metal brighteners will combine with aluminum to form a hydrogen gas that eats away
the stannous oxide used as an antistatic coating on electrothermal windshields. If metal brighteners are
a. Mask around the edge of the skin or skins containing the damaged area. Use a double thickness of heavy paper
to prevent accidental splashes of paint stripper from penetrating the masking.
I b. Apply urethane stripper as instructed by the manufacturer. Stay approximately 1/8 inch away from the masking
tape. This will necessitate a little more cleanup upon finishing, but will prevent damage to the finish on the
adjacent skin. The stripper will not attack aluminum during the stripping process and can be neutralized
aftennrards by rinsing the affected area with water.
CAUTION: Urethane strippers usually contain acids that irritate or bum the skin. Wear rubber gloves and eye
protection when using stripper.
I d. Wash the stripped area carefully with a cleaner (1, 2 or 8, Chart 1). This will prevent tiny particles of loose paint
from adhering to the stripped area.
e. Using a nylon scratch pad or aluminum wool dipped in clean water, clean the surface with a cleanser such as
Bon Ami, Ajar, Comet cleaner, etc. A good scouring will leave the surface completely clean.
f. Thoroughly rinse with clean water and carefully dry the affected area. If the stripped area includes several joints
of skin laps, let the airplane sit until all moisture has dried. This may be accelerated by blowing the skin laps and
seams with compressed air. Wet masking should be replaced.
Sep 30/4Page
4
20-08-00
RBy~heOll nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINiENANCE MANUAL
An acid etching primer (4, Chart l)should be applied to improve the adhesion of the finishing coats. A base primer
(5, Chart 1) and catalyst (8, Chart 1) are used in equal parts as a pretreatment wash primer at the factory.
b. Apply a thin wet coat of primer. It should be permitted to dry for at least an hour, but not over six hours, before i
the next coat of urethane primer is applied.
URETHANE PRIMER
NOTE: For the best results these directions must be followed carefully, some manufacturers require that the primer
be allowed to set for 112 hour after the catalyst and base have been mixed while others recommend
immediate use after mixing.
b. Apply a coat of urethane primer with a spray gun using 35 to 40 psi of air pressure. A spotted appearance only
indicates that the coat is thin.
c. If the initial primer coat is allowed to cure for more than 24 hours before the topcoat is applied, sand the primer
slightly toroughen the surface and assure adhesion. Wipe off the sanding dust with a cloth dampened with a
cleaner (8, Chart 1), then apply the topcoat.
URETHANE TOPCOA TS
b. Apply the topcoat with a spray gun at 35 to 45 psi of air pressure. Two coats are normally required to fully
conceal the primer and build up the topcoat film necessary for adequate service life and beauty. The urethane
finish will normally cure to approximately 85% of its full hardness in 24 hours at temperatures of 80"F or higher.
b. Remove all loose edges of paint by using a high tack adhesive tape around the edge of the damaged area.
c. Using a coarse sandpaper, fair the edge of the damaged area with the metal.
d. When the edge of the paint begins to fair into a smooth joint, use a fine grade of sandpaper to eliminate the
scratches left by the coarse paper. Take care to avoid removing any more metal than is absolutely necessary.
e. Wash the sanded area with a cleaner (2 or 8, Chart 1). Change often to clean wash cloths so that all of the
sanding dirt will be picked up.
f. After the area to be touched up has been cleaned until all traces of discoloration are gone, apply a thin coat of
pretreatment primer (4, Chart 1) to the damaged area.
5
A28 20-08-00Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: If a metal conversion coating such as iridite or alodine is used, the wash primer coating can be dispensed
with. If the metal has not been treated with a metal conversion coating but no wash primer is available,
carefully clean the surface to be touched up and apply urethane primer (7, Chart 1) to the bare metal. This
should produce a satisfactory undercoat for the repair area.
g. After the urethane primer has cured for 24 hours, sand the area under repair with medium line sandpaper. Sand
the edge of the
repair area until the indentation where the metal and old paint meet is gone. If necessary, apply
additional urethane primer until the juncture of old paint with metal is no longer visible.
PAINTING MAGNESIUM
WARNING: Do not use paint strippers that may cause an immediate corr~slve effect on magnesium andlor
aluminum surfaces. Acid base and some phenol base strippers are not recommended. Consult
the manufacturer for cautions if the stripper is not listed in the consumable materials chart of
this manual.
a. Mask areas not being stripped with two or more thicknesses of masking tape and aluminum foil to prevent
accidental spillage from penetrating the masking.
b. Apply paint stripper (27, Chart 1, 91-00-00) to the surface being stripped with a brush or non-atomizing gun.
NOTE: Most strippers are neutralized with water; therefore, the surface being stripped must be thoroughly dry before
any application of the stripper. Magnesium surfaces are treated at the factory with a brown to amber Dow
19 primer coat. Any magnesium surfaces not displaying this color should be resprayed with a primer coat
before application of paint.
Dow 19 is used in the field to restore the original anti-corrosion surface treatment that may have been
penetrated in service. The chemicals for Dow #19 formula may be purchased from a Raytheon Aircraft
I Company Authorized Outlet in powder form or may be procured locally and produced as follows:
1. Place approximately 314 gallon of distilled water in a plastic container which will measure one gallon of fluid.
The water should be at a temperature of between 70 and 90"F.
4. Add distilled water to make one gallon of solution and stir vigorously for at least 15 minutes.
5. Brush the solution in and around the bare surfaces of the magnesium, keeping the area wet with the solution
for one to three minutes to produce a brown film. Do not exceed three minutes.
6. Rinse with cold running water and dry by exposure to hot air blast.
WARNIOJG: Stripping should be accomplished in a well ventilated area, since prolonged exposure to
high concentrates of vapor may irritate the eyes and lungs.
c. Allow the paint stripper to remain on the airplane for 20 to 30 minutes, then work the remaining paint loose with
a bristle brush. The stripper may remain on the airplane for 2 hours but must not be allowed to dry on the surface.
CAUTION: Never use a wire brush when removing paint from magnesium surfaces for it may cause damage to the
surface.
d. Remove the masking paper and wash the affected area thoroughly with water under high pressure. Remove all
remnants of paint with lacquer thinner.
NOTE: Any time an airplane is repainted, inspect all placards to assure that they are not covered with paint, are
a. Prepare the surface to be repainted as indicated under PAINT REMOVAL FROM MAGNESIUM SURFACES.
Clean the affected area thoroughly with lacquer thinner or an equivalent solvent.
NOTE: Unprimed areas of magnesium castings are to be coated with MIL-M-3171 corrosion preventative compound
(23, Chart 1, 91-00-00) unless these areas will come in contact with oil or grease after assembly. Any holes
in the castings which will receive bushings or bearings shall be coated with wet, unreduced zinc chromate
primer or corrosion preventative compound at the time of installation.
b. Prime the affected area with corrosion preventative compound and apply the urethane topcoat.
NOTE: Prior to application of the primer base, the magnesium surface should be thoroughly dried. Drying may be
accomplished by subjecting the magnesium to an elevated temperature of 130 to 140"F for a minimum of I
one hour. Allow a minimum of four hours drying time between application of the primer and topcoat.
SPECIAL PROCEDURES
PROPELLER BLADES
Paint the propeller blades as instructed by the propeller manufactures owner’s manual.
RUBBER SEALS
Apply one coat of a thoroughly dissolved solution of one part Oakite No. 6 (13, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and two parts
water to all rubber surfaces that are to come into contact with metal or other rubber surfaces.
Steel, aluminum or magnesium parts and assemblies which are enclosed and subject to high humidity should be
protected against corrosion by coating with either epoxy primer, MIL-C-16173 corrosion preventative compound,
light grease or heavy oil (5, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
7
na, 20-08-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Apply two (2) coats of Epoxy-Polyamide Primer per MIL-P-23377 (56, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
b. Apply two (2) coats of Matterhorn White urethane paint No. 6160 (57, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
a. Engine controls.
c. Exhaustmanifolds andexhauststacks.
d. Firewalls and wrought aluminum surfaces forward of the firewall, with the following exception:
e. Aluminumflexible conduit.
f. All tubing except unplated steel, which shall receive two coats of primer on the exterior, on interiors where the
I color scheme must be maintained, and except as noted, on the interior of the engine compartment.
g. Stall wamingvane.
n. Utility door opening threshold (E-llll, E-1241 and After; EA-11 and After).
o. Window moldings, overhead console escutcheon, shoulder harness escutcheon, lower utility door escutcheon,
window latch escutcheon, OAT escutcheon, ignition panel escutcheon, circuit breaker panel escutcheon, upper
utility door latch escutcheon, wing bolt cover escutcheons, and sidewall air valve escutcheons.
p. All bearing surfaces subject to rotation or sliding, such as elevator trim tab linkage joints.
q. All exterior placards. See Chapter 11 in this manual for placard locations.
8
Sep 30/4Page 20-08-00
RayNheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CORROSION- DESCRIPTION
Corrosion may develop at areas where the protective coating has been damaged. When this happens,
important it is
to restore the protective coating. Corrosion also occurs when dissimilar metals are in contact with any moisture
present. High levels of humidity, high levels of environmental impurities (such as salt spray, acid rain, exhaust
deposits, or chemical fumes), or high ambient temperatures will increase the rate of corrosion. Some of the more
common types of corrosion are surface corrosion, inter granular corrosion, pitting, exfoliation, and electrolytic or
I
galvanic corrosion.
GALVANIC CORROSION
The galvanic series shown below shows which metals are attacked when in contact with a dissimilar metal (Ref.
Figure 1). The wider the separation in the series, from the top to the bottom, the faster the rate of corrosion. A partial
galvanic series list follows:
Magnesium alloys
Zinc
Cadmium
Lead
Tin
Steel
Copper alloys
Nickel alloys
Titanium
NOTE: Corrosion is relative. For example: aluminum alloys corrode when in contact with steel; steels corrode when
in contact with copper.
n~26 20-09-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE I
GALVANIC COUPLES
EMP
METALLURGICAL CATEGORY PERMISSIBLE COUPLESr
[VOLT)
GOLD, SOLID AND PLATED; GOLD-PLATINUM ´•0.15
LOYS WROUGHT T NUM
2 RHODIUM: GRAPHITE +0.05
3 SILVER SOLID OR PLATED: HIGH SILVER ALLOYS O
4 NICKEL, SOLID OR PLATED; MONEL; HIGH NICKEL- -0.15
COPPER ALLOYS: TITANIUM
5 ICOPPER, SOLID OR PLATED; LOW BRASSES OR -0.20
BRONZES; SILVER SOLDER; GERMAN SILVER: HIGH
COPPER-NICKEL ALLOYS; NICKEL-CHROME ALLOYS;
AUSTENITIC STAINLESS STEELS (301, 302, 304,
309, 316 321, 347)
6 COMMERCIAL YELLOW BRASSES AND BRONZES -0.25
7 HIGH BRASSES AND BRONZES: NAVAL BRASS, MUNTZ -0.30
METAL
8 18% CHROMIUM TYPE CORROSION RESISTANT STEELS -0.35
4~0-430 431 446 17-7PH 17-4PH
9 CHROMIUM, PLATED; TIN, PLATED; 12% CHROMTUM -0.45
TYPE ORROSION-RES TANT STEEL 410 416 4
10 TIN-PLATE TERNEPLATE: TIN-LEAD SOLDERS -0.50
II LEAD SOLID OR PLATED HIGH LEAD ALLOYS -0.55
12 ALUMINUM, WROUGHT ALLOYS OF THE DURALUMIN -0.60
T 2014 04 201
13 IRON, WROUGHT, GRAY, OR MALLEABLE: PLAIN -0.70
ARBON AND LOW ALLOY TEELS: ARMCO IRON
14 ALUMINUM, WROUGHT ALLOYS OTHER THAN DURALUMIN; -0.75
TYPE 6061, 7075, 5052, 5056, 1100, 3003.
CAST ALLOYS OF THE SILICON TYPE 355, 356.
15 ALUMINUM, CAST ALLOYS OTHER THAN SILICON TYPE; -0.80
CADM UM PLATED A CHROMAT
16 HOT-DIP-ZINC PLATE: GALVANIZED STEEL -1.05
17´• ZINC WROUGHT; ZINC-BASE DIE CAST ALLOYS; ZINC- -1.10
AT
18 MAGNESIUM AND MAGNESIUM-BASE ALLOYS CAST OR -1.60
WROUGHT
2000-610-U
RECOMMENDED MA TERIALS
The recommended materials listed in Chart 1 as meeting federal, military or vendor specifications are provided for
reference only and are not specifically required by Raytheon Aircraft Company. Any product conforming to the I
specification may be used subject to availability. The products included in these charts have been tested and
approved for aviation usage by Raytheon Aircraft Company, by the vendor or compliance to the applicable
specifications. GENERIC OR LOCALLY MANUFACTURED PRODUCTS WHICH CONFORM TO THE
REQUIREMENTS OF A SPECIFICATION MAY BE USED EVEN THOUGH NOT INCLUDED IN THE CHART. Only
the basic number of each specification is listed. No attempt has been made to update the listing to the latest revision.
It is the responsibility of the technician or mechanic to determine the current revision of the applicable specification
prior to usage of the product listed. This can be done by contacting the vendor of the product to be used.
Chart 1
Recommended Materials
3
Ale 20-09-00 , ,Pljso/~;JPage
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANC~ MANUAL
CORROSION CONTROL
Corrosion damage requires inspection to determine the depth of penetration and the cross-sectional area change.
The damaged area must be thoroughly cleaned. If deterioration has significantly reduced the structural strength of
a part (e.g., a reduction of thickness more than 5%), the component must be repaired or replaced. Upon completion
of the clean-up or repair, all elements must be treated and refinished as applicable. In all instances, good preventive
maintenance and regular cleaning will be the most effective corrosion control.
The following solvents may be used to remove grease, oil, stains and other surface contaminants on most materials.
Product Specification
Trichloroethylene .................................0-T-634
Perchloroethylene............................................................ O-T-236
Toluene........................................................................... TT-T-548
Xylene.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TT-X-916
Kerosene VV-K-211
Vapor degreasing of parts may be used when the proper equipment is available.
WARNING: Do not use chlorides on titanium. Do not use exotic solvents on composites. Do not use any
solvents in areas close to the oxygen system.
CORROSION PROTECTION
In mechanical removal, it is essential that the abrasive materials on the tool leave no residue or particles that could
cause future corrosion. An abrasive previously used on ferrous metals will contain minute particles which will imbed
in aluminum alloys and start a new cycle of corrosion. A steel wire brush used on aluminum alloys will leave tiny
particles sufficient to initiate corrosion of the aluminum.
On aluminum alloy parts, corrosion is best removed with aluminum oxide abrasive paper or aluminum wool.
On clad aluminum alloys, use a chemical alkaline cleaner. Mix and store alkaline solutions in plastic, stainless steel,
or glass containers. Mask off all dissimilar metals as well as all cracks and sheet laps. Apply cleaner with a soft
brush. Rinse thoroughly with clean water and dry with compressed air.
Page
20-09-00 P126
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTE~ANCE MANUAL
WARNING: Always wear rubber gloves and protective clothing when working with acids. A face mask may
be necessary, depending upon ventilation in the area. If acid accidentally contacts skin or eyes,
immediately flush with fresh water and seek medical advice.
a. Strip all paint from the surface as directed under STRIPPING AND CLEANING URETHANE PAINT in Chapter
20-08-00.
c. Inspect the surface carefully to ensure that sufficient material remains to satisfy structural requirements.
1. Rinse the treated area in COLD running water and dry in an oven or by exposure to hot air blast.
NOTE: If cold running water is not available, rinsing may be eliminated and the area dried as stated above.
2. Brush 2 coats (a minimum of 30 minutes apart) of epoxy primer (2, Chart l)on and around the reworked
area. Assure adequate penetration of primer into the treated area.
After corrosion removal and surface cleaning, metals should be given protective treatment and painted. Alodine
treatment of aluminum alloys forms a protective coating which resists corrosion and provides a good surface for
adhesion of the paint primer.
Alodine 1200, 1200S, 1201 (1, Chart 1), or equivalent, when mixed 2 ounces per gallon of water, will be an
acceptable treatment material. Mix only in rubber, plastic or stainless steel containers. Alodine 1200 series products
contain fluorides that should not be mixed in glass containers. Coat the area with the Alodine solution and allow the
coating to dwell for approximately five minutes. After the dwell time has elapsed, wash the area with water and blow
dry (do not wipe dry). Paint the coated area with epoxy polyamide primer (2, Chart 1) and allow to dry.
WARNING: Brushes and cloths should not be left in the Alodine solution. They should be washed
immediately after use. If such items are left to dry in the open air, they could create a fire hazard.
CAUTION: Keep the Alodine solution confined to the affected area. Mask or seal all cracks and crevices, all steel
parts, and any mechanical components. Wash all brushes and cloths immediately after use to prevent
inadvertent contact with the acid solution and to eliminate a possible fire hazard from any such materials
that dry without being washed.
a. Strip all paint from the surface as directed under PAINT REMOVAL FROM MAGNESIUM SURFACES.
b, Mechanically remove corrosion by sanding or rubbing as necessary. If sanding, use aluminum sandpaper. Start
grit and finish with 400 grit.
with 240
c. Inspect the surface carefully to ensure that sufficient material remains to satisfy structural requirements.
d. Clean the corrosion removed area with Methyl Propyl Ketone (MPK) or naphtha.
5
A26 20-09-00Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINIENAN~E i~lANUAL
Any bare magnesium component which will be returned to service should be lightly sanded to remove any oxide
coatings and coated with Dow 19 formula.
I The chemicals for Dow #19 formula may be purchased from a Raytheon Aircraft Company Authorized Outlet in
powder form or may be procured locally and produced as follows:
a. Place approximately 314 gallon of distilled water in a plastic container which will measure one gallon of fluid. The
water should be at a temperature of between 70 and 90"F.
d. Add distilled water to make one gallon of solution and stir vigorously for at least 15 minutes.
e. Brush the solution in and around the bare surfaces of the magnesium, keeping the area wet with the solution
for one to three minutes to produce a brown film. Do not exceed three minutes.
f. Rinse with cold running water and dry by exposure to hot air blast.
I Remove corrosion from steel parts by mechanical means. Use a steel wire brush, a steel scraper, steel wool, or 400
grit abrasive paper.
If acid cleaning must be used, it is essential that all plated areas, operating mechanisms, braided lines, or material
laps which could trap the acid be adequately masked. Mix one part of metal conditioner and rust remover
(3, Chart 1) with one part of clean water in a stainless steel,- plastic or glass container. Apply solution to the corroded
area using an acid resistant brush. Allow to stand one minute, then thoroughly rinse with hot water and wipe dry.
WARNING: Always wear rubber gloves and protective clothing when working with rust removal. A face
mask may be necessary, depending upon ventilation in the area. It acid accidentally contacts
the skin or eyes, immediately flush with fresh water and seek medical advice.
In most cases, steel that has been cleaned shall be treated with a minimum of one coat of epoxy primer (2, Chart 1)
to protect against future corrosion.
6
Sep 30/4Page 20-09-00 A26
CHAPTER
AIR
CON DITIOMING
aeechclarfi
EONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SU&IECT PAGE
21140´•´•00
21150100
21 -Contents
Page~
A18 Aug 18/95
aeechcra~ft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SU&IECT PAGE
21 -Contents
Page 2
Aug 18/95 A18
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
21-Contents
1 Aug 18/95
2 Aug 18/95
21-40-00
1 Oct 16192
2 oct 16/92
3 Oct 16/92
4 Oct16/92
5 oct16/92
6 oct 16/92
7 oct 16/92
8 Oct16192
9 oct 16/92
10 oct 16/92
21-50-00
1 Aug 18/95
2 Aug 18/95
3 Aug 18/95
4 Aug 18/95
5 Aug 18/95
6 Aug 18/95
7 Aug 18/95
8 Aug 18/95
9 Aug 18/95
10 Aug 18/95
11 Aug 18/95
12 Aug 18/95
21-Effectivity
Page 1
A18 Aug 18/95
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CABIN HEA TING pushing the CABIN HEAT control full forward. How-
ever, in extremely high temperatures, it may be
A heat desirable to pull the red FIREWALL AIR control and
exchanger connected to the right exhaust
stack provides for heated air to five outlets in the use only the fresh air ventilation described in the fol-
forward and ah areas of the cabin. The two forward lowing paragraphs.
outlets located above and forward of each set of
rudder
are
21-40-00
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
HEATER
FRESH AIR INTAKE
(ENGINE BAFFLE) \\\\tJ _\ -HEATED AIR
LEFT FORWARD
VERBOARD VENT
FRESH AIR
(LEFT WING RO T)~rOUTLE IRIGHT FORWARD OUTLET
FRESH AIR
FIREWALL AIR\ L~fJ /-~MIYtl I~J ~(RIGHT WING ROOT)
CONTROL
INDIVIDUAL OVERHEAD
FRESH AIR OUTLETS
AFT OUTLET
t~3/ ~i I REAR SEAT)
OL CABLE
OPTIONAL 5TH AND 6TH SEATi
INDIVIDUAL OVERHEAD FRESH AIR OUTtCTS
tllll t
CABIN AIR
21-40-00
Page 2
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
HEATED AIR
FRESH AIR (LEFT WING ROOT) I (I UIBII tc~--FRESH AIR (RIGHT WING ROOT)
INDIVIDUAL OVERHEAD
FRESH AIR OUTLETS
CONTROL CABLE
i
AIRBLOWER g
OVERHEAD FRESH AIR
SHUT OFF VALVE 1
OVERHEAD FRESH AIR SCOOP
(F33A. F33C and A-36)
j~ CE-941 AND AFTER. CJ-156 AND
AFTER, D-1034B, D-10364 AND
AFTER AND E-1809 AND AFTER.
C9200101
21-40-00
Page 3
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
MIXER VALVE
(COLD POSITION)
DEFROSTER CONTROL
AFT OUTLET
CONTROL CABLE
WATER DRAINTHROUGH ~B
BOTTOM OF FUSELAGE
~Qf
Heating and Ventilating
OVERHEAD FRESH AIR INLET
C9200102
21-40-00
Page 4
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
EXHAUST GASES
FROM ENGINE
(RIGHT SIDE ONLY)
HEAT EXCHANGER
HEATER
DEFROSTER CONTROL
AFT OUTLET
24
BEA-8ANDAFTER CB?m103
21-40-00
Page 5
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
RIIAINTENANCE MANUAL
FRESH AIR INTAKE (NOSE)
HEATER MUFF
EXHAUST GASES
TO TURBOCHARGER--\ I I I~AIREXHAUST
AND OVERBOARD
MIXER VALVE
HEATER AIR INLET
RIGHT FORWARD OUTLET
c
LEFT FORWARD OUTLET~SI
OL CABLE
21-40-00
Page 6
A16
Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Inspect the air intake ducts leading to the heater; b. Install the heater in the airplane.
check all clamps and connections for tightness and
the duct for holes and cracks. Check the duct for
c. Connect the engine exhaust system to the
internal restrictions and/or collapsing. Check the
heater.
screen at the intake duct; remove and clean as nec-
essary.
d. Connect the heater ducts to the heater.
21-40-00
Page 7
A16 Oct16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
HEA TER PRESSURE TESTING planes, pressurize the heater to 25 psig. On A36TC
and B36TC, pressurize the heater to 5 psig. Pres-
The heater should be inspected for cracks and leaks surize the heater with air or nitrogen and either
which could introduce carbon monoxide into the immerse in water or "paint" with a soap solution. If
heating system. any leaks are apparent, replace the heater. This test
is also recommended for the heater at every engine
On all Bonanzas except the turbocharged models change.
(EA-1 and after), perform a visual inspection each 100
hours and pressure test each 500 hours. On the NOTE
turbocharged models (EA-1 and after), visually
inspect and pressure test each 100 hours. The pres- The heat transfer studs along with the
sure test can be accomplished as follows: internal baffle and/or cone must be in
place for a correct supply of heat. Any
a. Remove the heater as indicated in HEATER warpage is cause for replacement.
REMOVAL.
c. If the inspection indicates a good heater,
b. Inspect the heater visually and pressure reinstall the heater as indicated in HEATER INSTAL-
Itest for leaks. On F33A, F33C, V35B and A36 air- LATION.
21-40-00
Page 8
Oct 16/92 Ale
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
DUCT TO
AIR INTAKE
ADAPTER IC´•\\\\\
MOUNTING
BRACKET ~f_,,,,,
DNUT SCREW (4)
’p-- SCREW 14)
13~ WASH,ER (3)
OVERHEADDUCT TO SPACER
NUT
OUTLETS
WASHER (3
CLAMP
g~/
SAFETY CLAMP (2)/ Ad~ SPACER (2)
SCREW \BLOWER
BOLT
nETnlL A~ DETAIL A~
21-40-00
Page 9
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Remove the fifth and sixth seats when a. Place the blower in position and install four
installed, screws attaching the adapter and blower to the
mounting bracket.
b. Remove the cabin rear upholstery panel.
b. Connect the air ducts with clamps.
c. Disconnect the electrical connector.
c. Install the screw, or bolt(s), and spacer(s)
d. Remove the clamps securing the ducts to through the blower fiange and brackets.
the fan inlet and outlet.
d. Blowers that have the safety clamps must
e. Remove the safety wire from airplanes that be safety wired.Use a minimum of three strands of
comply with Service Bulletin No. 2380. .041-inch safety wire looped through the safety
clamps. The safety wire should be installed with a
f. Remove the screw (or bolt/bolts) through slight tension and each strand should have equal
the blower flange and mounting bracket. Observe tension.
spacer and washer installation so they can be
installed in the original locations. e. Connect the electrical connector.
g. Remove four screws through the adapter, f. Install the rear upholstery panel.
mounting bracket and the blower housing. Remove
the blower from the airplane. g. Install the fifth and sixth seats if used.
"END"
CONTINUEB
21-40-00
Page 10
Oct 16/92 A16
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
switch will remove power from the compressor clutch inches. In flight, the door opens to approximately 3/4
coil, and drive the condenser air scoop door closed. 112 inch. The air scoop door-actuator-limit switches
When the airplane is airborne and the landing gear is are preset; however if adjustment becomes neces-
retracted, power is transmitted from the normally open sary, refer to CONDENSER CONTROL RIGGING in
contacts of the full throttle switch (actuated closed this chapter.
when the throttle isfully open), through right land-
the
The belt-driven compressor, which is coupled with a
ing gear uplock-position switch (actuated closed when
magnetic clutch, compresses the refrigerant to a high
the gear is up and locked) to the condenser air scoop
I pressure, high temperature gas. This gas passes
through the condenser where cooling air removes
normally open flight-position-limit
contacts of the door
heat from the gas, condensing it to a liquid state. The
switch located at the end of the door (actuated closed
liquid then passes through the expansion valve where
when the door is closed), causing the actuator to open
it is metered into the evaporator at a rate of 55 psi, (30
the door to the Right position. When the door flight-
psi on serials E-2104, E-2111 and after; EA-320,
position-limit switch is actuated, the power is then EA-440 and after;and CE-1037 and after) which
directed to the compressor clutch coil.
allows most of the liquid to return to a gas. The heat
A light, independent of the air-conditioner circuit, is required for evaporation is absorbed from cabin air
actuated by the condenser air scoop door, through the passing over the evaporator coils. After passing
leftlanding gear uplock-position switch’s normally through the evaporator, the refrigerant returns to the
closed contacts (closed with the landing gear compressor at a reduced pressure.
extended), which will indicate a door-open condition
while the gear is extended.
A time delay relay has been added to the compressor
circuit at serials E-2104, E-2111 and after; EA-320,
The high-pressure-sensing switch monitors the pres- EA-440 and after; CE-1037 and alter. The time delay
sure of the refrigerant from the compressor to the relay prevents the compressor from being energized
expansion valve. The normally closed high pressure while a high head pressure exists, which would cause
switch will actuate, causing an open circuit to the com- unnecessary stress on the belt and other components.
presser clutch coil when the pressure in the line The time delay relay is located on the forward side of
reaches 390 a 10 psi, (340 a 10 psi on serials E-2121 the front spar carry-through on the right side of the
and after; EA-320, EA-440 and after; CE-1030 and airplane.
after) which disables the compressor. The high pres-
sure switch automatically resets to the normally All Serials
(Effectivity: except E-2104,
closed position when the refrigerant falls to a safe E-211 I and after and except EA-320,
pressure. There is also a high-pressure-poppet relief
valve, located on the forward side of the firewall,
EA-369 and after)
which will relieve the system if the pressure reaches
The optional air-conditioning system is controlled by a
450 psi, and will reseal again at 360 psi.
switch on the powerplant control panel and by both
The low pressure switch, normally open (actuated high- and low-pressure-sensing switches. The switch
closed when the system is charged with refrigerant) which controls the system is located on the power-
senses system pressure. When the pressure in the plant control panel (console) and is placarded AIR
21-50-00
Page 1
A18 Aug 18/95
ciS3eechcfaft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
COND OFF HI LO. The system circuit breaker, umn and are placarded A/C OFF and BLOWER HI LO
located on the right hand subpanel, is placarded A/C and OFF. The two circuit breakers which protect the
CIR BKR. system are located in the left sidewall circuit breaker
The entire system is protected by a 15-amp circuit panel. One circuit breaker (5 amps) protects the com-
breaker. The compressor and condenser air scoop presser wiring, while the other (15 amps) protects the
door are protected by two separate 5-amp fuses. The blower wiring.
21-50´•00
Page 2
Aug 18/95 A18
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I i
15
r-- 9
16
10
17
I. Compressor
2. High Pressure Line
3. High Pressure Reltef Valve
4. High Pressure Sense Switch
5. Condenser
6. Receiver-Drrer and Sioht Class
7. High Pressure Service Valve
8. Expansion Valve
9. Evaporator
10. Low Pressure Service Valve
I. Low Pressure Limit Switch
I
12. Low Pressure Line i I
13. Louvers-Atr Duct
14. Air Duct
15. Fan
16. Fan Mater
17. Condenser Actuator
ie. Compressor Clutch and Pullev
c95E~sleoon c
Alr-Condltloner System
Figure 1
21-50-00
Page 3
A18 Aug 18/95
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 1
TROUBLESHOOTING
AIR-CONDITIONING SYSTEM (EffectSvity: Optional)
PROBLEM PROBABLE CAUSE i CORRECTIVE ACTION
1. Insufficient cooling. a. Blower not functioning. a. Repair.
b. Obstructed or disconnected air b. Remove obstruction or repair.
duct.
21-50-00
Page 4
Aug 18/95 A18
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
COOLING I MAINTENANCE PRACTICES freeze into ice at the expansion valve, but can also
(Effectivlty: Optional) cause hydrochloric or hydrofluoric
the formation of
acids in the system. The air-conditioning system must
MAINTENANCE OF AIR-CONDITIONER be purged if contaminated with foreign material or
moisture.
Servicing the air-conditioning system consists of peri-
odically checking the refrigerant level, checking com-
pressor oil level and changing the system air filter.
e. All precautions should be taken to prevent dam-
age to fittings or connections. Even minute damage to
I
a connection could cause it to leak. Any fittings getting
Recharge the system whenever the refrigerant level is
grease or dirt on them should be wiped clean with a
low, air has entered the system or components carry-
cloth dampened with alcohol. Do not use chlorinated
ing refrigerant replaced. Refrigerant leaks may be
are
for
solvents such as trichloroethylene a cleaning
detected by inspection with a flameless leak detector.
agent, for they contaminants. If dirt, grease or
are
moisture gets inside lines and cannot be removed, the
PRECAUTIONARY SERVICE MEASURES
line will have to be replaced.
a. Due to the air qualityregulations enacted
control
in the United States, R-12 refrigerant cannot be
vented into the atmosphere. When performing mainte-
f. For
EA-579,
airplane serials prior
use a
to CE-1792, E-2945 and
small amount of clean 500 viscosity I
refrigeration oil (8, Chart 1, 91-00-00) on all tube joints
nance on the air-conditioning system where R-12 can
and dip the o-ring in this oil before assembling the
escape from the system, evacuate the system with joint.
only a recovery or recycle servicing unit that will sal-
vage the refrigerant, g. For airplane serials CE-1792 and after, E-2945 1
and after, and EA-579 and after, use a small amount
b. The air-conditioning system is a high pressure of Ester Oil (65, Chart 1, 91-00-00) on all tube joints
system. Before disconnecting a refrigerant line, the and dip the o-ring in this oil before assembling the
system must be discharged with a recovery servicing joint. This will help in making a leak-proof joint.
unit. Purge the entire system to a 125-micron level.
1,,,,41
CAUTION
WARNING
Insufficiently torqued tubing connections
can result in loose joints while exces-
A face shield should be worn when
sively torqued connections can cause
performing maintenance on the Ilnes deformed joint parts. Either condition
because refrigerant coming In con-
can result in refrigerant leakage.
tact with the eyes can cause loss of
sight. h.
ant
connecting aluminum fittings in the refriger-
When
system, torque all 5/8-inch fittings to 18 21 foot- I
Do not smoke when servicing the pounds and all 1/2-inch fittings to 11 13 foot-pounds.
system with refrigerant because It
converts to a highly toxic gas when NOTE
exposed to an open flame.
The receiver-dryer is the last assembly
c. Before any service is attempted which requires to be connected. This is necessary to
opening of refrigeration plumbing or units, the person reduce and/or eliminate the entry of
moisture into the lines.
doing the work should be throughly familiar with
instructions onservicing the system. They should fol- For charging the air-conditioner or checking the oil,
low very carefully these instructions when performing refer to Chapter 12-10-00.
the task that will maintain this system in a proper func-
tioning order.
AIR-CONDITIONING FUNCTIONAL TEST
for these for
I d. The major reasons measures are
With the engine running at 1,000 rpm and the system
the system. Dirt contaminants may cause leaky valves on, observe the sight glass. If refrigerant appears
or wear in the compressor. Moisture may not only milky or bubbles appear, charge the system as noted
21-50-00
Page 5
A18 Aug 18/95
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE I~ANUAL
ELECTRIC
CLUTCH
SUCTION
ENGINE-DRIVEN
COMPRESSOR IDISCHARGE
HIGH PRESSURE
SWITCH
LOW PRESSURE
SWITCH
PRESSURE RELIEF
VALVE SERVICE VALVE
[SUCTION) UNDER
COPILOT’S SEAT
RECYCLE/
RECOVERY
UNIT
SERVICE VALVE
(HIGH PRESSURE)
UNDER COPILOT’S
SEAT
RECEIVER DRYER 5
O SIGHT GLASS UNDER
COPILOT’S SEAT
EXPANSION
VALVE
IN OUT
tII
CONDENSER
IN OUT
EVAPORATOR
C91E1~185118 C
21 -50-00
Page 6
Aug 18/95 A~8
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
under the heading CHARGING THE AIR- belt should be retensioned to 50 to 65 pounds and
CONDITIONING SYSTEM in Chapter 12-10-00. maintained at this tension. To check the compressor
Check the system for leaks using a flameless leak belt tension, use a Burrough’s Model BT-33-73F-50
detector. belt tension gage or equivalent. Position the belt ten-
sion gage as shown in Figure 3. If a belt tension gage
SYSTEM LEAK DETECTION is not available, a properly tensioned new belt will
A reduction of system cooling ability or the presence require 4.1 to 5.0 pounds force for a midspan deflec-
of bubbles in the refrigerant, may indicate a partial tion of 0.14 inch. After 5 hours operating time, the belt
loss of refrigerant. Check for bubbles in the sight glass should be retensioned. After 5 hours, a properly ten-
on the receiver-dryer located under the copilot’s seat. sioned belt will require a force of 3.3 to 4.1 pounds for
The sight glass should be checked during operation at a midspan deflection of 0.14 inch. The belt should be
maximum available ambient and cabin temperatures. maintained at this tension. See Figure 4 for belt ten-
Streams of bubbles past the glass and/or milky sion by midspan deflection.
appearance in the glass indicate an inadequate quan-
tity of refrigerant. If a loss of refrigerant is suspected, COMPRESSOR MOUNTING TORQUES
an inspection of the system plumbing should be car- Mounting Bracket to Engine
ried out to locate the source of the leak. Large leaks
Bolts 220 to 260 in. Ibs.
may be located by the appearance of oily spots where
oil has been carried out by escaping refrigerant. Nut ................................................275
to 325 in.lbs.
Smaller leaks, which are much more difficult to locate,
Compressor to Bracket
may be detected by detergent bubbles, or an elec-
tronic detector. Nut on Bolt ................................,.275
to 325 in. Ibs.
New belts should be installed with a static tension of f. If the drive pulley was removed, install the cotter
65 to 80pounds. After 5 hours of operating time, the pin.
21-50-00
Page 7
A18 Aug 18/95
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
If the cotter pin holes do not align within e. Install the fairing.
the prescribed torque range, a new nut f. Install the beacon light.
may be installed or one AN960-C916L
washer may be used under the nut. CONDENSER CONTROL RIGGING
The condenser is located on the bottom side of the
CONDENSER REMOVAL
airplane fuselage approximately even with the 3rd and
The condenser is located beneath the airplane aft of 4th seats. With the airplane on the ground and the air-
the main spar carry-through. conditioner turned on, the condenser will be fully
open. Any tine the air-conditioner is turned off or the
a. Remove the beacon light.
engine is at full throttle with the air-conditioner turned
b. Removethefairing aft ofthecondenser. on, the condenser will be fully closed. With the air-
c. Disconnectthe hosesatthecondenser. conditioner turned on the condenser will be open to
b. Secure condenser with attaching bolts. CONDENSER UPLIMIT AND DOWNLIMIT RIGGING
c. Installtheactuator bolt. For condenser full up travel of the
complete rigging,
condenser should first be checked.
DRIVE PULLEY
switch of the actuator and need not be adjusted. In the
fully extended position, the forward edge of the con-
36-425-3 denser fairing is approximately 3 inches beneath the
fuselage skin.
CONDENSER FLIGHT-UCTENSION LIMIT
R1GG1NG
Belt Tension Measurement Both the flight-extension limit and the condenser-
Figure 3 extended warning-light switches are located on a
21-50-00
Page 8
Aug 18/95 A18
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Remove the 12 screws and washers from the fair- pressure system. Before dlsconnect-
ing which covers the switches and pressure hoses aft Ing a reMgenmt line, the system must
be discharged with a recovery servlc-
of the condenser.
Ingunit. Purge the entire system to a
b. Remove the fairing. 125-micron level.
c. Disconnect each of the two pressure hoses
located on each side of the condenser assembly. A face shield should be worn when
performing maintenance on the lines
d. Connect a Right-extension-limit
voltmeter to the
because refrigerant coming In con-
switch (outboard switch), by attaching one lead to the tact with the eyes can cause loss of
top screw on one lead to the bottom
the switch and
sight.
screw. Do not make connection with the center screw.
21-50-00
Page 9
A18 Aug 18/95
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ACCESSORY COMPRESSOR
DRIVE PADS BRACKET
G
MIDSPAN
DEFLECTION
I\.ro~-o7 I CHECK
COMPRESSOR
O
ADJUSTING BOLT
STARTER
JAM NUT
IDLER PULLEY
DRIVE PULLEY
UP
ENGINE ´•C
CENTER
LINE
LEFT I)RIGHT
LOOKING FORWARD AT THE
REAR OF THE ENGINE
36-425-5
21-50-00
Page 10
Aug 18/95 A18
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
equipment kit. Torque the nuts 275 325 inch-pounds. a, Remove the pilot’s and copilot’s seats per Chap-
ter 25.
a. Loosen the jam nut on the adjusting bolt and self-
locking nut on the idler arm. Install the V-belt. Adjust b´• Remove the spar cover.
the idler outward by rotating theadjusting bolt inward c. Disconnect the electrical leads from the motor.
to obtain the proper belt tension. Adjust the V-belt to
d. Remove the bolts which attach the blower to the
the tension outlined in COMPRESSOR BELT TEN-
evaporator and remove the blower.
SION ADJUSTMENT in this chapter.
I g. Remove caps from lines and compressor and b. install the bolts attaching the blower to the evapo-
install lines to the fittings on the compressor, rater.
h. Install the electrical leads to the magnetic clutch. c´• Connect the electrical leads to the motor.
SPACER
PROPERIVIGNMENT
~j
DETAIL A
STARTER/ACCESSORY
DRIVER
SPACER
PULLEY
~iY
NUT (700 TO 800 IN. LBS. TORQUE) A
PIN
21-50-00
Page 11
A18 Aug 18/95
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
d.
Remove the filter
between the evaporator and duct. Install the filter and filter
g. cover.
f. Removethe sparcover.
h. Install the cover over the ducts.
g. Removethe ducts.
i. Install the seats per Chapter 25.
h. Disconnect the electrical leads from the motor,
21 -50-00
Page 12
Aug Al8
CHAPTER
COMMUNICATIONS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 23 COMMUNICATIONS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
23-10-00
23-60-00
Static Wick Installation (Priorto D-10383; CJ-156; CE-978; E-1932; EA-273) .......1
Static Wick Removal (D-10383; CJ-156; CE-978; E-1932; EA-273 and After) ......2
Static Wick Installation (D-10383; CJ-156; CE-978; E-1932; EA-273 and After) .....2
nzl 23-CONTENTS
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 23 COMMUNICATIONS
A24
23-LOEP
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
NIAINTENANCE #ANUAL
GROUND COMMUNICATION SYSTEM communication while all other electrical equipment is turned
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION off. The switch for this system is a push-on, push-off switch
located near the top of the instrument panel to the right of
O~OUND COMMUNICATION center. The system’s two 5-amp circuit breakers are located
(E-2104, E-2111 and afte~ EA-320, EA-389 and after) below the battery box. On airplane serials CE-1037 and
after, this optional equipment is available on the model
Theairplane may be equipped with an optional ground F33A; however, there are no standard locations for the
communication system. This system allows radio equipment.
"END"
23-1090
Page 1
A9 399 27/84
Ray~hean Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
A static electrical charge may build up in the surface of the airplane while it is in flight. This electrical charge, if
retained, can cause interference in radio and avionics equipment operation. Therefore, static wicks are installed on
the trailing edges of the flight surfaces to aid in the dissipation of the electrical charge.
On serials prior to D-10383; CJ-156; CE-978; E-1932, and EA-273, the static wicks are installed with one on each I
elevator, one on each aileron and one on the rudder. These five (four on model 35) static wicks are removed and
installed in the same manner. On serials D-10383; CJ-156; CE-978; E-1932; EA-273 and After, the static wicks are I
installed with one (three on the B36TC) on each wing tip, two (none on the B36TC) on each aileron, three on each
elevator and three on the rudder. These fifteen (twelve on the V35B) static wicks are removed and installed in the
same manner. The base of the later static wicks is riveted to the flight surface and need not be removed in normal
service.
b. Removethewickfromthe surface.
STATIC WICK INSTALLATION (PRIOR TO D- 10383; CJ- 156; CE-978; E- 1932; EA-273) I
Clean around the static wick area by:
a. Removing all grease, oil, paints, metal finishes or other high resistance properties with Minnesota 3M No. 600
grit sandpaper, or equivalent. The mating surfaces must be smooth and contoured so that the maximum surface
area is in actual contact. Alodine treatment for aluminum or Dow treatment of magnesium is a suitable corrosion
preventative to use between the static wick base and the airplane surface.
NOTE
Dissimilar materials are not to be used in intimate contact unless suitably protected against
electrolytic corrosion. Whenever it is necessary that any combination of such metals be assembled,
an interposing material compatible to each should be used.
b. Install the wick, using the two screws and lock washers.
NOTE
Check the continuity between the static wick base and the surface to which it is attached. There
should be a resistance 05 2.5 milliohms or less.
1
23-60-00 Sep 30/03Page
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I ’STATIC WICK REMOVAL (0-10383; CJ- 156; CE-978; E-1932; EA-273 AND AFTER)
a. Unscrewthestatic wickfromthebase.
STATIC WICK INSTALLATION (0-10383; CJ- 156; CE-978; E- 1932; EA-273 AND AFTER)
The threads must be clean and free from grease, oil and paint.
Static wicks are inspected to ensure correct discharge capabilities. Use a megohmeter with a minimum test voltage
of 500 volts to measure the resistance of the static wicks.
NOTE
All static wicks on the airplane must be the same type and manufacturer.
CAUTION 1
I CALmON
Refer to the megohmeter manufacturers operating data to correctly use the megohmeter and
prevent electric shock.
a. Connect a test lead from the megohmeter to the tip of the static wick.
b. Connect the other test lead of the megohmeter to the base of the static wick.
1. If static wicks part number 35-5010-3 are installed, the meter reading must be 470 kilohms 20%.
2. For other static wicks the reading must be between 1 and 100 megohms.
d. Replace static wicks that are outside the ranges given in Step c. above.
e. Set the switch on the megohmeter to OFF and disconnect the test leads from the static wick.
2
Sep 30/Page 23-60-00 n24
CHAPTER
ELECTRICAL
POVVER
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
24-30-00
24-31-00
24-31-01
Standby Alternator Description and Operation (E-3306 and After; EA-652 and After) ..................1
Standby Alternator- Maintenance Practices ~2
Standby Alternator Function Test ~2
Standby Alternator Removal ................._ ~2
Standby Alternator Installation ................._ ~3
1
nzr 24-CONTENTS Mar 31/05Page
MaYffraen nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
24-40-00
External Power Maintenance Practices (CE-1024 and After; CJ-156 and After; E-2111 and
After; EA-339 and After) (CE-748, CE-772 thru CE-1023; CJ-149 thru CJ-154;
D-1009’1, D-10120 and After; E-1241 thru E-2110; EA-11 thru EA-338;
Airplanes Modified by Factory Work Order or Airplanes with Kit 33-3008 Installed) 1
24-50-00
Page
ran~2
31105 24-CONTENTS A2l
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1
A27 24-LOEP Mar 31/05Page
RBytheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
The airplane electrical system includes a 28-volt, 50-amp (prior to CJ-156; CE-929; D-10354 EA-159; E-1766) or
60-amp (CJ-156 and After; CE-929 and After; D-~0354 and After; EA-159 and After; E-~766 and After) alternator.
A 1 OO-amp alternator is optional. The alternator and one 1 l.O-ampere-hour lead acid battery supply all the de power
to the airplane. The battery supplies power for the airplane starter system and electrical system when the engine is
not operating. The alternator provides the de voltage to the electrical system during engine operation.
The alternator output is controlled by a combined transistorized voltage regulator/overvoitage relay. Current to
excite the alternator field isnormally derived from the airplane bus through a 10 amp switch/circuit breaker and the
voltage regulator/overvoltage relay. The self excited alternator is designed to have a small amount of residual
magnetism. In the event the battery is discharged to the extent that it will not excite the alternator field, the residual
magnetism is strong enough to excite the alternator field if all the load is removed from the airplane electrical system
until the bus is brought up to proper voltage. When attempting to excite the alternator and develop output without
battery power, turn off all electrical load and operate the engine at near cruise speed. In the event the alternator is
not producing electrical power, the alternator sensor will illuminate an annunciator light.
Electrical system repair methods used must be made in accordance with the Federal Aviation Agency’s Aircraft
inspection and Repair manual AC 43.13-1A andlor the Aircraft Alterations manual AC 43.13-2. Any components
replaced and any wire, cable, or terminals used in the maintenance of the electrical system must be of airplane
quality. Any solderless terminals or splices used must be applied with tooling specified by the vendor.
1
n27
24-30-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
DC GENERATION -TROUBLESHOOTING
Troubleshooting procedures in this section apply to a 50-amp (prior to CJ-156; CE-g29; D-10354; EA-159; E-l 766),
60-amp (CJ-156 and After; CE-929 and After; D-10354 and After; EA-159 and After; E-1766 and After) or optional
100-amp alternator and may be accomplished without special test equipment. All supporting systems or equipment
must be operating. All circuit breakers, switches, etc. must be in the position required for proper operation before
troubleshooting begins.
The following troubleshooting charts are general in nature. Refer to the appropriate subchapter for further
information
Chart
Troubleshooting Alternator System
TROUBLE PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
e. Dirty slip rings, e. With alternator running, clean slip rings with
No. 400 or finer sandpaper. Use air jet to
remove grit.
f. Brushes not contacting slip f. Clean brushes and holders with a clean, lint-
Page
raM2
31/05 24-30-00 nz7
Raycheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 2
Troubleshooting Battery System
TROUBLE PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
Chart 3
Troubleshooting Voltage Regulator System
TROUBLE PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
3
nzT 24-30-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 3
Troubleshooting Voltage Regulator System (Continued)
TROUBLE PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
3. Overvoltage circuitinoperative a. External pin connections not a. Check external pin connections.
at anyvoltage, properly made.
Page
42’3t, 24-30-00
RB~heOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CAUTION: The output terminal of the alternator is connected directly to the battery. Make sure the battery switch is
OFF before removing the wires at the alternator or serious damage to the wiring harness and alternator
may result from accidental grounding of the output stud.
a. Access to the alternator is gained through the right cowl door and through the forward opening of the cowl.
CAUTION: Do not force the alternator into position or damage to the alternator or drive gears could result. Care
must be taken to assure that the alternator pilot enters the crankcase bore squarely, and the alternator
is resting flat on the engine pad.
CAUTION: Never turn the battery switch ON until all wiring harness connections have been made and properly
tightened or serious damage to the wiring harness and alternator may result from accidental grounding.
h. Start the engine and check for oil seepage and proper operation.
NOTE: If a new alternator is to be installed, refer to DRIVE GEAR AND COUPLING INSTALLATION ON NEW
ALTERNATORS to change the drive gear and coupling to the new alternator.
The new alternator may be received with or without a new drive gear and coupling. The drive gear and coupling from
the old alternator may need to be installed on the new alternator. The drive and coupling may be changed by
following the procedures as follows:
a. Remove the shipping spacer and washer (if installed) from the replacement alternator.
b. Install the woodruff key (if not already installed), coupling assembly and thrust washer. Ensure the bearing
surface (copper color) of the thrust washer is installed toward the alternator.
c. Install the nut and tighten to a torque of 400 in-lb. If the slots of the castellated nut do not align with the cotter
pin hole in the shaft, the nut should be tightened further, but not to exceed 500 in-lb. Do not back off the nut to
align holes.
d. Install an 1\11824665-302 cotter pin carefully to ensure clearance when the alternator is installed in the engine.
5
A27 24-30-00Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: Do not clamp the alternator body ormounting flange in a vise. The cotter pin must be installed and then
trimmed. The portion bent toward the alternator housing must NOT touch the thrust washer when bent over
the nut. The portion bent away from the alternator housing must NOT reach beyond the threads on the end
of the shaft.
a. Ensure that the battery switch is OFF, the battery is disconnected, and the external power source is
disconnected.
b. Locate the voltage regulator installed on the right aft side of the firewall in the flight compartment.
d. Remove the voltage regulator attaching screws and remove the voltage regulator.
a. Ensure that the battery switch is OFF, the battery is disconnected, and the external power source is
disconnected.
b. Place the voltage regulator in position and secure with attaching screws.
e. Operate the engine and confirm the voltage regulator setting under various loads.
NOTE: The voltage regulator is set and sealed at the factory. Breaking the seal prior to the warranty limitations voids
the warranty. Should it become necessary to adjust the voltage regulator, adjustments may be made in the
following manner.
a. Bring the voltage regulator and the alternator up to operating temperature (preferably by flying), by operating
the engine at 1,800 rpm with approximately 50% load for a minimum of 15 minutes.
c. Operate the engine at cruise rpm (2,500 rpm) with the alternator ON, and the electrical load reduced to a
minimum.
d. Check the bus voltage. If it is not 28.50 0.25 vdc, adjustment should be made as indicated in the following Step.
e. Remove the plastic plug labeled REG from the corner of the regulator and adjust the regulator by turning the
potentiometer clockwise to increase the voltage and counterclockwise to decrease the voltage. Make any
adjustments in small increments and allow 2 or 3 minutes operation time for the system to stabilize between
adjustments.
f. For final check and adjustment, the engine should be operated at cruise rpm (2,500 rpm) with the alternator ON
and carrying approximately 50% load.
Page
62~L, 24-30-00 n2l
Rayeheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The battery is accessible for servicing by raising the right engine cowl and removing the battery box cover. A
b. The battery should be removed from the airplane and serviced after 100 flight hours or 30 days, whichever
occurs first. If the ambient temperatures are above 90"F or the time between engine starts averages less than
30 minutes, the time between servicing may be reduced.
c. The fluid level of the battery should be checked every 25 hours and when fully charged, should barely touch or
be slightly short of the eyelet at the bottom of the vent well. if the fluid level is low, add distilled water to fill.
Recheck the battery after charging for a proper specific gravity.
NOTE: Do not overfill the battery. When the battery cells are overfilled, water and acid will spill on the lower portions
of the accessory section and lower fuselage. Neutralize the acid
engine spillage immediately with a water
solution of sodium bicarbonate (baking soda).
Do not allow the fluid level to drop below the top of the plates.
During periods when the ambient temperature is below 32"F, the battery should be maintained in a fully charged
prevent freezing. When distilled water is added, the battery should
state to be charged sufficiently to thoroughly mix
the water with the electrolyte as a precaution against freezing.
CAUTION: Excessive spewage may result if the cell vents are not kept clean and open.
d. For peak performance, the battery must be kept clean and dry. If foreign materials are present in sufficient
quantities, the resultant deposits may form conductive paths that permit a rapid self discharge of the battery. To
prevent the collection of such deposits, the battery should be cleaned after each 100 hours of service or every
30 days, whichever occurs first.
e. The log of battery service performed should be evaluated to determine the need to service the battery at the
above recommended intervals or to extend the intervals if justified. Accurate water consumption data is a valid
barometer to use for adjustment of the servicing intervals. For further servicing, information instructions are
BATTERY REMOVAL
a. Place the battery switch in the OFF position and ensure that the external power unit is disconnected.
b. Locate the battery in the engine compartment on the upper right hand side of the firewall.
CAUTION: Always remove the ground cable terminal first and install if last to prevent accidental short circuits.
d. Disconnect the positive cable from the battery and position it so it will not interfere with the removal of the
battery.
7
n27
24-30-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Place the battery switch in the OFF position and ensure that the external ground power unit is disconnected.
CAUTION: If the positive battery terminal is not marked POS, or painted red and the negative battery terminal
is not marked painted black, use a voltmeter to determine the battery polarity before
NEG, or
connecting the battery in the airplane. Reverse polarity will destroy the diodes and other electronic
components in the electrical system.
d. Coat the battery terminals and cable terminal with a light coat of petroleum jelly.
h. Position the battery box lid on the battery box and secure.
BA TTER Y CLEANING
CAUTION: Never use a wire brush or brush with a metal construction for this purpose as short circuiting or other
damage may result.
b. Ensure that the battery cell filler caps are in place and tight. Brush dirt off with a stiff bristle brush.
CAUTION: Entrance of ammonia or soda solution into a battery cell will neutralize the cell electrolyte. Never use
solvents to clean the battery, for these may damage the battery case.
c. Scrub the battery with a solution of ammonia or bicarbonate of soda tone part of soda to a gallon of water). This
will neutralize any electrolyte sprayed or spilled out.
d. Rinse the battery with clear water, then sponge off the excess water. Allow the battery to air-dry.
e. Wash the battery filler caps with clean hot water and no soap, then examine the vent holes in the battery filler
caps to make sure they are clear.
f. Inspect the battery for cracks, holes, or burn spots. Replace if necessary.
g. Make sure that all battery hardware is clean and in good mechanical condition.
NOTE: If additional cleaning of the battery terminals and cable terminal is required, use a battery terminal cleaning
tool and brighten up the terminals to ensure a good electrical connections.
Page
824-30-00 n27
RBytheOn AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The battery box is vented overboard to dispose of electrolyte and hydrogen gas fumes discharged during normal
charging operation. To ensure the disposal of these fumes, the vent hose connections at the battery box should be
checked frequently for obstructions. The battery box should be washed out thoroughly and dried each time the
battery is removed and cleaned.
BA TTERY SERVICING
The battery should be maintained in a fully charged state at all times and the electrolyte level checked at regular
intervals. A cleanfully charged battery will provide peak performance. Never add anything but distilled water when
adjusting the electrolyte level of the battery. If electrolyte is added each time the level in the battery is low, a high
concentration of electrolyte may cause dissolution of the plates. Under high temperature conditions, this may be
indicated by the presence of black particles in the electrolyte of the affected cells.
NOTE: Do not over fill the battery. Only lead-acid equipment should be used when servicing lead-acid type batteries.
9
nzl
24-30-00
RaytLdOn AiKraft company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The optional standby generator system is an independent electrical system incorporated into the main system in
such a manner as to furnish power only to essential engine instruments, fuel quantity, certain lights, turn coordinator I
and navigation and communication system. A diode in the circuit from the battery to the standby generator system
prevents the generator from furnishing any power to the battery, but allows the battery (if serviceable) to supply
power to the essential equipment in the event of inadequate output or failure of the standby generator.
NOTE: For airplanes with 12 vdc battery, the circuits from the battery to the standby generator system and the I
battery to the stall warning system are always alive, even though the battery switch may be in the OFF
position
The optional standby generator system should only be used when there is a loss of electrical power on the main
electrical system. As soon loss of electrical power is evident, turn the alternator and
as battery switches OFF (this
is to prevent possible damage to the main system if a short exists therein, and to save battery power for lowering
the flaps problem
and gear if the is determined to be only a faulty alternator). After turning the switches OFF, turn
the standby generator on. This optional generator is mounted aft of the right magneto aft of the engine baffle and is
cooled by air that is picked up from the engine baffle.
The switch and voltmeter are located on the right side of the instrument panel prior to E-2111 (except E-1946 and
E-2104), and EA-389 (except EA-320). At the noted serials the switch is moved to the left subpanel and the standard
voltmeter near the pedestal is used. The switch is placarded OFF-ON-GEN/RESET. The voltage regulator/
overvoltage relay is mounted aft of the firewall and controls the generator output.
The standby generator is self-exciting and requires no external electrical power for it to function, although it does
require 2,925 to 4,050 rpm (engine rpm is 1,950 to 2,700) to function proper\y. At a minimum engine speed of 1,950
rpm, the generator will produce a continuous 6.5 amps at 28 volts or for intermittent (1 minute on 2 minutes off)
operation 11 amps at 24 volts.
The standby generator system is controlled and protected by a voltage regulator/overvoltage relay. The regulator
will control the voltage at 28.50 0.50 volts. The overvoltage relay will remove the standby generator from the circuit
should the voltage reach 32.0 0.5 volts. The overvoltage relay is not sensitive to small voltage spikes (at 33 volts
it will not trip for 50 milliseconds). Should a transient voltage spike cause the overvoltage relay to trip removing the
generator from the system, it may be reset in flight by moving the switch momentarily to the GEN/RESET position.
1
24-31-00 Sep 30/04Page
Ray~heon nireraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Turnthebatteryswitch OFF.
c. Turn the standby generator switch ON (do not contact the GEN/RESET position).
f. The volt meter should register approximately 28 volts, with the engine operating at 1,950 rpm.
The standby alternator system is an independent electrical source that is connected to the main busing system and
will supply power to any components in the airplane up to it’s load limitation of 20 amps.
When the STBY ALT switch is set to ON, the standby alternator will be regulated to approximately 26.0 volts with
overvoltage trip off set at 32 volts. The standby alternator will then automatically power the airplane bus in the event
the primary alternator fails and/or the airplane bus voltage drops below 26 volts. System activation is controlled by
the standby alternator voltage regulator which monitors the airplane bus voltage. The automatic switching from the
primary alternator to the standby alternator is indicated by the illumination of the amber STBY ALT ON annunciator.
The primary alternator switch should be placed to the OFF position when the standby alternator is operating. If the
existing electrical load is small, such as may occur during the preflight check, automatic switching of the standby
alternator may be delayed until the bus voltage drops below 26 volts. Increasing the load, such as turning on the
taxi or landing lights, will facilitate the lowering of the bus voltage allowing the standby alternator to power the battery
bus more quickly. The standby alternator is not self exciting and requires that the battery master switch be left in the
ON position.
In normal operation, the standby alternator switch is turned on at the same time as the primary alternator switch.
The standby alternator switch should remain in the ON position for the duration of the flight.
If the LOW BUS VOLT annunciator illuminates during the operation of the standby alternator, engine speed may be
too slow for the alternator load or the load may exceed 20 amps. Annunciator illumination is a function of engine
speed, load on the standby alternator and ambient conditions within the standby alternator. Maintaining an engine
speed of 2,300 rpm or more and a standby alternator load of 20 amps or less, will keep the annunciator extinguished.
The standby alternator load may be monitored by placing the loadmeter switch to STANDBY from PRIMARY. On
airplanes equipped with a 100 amp primary alternator, the maximum output of 20 amps will be indicated as 100%
on the loadmeter. On airplanes equipped with a 60 amp primary alternator, the output of the standby alternator may
be read in amps directly from the loadmeter, i.e. a 20 amp output will indicate 20 on the loadmeter.
Output voltage of thestandby alternator will be indicated on the BUS VOLTS meter and will indicate approximately
26.0 volts with the engine at 2,300 rpm or above. If voltage drops below 25 volts, the electrical load should be
checked and reduced if above the 20 amp limit. The standby alternator is capable of outputs greater than 20 amps
for up to 5 minutes. Extended operation above 20 amps may cause immediate or premature alternator failure and
depletion of the battery reserve.
On early versions of the voltage regulator used in the standby alternator system, the STBY ALT ON annunciator
light will flash (light may go solid if left flashing for a period of time) if the STBY ALT switch is not selected ON with
power on the bus of the airplane. This is an indication to the pilot that the standby alternator is not activated. The
STBY ALT ON light should illuminate whenever the airplane bus voltage is 26 volts or below and the standby
alternator switch is ON.
On later versions of the voltage regulator, if the standby alternator switch is OFF the STBY ALT ON light is
extinguished.
With the standby alternator switch ON, the standby alternator light will be illuminated whenever the airplane bus
voltage is 26 volts or below and extinguished anytime the bus voltage is above 26 vdc.
During standby alternator operation, if the electrical load is over 20 amps, the STBY ALT ON annunciator light will
flash. After reducing the electrical load to less than 20 amps the annunciator light will be on steady.
Procedures for proper operation of the standby alternator system can be found in the supplement section of the
Pilots Operating Hand Book.
A2e 24-31-01
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: Depending upon the battery bus voltage, the electrical load may need to be increased (such as turning on
d. Check the loadmeter reading (greater than O, less than 100% or 20 amps).
f. Set the throttle between 1,000 and 1,200 rpm (LOW BUS VOLT annunciator light should illuminate).
Page
24-31-01 ~126
AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
STANDBYALTERNATOR INSTALLATION
CAU710N: Do not force the alternator into position or damage to the alternator or drive gears could result. Care
must be taken to assure that the alternator pilot enters the accessory case bore squarely, and the
alternator is resting flat on the engine pad.
f. Start the engine and check for oil seepage and proper operation.
3
24-31-01 Sep 30/04Page
RayNheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Use only an auxiliary power source that is negatively grounded. If the polarity of the power source is unknown,
determine the polarity with a voltmeter before connecting the unit to the airplane.~
b. Before connecting the external power unit, turn OFF all radio equipment and alternator switches, but leave the
battery master switch on to protect transistorized equipment against transient voltage spikes.
CAUTION: When the battery switch is turned off for extended ground power operation, place an external battery in
parallel with the output of the externalpower unit before operating any transistorized avionic equipment.
c. If theground power unit does not have a standard AN plug, check the polarity of the plug. The positive lead from
theground power unit must connect to the center post, the negative lead must connect to the front post and a
positive voltage of 24 to 28 vdc must be applied to the small polarizing pin of the airplane’s external power
receptacle. The power output of the external power receptacle must be capable of maintaining 28.5 0.25 vde
and should be checked periodically with a voltmeter of known accuracy.
n?e 24-40-00Pagel
Ral~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The following specifies the electrical load for each piece of equipment, either standard or optional, available on the
airplane. Based on this information, the total electrical load for the airplane may be determined.
Intermittent loads are defined as those items which will be operated for two minutes or less. Intermittent items should
not be figured into the total figure since the short duration of their usage will not significantly alter the standard load.
Under no condition shall the total continuous electrical load be more than 80% of the total alternator
capacity. Total
continuous load consists of loads listed continuous and the avionics receiving loads. Transient loads are intermittent
loads.
NOTE: The loads listed as continuous loads are for equipment which will be operated for periods of 15 minutes or
longer; however, the intermittent loads and avionics transmitting loads should be considered for determining
possible overloading during shorter periods of time, i.e., takeoff and landing.
1
Ate 24-50-00Page
Ray~heon AiKlaft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Continuous Load (Standard Equipment)
NUMBER
PER EACH TOTAL
EOUIPMENT
AIRPLANE AI~PS AMPS
Flap Indicator System 1 0.06 0.06
Fuel Indicator System 2 0.02 0.04
Inverter, Electroluminescent 1 0.50 0.50
Instruments, Engine 1 0.32 0.32
Clock, Panel 1 0.01 0.01
Clock, Digital 1 0.20 0.20
Potentiometer, Light Dim 4 0.03 0.12
Relay, Annunciator Dim 1 0.04 0.04
Relay, Battery Master 1 0.50 0.50
Sensor, Alternator Out 1 0.04 0.04
Turn Coordinator
1 0.40 0.40
Voltage Regulator 1 3.33 3.33
Flight Hour Meter 1 0.01 0.01
Power Supply, Strobe 1 5.00 5.00
Heater, Pitot 1 4.80 4.60
LIGHTING
Page 2
Sep 30/04 24150100 A26
RayNeon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Continuous Load (Standard Equipment) (Continued)
NUMBER
PER EACH TOTAL
LIGHTING (Continued) AIRPLANE AMPS AMPS
Chart 2
Continuous Load (Optional Equipment)
NUMBER
PER EACH TOTAL
EQUIPMENT AIRPLANE AMPS AMPS
Air Conditioning
Compressor Clutch 1 1.70 1.70
LIGHTING
3
A26 24-50-00
Raydheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 3
Intermittent Load (Standard Equipment)
NUMBER
PER EACH TOTAL
EQUIPMENT
AIRPLANE AMPS AMPS
Cigarette Lighter
1 6.00 6.00
Flap Motor 1 11.00 11.00
Elevator Trim
Actuator
1 0.85 0.85
Resistor, Shunt
1 0.37 0.37
Flasher, Gear Warning
1 0.04 0.04
Hem, Gear Warning
1 0.20 0.20
Horn, Stall Warning
1 0.20 0.20
Landing Gear Motor 1 40.00 40.00**
Relay, Ldg Gear Latch
1 0.08 0.08
Pump, Auxiliary Fuel 1 3.00 3.00*
Pump, Auxiliary Fuel 1 3.00 3.00***
Pump, Auxiliary Fuel
1 4.00 4.00****
Relay, Dynamic Brake 1 1.25 1.25
Relay, Starter
1 3.30 3.30
Starter, Engine
1 100.00 100.00
Starter Vibrator
1 2.00 2.00****
LIGHTING
Alternator Out
1 0.04 0.04
Courtesy Light 2 0.17 0.34
Door Ajar
2 0.024 0.048
Landing Gear Indicator
3 0.04 0.12
Landing Light 1 8.93 8.93
Taxi Light 1 8.93 8.93
NOTES: Used only on models A36, V358, F33A and F33C,
Sep 30/4Page 4
24-50-00 A26
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 4
Intermittent Load (Optional Equipment)
NUMBER
PER EACH TOTAL
EQUIPMENT AIRPLANE AMPS AMPS
Air Conditioning
Actuator, Condenser Door 1 0.77 0.77
LIGHTING
A26 24-50-00
C H A PT E R
EQUIPMENT/
FURNISHINGS
Ra)(thaan Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
25-00-00
Fifth and Sixth Seat Stowage (E-llll, E-1241 and After; EA-1 and After) .5
Vertical Position
Horizontal Position
Headliner Removal (CE-919, CE-923, CE-925, CE-927, CE-929 and After; CJ-156 and After;
D-10348, D-10353 and After; E-1422, E-1551, E-1569, E-1594 and After; EA-21, EA-28,
EA-33 and After).
(CE-919, CE-923, CE-925, CE-927, CE-929 and After; CJ-156 and After;
Header Installation
D-10348, D-10353 and After; E-1422, E-1551, E-1569, E-1594 and After; EA-21, EA-28,
EA-33 and After)
Forward Carry-Through SparCover Removal ............7
Forward Car~y-Through SparCover Installation. ..........7
25-60-00
NarcoELT10........................................................................1
Dorneand Margolin ELT. ......1
ArtexELT 110-4
Emergency- Maintenance Practices. .3
P5-CONTENTS
RBytheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 25 EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS
TABLE OF CONTENTS (Continued)
SUBJECT PAGE
Sep
30/Page 25-CONTENTS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 25 EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS
A24 25-LOEPPagel
Ray~heon AiKra´•H Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
On all serials except CJ-149 and After, the pilot and copilot seat backs fold forward to facilitate passengers entering
and leaving the airplane. Airplane serials CJ-149 and After have locking seat backs on the pilot and copilot seats I
which can be folded forward by rotating the seat back release lever, located on the lower inboard side of each seat.
An additional lever located behind copilot’s seat on the upper right corner is also used to fold the copilots seat
forward for access to the passenger seats.
The passenger seat backs can be folded forward by rotating the seat back release lever located on the lower inboard
side of each seat. All passenger seats have locking backs.
To adjust the pilot, copilot, and passenger seats forward or aft, an adjustment lever, located beneath the front of the
seats, must be pulled up. The seat can then be slid to the desired position.
A seat back adjustment lever, located on the lower inboard side of the pilot, copilot, passenger, and on the fifth and
sixth seats (A36 Series), enables the seat back to be adjusted to several positions. It is controlled by a mechanical,
three position cam lock. An optional seat installation is available whereby the adjustment of the copilot and
passenger seat backs are controlled by a Roton lock lever located on the forward inboard side of the seat bottom.
Airplane serials E-2104, E-2111 and After, and EA-389 and After are equipped with vertically adjusting seats in the I
flight compartment (copilot’s seat is optional). The seat is raised and lowered by gas springs mounted underneath
the seat. The seat is adjustable through a range of 1.3 inches for improved visibility and crew comfort. The raising I
and lowering action is initiated
by pulling up on a release lever located on the front RH side of the seat. When the
release lever is raised, two ratchet type camlocks are disengaged from sector gears attached to the gas springs
mounted on each side underneath the seat, allowing the gas spring piston rods to extend or retract to raise or lower I
the seat. To raise the seat the pilot’s weight must be shifted forward. To lower the seat the weight must be shifted
to the rear to overcome the gas spring tension.
a. Remove the seat stops at the aft end of the mounting tracks.
b. Pull up on the fore and aft adjustment lever located beneath the front of each seat, and slide the seat off the
mounting tracks.
NOTE
If shims were installed in the seat support, they should be reinstalled in the same location from
which they were removed to achieve proper seat locking engagement with the seat track.
a. Align the seat guide with the seat track. If shims were installed in the front seat guide, they should be reinstalled
in the same location as that from which they were removed.
b. Pull up on the fore and aft adjustment lever and slide the seat onto the seat track. Release the adjustment lever
and ensure that the seat is securely in place.
c. If the lock pin with the holes in the center seat track, it will be necessary to reposition the
does not align guides
with shims. Use shims as needed to center the locking pin with the holes in the seat track.
NOTE
Shims (three inches long x 0.3 inch wide) may be fabricated from 0.016 6061-T6 Sheet aluminum.
I The shims are placed inside the seat guide and formed around the guide (Ref. Figure 2).
d. Pull up on the fore and aft adjustment lever and slide the seat through the full travel of seat adjustment. Ensure
that the locking pin has positive engagement in all holes of the seat track.
e. Install the seat stops at the aft end of the seat track.
NOTE
I When airplane serials CJ-149 and After are used for aerobatics and parachutes are worn, the
headrests for the pilot and copilot seats must be removed and the seat back cushions rotated over
the seat backs and reattached to the bottom of the seat backs. The headrest can then be
reinstalled.
I a. When airplane serials CJ-149 and After are being operated in the aerobatics category, the passenger seats may
need to be removed in order to meet the center of gravity requirements.
b. Remove the seat stops at the aft end of the seat tracks.
c. Pull up on the fore and aft adjustment lever, located beneath the front of each seat, and slide the seat off the
mounting track.
2
Sep 30/Page 25-00-00 nn4
Raytheom Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SECTOR
GEAR
GAS SPRlNG
RELEASE ACTUATOR
LEVER ROD
TORQUE
TUBE ADJUST))NG
LNER EA258
A24
25-00-00 Sep 30/03Page 3
RBYLLheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SHIMS
SE~GUOE
L
I
T~--31NCHES
CENTER
SEAT TRACK
CENTER FRONT SEAT LEG SHIM
VIEW FROM FRONT
a. Align the seat guides with the slots in the mounting tracks.
b. Pull up on the fore and aft adjustment lever and slide the seat onto the mounting tracks. Release the lever and
ensure that the seat is securely in place.
c. Reinstall the seat stops at the aft end of the mounting tracks.
FIFTH SEAT REMOVAL (CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; D-10097, D- 10120 AND AFTER)
a. Remove the two bolts at the lower aft portion of the seat bottom.
the seat by removing the extrusion at the forward top side of the hat shelf. Reinstall the extrusion
I" the hat shelf.Rmove on
FIFTH SEA T INSTALLATION (CE-748 CE-772 AND AFTER; 0-10097, D- 10120 AND AFTER)
I b. Install the extrusion along with the seat back retaining strap on the hat shelf.
c. Install the seat bottom, seat belts, and the two securing bolts.
FIFTH SEA T STOWAGE (CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; D-10097, 0-10120 AND AFTER)
a. Pull forward on the lower portion of the seat back until the seat back is in a horizontal position. Lift up on the
forward side on the seat bottom, rotate the seat bottom to a vertical position, and position the seat bottom legs
parallel with the seat bottom.
b. Lower the seat back into a vertical position and snap the retaining strap into position.
FIFTH AND SIXTH SEA T REMOVAL (E- 1 I 1 1, E- 124 1 AND AFTER; EA-1 AND AFTER)
a. Fold the bottom of the seat up to a vertical position and fold the seat support in the retract position.
b. Removetheseatattach pins.
FIFTH AND SIXTH SEA T INSTALLA TION (E- I I I I, E 124 1 AND AFTER; EA-1 AND AFTER)
a. Position the seats.
b. Installtheseatattach pins.
c. Fold the seat bottom and seat support down and snap the support into the floor base.
FIFTH AND SIXTH SEA T STOWAGE (E- 1 I 1 1, E- 124 1 AND AFTER; EA- 1 AND A~-TER)
The fifth and sixth seats may be folded either in a horizontal or vertical position to provide additional cargo space.
This may be accomplished as follows:
VERTICAL POSITION
HORIZONTAL POSITION
a. Fold the seat support into retract position and position the seat bottom on the floorboard.
b. Fold the seat back forward and position on top of the seat bottom.
NOTE
A club seating arrangement is available (A36, A36TC and B36TC series only) that enables the third
and fourth passenger seats to be turned facing aft. On A36 serials prior to E-1371, when this
arrangement is used, the fifth and sixth seats must be moved four (4) inches aft to maintain proper
weight and balance. If the seats are returned to a standard seating arrangement (facing forward),
the fifth and sixth seats MUST be moved back to their original position. Holes are located in the
floorboard under the carpeting to facilitate installation of the side mounting brackets and the seat
support base. It is recommended that both the third and fourth passenger seats face the same I
direction at all times.
5
A24
25-00-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
HEADLINER REMOVAL (CE-919, CE-923, CE-925, CE-927, CE-929 AND AFTER; CJ-156
AND AFTER; 0-10348, 0-10353 AND AFTER; E-1422, E-1551, E-1569, E-1594 AND AFTER;
EA-21, EA-28, EA-33 AND AFTER)
I a. Perform the FIFTH SEAT REMOVAL and the FIFTH AND SIXTH SEAT REMOVAL procedures.
c. Working through the aft bulkhead, remove the tape from around the air ducts that connects the air duct to the
headliner duct.
k. Gently pull on the headliner to disconnect the fabric hook and loop fasteners. These hook and loop fasteners
are located wherever the airplane frame and headliner come together.
I. Separate the forward air ducts from the air duct in the headliner. A spatula or similar tool may be used to work
between the ducts to work the sealer loose.
m. Disconnect the electrical wiring to the headliner lights. (This connector is located near the center of the headliner
toward the front, or aft of thepilot’s side window.)
HEADLINER INSTALLA TION (CE-919 CE-923, CE-925, CE-927, CE-929 AND AFTER; CJ- 156
AND AFTER; D- 19348 0-10353 AND AFTER; E- 1422, E- 1551, E- 1569, E- 1594 AND AFTER;
EA-21, EA-28, EA-33 AND AFTER)
c. Connect the forward ventilation ducts. Seal ducts with adhesive (54, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
Sep 25-00-00
RayYheon Aircraff Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
j. Connect the wires to the console light and install the console.
k. Connect the duct aft of the rear bulkhead closure. Tape the joint with two-inch wide tape (55, Chart 1 91 -00-00).
m. Perform the FIFTH SEAT INSTALLATION and the FIFTH AND SIXTH SEAT INSTALLATION procedures.
c. On aft side of spar cover, pull back carpet and remove screws from spar cover.
d. On forward side of spar cover, pull back carpet and remove screws from spar cover.
e. Remove RHaccesscover.
f. From inside of RH access cover, loosen clamp and remove air duct from plenum and grill assembly.
I CAUTION
CAUTION 1
Improper installation of the forward carry-through spar cover may interfere with the landing gear
emergency hand crank operation. Ensure the landing gear hand crank will engage and rotate
without interference with the spar cover.
b. From inside of RH access cover, install air duct on plenum and grill assembly and tighten clamp.
d. On forward side of spar cover, install screws to secure forward end of spar cover and install carpet.
e. On aft side of spar cover, install screws to secure aft end of spar cover and install carpet. I
f. Check the emergency landing gear hand crankto ensure handle will engage and rotate without interference with
the forward carry-through spar cover.
25-00-00 ,,~:Page 7
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
EMERGENCY DESCRIPTION AND OPERA- impact switch which will actuate the ELT automat-
TION ically upon impact of the airplane. The TR70-13 also
has a remote switch which is accessible through a
LOCA TOR TRANSMITTER small door in the right side of the fuselage. The
placarded switch positions are REARM-ARM-XMIT.
The airplane is equipped with an automatically actu- The XMIT position is momentary and is used to test
ated emergency locator transmitter ~ELT) to assist in the operation of the ELT. The ARM position is used
the tracking and recovery of the airplane and crew in to arm the impact switch for automatic actuation upon
the event of a crash or emergency landing. The ELT impact of the airplane. The REARM position is used
system consists of a battery-powered emergency to reset the impact switch after testing the ELT.
locator transmitter (ELT), an antenna and a switch
accessible through a spring-loaded door in the right NARCO ELT 10
side of the fuselage adjacent to the ELT. The output (Figure 2)
frequencies of the ELT are 121.5 and 243.0 MHz,
simultaneously. Range is approximately line of sight. The Narco ELT 10 is installed with a two-position
The ELT is mounted near the right side of the fuse- remote switch (XMIT-ARM) on airplanes 0-10347 and
lage, at approximate, F. S. 230.00. after, EA-81 thru EA-411, E-1687 thru E-2147 and
i CE-906 thru CE-1032. The remote switch is placed in
The antenna for th.’e
ELT is mounted on top of the the XMIT position to test the ELT or in the ARM posi-
fuselage at F.S. 195 on airplanes 0-10097, 0-10120 tion for automatic operation upon impact of the air-
and after; E-llll, E-1241 thru E-2147; CE-748, CE-772 plane.
thru CE-1032; EA-1 thru CJ-149 thru
EA-411 and
CJ-155. The antenna is mounted under the dorsal fin The Narco ELT 10 is installed with a three-position
just forward of the vertical stabilizer on airplanes remote switch (TEST-ARM-XMIT) on airplanes E-2424
CJ-156 and after, CE-1033 and after and EA-412 and thru E-2693, EA-480 thru EA-530 and CE-1241 thru
after. CE-1646. The TEST and XMIT position are used for
testing the ELT.The ARM position is used for auto-
COMMUNICATIONS COMPONENTS CORPORATION matic operation upon impact of the airplane.
ELT TR70-17 AND TR70-13
(Figure 1) The Narco ELT 10 has a control switch decaled
ON-OFF-ARM. The ELT can be removed from the
There are two Communication Component Corpo- airplane and used as a portable unit. In this event,
ration ELT~ being used. The TR70-17 ELT is installed the ELT control switch would be placed in the ON
on airplanes D-10097, D-10120 thru D-10196; E-llll, position continuously. The OFF position
to transmit
E-1241 thru E-1406; EA-1 and EA-2; CE-748, CE-772 on prevents operation of the unit and the
the ELT
thru CE-828 and CJ-149. The TR70-13 ELT is installed ARM position is used to arm the impact switch for
on airplanes D-10197 thru D-10346, E-1407 thru E-1686, automatic actuation upon impact of the airplane.
EA-3 thru EA-80, CE-829 thru CE-905 and CJ-150 thru
CJ-155. Both, the TR70-17 and TR70-13, can be The Narco ELT 10 can be replaced with the Artex ELT
replaced with the Narco ELT 10 by Kit No. 101-3046-1 110-4 by Kit No. 101-3127-1.
or the Artex ELT 110-4 by Kit No. 101-3127-1.
DORNE AND MARGOLIN ELT
The TR70-17 ELT is mounted in the airplane so the (Figure 3)
control switch is accessible through a small door in
the right side of the fuselage. The placarded switch The Dorne and Margolin ELT is installed on airplanes
positions are ARM-OFF-ON. position pre-
The OFF CE-1033 thru CE-1240, CJ-156 and after, E-2148 thru
vents operation of the ELT. position is
The ON E-2423 and EA-412 thru EA-479.
momentary and is used to test the operation of the
ELT. The ARM position arms an impact switch which An AUTO-OFF-ON control switch located on the ELT
will actuate the ELT automatically upon impact of the controls the operation of the unit. When the switch is
airplane, on the ON position, the ELT will transmit for testing
or manual operation. The AUTO position arms an
The TR70-13 has a control switch which is not acces- impact switch which will actuate the ELT automat-
sible from outside the airplane. It is placarded ically upon impact of the airplane. The OFF position
OFF-ON-ARM. The OFF position prevents operation prevents operation of the ELT. A remote
of the ELT. The ON position can be used for manual TEST-AUTO-XMIT switch is used for testing and
operation of the ELT. The ARM position arms an manual actuation of the ELT. The TEST position is a
2160-00
Page 1
momentary switch which will cause the ELT to trans- An ON-OFF control switch on the ELT controls the
mit. The XMIT position turns the unit on for manual operation of the unit. When the switch is in the ON
operation and the AUTO position arms the unit to position, the ELT will transmit for testing or manual
operate when the impact switch is actuated upon operation. Place the switch in the OFF position to
discontinue the transmission. An internal impact
impact of the airplane.
switch will actuate the ELT automatically upon impact
of the airplane. The remote ARMED/RESET-ON
The Dorne and Margolin ELT can be replaced with the
switch is used to arm the ELT orto manually actuate
Artex ELT 110-4 by Kit No. 101-3127-1. in the ON
the ELT. When placed position, the ELT will
transmit. The ARMED/RESET position arms the ELT
ARTEX ELT 110-4 to operate automatically upon impact of the airplane.
(Figure 4) To reset the ELT, cycle the control switch on the ELT
to the ON position, then to the OFF position, and cycle
The Artex ELT 110-4 is installed on airplanes CE-1647 the remote switch to the ON position, then to the
and after, E-2694 and after and EA-531 and after. ARMED/RESET position.
25-60-00
Page 2
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
life and i"g base on the transmitter and remove the base.
Information battery
on replacement is
included in the data furnished with each ELT, and is
usually placarded on the battery. f. Remove the old battery and disconnect the
electrical connector. Discard the old battery.
NOTE
WARNING
Replacement batteries should be obtained
only from ELT and aircraft manufacturers DO NOT discard the battery in a fire.
25-60-00
Page 3
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TR70-13 ELT
CONTROL
SWITCH
A
RELEASE
KNOB
B
d DETAIL
SWITCH
ACCESS
CONTROL SWITCH DOOR
SWITCH TR70-17 ELT POSITION
(REMOTE) PLACARD
SWITCH
POSITION
PLACARD
REMOTE
SWITCH
REMOTE SWITCH
FOR TR70-13 ELT
DETAIL C
SWITCH
ACCESS
DOOR
DETAIL A
C9101610
25-60-00
Page 4
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g. Inspect for, and properly treat, any corro- e. Extend the portable antenna.
sion that may be indicated in the area where the
battery was installed. CAUTION
h. Connect a fresh battery and install it in the To avoid damage to the antenna or the
compartment. plastic tab the upper end, care must be
on
j. Install the transmitter in the airplane and f. Remove the four screws attaching the
attach the antenna cable. On the TR70-13 ELT, con- control head to the battery casing and slide the con-
nect the remote switch wiring. trol head and battery case apart. The battery con-
nection leads are approximately 3-inches long.
k. The new date should be
replacement
marked on visible area. This wil\ aid in
the ELT in a NOTE
future inspections of the ELT. This date is 50% of the
useful life of the battery as defined by the battery Do not the sealant the inside
remove on lip
manufacturer. of the seal will
battery pack or a watertight
not be made when the ELT unit is reas-
i. Test the ELT as instructed in TESTING THE sembled.
EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER.
Remove the cabin aft i. Connect the terminals of the new battery
a. upholstery panel to
to the bottom of the transmitter PC board.
gain access to the aft fuselage.
b. Place the ARM-OFF-ON control switch on j. Using a spatula, apply a bead of sealant
the ELT in the OFF position. (supplied with each battery pack) around the area of
the control head which is joined with the battery case
c. Disconnect the antenna cable from the when reassembled.
ELT. Disconnect the remote switch wiring from the
terminals on the ELT. NOTE
d. Unlatch the mounting strap and remove the This sealant provides a watertight seal
ELT from the airplane. when the unit is assembled.
25-60-00
Page 5
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CONTACT
SEPARATOR
CONTROL HEAD
MOUNTING ATTACHING SCREW (4)
STRAP
PORTABLE
LATCH
PORTABLE DETAIL B
ANTENNA
ANTENNA CONTACT
CONTACT FINGER
FINGER
PORTABLE ANTENNA BLADE
NOT
MAKING CONTACT
FIXED ANTENNA
CABLE CONNECTOR CONTACT
SEPARATOR
CONTROL
SWITCH
C91a1611
DETAIL A
2160-00
Page 6
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
k. Insert the control head section into the s. Install the cabin aft upholstery panel.
battery case, being careful not to pinch the wires and
install the four attaching screws. Wipe any excess DORNE AND MARGOLIN BA TTER Y
sealant from the outside of the unit. REPLACEMENT
(Figure 3)
NOTE
NOTE
If the four screw holes do not line up, rotate
the battery case 1800 and reinsert. Kit No. 101-3127-1 (Artex ELT 110-4) or Kit
No. 101-3046-1 (Narco ELT 10) may be
i. Stow the portable antenna. installed on these airplanes. Refer to the
appropriate procedure when one of these
CAUTION kits is installed on your airplane.
Exercise extreme care in order to avoid a. Remove the cabin ah upholstery panel to
damage to the antenna or the plastic tab gain access to the ah fuselage.
on the upper end.
b. Make certain the ELT is turned off.
m. Install the transmitter in the airplane and
secure the mounting strap. c. Disconnect the antenna cable.
n. Connect the fixed antenna cable to the ELT. d. Disconnect the remote switch.
Ensure that the contact (plastic) separator is inserted
between the portable antenna contact and the port- e. Remove the screws holding the ELT in
I able antenna as shown in Figure 2. place.
With the contact separator not in place, a g. Remove the screws from the bottom of the
very weak signal may be transmitted, ELT and remove the bottom.
which is strong enough for a functional
test, but too weak for emergency use. h. Disconnect the battery and discard it.
Iter.Eh71ERGENCY
r.
LOCATOR TRANSMITTER in this chap- useful life of the battery defined the
.rerutcafunamyrebyttab
as
25-60-00
Page 7
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SWITCH
POSITION
PLACARD
REMOTE
SWITCH
WIRING
DEtAIL A
C9101612
25-60-00
Page 8
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
n. Test the ELT as instructed in TESTING THE Replacement battery packs should be
obtained only from ELT and airplane man-
EMERGENCY LOCATOR TRANSMITTER in this chap-
ter.
ufacturers or from other acceptable sup-
pliers, since the condition and useful life
of over-the-counter batteries, such as
o. Install the cabin aft upholstery panel.
those sold for flashlights, portable radios,
ART~X ELT 1 10-4 BA TTER Y PA CK etc., are usually unknown.
R~PLACEMENT
i. Inspect for and properly treat any corro-
(Figure 4) sion that may be indicated in the area where the
battery was installed.
NOTE
j. A
battery pack replacement date must
new
This procedure must be used for airplanes be marked the outside of the transmitter.
on The
that have Kit No. 101-3127-1 installed on date is 50% of the useful life of the battery pack as
them. defined by the battery pack manufacturer.
a. Remove the cabin aft upholstery panel to k. Connect the battery pack electrical con-
gain access to the aft fuselage. nector (10).
b. Place the control switch (12) on the ELT in I. Secure the battery pack to the ELT with the
the OFF position, screws (8). Make certain that ail gaskets are properly
aligned and in good condition.
c. Loosen the two thumb screws (1) securing
the mounting frame (2) to the m. Insert the antenna cable (4) through the
cap mounting frame
base (5). mounting frame cap (2) and connect to the ELT (11).
h. Remove the screws (8) securing the bat- q. Place the control switch (12) on the ELT in
tery pack to the ELT (li). the OFF position.
25-60-00
Page 9
Ale Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE NIANUAL
14
n~,
15
0"
O
13
DETAIL B
11
1. THUMBSCREW
12 2. MOUNTING FRAME CAP
3. REMOTE SWITCH HARNESS
4. ANTENNA CABLE
5. MOUNTING FRAME BASE
3 4
6. SCREW
7. WASHER
3. SCREW
9 anrrERupncK
00 10. BATTERY PACK CONNECTOR
11. ELT
9
i 12.
13.
CONTROL SWITCH
SWISCH POSITION P~ACARD
14. ACCESSDOOR
10 15. REMOTE SWITCH
B 7
Ytl g s_
DETAIL A
iii 2 1
C9101613
25-60-00
A16
Page 10
Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE ~1ANUAL
r. Test the ELT as instructed in TESTING THE TESTING THE COMMUNICATIONS COMPO-
EMERGENCY TRANSMITTER in this chapter. NENTS CORPORATION ELT TR70-13 AND
TR 70-1 7
s. Install the cabin an upholstery panel. (Figure 1)
TESTING THE EMERGENCY LOCATOR a. Turn on the airplane’s COMM-1 and tune
TRA NS MI TTER it to 121.5 MHz.
The control tower should be notified that a test is Monitor a frequency on COMM 1 to be
about to be performed. certain the radio is operating.
and create frequency jamming of real emergency TR70-13 remote switch to XMIT for approximately one
transmissions. Be certain that all procedures are second and monitor the ELT signal.
closely followed and that monitoring of frequencies
occurs to ensure the ELT switches are placed in the
NOTE
proper positions after testing is complete. If the test
is performed with the ELT removed from the airplane, A distinctive downward sweeping tone
Federal Communications Commission regulations should have been heard from the monitor-
require the testing be done in a screened or shielded ing receiver during the test. if the tone was
test room, or in a test enclosure that will hold the heard, the ELT is functioning properly. If
self-contained ELT and an antenna. there was no (assuming
audible tone that
the VHF transceiver is operating properly),
CAUTION the battery is probably disconnected, out-
dated or discharged.
700 Hz, within the range 1600 to 300 Hz, g. On the TR70-17 ELT, place the control
and a sweep repetition rate between two switch to ON, then place it firmly in the ARM position.
and four Hz. Tests should be conducted On the TR70-13 ELT, gain access to the ELT control
only in the first five minutes of any hour. If switch and place it in the OFF position. The audio
the operational tests must be made at a signal should stop. Reset the.TR70-13 ELT to the
time not included within the first five min- ARM position.
utes after the hour, the tests should be
coordinated with the nearest FAA tower or TESTING THE NARCO ELT 10
night service station. (Figure 2)
Operational testing of installed ELTs must be accom; a. Turn on the airplane’s COMM-1 and tune
25-60-00
Page 11
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Turn the COMM-1 audio switch to’the c. Place the remote TEST-AUTO-XMIT switch
SPEAKER position and place the volume control in in the TEST position and hold the switch for app
the center of its range. mately one second.
NOTE NOTE
certain the radio is operating, should have been heard from the monitor-
ing receiver during the test, if the tone was
audio signal disappears from the COMM 1. The ELT’s SPEAKER position and place the volume control in
the center of its range.
control switch must be in the ARM position when
completing the test procedure.
NOTE
TESTING THE DORNE AND MARGOLIN ELT
Monitor a frequency on COMM 1 to be
(Figure 3) certain the radio is operating.
end.
b. Turn the COMM-1 audio switch to the
SPEAKER position and place the volume control in NOTE
the center of its range.
A distinctive downward sweeping tone
NOTE should have been heard from the monitor-
ing receiver during the test. if the tone was
Monitor a frequency on COMM 1 to be heard, the ELT is functioning properly. If
certain the radio is operating, there was no audible tone (assuming that
25-60-00
Page 12
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
the VHF transceiver is operating properly), f. If the ELT continues to operate, be certain
the battery is probably disconnected, out- the remote switch is in the ARMED/RESET position.
dated or discharged. Gain access to the ELT and check that the control
switch is in the OFF position also.
d. After the test, place the remote
ARMED/RESET-ON switch in the ARMED/RESET g. If the ELT still continues to send a signal,
position. cycle the control switch on the ELT to the ON and
then OFF position and the remote switch to the ON
e. Monitor the emergency channel to ensure and then ARMED/RESET position to reset the ELT
that the ELT has discontinued operation, impact switch.
"END"
25-60-00
Page 13
A16 Oct 16/92
C H A PT E R
FLIGHT
CONTROLS
RBYtheOll Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJEC T PA GE
27-00-00
27-10-00
Aileron and Tab Maintenance Practices (CE-748, CE-772 and After; CJ-149 and After; D-10097,
D-10120 and After; E-llll, E-1241 thru E-2110, except E-1946 and E-2104; EA-~1 thru EA-388,
except EA-320).
Single Throw-Over Control Column .1
Control ColumnArm Removal ........._
~´•1
Control Column Arm Installation. ~1
Rigging theControl Arm Chain. ~1
Dual Control Arm. ........._......._
Aileron Installation
RiggingtheAileron Control System ............_.._._
.6
AileronControlTrimmer(Single Control ColumnAirplanes). ~7
Trimmer Removal
Trimmer Installation .........~7
Aileron Tabs
27-11-00
Aileron and Tabs Maintenance Practices (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389 and After) ..1
Dual Control Column. ........._____
1
A27 27-CONTENTS Mar 31/05Page
PaYtheery AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
27-20-00
27-21-00
Rudder(V35B)....... 1
Rudder Rigging Procedure 1
Ruddervator Removal
Ruddervator Installation
ElevatorTrim Tab Removal 4
Elevator Trim Tab Installation 6
Elevatorand Tab (V35B)
Elevator Rigging Procedure. 6
inspection of ElevatorTabs 10
Electric ElevatorTrim (Optional) 10
ElevatorTab Rigging 10
Rigging ElevatorTrim Tabs to CorrectforYaw 12
Right Yaw (Nose of Airplane tends to move to the Right with Wings Level)
For 12
ForLeftYaw(Nose ofAirplanetends to moveto the Leftwith Wings Level) 12
ElevatorTab Indicator Cable Replacement 12
Inspection of Tab Hinges 14
TrimTabActuator Removal (V35B) ........._._._.._
14
TrimTabActuator \nstal\ation(V35B) .................14
Page
raM2
31105 27-CONTENTS
Ral~heon AiKraft company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
27-30-00
Elevator and Tab Maintenance Practices (F33A, F33C, A36, A36TC, B36TC) ...............___
......1
Elevator Removal
Elevatorlnstalla~on.
Rigging the Elevator Control System (CE-748, CE-772 and After; CJ-149 and After; Prior to E-2111,
except E-1946 and E-2104; Priorto EA-389, exceptEA-320) .................1
Rigging the Elevator Control System (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389 and After) .6
Elevator Tab Indicator Cable Replacement (CE-748, CE-772 and After; CJ-149 and After; Prior to E-2111,
exceptE-1946 and E-2104; Priorto EA-389, exceptEA-320) .................6
Elevator Trim Tab Forward Cable Replacement (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320,
EA-389 and After).
Rigging the ElevatorTrimTab. 68
ElevatorTrim TabActuator 68
Elevator Trim Tab ActuatorDisassembly (F33A, B36TC, A36TC and A36, except E-llll; F33C
Priorto CJ-156, except thoseAirplanes with Kit 33-4002-1 Installed) 68
Elevator Trim Tab ActuatorAssembly (F33A, B36TC, A36TC and A36, except E-llll; F33C
Priorto CJ-156, exceptthose Airplaneswith Kit 33-4002-1 Installed) 6C
ElevatorTrim TabActuator Disassembly (E-llll Only) .7
ElevatorTrim Tab ActuatorAssembly (E-llll Only) .8
Elevator Trim Tab Actuator Disassembly Model F33C (CJ-l 56 and After, and Earlier Airplanes
Incorporating Kit 33-4002-1). .8
Elevator Trim Tab Actuator Assembly Model F33C (CJ-156 and After, and Earlier Airplanes
Incorporating Kit 33-4002-1). .9
Checking Elevator Tab Free Play (CE-748, CE-772 and After; E-llll, E-1241 and After;
CJ-149 and After)
Elevator Trim Tab Actuator Removal (F33A, F33C, A36, A36TC and B36TC) ......11
Elevator Trim Tab Actuator Installation (F33A, F33C, A36, A36TC and B36TC) .........___
....12
ElevatorTrim Tab Actuator Color Coding (F33A, F33C, A36, A36TC and B36TC) ........._.._._
.12
Electric Elevator Trim (Optional) ...12
ModelA36, A36TC and B36TC 12A
Electric ElevatorTrimTab Servo Removal 12A
Electric ElevatorTrimTabServo Installation 12A
Electric ElevatorTrim Ground Checks (Airplanes withoutAutopilot) 12A
Model F33A, F33C andVB58. 128
Electric Trim Tab Actuator Removal 128
ElectricTrim TabActuator Installation 128
NewTabCable Installation. 128
Magnetic Clutch Removal 128
Magnetic Clutch Installation. 128
Electric Trim Tab Actuator Brush Replacement Schedule ...............13
Magnetic Clutch Torque Test 13
3
n2l 27-CONTENTS
Raycbeon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJEC T PA GE
27-31-00
27-50-00
Flap Removal
Flap Installation................._
27-70-00
GustLockAnd Damper
ControlLock. 1
Page
27-CONTENTS ntl
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1
A27 27-LOEP Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CONTROL SURFACES
All Model F33A, F33C, V35B and A36TC airplanes and earlier Model A36 and B36TC airplanes are equipped with
either a single throw-over or dual T control column. At serials E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389
and After, dual control columns were installed as standard equipment. The flight controls are cable operated I
conventional surfaces which require no power assistance for normal control by the pilot or copilot. The flaps and
optional electric elevator trim are electrically driven.
All primary flight control surfaces are manually controlled through cable bell crank systems. Each system
incorporates surface travel stops and linkage adjustments. The ailerons, elevators and rudder may be secured with i
control locks (gust locks) in the flight compartment. When these locks are installed, the elevator is at approximately
11" down and the control wheel is approximately 12" to the right. The rudder pedals are interconnected by a linkage
below the flight compartment floor. The rudder pedals are adjustable to two positions by pressing the spring-loaded
lever on the side of the pedal. If brakes are not installed on the copilot’s pedals, this same lever may be used to
place the copilot’s pedals against the floor.
One flap installed on eachwing is operated by an electric motor-driven gearbox on the rear side of the front spar at
the centerline of the airplane. The gearbox drives two flexible drive shafts, each connected to an acme thread type
jackscrew at each flap. The flaps are controlled by a lever in the subpanel, and their position indicated by an I
instrument to the left of the control column. The lever (switch) must be pulled out of a detent to change positions.
On airplane serials CJ-149; CE-748, CE-772 thru CE-815; D-10097, D-10120 thru D-10178; E-llll, E-1241 thru I
E-1370, the flaps may be stopped at any desired position by moving the flap switch to the OFF position when the
flaps are at the desired position. The switch is placarded UP, OFF and DOWN. The markings on this position
indicator will be 10", 20" and DN.
NOTE
On serials E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After, the approach position is 12".
On airplane serials CJ-150 and After; CE-816 and After; D-10179 and After; E-1371 thru E-2110 except E-l 946 and
E-2104; EA-1 and After, the flaps have three positions: UP (O"), APPROACH (15") and DOWN (30"). The switch is
placarded UP, APPROACH and DOWN. There is no way to stop the flaps in other positions without using the circuit
breaker. The flap position transmitter (if installed) is located near the left flap actuator.
On airplane serials E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389 and After, the position of the flaps is 1
indicated by three lights, located near the flap control handle, in the subpanel. The lights will indicate down,
approach and in-transit positions. All lights are out when the flaps are up.
Trim tabs are installed on each elevator. The tabs are manually controlled by the pilot through drum-cable systems
using jackscrew actuators. Tab position indicators are provided on the tab controls.
The optional electric elevator trim tab is operated by a control switch on the outboard handle of the pilot’s control
wheel. A down spring and bob weight are incorporated into the elevator control system for improved stability.
On earlier serials, aileron trimming was performed by bendable tabs on each aileron and a spring tension trimmer
in the control column. The bendable tabs were adjustable only on the ground. The spring tension trimmer was I
adjustable in flight.
The spring tension trimmer and left bendable tab were replaced by an inflight adjustable trim tab at serials E-2111
I and After, except E-1946 and E-2104, and on serials EA-320, EA-389 and After. This system is
system with a jackscrew actuator and a trim wheel in the pedestal.
hand threaded cable end. Proper routing of the cables as shown in the applicable sub-chapter will aid against
I crossing the cables, and causing improper movement after the cables have been removed and reinstalled.
Refer to the applicable rigging procedures for details regarding chain and cable tension, control wheel movement
I and force, and down spring force and system friction.
Graphs specifying the correct maximum and minimum cable tension permissible for the various controls appear on
the individual control system illustrations. The graphs provide rigging limits at temperatures varying from O" to
1100 F. The horizontal scale on the graphs designates the temperature in degrees Fahrenheit at which the control
I cables may be rigged, and the vertical scale designates the correct tension in pounds for each temperature reading.
TAPER PINS
Refer to the applicable rigging procedures for details regarding chain and cable tension, control wheel movement
I and force, and system friction. Any time the control column has been removed and disassembled, the following
precautions should be observed:
CAUTION 1
I CAUTION
The taper pin may crack the torgue tube if driven excessively.
a. When taper pins are to be installed, use a light weight rawhide or nylon mallet to set the pin. The small end of
the tapered shank should be flush with, or extend no more than 0.06 inch over the surface.
IWARNINQ)
WARNING
On airplane serials 6-1946, 6-2104, 6-2111 and After; EA-320, 6-389 and After, observe the
color on all parts when replacing or reinstalling control cables, bellcranks and/or other
control system components. DO NOT connect coded parts of one color to coded parts of
different color.
a. Remove the four screws that secure the retainer collar assembly to the control column housing (Ref. Figure i).
c. Remove the aileron trimmer. Perform the AILERON CONTROL TRIMMER REMOVAL procedure.
d. Pull the T handle located on the forward side of the control arm.
e. Rotate the control column arm to the nearly vertical position and slide the control column arm off the housing.
a. Position the control column arm vertical (Ref. Figure 1). Make sure that the slot in the lower sprocket is
approximately parallel to the sides of the arm and that the turnbuckles between the long and short chains are
c. Pull the T handle located on the forward side of the control arm.
e. Connectall electricalwiring.
f. Install the retainer collar and attach it with the four screws.
g. Install the aileron trimmer. Perform the AILERON CONTROL TRIMMER INSTALLATION procedure.
h. Check the control column for full movement and the control surfaces for proper direction of movement.
a. Position the control arm, control wheel and sprockets (Ref. Figure i). The long and short chains must be
centered on the sprockets within one link. The turnbuckles must be near the access opening. The slot in the
lower sprocket should be approximately parallel to the sides of the arm.
b. Remove the safety wire from the turnbuckles and loosen or tighten the chain as necessary.
NOTE: Tighten the chain until friction or binding is felt on the control wheel, then loosen the chain just enough to
remove the binding or friction from the control wheel.
c. Check the control wheel and control surfaces for proper operation and freedom of movement.
d. After the adjustments are complete, check that the location of the control wheel, sprockets and turnbuckles are
1
n27 27’1 0-00
RBYtheOll Aircraft tompany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
’;A
I :;i
c-´•
r:
LONG CHAIN
ACCESS OPENING
TURNBUCKLE
CHAIN
SLOT IN SPROCKET
C9201 738
Page
2Mar31/05 27-~ 0-00 A27
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Remove the four screws that secure the retainer collar assembly to the control column housing (Ref. Figure 2).
NOTE: Some installations may have a T handle on the right forward side of the control arm. Pull the T handle
and omit the following step.
b. Remove the screw and washer retaining the pin assembly on the right forward side of hub of the control arm.
b. Make sure the slot in the center sprocket is approximately vertical and the turnbuckles between the long chains
and the short chains are opposite each other near the access openings.
NOTE: Some installations may have a T handle on the right forward side of the control arm. Pull the T handle.
e. Install the pin assembly on the right side of the control arm hub.
f. Install the retainer collar and attach it with the four screws.
g. Check for full control movement and for proper direction of movement.
3
A27
27-1 0-00
RaY(iheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TURNBUCKLES MUST
BE OPPOSITE
SLOT IN SPROCKEI
CHAIN
Q
Al
A ´•j;IONG
C
RIGHT LEFT
RIGHT LEFT
DETAIL A
FWD
C920 759 C
a. Position the control arm, control wheel and sprocket as shown (Ref. Figure 2).
b. Center the long and short chains on their sprockets within one link.
e. Adjustthechainsas necessary.
NOTE: The chains are properly adjusted by tightening the chains until binding is noticed on the control wheel;
then loosen the chains just enough to remove the binding or friction from the control wheel.
f. After the adjustments are complete, check that the location of the control arm, control wheels, sprockets and
turnbuckles are as shown.
h. Check the controls for freedom of movement and the control surfaces for proper direction of movement.
AILERON REMOVAL
a. Support the aileron and remove the two attaching screws from the top and bottom of each hinge bracket.
b. Pull the aileron straight away from the wing to avoid damage to the attaching areas.
a. Attachthebonding cabletotheaileron.
b. Place the aileron in position on the hinge brackets. The hinge brackets must be in the correct place between the
aileron skin and the reinforcing structure.
d. Pull on the aileron in a direction straight away from the wing to make sure that the hinge brackets are positioned
correctly. If there is any movement of the aileron, recheck the position of all hinge brackets.
5
27-1 0-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: Raytheon Aircraft Company recommends the use of the aileron travel gage. Refer to Chapter 12-20-00,
SPECIAL TOOLS. The front of the travel gage should be located over the leading edge skin splice with the
aft portion over the number 8 wing rib (just outboard of the inboard aileron hinge).
a. Aileron and flap surfaces must align with the upper and lower surfaces of the wing within 1/16 inch.
b. Adjust the aileron downstops in the wing until the bellcrank just clears the gusset on the wing rib. Set the aileron
upstep in the wing so that the aileron bellcrank just misses the aileron pushrod (Ref. Figure 3).
c. Adjust the link connecting the aileron to the bellcrank to allow full travel of the ai leron surface between the upstep
and downstop.
NOTE: The aileron is in neutral when the aileron trailing edge aligns with the trailing edge of the wing, and its inboard
end is parallel with the outboard end of the flap.
d. Adjust the cables from the wing to the control column cables. The turnbuckles are in the wheel wells.
e. Secure the control column wheel in neutral by securing a bar across the top of the control wheel and leveling
the control wheel with a bubble level.(With the control locks
installed, the control wheel is rotated 12" to the
right). Adjust the tension as shown on the aileron temperature cable tension graph (Ref. Figure 3).
NOTE: The control wheel must be level in relation to the airplane. If the airplane is not level, make a corresponding
change to the position of the control wheel using a spirit level protractor.
Take the cable reading in the wheel well where the control column cables attach to the wing cables.
f. Rotate the control wheel to ascertain by feel that the wing bellcranks reach their stops before the control column
reaches its stops.
g. If there is less travel of the control wheel in one direction than in the other direction, loosen one turnbuckle on
the lower cable and tighten the opposite lower cable turnbuckle, depending on which way the travel is off.
h. Secure the control wheel in neutral after the correct travel of the wheel is obtained. Adjust the link connecting
wing bellcrank to obtain the aileron in neutral. Neutral position of the aileron is determined by
the aileron to the
aligning the inboard end of the aileron with the outboard end of the flap with the flap in the up position.
i. Set the bellcrank stops to give a deflection of 20 2" up and/or down (Ref. Figure 3).
NOTE: The aileron bellcrank stops should make contact 1/16 inch before the control column stops are reached.
j. Be sure each aileron bellcrank contacts its upstep at the same time as the bellcrank in the opposite wing
contacts its downstop.
k. Check the control stop (secondary stop) in the control column for 1/16 inch clearance in each direction. If the
clearance is not correct, recheck the entire aileron control system for correct chain and cable rigging.
NOTE: The control stop clearance provides a slight movement of the control wheel (a cushion) after the travel stops
and the aileron bellcranks make contact.
WARNING: Check the ailerons for correct direction of movement. When the control wheel is moved to
the left, the left aileron must move up and the right aileron must move down. When the
control wheel is moved to the right, the right aileron must move up and the left aileron must
move down.
Check to make sure that cabin floorboards, floorboard insulation and other interior parts
do not contact the control cables.
TRIMMER REMOVAL
a. Unscrew the two body halves by holding the clutch body housing touter half) and turning the clutch body nut
b. Separate the two body halves by pulling out on the clutch body housing.
TRIMMER INSTALLATION
a. Carefully insert the shaft through the felt seal into the hub bearing, being careful not to shear the felt seal.
b. Screw the two halves of the unit together by holding the clutch body and turning the clutch body nut. Hand
c. Check that the tangs of the drive shaft engage properly with the sprocket as the unit is being tightened by hand.
Also note that the position indicator on the face of the unit is right side up as the shaft engages with the sprocket
tRef. Figure 4).
nlr
27-~ 0-00Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
50
50
20´UP
-2
40LBS +-S LBS AT
AILERON
59"F
BUNGEE SPRINGS +2
10
20" DOWN
CONNECTED -2
10 20 30 40 50 66 70 Se 90 100 110
fEkdPERATURE- ’F
RIGHT AILERON
UP CABLE
T~RNBOCI(LES
IN WHEEL WEU
DOWNSTOP
UPSTOP
Illll~llre
LEFT UP
THAWGH
‘L-
d%- RK;HT UP
LEFT AILERON
UPCABLE
i~B* I
,i
\1 36-151-17
oO~
RUDDER INTERCONNECT
BUMGEE
9
A27 27-1 0-00 Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
AILERON TABS
The ailerons are equipped with sheet metal tabs which may be adjusted while the airplane is on the ground. The
tabs are adjusted by bending them in opposite directions to each other. Bend the tabs only a small amount each
time and check the setting by flight test.
3. AILERON TRIMMER
II:
A27
27-~ 0-00 Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon AiKra´•H Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I WARNING)
WARNING
Make certain that insulation, tie wraps, etc. do not interfere with control components such
as cables, chains, etc.
IWARNING)
WARNING
On airplane serials E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389 and After, observe the I
color coding on all parts when replacing or installing control cables, bellcranks and/or other
control system components. DO NOT connect parts of one color to coded parts of a different
color.
a. Paint one tooth of each control column’s sprocket and its corresponding chain link to ensure proper alignment
of the control wheels at installation (Ref. Figure 1).
b. Loosen the turnbuckles of the control column chain and the aileron turnbuckles in the wheel well.
c. Remove the safety wire from the four bolts (two on each end), and remove the six bolts from the channel
between the control columns.
f. Remove the four connector links from the stop link assembly, then remove the stop link assembly. I
NOTE
It may be necessary to remove the stop block before removing the stop link assembly.
g. Slide the sprocket support assembly aft over the joint then remove the chains from the control columns.
1
n24 27-11-00 Sep 30/03Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TURNBUCKLE
STOP
TORQUE
GUARD PIN
SHAFT
LINK
ASSEMBLY CHAIN
ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR SPROCKFT
LINK ASSEMBLY
AILERON CABLE
ASSEMBLY
Q
AIRCRAFT
36´•1558
a. Install the chains over the control column sprockets (Ref. Figure 1).
b. Install the stop link assembly. The outboard holes are used with the control column chain.
c. Install the aileron cable chains. The inboard holes of the stop link assembly are used with the aileron cable
chains.
NOTE
Make certain the conn~ctor links are properly installed.
d. Install the stop block if removed.
I g.
columns.
Tighten
Safety wire the four bolts.
the control column chains. Refer to the CONTROL COLUMN CHAIN RIGGING procedures.
WARNING
Check the ailerons for proper motion. When the control column is turned to the right, the left
aileron should move down and the right aileron move up.
2
Sep 30/ Page 27-11-00 A24
RaylheQn AiKlaft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Rig neutral on the control wheels by placing a straightedge across the top of the control wheels. One of the grips
may be 0.06 inch off the straightedge (Ref. Figure 1).
I
It
b. Ensure that the ends of the control column chain around the right sprocket are within one link of equidistance
from the centerline of the sprocket.
c. If the stop link assembly is not centered within f 0.02 inch with respect to its stop, adjust the turnbuckles to I
center the link.
d. Place a vertical load of two pounds on the top chain near the airplane centerline. The chain should deflect 0.25
0.06 inches. Adjust the turnbuckles as necessary to obtain this deflection. I
e. After rigging the control column chain, refer to RIGGING THE AILERON CONTROL SYSTEM and make certain
the ailerons are properly rigged.
clearance. These two bolts may be identified by their 10-32 threads. Refer to Figure 2 and adjust the rollers as I
follows:
a. Wipetheshaftsclean anddry.
b. Hold one of the nonadjustable rollers firmly against the shaft.
c. The roller on the opposite side of the shaft should turn freely while having no more than 0.002 inch clearance.
d. If the conditions of Step c. are not met, loosen the nut on the roller which has the bolt with 10-32 threads.
e. Turn the bolt until the conditions of Step c. are complied with.
f. Tighten the nut, then recheck the roller clearance in accordance with Steps b. and c..
h. If the adjustment is needed, follow Steps d., e. and f. for the second set of rollers.
3
27-11-00 Sep 30/03Page
RMJlheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
O FORCE
THIS ROLLER
SHOULD ROLL
FREE
.002 OR LESS
381506
Pull the control column fore and aft until the position of least clearance between the control column and support
rollers is located. Keep the control column in this position while checking and/or adjusting the clearance. Each
control column will probably have its own position of least clearance.
a. Hold the control column firmly against the two top rollers.
b. The clearance between the control column tube and the lower roller should be 0.005 0.002 inch.
c. If the correct clearance is not indicated, loosen the nuts on the two top rollers.
AILERON REMOVAL
a. Lower the flaps and disconnect the push-pull rod to the aileron tab.
b. Support the aileron and remove the two attaching screws from the top and bottom of each hinge bracket.
c. Pull the aileron straight away from the wing to avoid damage to the attaching areas.
4
Sep 30/Page 27-11-00
RaJlheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
AILERON INSTALLATION
b. Place the aileron in position on the hinge brackets. Be sure the hinge bracket is in the proper place between the
aileron skin and the reinforcing structure.
d. Pull on the aileron in a direction straight away from the wing to assure that the hinge brackets are properly
positioned. If any movement of the aileron is noted, recheck the position of all hinge brackets.
e. Lower the flap and connect the aileron tab push-pull rod and install the cotter pin.
b. Remove the forward passenger seats and the floorboards between the main and rear spars.
c. Remove the access plates as necessary to gain access to the aileron cables and pulley brackets on the lower
trailing edge of the wings.
d. Remove all necessary cable retaining pins from the cable pulley brackets.
e. Disconnect the forward aileron cables from the chain and cable assembly at the connector link below the control
column. Install lead lines to both aileron cables (Ref. Figure 4). 1
f. Disconnect the forward aileron cables and the forward outboard wing cable at the turnbuckles in each wing.
Connect a lead line to one end of the cable and remove the cable.
g. Disconnect the balance cable at the turnbuckle in each wing. Connect a lead line to one end of the cable and
remove the cable.
h. Disconnect the forward outboard and the aft outboard cables at the bellcrank in each wing. Identify and remove
the cables.
5
Pi24
27-11-00
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WHEEL
1~
COLLAR ASSEMBLY
2.
COLUMN TORQUE TUBE
3.
ELEVATOR TORQUE ARM
4.
ELEVATOR TORQUE TUBE
5.
ELEVATOR BELtCRANK
6.
7. ELEVATOR TORQUE TUBE SUPPORT
8. BOB WEIGHT ASSEMBLY
S.COUAR
10. COLLAR ASSEMBLY
11. ELEVATOR PUSHROD
12. CONNECTOR
13. INNER COLUMN GUIDE
14. INNER COLUMN TORQUE TUBE
15. UJO1M 20 21
!j
16. SPROCI<FF SUPPORT 19
17. TAPER PIN
18. SPROCKFT 1
20.
FORWARD SUPPORT
.91TUN 16
1
21. COTTER PIN
22. SUPPORT ROLLERS
11
12 K 15 17
4---~
1 BJj
q Q~k
4
17 ~B
3
5
ii 8
22
17
17
j
c
3&(55´•(4
Control Column
Figure 3
Sep 30/Page 6
27-11-00 A24
RayIheon Airuaft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
e
F.S. 96.00
1 a RIGHT A1LERON UP
F.S. 84.358
DETAILC oE´•rAI1B N
RIGHT AILERON BALANCE CABLE
LEFT AILERON UP
~c-
BALANCE ‘2. F.S. 117.187
A B DETAIL D
F.S. 112.000
C LEFT AILERON UP
AILERON TAB
ACTUATOR
B
BALANCE CABLE
E
QD TEMPERATURE CABLE TENSION GRAPH
~m ~-TRAVEL STOPS
AILERON g
BEUCRANK ~AB.
CABLE I CABLE TENBIDN SURFACETRAVU
B
DETAIL E z~
35 5 Las W~
DETAIL A AILERON AT 59"5 BUN~EE 20~ 2" ilP
20" 21 DOWN
80
SPRINGS CONNECTED 10 20 .30 ´•40 50 60 70 90 100 HO 120
TEMPERATURE "F
~6151-18
Aileron System
(2-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After;
EA-320, EA-389 and After)
Figure 4
A24
27-11-00 Sep 30/03Page 7
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
27111100 A24
RayYheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Route the balance cable through one wing, the fuselage, then through the opposite wing. Disconnect the lead
line and connect the balance cable and the aft outboard cables to the turnbuckles in each wing.
c. Routeone end of the aileron cables outboard in each wing, and the other end forward to the control column.
Connect the cables to the turnbuckles at the forward outboard cable in each wing.
d. Connect the chain and cable assembly to both aileron cables at the connector link below the control column.
g. Install the access plates on the lower trailing edge of the wings.
I WARNI~NQ)
WARNING
Make certain that insulation, tie wraps, etc. do not interfere with control components such
as cables, chains, etc.
Check for correct direction of movement by moving the control wheel. When the control
wheel is moved to the left, the left aileron should move up and the right aileron move down.
When the control wheel is turned to the right, the right aileron should move up and the left
aileron down.
Check to make sure that cabin floorboards, floorboard insulation and other interior parts do
not contact the control cables. I
RIGGING THE AILERON CONTROL SYSTEM
NOTE
Raytheon Aircraft Company recommends the use of the aileron travel gage. Refer to SPECIAL I
TOOLS in Chapter 12-2q-00. The front of the travel gage should be located over the leading edge
skin splice with the aft portion over the number 8 wing rib (just outboard of the inboard aileron
rigging with TE-100TB Universal Travel Board and KS6005 Digital Protractor is
ac eptable.hinge).
Alternate
I
a. Aileron and tab surfaces must align with the upper and lower surfaces of the wing within 1/16 inch.
b. Place the aft arm of both aileron bellcranks parallel to the adjacent wing rib. If the aileron is not in neutral, loosen
the locknuts on both ends of the push-pull adjust the push-pull tube until the aileron is in neutral.
tube and
c. Tightenthe locknuts.
~224
27-11-00 Sep 30/03Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
d. Rig neutral on the control wheels by placing a straightedge across the top of the two control wheels. One grip
I may be 0.06 inch off of the straightedge.
e. Assure that the ends of the chain around the right control column are within one link of equidistance from the
centerline of the sprocket.
f. If the link stop assembly is not centered with respect to its stop, adjust the turnbuckles to center the link.
g. Place a vertical load of two pounds on the top chain near the airplane centerline. The chain should deflect 0.25
i. With a straight rig pin installed between the pilot’s rudder pedals and with a simulated (10 Ibs.) cable tension,
adjust the turnbuckle above the forward aileron bungee spring until both bungee springs are extended equally
I rt 0.06 inch.
j. Adjust the turnbuckles in the wheel wells to bring the ailerons to neutral (O").
I i. Adjust the aileron bellcrank stops (primaly stops) for a deflection of 20 zt 20 UP, and 20 2" down from neutral.
n. Rig the aileron cables to the tension indicated in Figure 4. Use the turnbuckles in the wheel wells.
o. Be sure each bellcrank contacts its upstep at the same time the bellcrank in the opposite wing contacts its
downstop.
p. Set the secondary stop bolts (the stop link atthe forward end of the control column) to maintain 0.06 to 0.12 inch
clearance from the stop with the ailerons at full travel (both right and left).
q. With straight rig pin installed between the pilot’s rudder pedals, the control wheels should center within 5" of
a
neutral. If necessary, readjust the vertical turnbuckle above the forward bungee spring and the aft turnbuckle in
the wheel well as required to center the control wheels.
Recheck cable tension and safety the turnbuckies. Make certain all locknuts are tight.
s. With the ailerons fully rigged (bungee springs disconnected), the torque required to move either control wheel
10" right or left of neutral shall not exceed 15 inch-pounds.
I WARNING
W~RNING)
Check for correct direction of movement by moving the control wheel. When the control
wheel is moved to the left, the left aileron should move up and the right aileron move down.
When the control wheel is turned to the right, the right aileron should move up and the left
aileron down.
u. Removeallrigging pins.
Sep 27-11-00
Raylheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
AILERON TAB
A trim tab has been installed in the left aileron which is controllable from inside the airplane while in flight. The aileron
tab is controlled through normal cable and chain linkage to a control wheel located in the pedestal with the indicator.
b. Remove the lower forward upholstery panel on the left side of the pedestal.
d. Remove necessary access plates to gain access to the trim tab cables, actuator, and cable pulley brackets.
f. Disconnect the tab cables at the turnbuckles in the left wing. Identify and connect lead lines on the cable ends.
h. Remove the outboard cable from the actuator sprocket. Remove the cable through the actuator access opening.
i. Remove chain master link at the sprocket on the pedestal. Remove cable through the actuator access opening.
a. Position the chain of the forward tab cable around the pedestal sprocket and install the chain master link.
b. Route the cable ends aft in the fuselage and outboard into the left wing and disconnect the lead lines.
c. Position the chain of the outboard cable around the actuator sprocket and route the cable ends inboard.
d. Install the cable stops at WS 43.375 and connect the cables at the turnbuckles in the wing. I
e. Install the cable retaining pins in the pulley brackets.
f. Rig the aileron trim tab control system, refer to AILERON TRIM TAB RIGGING procedure. I
g. Install all access plates in the left wing.
h. Install the floorboard and the left forward passenger seat.
lwnREllNaI
WARNING
Make certain that insulation, tie wraps, etc. do not interfere with control components such
as cables, chains, etc.
The aileron tab should stay in the same plane with respect to the aileron when the aileron is
moved. When the tab control wheel is turned to indicate left wing up, the aileron tab should
move up. If the aileron and aileron tab do not move in the proper direction, recheck rigging.
11
nz4 27-11-00 Sep 30/ 3Page
RayMheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
Place the aileron in neutral.
b. Place the aileron in neutral position and connect the trim tab to the tab actuator.
c. By tu ming the sprocket on the actuator, adjust the trim tab to both extremes of travel; measu re both settings and
return the tab to the midpoint of the two extremes of travel. This will place the actuator in the neutral position.
d. If the trim tab is not in the neutral position upon completion of Step c., adjust the pushrod to place the tab in
neutral position.
f. Set the aileron tab stop (at WS 43.375) to obtain a surface deflection of 9" 0" 1" up and down. Torque the
I g.
stops to 40 to 60 inch pounds.
I WARNINQ)
ARNINO
After rigging the aileron and aileron tab control system, check for correct movement of the
control surfaces with respect to the movement of the controls. The aileron tab should stay
in the same plane with respect to the aileron when the aileron is moved. When the tab control
wheel is turned to indicate left wing up, the aileron tab should move up. If the aileron and
aileron tab do not move in the proper direction, recheck the rigging.
e. Remove the bolts attaching the actuator to the wing structure. Remove the actuator.
a. Position the actuator against the wing structure and install the attaching bolts.
c. Remove the actuator screw (8) from the nut assembly (5).
d. Remove the pins from the actuator screw (8) and the actuator rod end (11) and remove the actuator rod end
from the actuator screw. The bearing (4) and the bushing (9) can now be removed from the actuator screw.
e. Remove the check nut (2), and screw out the adjusting bushing (3) with a spanner wrench.
nn~Pagel3
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANGE MANUAL
V/
9 4 5
13 1?
ta 11
s TH27B
98~BS9AA
NOTE
During assembly lubricate all moving parts with grease (11, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
b. Install the other bearing (4) and bushing (9) on the actuator screw (8).
d. Push the nut assembly (5) into the actuator housing (6), and install the snap ring (10) in the actuator housing (6).
Use spanner wrench to install the adjusting bushing (3) into the actuator housing (6) until the end play between
I
e. a
the screw housing and nut assembly (5) is less than 0.025 inch. If the end play cannot be reduced to within limits,
replace the actuator.
g. Install the actuator rod end (11) on the actuator screw (8).
h. Align the holes in the actuator screw (8) with those of the actuator rod end (1 1) and install the two pins.
j. Align the holes in the sprocket (1) with those in the nut assembly (5) and install the two pins.
Visually inspect the aileron trim tab for damage, security of hinge attach points, and for tightness of the actuating
system. Inconsistencies must be corrected before checking the free play of the tab.
A check fixture (P/N 45-135030-9/810) or equivalent, a dial indicator, and a push-pull scale for applying accurate
loading to the tab are required for making the inspection for tab free play (Ref. Figure 6).
a. Securely lock the control surfaces to prevent movement of the ailerons. Set the aileron trim tab in neutral.
b. Use shot bags to hold the dial indicator check fixture so that the point of the dial indicator is 2.0 inches aft of the
tab hinge line and on the outboard edge of the aileron tab.
c. Apply a small piece of masking tape (for paint protection) 4.0 inches aft of the tab hinge line and along the
centerline of the tab actuator. This is the point of pressure against the tab by the push-pull scale.
d. Apply another piece of masking tape in the corresponding location on the bottom surface of the tab.
e. Set the dial indicator at zero. Do not reset the dial indicator during the checking procedure.
f. With the push-pull scale on the masking tape, apply a 3.0 pound downward load. Record the dial reading as A.
g. Release half of the load to obtain a 1.5 pound downward load. Record the dial reading as B.
h. On the masking tape on the bottom surface, apply a 3.0 pound upward load. Record the dial reading as C.
i. Release half of the load to obtain a 1.5 pound upward load. Record the reading as D.
1. SubtractAfrom2Band recordasX.
2. MultiplyBby2and recordases.
3. MultiplyDbyeand recordas2D.
NO~E
X and Y can be negative numbers.
Pi24 27-11-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i. If the free play is over the maximum specified in Chart 1, inspect all components of the tab actuator system to
determine the cause. All worn parts must be replaced.
This check should be performed at least once a year to ensure that the trim tab free play falls within the prescribed
limits.
A check fixture (P/N 45-135030-9/810) or equivalent, a dial indicator, and a push-pull scale for applying accurate
I loading to the tab are required for making the inspection for free play of the tab (Ref. Figure 6).
a. Securely lock the control surfaces to prevent movement of the ailerons. Set the aileron tab in the neutral
position.
b. Using shot bags, affix the dial indicator check fixture so that the dial indicator point is 2.00 inches aft of the tab
hinge line and on the outboard edge of the aileron tab.
c. Apply a small piece of masking tape (for paint protection) 4.00 inches aft of the tab hinge line and along the
centerline of the tab actuator. This will be the point of pressure against the tab by the push-pull scale.
d. Apply another piece of masking tape in the corresponding position on the bottom surf ace of the tab for the same
purpose.
e. Zero the dial indicator at no load initially. Do not reset during the checking procedure.
f. With the push-pull scale at the point of masking tape, apply a full 3-pound downward load. Record the dial
reading as A.
I g. Release half the load until a 1.5 pound downward load is obtained. Record the dial reading as B.
h. Apply a full 3 pound upward load at the masking tape on the bottom surface. Record the dial reading as C.
I i. Release half the load until a 1.5 pound upward load is obtained. Record the dial reading as D.
1. MultiplyBby2and recordas2B.
3. MultiplyDby2and recordas2D.
4. SubtractCfrom2Dand recordas\(.
NOTE
The results of X and Y can be negative numbers.
k. If the free play exceeds 0.094 inch, inspect all components of the tab actuator system to determine the cause.
CHART1
AILERON TAB FREE PLAY LIMITS
2B -A =X
2D -C =Y
X +Y =E
(E=O.Og4-inch maximum)
9 12
~o
13 678
1I
5
.8 IN
~1’-----------
.25 IN
I
1.30 IN
t~
ITEM QUANT. DESCRIPTION 1 1----C-C i
NO.
.68 IN
7
1 2 3/4 x i x 8 aluminum or equlv.
2 2 1 x 1 9/8 x i 3/4 aluminum or equlv.
3 1 1/2 x 7 1/2 x 10 aluminum or equiv.
4 i C81P Indicator"
5 1 3/4 x 2 1/2 x 14 aluminum or equlv. 1.6 IN
6 114 Dia. x 2 oarrosion res. stl.
7 i 1/4 Dia. ~e 1 corrosion res, sH. .31 IN
8 1 114-28 nut
9 1 3/8 x 5 x 10 rubber
10 1 3/8 x 2 x 10 rubber
11
12
13
14
i
2
2
2
1/4
1M
x
x
2
13
x
x
10 corrosion res. sil,
3 VLIER
KNB13 Keensert or tap 1/2
1/8 x 1 x 3/4 rubber
Torque sorew
13
SEC710N,t
4k THIS GROOVE TO BE A SNUG FIT
TO THE SCREW 5RACKET ON
"P/N or Federal Products Corp., Proddence, R. I. THE DIAL INDICATOR
ioo-,,5-e
18
Sep 30/Page 27-11-00 A24
RayIIheoIlt Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WARNING I
I WARNING
On 06-1566 and after; 6-1946, 6-2104, 6-2111 and after; EA-320, EA-389 and
airplane serials
after, observe the color coding on all parts when replacing or installing control cables,
bellcranks and /or other control system components. DO NOT connect parts of one color to
coded parts of a different color.
RUDDER REMOVAL
a. Detach the tail cone, disconnect the tail navigation light wire and remove the tail cone.
b. Remove the tail section access doors on the left hand side of the aft fuselage.
e. Removethe rudder.
RUDDER INSTALLATION
a. Placethe rudderinposition.
e. Connectthenavigation lightwires.
nm
27-20-00 Feb 26/99Pagel
RayZhe8888 Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Rig Pin
CL
CL
0.38" to 0.45"
8-8
i.,
B
j A-A
56-1~46
Page
beF2
26/99 27-20-00 A20
RayEheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LEFT
RUDDER
RUDDER
RFII.CRAM(
mAnA C*BLE~_ STOPS
CABLE
LEFT
RUDDER RIGHT
CABLE RUDDER
CABLE
DerA~a E
DETAPLD
m~C /I ~e,
mAI~B
Rudder System
Figure 2
A20
27-20-00 Feb 26/99Page
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Page
beF4
26/99 27120100 A20
Raytheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
20 +0 -I LEFT B36TC
AND RIGHT
23 +O -1 E-1946, E-2104
LEFT AND AND E-2111 AND
RIGHT OF AFTER
NEUTRAL
,40
a30
n
20
4
io
EA278
sadaol*a
5
A20 27-20-00 Feb 26/99Page
Raytheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
rigging of the rudder pedals a rigging tool may be fabricated from a steel block 1/2 inch
To facilitate
X 1 inch X 2 inches; and two 3/8-inch- x 2-1/8-inch-long pins. The rig pins are located parallel and
forward of the block, one on each side, and welded. The rig pins should be spaced as noted in
Figure 1.
b. Install a rig tool in the holes provided in the pilot’s rudder pedals.
c. With the bellcrank in the neutral position, rig the cables to the tension shown on the temperature cable tension
graph in Figure 3, then remove the rig pin.
NOTE
Installation of the rig pin in the pilot’s rudder pedals will bring the copilot’s pedals to the same ad-
The right hand rudder pedals are rigged 0.38 0.45 inch forward of the neutral position.
d. Adjust the rudder travel at the rudder bellcrank stops as indicated in Figure 2.
e. Adjust the rudder pedal travel at the rudder pedal stops so that contact with the rudder bellcrank stops occurs
f. Make sure that the rudder movement corresponds to the movement of the rudder pedals.
Page
627-20-00
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE NOTE
All rudder rigging should be accom- The 35-590087 differential mechanism
plished with a travel board installed. A jig assembly is to be used with the
bubble protractor should not be used for 35-590087-9 stop installed.
any rudder rigging procedure.
With the rudder, elevator and tab sys-
The rudder system and elevator system
tems correctly adjusted and in neutral,
are separate systems forward of the
the differential mechanism tail control
empennage. The control surfaces for (rudder) arms are lightly contacting the
both the rudder and elevator are the aft side of the 35-590087 differential
same parts. The rudder and elevator
mechanism jig assembly and the out-
control surfaces will be referred to as
board ends (legs) of the jig assembly are
ruddervator,
lightly contacting the forward side of the
a. Adjust the stops on the aft fuselage bulkhead to fuselage station 256.9 bulkhead. The nut
permit a maximum combined ruddervator travel as on the differential mechanism elevator
shown on the overall travel tables. Refer to Figure 1. control (center) arm is to be positioned
link at the rudder
inside the hole in the jig assembly.
b. With the adjusting quadrant,
located aft of the
just rudder pedals, lengthen or The elevator and rudder system are in
shorten necessary to align the copilot’s pedals with
as neutral when the differential mechanism
the pilot’s pedals. When aligning the pedals, be sure jig assembly, the rudder rig tool and the
both sets of pedals are in the same position, control column block are installed with
c. Straighten the nose wheel and position the rudder the ruddervators in the 0" position with
pedals in neutral position with an aligning (rig) tool in the cable tensions set to the tempe~a-
the pedals. Refer to Figure 1, 27-20-00. ture cable tension graph. The trim tab
system is in neutral when the cockpit
NOTE indicator is at 0", the cable tensions are
The left rudder pedal is rigged .38 to .45 set to the temperature cable tension
inch aft of the neutral position. To facili- graph and the tabs are at O" or sym-
tate rigging of the rudder pedals to these metrically split. The tabs are at 00 when
dimensions, a rigging tool may be fabri- their trailing edges align with the trailing
cated from a steel block 1/2 x 1 x 2 edges of the ruddervators.
inches, and two 3/8 x 2-1/8-inch-long rig
pins. See Figure 1, 27-20-00. The rig f. Adjust the short, lower elevator cable to a total
pins are located parallel and forward on length of 23.62 ~t.06 inches as measured from the
the block, one on each side, and center of its attachment points at the reduction bell-
welded. Rig pins are spaced per Figure crank and the differential mechanism. Refer to Figure
I
side of the barrel after adjustment. Safety the turn-
d. Position the control column in the neutral
position
buckle. No further adjustment of this cable is required.
with 4-1/2 inches (4-3/4 inches on D-10359 and after)
between the collar on the instrument panel and split g. Adjust the main rudder cable tensions to the ten-
collar on the control column. This can be accom- sion shown on the temperature cable tension graph.
plished by cutting a block 4-1/2 (or 4-3/4 for D-10359 Refer to Figure 7. (The cables can be adjusted simul-
and after) inches long and taping it to the control coi- taneously with the rudder balance cable.) The balance
umn. cable is adjusted by adding or removing washers
27-21 -00
Page 1
A19 Mar 29/96
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
z
H
g I
RUDDER
i 30 RUDDER PEDAL SETLlNGS BALANCE CABLE
O a r
10
20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110
TEMPERATURE-FO
fD
35-590087 AND 35-590087-9
DIFFERENTIAL MECHANISM
JIG ASSEMBLY
FUSELAGE STATION
151.0
DETAIL E
DETAIL C
DETAIL B
35-153-17
003
27-21-00
Page 2
Aug 18/95
Ai8
Baeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
RUDDERVATOR REMOVAL
behind swivel bolt on the balance cable pulley bracket.
The differential mechanism, control column and rud-
der pedals are still to be in their neutral positions after
(Figure 2) I
cable tensions are adjusted. NOTE
h. Set the ruddervators in the neutral position (00) by The rudder system and elevator system
are separate systems forward of the
adjusting the length of the control push-pull rods,
Make sure the rod ends remain screwed the required empennage. The control surfaces for
both the rudder and elevator are the
length into the push-pull tubes. They should extend
past the inspection hole, i.e. a wire should not pass
same parts. The rudder and elevator
control surfaces will be referred to as
through the inspection hole.
ruddervator.
i. Remove the differential mechanism jig assembly
and remove the rudder pedal rig tool. Leave the con-
Before disassembly check the rudderva-
trol column 4-1/2- (or 4-3/4- for D-10359 and after)
tor for movement perpendicular to the
hinge line. If any movement exists, find
inch-long block inplace to prevent elevator system
the cause of the looseness. If any hinge
influence on rudder rigging.
bolt, bearing or bushing shows signs of
j. Set the rudder travel by adjusting the stop bolts wear, they must be replaced.
(refer to Figure 1, Detail A) just aft of the pilot’s rudder
pedals. Refer to Figure 1 for the applicable table of
a. Remove the screws holding the tail cone in posi-
tion.
travels and the appropriate ruddervator travel values.
Steps b through h should result in the ruddervator b. Remove the tail cone and disconnect the naviga-
travel being correct nearly
or correct. Make any final tion light wire.
minor adjustments by lengthening or shortening the c. Remove the aft fuselage side and bottom panels.
control push-pull tubes. Make sure the rod ends
remain screwed the required length into the push-pull
d. Remove the 5/16-inch bolt from the push-pull
tube.
tubes. They should extend past the inspection hole,
i.e. a wire should not pass through the inspection hole. e. Working inside the open left side inspection hole,
release the tab cable tension, then fasten the rudder-
k. When ruddervator travels are correct, tighten the
vator tab cables so that no slack in the cables will be
rod end jamnuts, the rudder stop jamnuts, safety the the affected tab.
transmitted beyond
turnbuckles, safety the nut on the swivel bolt on the
pulley bracket of the balance cable and recheck travel. NOTE
Remove the elevator column 4-1/2- (or 4-3/4- for
D-10359 and after) inch-long block. Identify the cables so that they may be
reinstalled in the proper location.
i. Changing rudder rigging may change elevator rig- f. Disconnect the elevator tab cables at the tab.
ging. Check elevator rigging after changing rudder rig-
g. Remove the guide block located on the tab cable
ging.
at the front of the ruddervator.
I -´•I´•´•I
WARNING i. Remove the nuts from the three hinge bolts.
NOTE
Check the ruddervator for the correct
direction of movement by working the Support the ruddervator so that it will not
rudder pedals. When the left rudder fall or twist when the hinge bolts are
removed.
pedal is depressed, the left rudderva-
tor should move down and the right
Note the position of the washers in each
ruddervator should move up. When
the right rudder pedal Is depressed,
hinge assembly. Tag each hinge assem-
the left ruddervator should move up,
bly as to the location of the washers.
Refer to Figure 2.
and the right ruddervator should
move down. j. Remove the bolts from the hinges.
27-21-00
Page 3
A19 Mar 29/96
aeechcnnft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
k. Remove the two bonding jumpers which are d. Install the nuts on the center and outboard hinge
attached near the hinges. bolts.
i. Remove the ruddervator.
NOTE
RUDDERVATOR INSTALLATION The center and outboard hinge bolt each
g. Install the guide block for the tab cable at the front
of the ruddervator.
NOTE
h. Connect the tab cables to their respective tab
The elevator/rudder control surfaces will
horn.
be refered to as ruddervator.
NOTE
a. Support
the ruddervator in its proper position.
Make sure the hinge bushings are installed in the The bolt connecting the cable to the tab
hinge halves on the stabilizer, horn should be tight enough to prevent
rattle, but loose enough to swivel. If the
NOTE bolt is too tight, the tab control system
will bind.
Any hinge bolt, bearing or bushing
showing signs of wear must be replaced. i. Remove the fasteners which were installed to pre-
The maximum wear for the inboard
vent cable slack from being transmitted to the rest of
bearing is.001-inch radial and .025-inch
the tab system.
axial.
j. Install the 5/16-inch push-pull tube bolt.
b. Install the bonding jumpers at the center and out-
board hinges (two 105090D032-1D washers go k´• Install the aft fuselage inspection panels.
between the screw head and skin).
i. Connect the tail light wire and install the tail cone.
c. Using the notes made during removal (refer to
Figure 2), install the proper washers and bolts in the NOTE
hinges as follows: Check for proper ruddervator and trim
tab travel after installation is complete.
NOTE
When the control column is pulled back,
Install the bolts with the nuts toward the the correct ruddervator movement is up.
fuselage. When the elevator trim tab control is
moved toward the nose-up position, the
1. The inboard hinge requires two AN960-416L
trim tab should move DOWN. When the
and one AN960-416 washers. Install one AN960-416L
elevator trim tab control is moved toward
washer under the bolt head and one between the tor-
the nose-down position, the trim tab
que fitting and the ruddervator inboard hinge support, should move UP.
One AN960-416 washer should be installed under the
nut.
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB REMOVAL
2, Torque the nut to 30 to 40
inch-pounds, It may (Figure 3)
be tightened up to 70 inch-pounds to align the cotter
pin holes. a. Remove the screws from the tail cone.
27-21-00
Page 4
Mar 29/96 A19
Qeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENAN~E iVIANUAL
STABILIZER
2 BOLT
3 WASHER
4 ELEVATOR (RUDDERVATOR) INBOARD HINGE SUPPORT
5 NUT
6 WASHER
7 WASHER
8 TOROUE FITTING
23
‘c~´•
I
~Y?
~O
8765 4
C950X2783131
Ruddervator Installation
Figure 2
27-21-00
Page 5
A19 Mar 29/96
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Disconnect the electrical wires and remove the tail ELEVATOR RIGGING PROCEDURE
cone.
NOTE
c. Remove the cotter pin from the control cables
devises and trim tab. All elevator rigging must be accom-
plished with a travel board installed. A
d. Remove the nuts, washers and bolts from the
bubble protractor should not be used for
control cable devises.
any elevator rigging procedure.
e. Support the trim tab so that it will not fall or twist
when the hinge pin is removed. a. Adjust the stops on the aft fuselage bulkhead to
f. Remove the safety wire from the trim tab hinge permit maximum combined elevator/rudder (rudderva-
pin. tor) travel as shown in the table of travels under
the OVERALL TRAVEL in Figure 4.
g. Unclip hinge pin.
out and remove the elevator b´• Position the control column in the neutral position
h. Pull the hinge pin
trim tab. with 4-1/2 inches (4-314 inches on D-10359 and after)
between the collar on the instrument panel and the
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB INSTALLATION split collar on the control column. This can be accom-
(Figure 3) plished by cutting a block 4-1/2- (or 4-3/4- for D-10359
and after) inches long as applicable and taping it to
a. Support the elevator trim tab in position on the the control column.
ruddervator.
c. Straighten the nose wheel and adjust the pilot’s
b. Install the trim tab hinge pin. Refer to Figure 3. rudder pedals (fore and aft) to the same position.
c. Clipthe hingepin in positionandsafetywire. Install the rudder pedal rig tool in the pilot’s rudder
27-21-00
Page 6
Mar 29/96 A19
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i. TAB HINGE
PIN
2. TAB HORN
CABLE BOLT
1’
DETAIL A DETAIL B
RIGHT ./Q\I I o
OI I lo o o o
RIGHT
DETAIL D
DETAIL C _
Be TAB
HINGE PIN
~e RUDDERVATOR
#TAlL G DETAflH
WRONG
O O
O O O O
O
WRONG
DETAIL E DETAIL F
C91011785155 5
27-21-00
Page 7
A19 Mar 29/96
Beec~M´•dft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
50
5
I ELEVATOR TRAVEL
OVERALL TRAVEL
UP IRCIYEL WWN TRLIVEL (C~OMBINU) CL~YATOR G
V"L *N~RvDDER)
3 _
g ,E
i
P _
F
i
1
F
~C,
~I i’ ~D
0
20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110
TEMPERATURE -"F
B ELEVATOR DOWNS.
272
DETAIL E
ELEVATOR DOWN SPRING
UP ELEVATOR
CABLE
TAB UP CABLE
ij
jig assembly, the rudder rig tool and the (reset if necessary) the elevator cable tensions. The
control column block are installed with elevator trim system may be repositioned to minimize
the ruddervators in the 0" position and the downspring/bob weight effect on the elevator arm
the cable tensions set to the tempera- and elevator cable tensions. After the downspring
ture cable tension graph. Refer to Figure effect is minimized, the up-and-down cable tension
4. The trim tab system is in neutral when average must fall within the maximum and minimum
DIFFERENTIAL
MECHANISM
ELEVATOR
REDUCTION
BELL CRANK
23.62 ?1 ´•06
INCHES
FS 256.9
SHORT, LOWER
FS 233.5 ELEVATOR CABLE
35-152-41
values designated by the temperature cable tension a. Check the up and down travel of the elevator tabs.
graph. Refer to Figure 4. The travel should be 5-1/2" +1/2" -1" up and 23" +2"
i. Check the elevators for correct up-and-down travel ’00 down.
limits: 22-1/2 degrees +0 -1 degree up and 19 +2 -1 b. Check the main and the aft tab cables for proper
degrees down. The stops are nonadjustable stops for- tension as shown on the temperature cable tension
ward of the instrument panel and underneath the con- graph. Refer to Figure 4. The same number of termi-
trol column. Steps b through h should result in the nal threads should be visible on each end of the turn-
ruddervator travel being correct or close to correct. buckle barrels (a maximum of three threads may be
Make any final minor adjustments by lengthening or visible).
shortening the ruddervator push-pull tubes, but make
sure the rod ends remain screwed the required length ELECTRIC ELEVATOR TRIM (OPTIONAL)
into the push-pull tubes. They should extend past the For the Model F33A, E33C and V35B electric trim sys-
inspection hole, i.e. a wire should not pass through the teml see Chapter 27-30-00.
inspection hole.
ELEVATOR TAB RIGGING
j. Adjust the elevator downspring cable turnbuckle
with the ruddervators 9" up and the tabs 20" down
NOTE
(nose up) to remove all slack from this cable system;
then check the force on the elevator control column. The use of a bubble protractor is not
With the trim tabs set at neutral (O"), a force of 19 ~3 adequate to set the ruddervator travels.
A travel board must be used for this.
pounds applied on the control column is required to
move the ruddervators through neutral. If necessary, However, with the ruddervator set at
adjust the elevator downspring cable turnbuckle to neutral, a tab travel board or a bubble
obtain the value. protractor may be used to set elevator
tab travel.
k. When the elevator travels and forces are correct,
tighten the rod-end jam nuts, safety the turnbuckles Elevator tabs should be rigged with the
and recheck the travels. Remove the rudder rig tool. travel board or bubble protractor perpen-
dicular to the chord plane of the stabi-
I. Changing elevator rigging may change rudder rig-
lizer or tab respectively.
ging. Check rudder rigging after changing elevator rig-
ging. a. Install a 4-1/2-inch-long block (or 4-3/4-inch-long
on D-10359 and after) on the control column and
I ARNING
install the rudder pedal rig tool (Figure 1, 27-20-00) to
maintain the ruddervators in neutral. Rotate the eleva-
tor tab wheel in the cabin so the indicator dial is set on
Check for correct direction of rudder- zero.
27-21-00
Page 10
Mar 29/96 Ai9
aee~hcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANC~ ~ANUAL
c. Adjust the length of the actuator screw by discon- f. Move the tab system to neutral (0") position.
necting the bellcrank at the actuator bolt and turning Check and readjust cable tension per the temperature
the screw to the dimension shown in Figure 6. Recon- cable tension graph in Figure 4 if necessary.
nect the bellcrank to the tab actuator.
g. Move the tab control wheel toward nose-down
a"d establish trim tab up-travel per the chart on Figure
d. Adjust the four trim tab cables aft of the bellcrank
4. Move the trim tab cable adjustable upstep against
to obtain 23" +2" -0" tab down position, and establish
the fixed stop in the fuselage.
the initial trim tab cable tension per the temperature
cable tension graph on figure 4. Loosen the tab cable h. Check the clevis bolts which attach the tab cables
stop if necessary. The same number of terminal to the tab horn. The clevis bolts should be free of cor-
threads should be visible on each end of the turn- rosion and dirt and be loose enough to allow free
buckle barrel (a maximum of 3 threads). movement of the horn without binding the tab cables.
i. Move the trim tab wheel toward nose-up and
e. Move the tab control wheel to fully nose down on
establish the trim tab down-travel per the chart on Fig-
the indicator (tabs up). The trim tab up-position should
ure 4, and move the trim tab cable adjustable down
be 5-1/2" +1/20 -1" without altering the tab cable
stop against the fixed stop in the fuselage. Move the
adjustment. Loosen the tab cable stop, if necessary, tab control wheel to neutral
to obtain these dimensions.
(O") on the indicator. The
trailing edge of the trim tabs should align with the trail-
The preceding procedure has established the capabil- i"g edge of the ruddervators.
ity of the elevator tab actuator to move through its j. Reinspect and safety all turnbuckles, nuts, bolts
maximum available range and has correctly oriented and cable stops affected during this procedure. The
the tab indicator, the tab actuator and trim tabs to one tab cable stops are to be tightened to 20 +5 -O inch-
another, pounds of torque and safetied.
CLEVIS END
BELLCRANK
BELLCRANK LINKAGE
ACTUATOR SCREW O
ACTUATOR BOLT
FACE OF ACTUATOR
ACTUATOR
1 \O
.50.38
TO ACTUATOR BOLT CENTERLINE
TO ACTUATOR FACE DISTANCE
35-152-040
After rigging the ruddervator and c. Set cable tension to the graph specifications on
RIGGING ELEVATOR TRIM TABS TO CORRECT b. To install the dial indicator cable, thread the cable
FOR YAW through the hole in the head of the cotter pin and out
through the holes in the indicator drum.
The elevator tabs can be
rigged to function as a rud-
der tab by making minor adjustments up and down c. With the dial at 0 degrees, slip the cable so that
from neutral position. both ends of the cable are of equal length.
FOR RIGHT YAW (NOSE OF AIRPLANE TENDS d. Wrap the cable around the drum one full turn in
TO MOVE TO RIGHT WITH WINGS LEVEL) each direction. The end that wraps to the right will be
wrapped clockwise around the drum, and the end that
a. Adjust the right elevator tab down approximately wraps to the left will be wrapped counterclockwise, as
1" by lengthening the upper right trim tab cable and viewed from the left side.
shortening the lower right trim tab cable.
e. Route the cable over the appropriate idler pulley
b. Adjust the left elevator tab up approximately 1" by down to the shaft of the tab control wheel.
shortening the upper left trim tab cable and lengthen-
ing the lower left cable. f. With the dial still in O degrees position, take the
cable coming off the top of the elevator tab dial
c. Set cable tensions to the graph specifications on
sheave and bring it down to the forward side of the tab
Figure 4.
wheel shaft to the left of the small hole.
d. Safety the two turnbuckles, close inspection pan-
els and test fly the airplane. g. Wrap the cable (counterclockwise) around the
shaft toward the hole three turns. Insert the cable
FOR LEFT YAW (NOSE OF AIRPLANE TENDS TO through the hole. Wrap the surplus cable around the
MOVE LEFT WITH WINGS LEVEL) shaft.
a. Adjust the right elevator tab up approximately 1" h. With the dial set at 0 degrees, take the cable com-
by lengthening the lower right tab cable and shorten- ing off the bottom of the trim tab dial sheave and bring
ing the upper right tab cable. it down to the aft side of the tab wheel shaft, to the
2’1-21-00
Page 12
Mar 29/96 A~9
Beechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
COTTER PIN
DETAIL A
TIE
ANDIDLER PULLEY
A
SOLDER
INDICATOR
DRUM ~SHEAVE)
r-
II///
B
W/
----~yylL--
DETAIL B .36-152-39
27-21-00
Page 13
Mar 29/96
A19
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
right of the hole in the shaft, and wrap the cable b. Remove the access panel on the left side of the
(clockwise as viewed from the left end of the shaft) fuselage, justforward of the ruddervator.
three turns toward the hole in the shaft.
c. Install identification tags to the cables and discon-
i. Insert the cable through the hole in the shaft and nect the cables which are routed aft to the elevator
wrap it around the shaft. trim tabs.
j. Twist the cables together and solder them. Use d. Install identification tags to the cables on each
only rosin core solder. side of the first turnbuckle and disconnect the actuator
k. Check the tab dial to see that it will roll from one cables routed forward to the flight compartment.
stop to the other. Secure the cables so they do not come off of the for-
ward pulleys. Secure the cables to the actuator so the
i. Set the tab dial at O degrees. Place tension on the
tab cables in the tail section to hold the tabs in line
actuator screw position can be maintained.
with ruddervators.
NOTE r~ CAUTION
With the ruddervators set in the neutral Do not damage, kink orput bends in the
position, the left elevator tab should be cables.
set at 2" ~1" above neutral ruddervator
position. The right elevator tab should be e. Identify the cables on the actuator being removed
set at 0" ~10 ruddervator position. so that the cables on the replacement actuator are
m. Safety the turnbuckles and set the stops on the reconnected correctly.
fuselage cables to maintain proper travel in accor- f. Remove the three bolts securing the actuator to
dance with the travel table in Figure 4. the bracket and remove the actuator and attached
bellcrank from the airplane.
I --,´•´•I
~ING NOTE
It may be necessary to remove the two
After rigging the elevator and elevator tab cable pulleys located directly below
trim tab control system, check for the actuator, in order to provide clear-
correct movement of the control sur- ance for the cable ends on the actuator
faces with respect to the movement cables through the pulley bracket.
of the controls. When the elevator
trim tab control wheel Is moved TRIM TAB ACTUATOR INSTALLATION
toward the NOSE DOWN position, the (V35B)
elevator trim tab should move UP.
a. Position the actuator assembly in the bracket and
INSPECTION OF TAB HINGES install the three attaching bolts.
Improper cable tensions, either above or below the b. Using the cable at the forward side of the actuator
recommended limits, will cause excessive wear on the drum, be certain the cable is at the end of its actuator
tab hinges. If excessive wear is noted on the rudder- drum travel.
vator half of the hinge, it should be replaced. c. Rotate the actuator drum upward until the pin
The bolt securing the cable to the elevator tab horn securing the cable to the drum is no longer visible
should swivel in the horn at all times, if the bolt binds, through the actuator cable opening.
it will cause cracks to develop in the tab horn. The bolt
should be
NOTE
just tight enough to prevent rattle, but not
tight enough to cause binding in the horn. If the bellcrank-to-actuator screw linkage
is disconnected, install the actuator bolt,
TRIM TAB ACTUATOR REMOVAL (V35B) washers, nut and cotter pin to attach the
bellcrank to the actuator.
a. Using the trim tab control in the flight compart-
ment, move the trim control to the fully nose-up posi- d. With the actuator bolt connecting the bellcrank to
tion as noted on the elevator trim tab indicator. actuator screw linkage installed, position the trim tab
27-21-00
Page 14
Mar 29/96 A19
~eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
actuator screw by rotating the actuator drum to obtain h. The elevator trim tab indicator on thepilot’s instru-
the actuator bolt-centerline-to-actuator-face distance ment panel should indicate the fully nose-up position
of.38 to .50 as shown in Figure 6. in degrees as noted in Figure 4.
g. Connect the bellcrank cables routed aft to the i. Install the access panel on the left side of the fuse-
elevator trim tabs, lage, just forward of the ruddervator.
27-21-00
Page 15
A19 Mar 29/96
c~T)eechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ELEVATOR AND TAB MAINTENANCE c. Install the attaching nut at the inboard point for the
PRACTICES (F33A, F33C, A36, A36TC elevator and torque to 50-70 inch-pounds.
AND B38TC) d. Connect the push-pull tubes at the torque tube fit-
ting for the elevator.
2790-00
Page 1
A18 Aug 18/95
4aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
15 5 LBS. F33C
O LBS.
E
AT 59"F 10"+ 1" UP
21’~ 1" DOWN
ELEVATOR UP ELEVATOR UP
uv~--
r~ DETAIL D
e o
DoO 5YS 8
O
fA C
C
MTIAILA B c\SC
7 a
?1
ELEVATOR UP
ELEVATOR DOWN
Elevator
TAB NOSE UP DETAIL E3
System (CE-748, CE-m and after; ~149 and atter:
prior to E-2111, except E-1948 and E-2104;
prior to EA-389, except EA-320)
(Sheet 1 of 2)
Figure 1
27-30´•00
Page 2
Aug 18/95 A18
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
f 10
40
I~
i TOP’ELE~P
B ANS!
i
B
~E;
;;6~*
MU~
~e r´•AL)LS_
~WER.
16
27-30-00
Page 3
A18 Aug 18/95
Beechc~ft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
DETAIL C
A36 2.50 t.03 INCHES
B36TC 3.45 +.03 INCHES
L
ELEVATOR DOWN
~47
10" ´•e 10 UP RH
8" I" UP LH
ELEV. UP
ON SERIALS E-1946. E-2104. E-2111 AND AFTER: EA-320. EA-389 AND AFTER. THE
ELEV. DOWN IN-LINE FORCE REOUIRED TO MOVE THE TRIM TAB SYSTEM CABLES SHALL NOT
ELEV. DOWN
NOSE DOWN‘--" 7
EXCEED 16 POUNDS. WITH OR WITHOUT ELECTRIC TRIM.
L--;.3
NOSE UP ON MODELS A36. AND B36TC WHERE THE TAB CABLES DIVIDE INTO TWO CABLES
EACH. THE TWO CABLES SHALL BE ADJUSTED FOR EOUAL TENSION WITHIN 2 .5
POUNDS.
1111 ELEV. UP
THE TENSIONMETER READINGS SHALL BE TAKEN ON THE TOP AND BOTTOM CA-
DETAIL E BLES WITH THE ELEVATOR IN THE NEUTRAL POSITION. AGAINST THE STOPS AND
27-30-00
Page 4
A18
Aug 18/95
~aeechrraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
q20
&ikiMUM
40
8
o’’
a TbrZ
50
t~
2’1-30-00
Page 5
j. The gage reading at NEUTRAL elevator and 23" POU"dS. The force required to return the wheel
(A36, A36TC, and B36TC) or 25" (F33A, F33C) UP through neutral shall be 20 to 24 pounds. The differ-
elevator (.06 inch off fully upstep) must be taken while ence (friction of the system) between the two readings
the control wheel is in motion. shall never exceed 9 pounds (7 pounds is desired) nor
be less than 4 pounds.
k. Adjust each spring by transferring the upper end
to spring-attaching hole providing increased or
a j´• Maintain a minimum clearance of .06 inch between
decreased tension, as applicable. The elevator sys- the control wheel adapter and the inner control column
tem should have sufficient freedom to allow free return guide assembly (both the pilot’s and copilot’s) at fully
of the elevator from fully UP to fully DOWN. down elevator on the A36 and B36TC.
NOTE NOTE
After rigging the elevator and elevator After rigging
the elevator and trim tab
trim tab control system, check for correct system, check for correct movement of
movement of the control surfaces with the control surfaces with respect to the
respect to the movement of the controls. movement of the controls. When the trim
tab control wheel is moved toward the
RIGGING THE ELEVATOR CONTROL NOSE DOWN position, the trim tab
SYSTEM (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 AND should move UP.
27-30´•00
Page 6
Aug 18/95 A18
aeec~craft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g. Wrap the cable (counterclockwise) around the c. Remove the upholstery panel from the back of the
shaft toward the hole three turns. Insert the cable baggage area.
shown in FIFTH AND SIXTH SEAT REMOVAL in O´• Make certain that the correct number of chain
links are on each side of the mark on the sprocket.
Chapter 25-00-00.
P. Co""ect the turnbuckles in the aft fuselage.
b. Remove the screws from the baggage area floor
and remove the floor. q. Tension the cables per Sheet 2 of Figure 1A.
27-30-00
Page 6A
A~8 Aug 10195
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
r. Check for proper elevator tab travel. 2. The normal total difference between the tab
Surfaces is to be 2"+ .5" for all positions.
s. Set the tab travel as indicated in Sheet 1 of Figure
1A. 3. Set the cable stops to provide 8" +1" up on LH
tab and 10" ~tl" up on RH tab, and 27" ~1" down on
t. Installtheaft upholstery panel.
LH tab and 25" +1" down on RH tab as indicated in
u. Install the baggage floor panel. Sheet 1 of Figure 1A.
v. Install the back seats. See FIFTH AND SIXTH The indicator is to read 9" ~2" up and
4. cockpit
SEAT INSTALLATION in Chapter 25-00-00.
26" ~2" down.
w. Install the access panel (actuator door) below the d~ Adjust the stops on the cables to allow surface
pedestal. travel as shown in Sheet 1 of Figure 1 except on air-
x. Install the access panel(s) on the pedestal. 2rb, planes with the serials listed in the preceding note.
e. Torque the stop bolts to 40 to 60 inch-pounds.
I WARNING
w~., I NOTE
After rigging the elevator and elevator
Make certain that Insulation, tie tab control system, check for correct
movement of the control surfaces with
wraps,etc. do not Interfere with con-
trol components such as cables, respect to the movement of the controls.
chains, etc. When the elevator tab control is moved
toward the "NOSE DOWN" position, the
tab should move up.
After rigging the elevator and elevator
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB ACTUATOR
tab control system, check for correct
movement of the control surfaces
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB ACTUATOR
with respect to the movement of the DISASSEMBLY (F33A, B36TC, A36TC AND A36,
controls. When the elevator tab con-
EXCEPT E-llll, F33C PRIOR TO CJ-156 EXCEPT
trol Is moved toward the "NOSE
THOSE AIRPLANES WITH KIT 334002-1
DOWN’ position, the tab should move
up. INSTALLED)
(Figure 2)
RIGGING THE ELEVATOR TRIM TAB
a. Remove the snap ring (6) from the actuator hous-
ing andpull the nut assembly (10) out of the housing.
I a.
tion.
Place the elevator tab indicator in the neutral posi-
b. Remove the actuator screw (9) from the nut
b. Rig the cables to the tension shown on the eleva- assembly.
tor temperature cable tension graph in Sheet 2 of Fig-
ure 1 or 1A, as applicable. CAUIION
c. Place the elevator in neutral position and adjust
the trim tab pushrod to bring the tab into the neutral Do not damage the rod end when drilling
position. out rivets.
NOTE
c. Remove nut (2), washer (3) and shoulder pin (5)
To improve elevator the LH
centering,
then drill out rivet (1). Remove actuator rod end (4)
and RH trim tabs are rigged to a different
setting in the neutral position on serials
from the screw. The bearing (7) and the bushing (8)
can now be removed from the screw.
E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and after,
EA-320 and EA-389 and after. Rig these d. Remove check nut (15) and screw out the end
airplanes per steps 1 through 4. adjusting bushing (14) with appropriate spanner
w’e"ch.
1. Rig neutral tab surfaces with LH down 1" .5"
and RH up 1" .5" with indicator at O". e. RemovetheO-ring (13).
27-30´•00
Page 66
Aug 18/95 A18
aeedacraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
f. Remove the bearing (12) from the housing (11). deterioration. Lubricate all parts with MIL-G-23827
grease (11, Chart 1, 91-00-00) prior to assembly.
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(f33A, B36TC, A36TC AND A36, U<CEPT E-llll,
F33C PRIOR TO CJ-156, U(CEPT THOSE
AIRPLANES WITH KIT 33-4002-1 INSTALLED
(Flgure 2)
Clean all parts in PD680 solvent (16, Chart 1, 91-00-
00) and inspect for cracks, corrosion, and distortion.
Replace bushings and any parts showing evidence of
27-30´•00
Page 6C
A18 Aug 18/95
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
15 14 12
:-B i
13
11 8
1. Rivet 9. ActuatorScrew
2. Nut 10. NutAssembly
3. Washer 11. Housing
4. Actuator Rod End 12. Bearing
5. Shoulder Pin 13. O-Ring
6. SnapRing 14. Adjusting Bushing
7. Bearing 15. CheckNut 33-164-3
8. Bushing
a. Install bearing (12) into housing (11). clockwise when screwed into the nut
assembly (10).
b. Install O-ring (13) into adjusting bushing
~14). g. Install nut assembly (10) into housing (11);
secure with snap ring (6).
c. Install adjusting bushing (14) and check nut
(15). (00 not tighten.) h. Screw adjusting bushing (14) into housing
(11) until the end play has been removed from the nut
d. Install bushing (8), bearing (7) and snap assembly, and tighten the check nut(l5). An end play
ring (6) on actuator screw (9). of 0.003 inch is permissible.
e. Install actuator rod end (4) on actuator ELEVATOR TRIM TAB ACTUATOR DISASSEMBLY
screw (9) and secure with rivet (1) and shoulder pin (E-llll ONLY)
(5), washer (3) and nut (2). (Figure 3)
f. Install screw (9) into nut (10). c. Drill out rivet (12).
horizontal stabilizer shall have threads on torted. Lubricate all parts with lubricating grease (11,
the actuator screw (9) that rotate counter- Chart 1, 91-00-00) prior to assembly.
27-30-00
Page 7
A14 Jun 20/91
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
3 7
1~ 36153´•8
II’
Elevator Tab Actuator Only)
Figure 3
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY g. Install bushing (7) and secure withl check nut (8).
(E-llll only)
NOTE
(Figure 3)
Place collar and retainer ring (2) When assembling the actuator, screw the
a. (3) on actuator
screw (4). threaded bushing (7) into the assembly (5) until
Install actuator rod end (4) end play of the nut assembly (6) has been
b. (1) on actuator screw
being careful to align the holes. removed, then lock in place by tightening the
(10). check nut (8). The nut assembly (6) must be free
c. Install shoulder pin (9) washer (11) and nut
to rotate and provide smooth operation through
d. Install rivet (12), P/N MS20613-3C10.
its full travel with a maximum end play of 0.0015
NOTE inch.
tuator screw (4) that rotate counterclockwise Do not damage rod end when drilling out rivet.
when screwed into the nut assembly (6).
f. Install nutassembly (6) into housing (5) and secure c. Remove nut (1), washer (2) and shoulder pin (3).
The bushing (5) can now be removed from the
with retainer ring (2). screw.
27-3090
PageB
May 31/85 A10
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANOE UANUAL
112
1! 9
b) ’I b
4
10
1. Nut Assembly
7. Nut
2. Washer Housing
8,
3. Shoulder Pin 9, Bearing
4. Snap Ring 10, O-Rng
5. Bushing 11. Adjusting Bushing
6. Actuator Screw 12, Check Nut F33C-164-6
d. Remove check nut (12) and screw out the end c. Install adjusting bushing (11) and check nut (12).
e. Remove O-ring (10). d. Install bearing (5) and snap ring (4) on actuator
f. Remove the bearing (9) from housing 18). screw (6).
Clean all parts in PD680 solvent horizontal stabilizer shall have threads on the ac-
(16, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and
inspect for cracks, corrosion, and distortion. Replace
tuator screw (6) that rotate counterclockwise
bushings and any parts showing evidence of deterioration,
when screwed into the nut assembly (7).
Lubricate all parts with MlL-G-23827 grease (11, Chart 1,
91-00-00) prior to assembly.
a. Install bearing (9) into housing (8). g. Install nut assembly (7) into housing (8), secure
b. Install O-ring (10) into adjusting bushing (11). with snap ring (4).
27-3090
Pageg
A10 IMBy31/85
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
~IIAINTENANCE MANUAL
9 12
io 678
13
1I
5
.8 IN
-t F~ .5 IN
:S
.25 IN
TAP5/8-ll Tbll
I
_____TYPI 2.9 IN
TAB
4
I_A A~a I
14
1.30 IN IN --e
C
x x res.
27-30-00
PagelO A6
Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
1. Multiply "B" by 2 and record as "28".
2. Subtract "A" from "28" and record as "X".
3. Multiply "D" by 2 and record as "2D".
Lubricate all parts except O-ring with
4. Subtract "C" from "20" and record as "Y".
MI L-G-23827 g rease prior to assembly. Lubricate
5. Add "X" and "Y" and record as "E".
the O-ring with MIL-S-8660 (50, Chart 1,
91-00-00).
CHART 1
ELEVATOR TAB FREE PLAY LIMITS
permissible.
28 -A =X
D
CHECKING ELEVATOR TAB FREE PLAY
2D
(CE-748, CE-772 and after; E-llll, E-1241 and after;
CJ-149 and after)
X +Y =E
NOTE
A check fixture (P/N 810 45135030-9) or equivalent, a dial
indicator, and a push-pull scale for applying accurate
The results of "X" and "Y" can be negative
Ioading to the tabs are required for making the inspection for
numbers.
free play of the tabs.
27-30-00
Page 11
’A10 May 31/85’
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g. Remove the chain and cable assembly g. Install the access panel located near the
from the elevator trim tab actuator sprocket. leading edge of the horizontal stabilizer.
h. Remove the hardware attaching the eleva- h. Install the access panel located near the
tor trim tab actuator to the horizontal stabilizer. trailing edge of the horizontal stabilizer.
Remove the actuator from the airplane.
i. Install the access panel on the left hand
ELEVATOR TRIM TAB ACTUATOR INSTAL- side of the fuselage just forward of the horizontal
LATION (F33A, F33C, A36, A36TC AND stabilizer.
sssrc)
j. Connect the tail navigation light wire and
WARNING install the tail cone.
attitude. Refer to ELEVATOR TRIM TAB RH black. Actuators may be inspected for proper
ACTUATOR COLOR CODING to reduce the by removing the actuator inspection hole
installation
the cover and visually inspecting that the appropriate
probability of unintentionally switching
actuators upon installation. color coded actuator is installed (LH blue and RH
black).
a. Position the elevator trim tab actuator in
the horizontal stabilizer and install the attaching On earlier airplanes, elevator trim tab actuators were
After rigging the elevator and elevator trim switch), then moved forward(down-trim) or rearward
tab control system, check for correct (up-trim). On the control wheel left hand grip is a
movement of the control surfaces with quick-interrupt switch (placarded TRIM INTER) which
respect to the movement of the controls. opens the circuit to the servo and stops the action of
When the elevator trim tab control wheel the electric trim system. The PITCH TRIM OFF-ON
is moved toward the NOSE DOWN position, switch is located in the lower left corner of the float-
the elevator trim tab should move UP. ing instrument panel and the circuit breaker (plac-
27-30-00
Page 12
Jun 20/91 A14
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
arded TRIM) is located in the electroluminescent ELEC TRIC ELEVA TOR TRIM GROUND
circuit breaker panel below the instrument panel. CHECKS (AIRPLANES WITHOUT
LOT)
AUTOPI-I
MODEL A36, A36TC, AND B36TC
a. After inspection of the electric trim instal-
ELECTRIC ELEVATOR TRIM TAB SERVO lation for loose wires, obstructions safetied cables,
REMOVAL etc., turn "ON" airplane master switch.
a. Gain access to the servo by removing the b. Turn ON the trim master switch and
fifth and (if installed) sixth seat (refer to Chapter 25 engage the "TRIM" system circuit breaker.
under FIFTH AND SIXTH SEAT REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION) and the partition between the bag- c. Simultaneously press the enable switch
gage compartment and ah section of the airplane, and move pilot’s control wheel switch forward. Note
that the trim wheel moves toward "DOWN" trim posi-
b. Unsafety the turnbuckle on the left trim tion.
cable and loosen the cable.
d. With pilot’s control wheel switch still
c. Remove the cable (make a note and dia- engaged, grasp the manual trim wheel and check for
gram of the cable routing for reinstallation) from the manual override capability; the clutch will slip.
pulleys and capstan.
e. Simultaneously press the enable switchl
d.Remove the 4 bolts, nuts, and 8 washers
and move pilot’s control wheel switch rearward. Note
which secure the servo to the brackets in the air-
that the trim wheel moves toward the "UP" trim posi-
plane. tion.
e. Remove the servo ~note on which side of f. With pilot’s control wheel switch still
the brackets the servo is mounted) from the airplane.
engaged, grasp the trim wheel and check for manual
Ove"ide capability; the clutch will slip.
ELECTRIC ELEVATOR TRIM TAB SERVO
INSTALLATION
g. Press the enable switch only; trim system
must not run.
a. Place the servo in position and install the
4 bolts, 8 washers, and 4 nuts (make certain the servo
h. Move the trim switch fore and ah only; trim
is installed in the same position from which it was
system must not run.
removed).
b. Install the cables on the servo. The left i. The control wheel mounting includes an I
trim cable should be routed forward electric trim-interrupt switch. This switch has the
(outboard)
around the outside groove of the capstan and back to primary purpose of stopping all trim action by inter-
the aftpulley, then forward to the other pulley; wrap rupting both the trim A and ground. The interrupt
around the forward pulley and aft around the inside switch is a momentary type pushbutton, which may
to the turnbuckle. be Checked as follows:
groove of the capstan and forward
c. Install the right (inboard) elevator trim i. With the trim system still turned on,
cable to the pulley as indicated in step "b". actuate the trim switch to drive the trim
system. While
system is being driven, push the interrupt switch and
d. Adjust the capstan cable guard to within note that the trim system stops running while the
1/32 inch of the capstan and secure with the attaching switch is depressed.
screws. Tighten the attaching bolts of the 2 idler
pulleys. 2. If the trim system operates while the
interrupt switch is depressed, the trouble should be
e. Adjust the cable tension per RIGGING THE located and corrected before flying the airplane.
ELEVATOR CONTROL SYSTEM and Figure 1.
j. If the circuit breaker trips or the trim runs
f. Operate the elevator trim system through without both the enable switch and the direction
its complete range of of travel to check for any bind- switch actuated, pull the trim circuit breaker, turn the
ing or restrictions, trim master switch OFF and leave disconnected until
27-30-00
Page 12A
A14 Jun 20/91
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
the trouble is located. If the trim runs with the circuit NEW TAB CABLE INSTALLATION
breaker out, do not fly the airplane.
Note the position of the old cable in relation to the
k. After the electric trim system check-out, cable drum and forward end cable fittings. Install the
the airplane manual trim system should be free of new cable in the same positions
excessive friction and should functionnormally.
MAGNETIC CLUTCH REMOVAL
MODEL F33A, F33C AND V358 (Figure 5)
ELECTRIC TRIM TAB ACTUATOR REMOVAL Remove the lid from the clutch
a. housing.
a. Remove the access door on the fuselage b. Loosen the set screw in the clutch rotor
just below the leading edge of the L.H. stablizer, and armature hubs.
ELECTRIC TRIM TAB ACTUATOR INSTAL- a. Install the clutch in the clutch housing.
LA TION
b. Slide the cable drum and shaft assembly
a. Place the actuator in its mounting location, into the clutch housing.
b. Install the bolts securing the actuator in c. Tighten the clutch armature set screws
21-30-00
Page 128
Jun 20/91 A14
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CLUTCH
CLUTCH HOUSING
ROTOR
.010 to .015
SETSCREWS
CLUTCH
CLUTCH ASSEMBLY"n L_J~J WE´•C~ARMATURE
SETSCREW
CABLE DRUM
60-364-1
CAUTION tool that will fit the shaft on which the cable drum is
mounted.
With no visible end play in the cable drum shaft, 3. Remove the handle from the screwdriver or
the clutch faces must not make contact while fabricate a similar tool so that a low speed (approximately
the clutch is de-energized or damage to the 450 rpm) ’/2 inch drill motor may be attached to the
clutch will result. screwdriver or similar tool.
4. Secure the screwdriver in the ’/2 inch drill
ELECTRIC TRIM TAB ACTUATOR BRUSH motor.
REPLACEMENT SCHEDULE 5. Remove the access plate from the clutch
housing and blow the housing and clutch clean with clean
Replace the brushes at intervals of 2000 fright hours, dry air.
6. Using a regulated power source set at 14 to
MAGNETIC CLUTCH TORQUE TEST 16 vdc, connect the red electrical lead of the clutch to
ground and the white lead to the power source with alligator
The following check should be performed any time the clips.
magnetic clutch is replaced. 7. With the screwdriver in the slot in the drum
shaft turn the drill motor on and run for 15 seconds. Turn the
a. Using 28 vdc power source, connect the red
a drill off and unclip the leads to the clutch.
lead of the magnetic clutch to ground and the white lead to 8. the clutch cool for approximately one
Let
the power source. Using a torque wrench, check that the minute before reattaching the lead for another 15 second
clutch holds with 30 inch-pounds of torque applied at the interval. Repeat the foregoing sequence until the clutch will
actuator shaft, hold with 30 inch-pounds of torque as indicated in step "a",
b. If the static torque of the clutch is less than 30 then blow the clutch and housing clean with clean dry
inch-pounds, burn the clutch as follows: compressed air. Install the access plate on the clutch
housing.
1. Find a metal plate of sufficient thickness for
rigidity and large enough to fit in a vise with the actuator
assembly attached. Anchor the plate in a vise and drill 3 CAUTION
holes in the plate to match the actuator mounting holes. Bolt
the actuator to the plate. Exceeding the 15 second burn-in periods may
2. Locate a blade type screwdriver or similar overheat and damage the magnetic clutch.
"END"
27-30-00
Page 13
A6 Oct7183
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
plate. The airplane should then be flown and replaced extensively repaired, or if a new switch is
or
the adjusted
switch as indicated in the installed. The switch should require no adjustment in normal
following procedure. service.
"END"
27-3140
Page i
May 9/80
RaylSleon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The flaps are hinged in specially designed tracks. When extended, the flap moves rearward as it pivots downward.
This gives a large, effective wing area, which produces additional lift and drag.
One flap is installed on each wing. The flaps are operated by an electric-motor-driven gearbox on the aft side of the
front spar at the centerline of the airplane. The gearbox drives two flexible drive shafts, each connected to an
acme-thread-type jackscrew at each flap. The flaps are controlled by a lever in the subpanel, and the flap position
by an instrument to
is indicated the left of the control column. The lever
(switch) must be pulled out of a detent to
change positions. On airplane serials E-llll, E-1241, thru E-1370; CJ-149; CE-748, CE-772 thru CE-815;
D-10097, and D-10120 thru D-10178, the flaps may be stopped at any position by moving the flap switch to OFF I
when the flaps reach the desired position. The switch is placarded UP, OFF, and DOWN. The markings on the
position indicator will be UP, 10", 20", and DN. On airplane serials CJ-150 and After; CE-816 and After; D-l 0179
and After; E-1371 thru E-2110 except E-1946 and E-2104; EA-1 thru EA-388 except EA-320, the indicator is marked
UP, 15", and DN. Serials E-1946, E-2104 and E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389 and After have lights to indicate
flap position. These lights are marked to indicate the down, in-transit, and approach positions of the flaps. All lights
are out when the flaps are up. The flaps can be stopped only on the up, approach, or down position as indicated by
the flap switch.
The flap position transmitter (if installed) is located near the left flap actuator. Power to operate the indicator lights
of later serials is controlled by the flap relay and limit switches.
NOTE
After emergency extension at speeds above the normal extension speeds,
an inspect the flaps for
damage or distortion before the next flight.
FLAP REMOVAL
c. Remove the bolts from the flap track brackets and remove the flaps.
FLAP INSTALLATION
a. Hold the flap in position and install the rollers and the bolts in the flap track bracket.
NOTE
Install the flap track rollers (four rollers per flap and two rollers per track) in the flap track brackets
with the flanges of the rollers in one track facing the flanges of the rollers in other track.
b. Connect the bonding cable and install the bolt in the flap actuating arm.
1
p~, 27-50-00 Sep 30/03Page
Ray)lheon Air~raft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The allowable track wear on the bearing surface is 0.032 inch resulting in a maximum dimension of 0.785 inch in
I the track slot. The allowable wear into the track side surface is 0.050 inch. Track wear within the preceding
limitations may be dressed smooth with light emery cloth to prevent roller binding. Lubricant mixed with solvent (49
and 26, Chart 1, 91-00-00) may be brushed on the flap tracks during servicing of the airplane.
NOTE
Battery voltage is not sufficient to properly cycle the flaps during rigging. An auxiliary power supply
I capable of maintaining 28.25 0.25 volts should be used. If an external power receptacle is not
available on the airplane, jumper cables may be used between the battery and the power supply.
Be sure of the polarity before making the connection.
I CAUTION
CAUTIOW 1
Excessive operation of the flap motor withoutproper cooling may cause damage to the motor Allow
a short cooling time after each extension and retraction cycle.
The flap limit switches are mounted on a bracket and installed on the outboard side of the inboard flap track in the
left wing panel. The limit switches control the travel of the flaps by breaking the circuit to the flap motor at the extreme
limits of travel. They are accessible by lowering the flaps.
TWO-POSITION FLAPS
(05-748, 05-772 THRU 05-815; CJ-149; 0-10097, 0-10120 THRU 0-10178; E-llll, 5-1241 THRU 5-1370)
There are two limit switches for this system, uplimit position, and one for the downlimit position. To adjust
one for the
theflaps position,
to neutral loosen the screws assembly so that the assembly can pivot on the fomard
of the switch
elongated hole. Adjust the switch as necessary to stop the flaps in neutral position. Actuate the flap switch to the
down position and measure the degrees of travel (proper degree of travel is 300 0" 2"). Adjustment of the down
THREE-POSITION FLAPS
(05-816 AND AFTER; CJ-150 AND AFTER; 0-10179 AND AFTER; 5-1371 AND AFTER; EA-1 AND AFTER)
The limit switches, one for up, two for the approach position and one for the down travel, control the travel of the
flaps by breaking the circuit to the flap motor at the extreme limits of selected travel. The switches are accessible by
lowering the flaps.
The flap travel is adjusted by moving the limit switches. The left flap is rigged first, then the right flap is synchronized
with it. Rig as follows:
Sep 27-50-00
RByeheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
Rig the flaps under a simulated flight load to reduce overtravel to a minimum after the limit switches
have been actuated.
When the flaps are in the 0" position, a clearance of 1/16 inch 1/16 inch 1/32 inch must exist I
between the flap roller and the forward edge of the flap track slot.
a. Adjust the uplimit switch so the flaps will stop at the 0" position.
NOTE
At serials E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After, the flap switch approach position is 12". Adjust the
11" limit (outboard) switch until the
flaps positioned are at 11" to 11.5" after the
flaps have been
actuated from fully up position to the approach position. Adjust the 13" limit switch (inboard) switch
until the flaps are at the 13" to 12.5" position after the flaps have been actuated from fully down to
the approach position.
c. Adjust the downlimit switch in its mounting slot until it actuates at 28" to 300 of flap travel.
d. Remove the bolt attaching the right actuator to the right flap.
e. Turn the jackscrew on the right actuator in or out to align the right flap with the left flap.
CAUTION I
I cnuTlou
If the flaps are removed for any reason the main power switch should be in the OFF position.
NOTE
After theflap is completely rigged, adjust the rubber bumper (flap down) installed on the flap and
dividing rib. Turn the adjusting screw in or out, as required, to take out play or stop vibration
aileron
when the flap is in the up position. A distinct change in the sound of the flap motor near the
completion of the flap-up travel may indicate an excessive outward adjustment of the bumper.
g. Operate the flaps through full travel to ensure that the flaps contact the limit switches before they contact the
rubber bumper.
3
0124 27-50-00 Sep 30/03Page
RaYHleOll nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FLAP SYSTEM
FLAP SETTING
FLAP ACTUATOR
INDICATOR INDICATOR
o~--FLAP ACTUATOR
CE-748, CE-n2 THROUGH CE-816ANDAFTER
TRANSMITTER~ CE-B15; 01-149, D-~0097, CJ-150 AND AFTER
0-10120 THROUGH D-10178 D-10179 AND AFTER
E-llll, 5-1241 THROUGH E-1370 E-1371 THRU 5-2110 EXCEPT
TO ADJUST, LOOSEN MOUNTING E-1946 AND E-21D4’
EA-1 THRU EA-388 EXCEPT
BOLTS AND MOVE FORE AND AFT,
EA-320
OR ROTATE SLIGHTLY.
POSITION
SWITCHES
SWITCHES
DOWNLIMIT SWITCH
""C"’S
UPLIMIT
SWITCH
CE-816 AND AFTER
CJ-150 AND AFTER
CE-748, CE-n2 THROUGH CE-815, 01-149; D-lOlm AND ARER
0-10097, 010120 THROUGH D´•10178; 5-1371 AND AFTER
E-llll, E-1241 THROUGH E-13f0 FLAP LIMIT SWITCHES EA-1 AND AFTER
33-161-15
Flap System
Figure t
The flap position indicator gage is installed in the instrument panel. An adjustable flap position indicator transmitter
is installed on the flap actuator in the left wing just forward of the rear spar to coordinate gage reading with flap travel.
Adjust the flap travel limit switches to provide the correct up and down travel of the flaps. Refer to FLAP LIMIT
a.
c. Run the flaps up and check the indicator for up flaps reading.
ICAUTIONI
CAUTION
If the flap motor fails or if major overhaul is required for it to operate properly, the flap motor should
be replaced. No attempt should be made to overhaul the motor in the field.
b. Removethe sparcover.
c. Detach the clamp supporting the electrical wiring from the right-hand flap-shaft housing.
h. Pull the flexible drive shafts from the flap motor shafts and retainers.
i. Remove the flap motor attaching bolts and remove the flap motor.
Connect the LH and RH flexible flap drive shafts to the flap drive motor shaft as follows, refer to Figure 2 for I
component locations:
a. Install the outboard nut and washer as far as they will go onto the threaded portion of the flap shaft housing.
b. Start set screws (2) into retainer. Insert the retainer through the flap shaft mounting support and onto the motor I
shaft as far as it will go.
c. Align retainer keyway with key slot in flap motor drive shaft and tighten one set screw temporarily.
d. While inserting the flap shaft through the mounting support, install the inboard washer and nut.
5
27-50-00 Sep 30/03Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
e. Install the flap shaft through the retainer and into the motor drive shaft until the keyway is just past the key slot
in the retainer.
g. Ensure that the retainer is still installed on the motor shaft as far as it will go and rotate retainer 90".
h. Keep inboard pressure on the retainer and tighten both retainer set screws.
i. Secure the flap drive shaft to the mounting support by tightening the two nuts. Tighten inboard nut to that
I ensure
there is sufficient clearance between the outboard edge of the retainer and the cable housing to allow the
retainer to rotate without coming into contact with the cable housing. In threaded part of cable housing is not
long enough to install the two nuts and washer, use a die to add 5/8-24 UNEF threads until 0.88 inch thread
length is attained.
FORWARD
LOUTBOARD
TAINER (50-361131)
MOUNTING
SUPPORT
r---,
FLAP
SET SCREW
MOTOR
SET SCREW RETAINER
ii’
OUTBOARD
KEYWAY
NUT
SETSCREW OUTBOARD
WASHER
CAUTION i
Icnunou
Should the flap motor fail or should major overhaul be required for the flap motor to operate
properly, it should be replaced. No attempt should be made to overhaul the motor in the field.
a. Place the flap motor in position and secure with the flap motor attach bolts.
c. Install flexible flap drive shafts into the flap motor shafts, refer to CONNECTING FLEXIBLE FLAP DRIVE
SHAFT TO FLAP MOTOR SHAFT procedure. I
d. Attach the clamp that supports the electrical wiring from the right flap shaft housing.
e. Run the flaps through full travel, up and down, to check flap rigging.
a. Place the airplane on jacks and use the circuit breaker to retract the landing gear until the inboard doors are
open.
e. Rotatethecable retainer90".
g. Pull the flexible drive shaft from the flap motor shaft and retainer.
h. Disconnect all clamps securing the shaft housing to the wing structure.
i. Remove the dust cover in the rear section of the wheel well.
j. Disconnect the flap actuator from the wing flap and the wing spar section.
k. Pull the actuator and flexible shaft housing out of the wing.
a. Pull the flexible shaft and housing through the wing and attach the actuator to the wing flap and wing spar
section.
7
27-50-00
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Settheflapsinthe upposition.
c. Push the flexible shaft into the flap motor shaft and retainer.
d. Rotatethe retainer90".
e. While holding the retainer onto the motor shaft as far as possible, tighten the two set screws in each retainer.
g. Install the clamps securing the shaft housing to the wing structure.
h. Install the dust cover in the rear section of the wheel well.
i. Run the flaps through full travel, up and down, to check flap rigging.
j. Lower the landing gear and remove the airplane from the jacks.
a. Place the airplane on jacks and retract the landing gear until the inboard door is open (use the circuit breaker).
b. Remove the dust cover in the rear section of the wheel well to gain access to the actuator.
c. Lower the flaps and disconnect the actuator from the flap.
NOTE
To retain the original rigging of the flaps, mark the extension of the flap actuator before it is removed
e. Remove the snap ring and disconnect the flexible drive housing.
f. Remove the pivot bolts from the flap actuator mounting bracket and remove the flap actuator.
a. Place the flap actuator in position and secure it to the flap actuator mounting bracket with the pivot bolts.
b. Connect the flexible drive housing and install the snap ring.
NOTE
The flap position transmitter is on the left-hand flap actuator only.
d. Connect the flap actuator to the flaps in the extended position marked during removal.
8
Sep
30/Page 27-50-00 na4
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
e. Install the dust cover in the rear section of the wheel well.
g. Lower the landing gear and remove the airplane from the jacks.
a. Place the airplane on jacks and retract the landing gear (using the circuit breaker) until the inboard door is open.
b. Removethe frontseatassemblies.
d. Loosen the two set screws on the cable retainer (Ref. Figure 2). 1
e. Rotatethecable retainer90".
f. Remove the dust cover in the rear of the wheel well to gain access to the actuator.
g. Remove the two bolts holding the forward end of the actuator in place.
NOTE
The first clamp which secures the flex drive to the wing may have to be removed to allow more
h. Remove the snap ring holding the flex drive to the actuator
NOTE
Do not lose the spacers located under the flange of the flex drive.
i. To facilitate installation, note how far the shaft protrudes past the flange of the housing.
a. Lubricate the inner flex shaft with grease (11, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
b. Install the inner flex shaft into its housing (Ref. Figure 2). 1
c. Rotate the inner flex shaft until the key on the inner end of the shaft slides into place. (When this is
accomplished, the measurement noted in FLAP INNER SHAFT REMOVAL procedure Step i. should again be I
noted at this time.)
d. Push the flap shaft into the flap motor shaft and retainer.
e. Rotatethe retainer90".
f. While holding the retainer onto the motor shafts as far as possible, tighten the two set screws in the retainer.
9
nns 27-50-00 Sep 30/03Page
Raylheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
Be certain the spacers are in place in the actuator.
g. Install the flap shaft into the actuator and install the snap ring.
NOTE
A screwdriver may be used to make small adjustments to the screw of the actuator if the slot in the
actuator does not align with the key of the flex shaft.
h. Secure the actuator in place with the two bolts, washers, and nuts.
NOTE
The position transmitter will have to be installed on the left flap if it was removed. Install the clamp
on the shaft if it was removed.
j. Lower the landing gear and remove the airplane from the jacks.
NOTE
For correct adjustment and rigging of flap position
the transmitter refer to the FLAP POSITION
a. Remove the snap ring (2) to disconnect the flexible shaft (I)from the actuator (Ref. Figure 3).
b. Tap on the piston plug (11) to drive out the seal (17), spacers (3) and bearings (4).
I d. Check that the end play between the piston (6) and the actuator screw (5) does not exceed 0.012 inch under 25
to 50 pounds of force in both compression and tension at any of the following positions:
2. Withtheactuatorscrew 1/2extended.
e. If the 0.012 inch tolerance is exceeded, replace the piston and plug with a new one. If the tolerance is still
unacceptable replace the screw. Check the end play of the new piston and screw per the preceding step.
NOTE
Mark the piston and screw so that the same threads will be in contact when the piston and screw
are assembled.
NOTE
The following step should be accomplished only if the piston (6) or piston plug (1 1) is to be replaced
due to damage or wear.
h. Drill out the pin (14) and take the piston plug (11) out of the piston (6). ;1
NOTE
A replacement plug (11) may be supplied without the hole for the pin (14).
A replacement piston (6) may be supplied with an under sized hole for the pin (14), on one side of
the piston only.
a. If necessary drill a 0.185 to 0.189 inch diameter hole through the piston (6) and piston plug (1 1) for the pin (14).
Countersink the hole on both sides of the piston 100" to 0.250 inch.
b. Clean all parts with solvent (16, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and inspect for cracks, corrosion, distortion and excessive
wear. Refer to Chart 1 for tolerances and wear limits.
d. Coat the piston plug (11) and pin (14) with adhesive (68, Chart 1, 91-00-00) before assembly. I
e. Peen the pin (14) and file it flush with the piston (6).
i. Pack the bearings (4) with lubricating grease (50, Chart 1, 91-00-00) before inserting the piston (6) in the
housing (8).
g. Pour lubricating oil (51, Chart 1, 91-00-00) into the housing (8) until it is about two inches from being full. I
NOTE
When the screw and piston are assembled, be sure the same threads are in contact as when they
disassembled. Check the piston and assembly end play Step d. of FLAP
were
j. Install the remaining bearing (4) and seal (17). Seat these parts in the housing (8) with approximately 100 Ibs.
k. Install the spacers (3), shaft (1) and snap ring (2).
I. Tap the piston plug (11) with a rawhide mallet to seat the parts against the snap ring (2).
p~,
27-50-00 Sep 30/03Pagell
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
m. Check that the end play between the piston (6) and housing (8) is between 0.002 inch and 0.010 inch.
NOTE
The total end play between the piston (6) and actuator screw (5) plus the end play between the
housing (8) and piston (6) shall not exceed 0.022 inch. Subtract the piston-to-screw end play
(determined in Step d. of FLAP ACTUATOR DISASSEMBLY procedure) from the total to get the
piston-to-housing end play.
If the piston-to-housing end play is not within tolerance, the spacers (3) may be removed or installed
to correct the end play.
Spacers (3) are made up of 3 different spacers (35-251230-2, 35-251230-4 and 35-251230). A
maximum of one 35-251230-2, five 35-251230-4 and seven 35-251230 spacers may be used to
make up spacers (3).
n. Run the actuator in and out several times to assure proper operation in its full travel. Excess lubricant will be
forced out of the vent hole the first time the actuator is run all the way up.
CHART1
FLAP ACTUATOR MANUFACTURING TOLERANCES AND WEAR LIMITS
Piston (6)
Pivot Bolt Holes (7) Inside Diameter 0.3432 to 0.3442 0.3452
Housing (8)
Inside Barrel Dimension (9) Inside Diameter 0.875 to 0.878 0.879
Page
27-50-00 a24
Ray~heon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I. FLEXIBLE SHAFT
2. SNAP RING
3. SPACERS
4. BEARINGS
5. ACTUATOR SCREW
6. PISTON
8. HOUSING
12. O-RING
14. PTN
17. SEAL
17
16
10
15
12
14
13
C94EA2782829
Flap Actuator
Figure 3
A24
27-50-00
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
GUST LOCK AND DAMPER b. Push the control column lock pin through the
hole provided in the control column guide and into the
a. Rotate the control wheel to the right and move Always completely remove the control lock
the column forward so the hole in the bracket and the assembly before engine start, taxiing, and
column align to accept the pin. flight.
"END"
27-70-00
Page 1
May 9/80
CHAPTER
FUEL
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 28 FUEL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
28-00-00
Fuel System
Auxiliary Or Fuel Boost Pump (CE-748, CE-772 after, D-10097, D-10120 8 after, E-llll, E-1241 thru E-2110
except E-1946 8 E-2104) 1
Auxiliary Or Fuel Boost Pump (CJ-149 and after) 1
Auxiliary Or Fuel Boost Pump (EA-I thru EA-272 except EA-242) 1
Auxiliary Or Fuel Boost Pump (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and after, EA-242, EA-273 and after) 2
Fuel System Drains 2
28-1 E-OO
Goodyear 9
Uniroyal 9
Fuel Cell Repair 9
28-20-00
Auxiliary Fuel Pump Removal (CE-748, CE-772 and after, CJ-~49 and after, D-10097, D-10120 and after) 1
Auxiliary Fuel Pump installation (CE-748, CE-772 and after, CJ-´•149 and after, D-10097, D-~0120 and after) 1
Auxiliary Fuel Pump Removal (E-llll, E-1241 and after, EA-1 and after) 1
Auxiliary Fuel Pump Installation (E-llli, E-1241 and after, EA-1 and after) 1
Fuel Selector Valve Removal 2
Fuel Selector Valve Installation 2
Fuel Strainer Removal (Selector Valve) 2
28-40-00
"END"
28-CONTENTS
Page 2
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 28
CHAPTER
SECTION
SusJECT PACE DATE
"END"
5&EFFECTIVITY
Page 1
forward spar carry-through on the left side of the airplane. The Refer to the B36TC(EA-242, EA-273 and after) for
auxiliary fuel pump provides pressure for starting and emer- the description and operation.
28-00-00
Page 1
All Aug 29/85
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
hlAINTENAMCE IliANUAL
BEECHCRAFT Service Instructions No. 1093 is check for contaminants in the fuel; the other drain with its
placarded OFF-LOW-HI/LOW. Adapter, P/N 1078, is for draining the fuel system.
pump is controlled by three switches located in the cabin. One valve is accessible through a door inboard of the left wing
of the switches is located on the fuel control panel and pla- root.
carded AUX FUEL PUMP OFF; LOW, AUTO or HIILOW. In the
AUTO or HI/LOW position the pump is operating at all times. At
low power settings it operates at low boost, and at higher GENERAL MAINTENANCE PRACTICES
power settings (27 to 30 in.
Hg manifold
pressure) it operates
at high boost. The mode at which the boost pump operates in FUEL HANDLING PRACTICES
the AUTO or HIILOW position is determined by a switch actu-
atedby manifold pressure. Another switch is located in the When filling the airplane fuel tanks, always observe the
subpanel just to the left of the fuel control panel and placarded following:
EMERGENCY FUEL PUMP OFF ON. This switch will override
the other switches and actuate the
high pressure side of the a. Service the airplane fuel tanks with Grade 100LL
pump for emergency operation, such as with a failed engine (Blue) aviation gasoline, or Grade 100/130 (Green) aviation
driven fuel pump. The third switch´• is located forward of the gasoline (1, Chart 1, 91-00-00). If these fuels are not
instrument panel and plumbed into the manifold pressure available, Grade 115/145 (Purple) aviation gasoline (1,
gage line. This switch is actuated by manifold pressure, and Chart 1, 91-00-00) may be used.
closes between 29 to 30 in. Hg on increasing pressure (to b. Be certain the airplane is statically grounded to
actuate the high pressure side of the
pump), and opens be- the servicing unit.
tween 27 to 30 in. Hg on decreasing pressure (to return the c. Do not fill fuel cells near open flame or within 100
pump to low pressure operation). This switch actuates the high feet of any open energized electrical equipment capable of
pressure side of the pump, but only functions if the switch on producing sparks.
the fuel control panel is in the AUTO or HIILOW position.
28-00-00
Page 2
Aug 29/85
All
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUEL
MANIFOLD FILTER DRAIN E-1313
,JFUEL
V- AND AFTER EOUIPPED WITI1
FUEL I ALITOMATIC POWER CONTROL
TRANSDUCER
METERING
CONTROL
SUPPLY UNIT
RETURN I I i FUEL
FLOW
VENT
GAGE
DRAIN I I I INJECTION
PUMP
1L FUEL TRANSMITTER
FWD
FILLER I SEAL
CHECK
VALVE
t AT SERIALS E-1946. 61104. AND E´•2111
AND AFTER A DUAL PRESSURE AUXILIARY
PUMP IS INSTALLED
c´•1 nUx.
-I--´•´•1
PVMP 5
1~----11-1
I~
(Cp i
~I
it L.H FUEL TANK R.H FUEL. TANK
~SELECTOR
250AL.IZZGAL.VSPIBLEI 26CAL I~SGPIL.USARLE)
VALVE
40 GAL 137 GAL. USABLEI OPT 40cnL.137cnL.usnsLE,oPT
(STRAINER&
SUPPLY
RETURN
FUEL
VENT MANIFOLD
CONTROL
DRAIN
UNIT
FUEL TRANSMITTER
~´•j
11.~ PRESSURE
PRESSURE ~iCII´•l´•l
RELIEF
V~LVE
RELIEF VALVE ~´•)´•I
I
AUX.PUMP ii ii
!SELECTOR
VALVE
j i t (STRAINER
NVD &DRAIN) ODRAIN
3 DRAIN O !VENT
VALVE
R.H. FUEL TANK
L.H. FUEL TANK
25 GAL. (22 GAL. USABLE) SEAL (22 GAL. USABLE)
25 GAL.
VENT VENT
A36TC-2B(´•32
Fuel System
Figure 1
28-00-00
Page 3
All
Aug 29/85
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAIN~ENANCE MANUAL
ENGINE DRIVEN
FUEL OUANTITY FUEI. SUPPLY LINE 7 PUMP
SIGHT GAGE
28-00-00
Page 4
Aug 28/87 A12
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
c. Remove the filler caps to vent the gized electrical equipment capa-
system, ble of producing sparks.
"END"
28-00-00
Page 5
A12 Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. the
Remove outboard fuel cell The molded nipple fittings used on the
access and fuel
plate quanti ty sensor, fuel cell are lightweight fittings devel-
(The outboard fuel quantity sensor is oped for ease of installation in certain
installed only in the optional 80 gallon locations in the airplane. To get the best
fuel system). service from this type fitting, it is
necessary to exercise certain procedures
c. Remove the inboard access cover at the time of installation. The specific
and fuel quantity sensor. precautions other than the general care
in handling are as follows:
d. Disconnect all fuel and vent
plumbing. 1. Insert the flow tube into the
fitting until 3/8 inch or more of the tube
e. Unsnap the fuel cell and remove extends through the fitting.
it through the outboard fuel cell access
hole. 2: Locate the hose clamp on the
fabric-re7nforced area of the nipple; it
CAUTION should clear the end of the fitting by 1/4
inch.
Tape the edge of the access hole
to prevent damage to the fuel 3. Torque hose clamps as indi-
cell, cated in Chart 1 in this chapter. They
should be drawn up in one operation; if
FUEL CELL INSTALLATION (PRIOR TO retightening is n e c e s s a ry rel e a s e the
EA-273 EXCEPT EA-242) clamp completely and wait at least 15
minutes before retightening.
CAUTION
4. Use no sealing paste or gasket
Care should be taken when replac- compounds.
ing fuel cells to ensure that the
correct type fuel cell is used as 5. Ap_qly thin film of Simonize
a
28-10-00
Page 1
A1Z Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Install the reservoir after the fuel cell i. Close all access openings used for
is in the wing and before the access plate installing the reservoir.
is installed. Installation may be accom-
pi i shed as fol lows: CAUTION
a. Tape the reservoir flapper valve The parts of the non-baffled fuel
shut before installing the reservoir. cells the baffled fuel cells
and
are not be interchanged. When
to
b. Compress the reservoir (squeeze installing a new fuel cell, use
by hand) into a small circumference and only those items pe rtaining to
pass it through the fuel access ring into that particular cell being
the fuel cell, installed. The strainer for the
non-baffled cell with reservoir,
c. Release the reservoir allowing it for example, is considerably
to assume its original shape. longer that the one for baffled
cell and may damage the cell if
installed in the baffled cell.
28-10-00
Page 2
Aug 28/87 A?2
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUEL RETAINING
MODULE WITH SPECIAL
SPONGE CORE
FLAPPER
VALVE
-::::´•::_:::
TO
FUEL
LINE EXISTING
FUEL CELL
FUEL CELL
CLAM P
NIPPLE
36-28~-33
28-10-00
Page 2A
A12 Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SPiRIES
MAlNTENANCE MANUAL
a. Drain and purge the fuel cells. Before closing the zipper inspect the fuel cell for
b. Remove the outboard fuel cell access cover, fuel any foreign material. n the cell is not thoroughly
quantity sensor, and fuel sight gage and mounting plate. clean, it should be cleaned with a lint-free cloth
c. Remove the inboard access cover and fuel moistened in water, alcohol or kerosene. No
quantity sensor. other solvent should be used to clean the fuel
d. Remove the access cover under the fuel sump. cell.
e. Remove the safety wire and bolts holding the
sump in place.
f. Lower the sump assembly and disconnect the b. Close zipper in fuel cell dam.
hose from the fuel outlet. Remove the sump and hose
assembly.
g. Remove the clamp from the drain valve nipple.
h. Remove the drain valve. CA UTION
i. Remove the copilot’s seats as outlined
pilot’s and
in PILOT AND COPILOT SEAT REMOVAL(Chapter 25-10- The access cover and fuel quantity sensor may
00). have to be removed from the 14 gallon fuel cell
i. Remove the royalite covet over the main spat. so the small interconnect nipple may be held
k. Disconnect the fuel line from the fuel cell fitting, inplace during installation of the 40 gallon cell. A
i. Remove the two bolts holding the fuel cell to the light film of petrolatum tech (VV-P-236) 142,
wing root rib. Chart 1, 91-00-00) may be used as a lubricant
m; Remove the cotter pin from the flapper valve and on the nipples and under the clamps.
interconnect tube at the outboard end of the fuel cell.
n. loosen the bolt to the fiapper valve clamp, and
remove the fiapper valve, c. Install the fuel cell nipples on the interconnect
o. Remove the clamps from the two interconnect tubes. Torque the nipple clamps per Chart 1 in this chapter.
tubes.
p. Unsnap the fuel cell and remove it through the
outboard fuel cell access hole.
CAUTION
any debris before installing a replacement cell. in this chapter. The hose clamps should be
tightened in one operation; if retightening is
necessary, release the clamp completely and
a. Install the fuel cell through the outboard fuel cell wait at least 15 minutes before retightening.
access hole and snap it into place. 4. Use no sealing paste or gasket compounds.
2810-00
Page 3
A4 Jan 20182
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINtENANCE YANUAL
d. Install the flapper valve. g. Remove the nipple clamps from the interconnect
tubes, and remove the nipples from the tubes.
1. Install the cotter pin through the interconnect h. Unsnap the fuel cell and remove it through the
tube and flapper valve clamp, outboard fuel cell access hole.
2. Tighten the fiapper valve clamp.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Tape the edge of the access hole to prevent
Use new gaskets. damage to the fuel cell.
NOTE
FUEL CELL INSTALLATION (14 GaIIon)
On Uniroyal cells remove two screws to allow
installation of the bolts which secure the fuel cell
to the wing root rib. CAUTION
a&1000
page 4
Jan 20/82 44
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
28-10QO
Page 5
A4 Jan 20/82
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
klAINTENANCE MANUAL
INSPECTION OF FUEL CELL FLAPPER VAL~E full travel. There should be no binding and the element
should seat securely against the valve plate.
On airplanes that are equipped with baffled fuel cells, the 2. If the flapper element binds and/or does not
flapper valves (metal or phenolic) should be inspected seat properly, the upper rear side of the flapper element
periodically (Beech Aircraft recommends that the inspection may be binding against the valve plate.
be accomplished at each 100 hr. inspection) for freedom of 3. The flapper valve element may be relieved
operation and proper seating, from binding by filing a small radius on the upper rear side
of the element.
The inspection may be accomplished as follows:
e. Locate the flapper valve in the lower outboard k. Tighten the fuel cell access plate attaching bolts
section of the baffle and determine if the flapper valve is to a torque of 45 to 50 inch-pounds and safety wire.
metal or phenolic. i. Reinstall the rectangular access plate on the wing
f. If the flapper valve is metal, it should be inspected leading edge skin.
and repaired, if necessary, as follows:
1. Move the flapper element of the valve FUEL CELL LEAKAGE TEST
through its full travel. There should be no binding and the (Figure 2)
element should seat securely against the valve plate.
2. If the flapper element binds andlor does not i Rubber bladder type fuel cells may be bench tested for
seat properly, the flapper element arm could be bent. The leakage by sealing off all openings and inflating the empty
arm can be straightened by placing a screwdriver between cell to 1/4 psi with a mixture of shop air and ammonia gas,
the arm and the element and pressing the element toward then checking for visible indications of leakage on a cloth
the closed position, i saturated with phenolphthalein solution. To set up and
3. If after straightening the arm, the flapper t donduct the leakage test, proceed as follows:
element still binds and/or does not seat properly, the flapper
element should be removed and replaced with a new a. The following equipment is required and should
flapper element assembly. The flapper element assembly j be hooked up as indicated in the schematic in Figure 2.
may be replaced by removing the two attaching bolts from
the upper part of the flapper valve. The same attaching 1. Closure plates for the fuel cell openings.
parts should be used to install the new flapper element Such plates may be fabricated of aluminum sheet cut to a
assembly. The new flapper element assembly should be size sufficient to cover the cell openings. Drill holes in the
inspected after installation to determine that the assembly closure plate to match the hole pattern around the opening
did not receive damage during installation that could cause i in the fuel cell.
it to bind and/or not seat properly. 2. Rubber stoppers to plug the fitting openings
in the fuel cell. One of the stoppers should have a hole for
g. If the flapper valve is phenolic, it should be insertion of the plastic tubing used to connect the fuel cell
UI-10´•00
Rage 6
A4
Jan 20/02
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAIMENANCE MANUAL
LEAK PROOF
STOPPERS ,rrtn MOISTURE
COLLECTOR
REGULATO R
SET TO ’/4 PSI GLASS
TUBES
33´•281-30
glass or clear plastic tubing; frame and scale similar to the 9. The Pressure Test Baffle Restrainer (Figure
illustration shown. 3) is made of 3/4 inch thick plywood. Sand all edges to
4. A regulator that can be set to provide 1/4 psi remove sharp corners and/or splinters that may damage the
2810-00
Page f
All Jan 20/02
BEECHCRACT
BONANZA SERIES
MAlNtENANOE MANUAL
8.0" 20.0"
6.00(NP)
TYPi--
6.0" 15.0"
27.0"1~
LOCATE BAFFLE
RESTRAINER OVER
VELCRO TAPE AREA
PRIOR TO INFLATING
TO MAXIMUM 1/4 PSI.
83
INBD
~y/ /8~a
AFT
2&10´•00
Paga 8
Jan 20182 A4
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
interconnect the regulator, beakers, fuel cell, and Aerospace Corporation Fuel Tank Repair
manometer as indicated in Figure 2. Manual AP368 far further information on
"END"
2~1M10
Page 9
A4 Jan 20/82
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
e. Disconnect the fuel plumbing from the fuel auxiliary fuel pump.
selector valve.
e. Remove the four bolts securing the auxil-
f. Remove the bolts securing the fuel selec- ia’y fuel pump to the mounting bracket and remove
the fuel the auxiliary fuel pump. The pump is located in front
tor valve to the mounting bracket and remove
selector valve.
of the spar carry-through on thepilot’s side.
FUEL PUMP INS TALLA TION b. Reconnect the fuel plumbing to the auxil-
AUXILIARY
(CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER, CJ-149 AND iary fuel pump.
AFTER, D-10097, 0-10120 AND AFTER)
c. Replace the royalite cover over the main
b. Reconnect the fuel plumbing to the auxil- lined in PILOT AND COPILOT SEAT INSTALLATION
iary fuel pump. (25-10-00).
28-20-00
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
IL
selector valve.
\450
f.
valve to the
Remove the
mounting bracket
bolts securing
and remove
the selector
the selec- L
tor valve.
3e-2ao2
10"
FUEL SELECTOR VALVE INSTALLATION
Fuel Vent
e. Replace the handle on the fuel selector b. Remove the bottom of the selector valve
back the and pull the fuel strainer screen from the fuel selector
valve and screw the post light covers on
valve.
royalite truss cover.
s´• Install the seats as outlined in PILOT AND a. Install the screen in the
selector valve with the flange up.
bottom of
the(
COPILOT SEAT INSTALLATION (25-10-00).
28-20-00
Page 2
Oct 16/92 Ale
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FLANGE
FUEL STRAINER
SPRING
t ~3
UP GISI(ET
d~/"-’ C9201514
Fuel Strainer
Figure 2
28-20-00
Page 3
Ale Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
DO NOT LUBRICATE
FEMALE THREADS
STRAIGHT THREADS
NEVER ALLOW LUBRICANT
60-604-5
TO CONTACT THIS SURFACE
FUEL STRAINER REMOVAL (WING FUEL a. Remove the access plate for each wing
CELLS) fuel cell from the lower wing surface.
a. Drain and purge the fuel system. b. Disconnect the fuel cell vent line from the
fuel cell.
b. Remove the finger strainer access cover
located between the lower portion of the wing and c. Apply air pressure to the fuel cell end of
fuselage. the vent line.
c. Disconnect the fuel line from the connector d. Alternately plug each vent opening to
assembly, assure passing through all branches of the
that air is
vent system for the cell. Continue to blow air through
d. Loosen the fuel cellnipple clamp; discon- each branch until any obstructions have been
nect the finger strainer and slide the fuel finger removed.
strainer from the fuel cell.
e. Remove the siphon break check valve and
FUEL STRAINER INS TALLA TION (WING blow air through the siphon break line from the check
FUEL CELLS) valve end, then reinstall the valve.
a. Install the connector assembly in the fuel f. Reconnect the fuel cell vent line to the fuel
cell and tighten the nipple clamp, cell.
b. Connect the fuel line to the connector g. Reinstall the access plate below each fuel
assembly. cell.
c. Install the access cover on the airplane. h. Visually check each fuel cell filler cap for
looseness or deterioration of the seal which could
INSPECTION OF FUEL CELL VENT LINES cause leakage. If seals are deteriorated or damaged
AND FUEL FILLER CAPS in any way, they should be replaced.
(Figure 1)
i. Check the extended vent to ascertain that
The following procedure is recommended for the vent extends a minimum of 1.75 inches below the
inspection of fuel tank vent lines and filler caps: lower wing skin surface. The vent tube should be
28-20-00
Page 4
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
scarfed at a 450 angle on the forward side and should FLARIFD FITTINGS
be canted forward 100 from perpendicular to the skin. (Figure 3)
"END"
28-20-00
Page 5
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
28-40-00
Page 1
A12 Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
28-40-00
Page 2
Aug 28/87 A12
CHAPTER
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
GENERAL 30-00-00
Description and Operation .......1
PROPELLERS 30-60-00
Description and Operation ..................1
Electric Propeller Deicing ........1
Troubleshooting ........1
Maintenance Practices ........5
"END"
30-CONTENTS
Page 1
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 30
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
30-EFFECflYITY
Page 1
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINtENANCE MANUAL
GENERAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION the airplane electrical system for protecting the pitot
opening from becoming clogged with ice.
The airplane is equipped with a variety of ice and rain
protection systems that can be utilized during operation An optional weather radar system is available for the
under inclement weather conditions. Air from the cabin Bonanza series airplanes starting at serials GO-878 and
heating system prevents the windshield from fogging. The after, D-10284 and after, E-1534, E-1537 and after, and
propellers are protected against icing by optional EA-11 and after. The indicator is located in the radio
electrothermal boots oneach blade that, when activated, section of the instrument panel and the antenna is located
automatically cycleto aid in dispersing the formation of ice. in the outboard leading edge of the right wing. (See 34-40-
The pitot mast contains a heating element connected to 00.)
"END"
30-00-00
Page 1
Oct 10180
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
heated boot for each propeller blade. When the on-oh ammeter test outlined in step "a." of the 50-hour inspection
switch is turned ON, the ammeter (near the center of the (Chapter 5), and the HEAT TEST described in this chapter.
instrument panel) registers the amount of current (Bbladed, A reading of two-thirds the nonnal amount of current (or
8-12 amps; 3bladed, 14-18 amps) passing through the one-half on two-bladed props) is an indication that one of
system. If the current rises beyond the switch limit, an the circuits is open between the slip ring assembly and
breaker will cut off the power to the timer.
integral circuit deicer heater. If the ammeter registers excess current, the
The current flows from the timer (forward of instrument power lead is shorted to ground. It is possible that the
panel) to the brush assembly (mounted in front of the excess current has welded the timer contacts in one phase.
engine case) and is conducted by the brush assembly to the Under these circumstances, the timer will either feed current
slip rings installed on the spinner backing plate. At serials D- to the welded contacts continuously, or not cycle. If the
10404 and after, CE-1024 and after, E-2069 and after, and former is true, the heat test wil\ show heating throughout the
EA-378 and after, the slip rings became part of an assembly two phases. Unless the grounded power lead is located and
attached between the engine hub and the propeller. The slip corrected, any new timer that is installed may suffer the
rings distribute current to the deicer boots on the propeller same internal damage during the first use of the system. In
blades. Heat from the boots reduces the grip of the ice, general, for most effective use of the troubleshooting chart,
which is then removed by the centrifugal effect of propeller all of the "indication" entries should be read to locate that
rotation and by the blast of the airstream. The timer cycles which matches conditions of the particular system being
power to the heating element on each blade. It takes 3 checked. The numbered "probable cause" and "remarks"
minutes for the timer to complete a cycle of 90 seconds on, then indicate the proper sequence of checks. It should be
90 seconds off. Whenever the system is turned on, the noted, however, that such numbers are assigned with
ammeter in the instrument panel or subpanel and registers respect to the approximate usefulness of the check rather
the proper amerage, or zero amperage, depending on the than to the most likely sequence of occurance.
30-60-00
Page 1
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i. Ammeter shows zero current. a. Switch circuit breaker tripped. a. Locate and correct short before resetting
(8oth phases of the 3 minute circuit breaker by turning switch OFF,
cycle.) then ON.
d. Ammeter faulty. (If some or all d. Test for voltage up to and out of ammeter.
Deicers heat with ammeter at If low or zero output but proper input,
zero, replace ammeter.) replace ammeter. If no voltage to
ammeter, locate and fix open between
switch and ammeter.
2. Ammeter shows normal a. Open in Deicer or slip ring a. Disconnect Deicer straps to check heater
current part of cycle, low assembly. resistance. If resistance is within specified
current rest of cycle, limits, locate and fix open in slip ring
leads. If not, replace Deicer with open
circuit.
3060-00
Page 2
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINtENANCE MANUAL
3. Ammeter shows low current. a. Airplane voltage low, a. Check bus voltage.
5. Ammeter does not "flick" a. Timer ground open, a. Disconnect harness at timer and check
each 90 seconds, with ohmmeter from pin G tot harness) to
ground. If no circuit, refer to Bonanza
Wiring Diagram Manual P/N 35-590012-9.
5. Ammeter flicks between 90 a. Loose connection between a. If trouble occurs over entire cycle, trace
second phase periods. airplane power supply and wiring from power source to timer input to
timer input, locate and tighten loose connection.
b. Loose or poor connection b. Check for rough or dirty slip rings causing
timer to Deicers. brush to "skip." If not this, trace circuits to
locate and fix loose or poor connection.
3060-00
Page 3
May 9/80
BEECHORAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAIWTENANCE MANUAL
7. Radio noise or interference a. Blushes "arcing." a. Check brush alignment as in step "h" of
with Deicers on. 100-hour inspection (Chapter 5). Look for
rough or dirty slip rings. If this is the
cause, clean, machine or replace slip ring
assembly. Check for slip ring alignment.
8. Rapid brush wear or frequent a. Brush block out of alignment. a. Check brush alignment as in step "h." of
3060-00
Page 4
A6
Oct7183
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
PROPELLERS MAINtENANCE PRACTICES h. Remove the remaining adhesive from the boot
and propeller blade with toluol or methyl ethyl ketone (19 or
PROPELLER DEICEfl BOOT REMOVAL 31, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
CAUTION
sufficiently to grasp it with vise grip pliers or a similar tool. the area thoroughly with methyl ethyl ketone or toluol, (31 or
g. Apply a slow, -steady pull on the boot to pull it off 19, Chart i, 91-00-00). For final cleaning, wipe the solvent
the propeller surface while continuing to use the solvent to off quickly with a clean, dry, lint-free cloth to avoid leaving a
soften the adhesive. film.
3060-00
Page5
A6 Oct7/83
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
OEICERBOOT
-:--:::::I
I
1/2"
CAU770N NOTE
If the blade is painted with laquer remove all When solvent is used to soften cement, methyl
paint within the masked off area. If the blade is ethyl ketone (MEK) provides approximately 10
painted with polyurethane, lightly sand within seconds time for de-icer application, while
the masked off area, using 400 grit sand paper. Toluol will provide approximately 40 seconds
working time.
CAUT/ON
g. Position the deicer boot on the propeller, starting
The metal and rubber parts must be thoroughly 1 inch from the blade retaining clamp, making sure the lead
clean to assure maximum adhesion. strap is in position to clamp to the blade retaining clamp.
Moisten the cement lightly with methyl ethyl ketone or toluol
(31 or 19, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and tack the boot center line to
the blade leading edge. If the center line of the boot
deviates from the blade leading edge, pull up with a quick
d. Moisten a clean cloth with methyl ethyl ketone or motion and replace properly. Roll firmly along the center line
toluol (31 or 19, Chart i, 91-00-00) and clean the unglazed with a rubber roller (see Figure 2).
surface of the deicer boot and both sides of the rubber
retainer strap if applicable, changing the cloth frequently to
avoid contamination of the clean area. CAUTION
a. Thoroughly mix EC-1403 cement (EC 1300L
cement may also be used) and apply one even brush coat Never use a metal or wooden roller for this
to thepropeller blade and to the unglazed back side of the purpose, for they would damage the heating
boot. Allow the cement to dry for at least one hour at 400F or elements in the deicer boot.
above when the relative humidity is less than 75%, or two
hours if the humidity is between 75% and 90%. Do not apply
the cement if the relative humidity is higher than 90% or the
temperature is below 50"F.
f. After
allowing sufficient drying time, apply a
second brush coat of cement to the propeller and to the
unglated surface of the deicer boot. Apply cement to the h. Gradually tilting the roller, work the boot carefully
lead strap as necessary to cement the strap to the propeller, over each side of the blade contour. Avoid trapping air
up to the hub. Allow the cement to dry. pockets under the boot (see Figure 3).
30-60-00
pages
Oct 7/83 A6
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
A--A
i jc.50" TYPICAL
OVERLAP EDGE OF BOOT AND
~c-- .129’
STRAP WITH SEALANT BY ~a"
AS SHOWN.
SEALER
;I ~------DE-ICE BOOT
.375+ .125
RETAINER STRAP
36-251-8
30-60-00
Page 7
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE CAUT1ON
The rubber retainer strap should wrap around After deicer boot installation allow at least 12
the blade shank over the inboard 1/4 inch of hours for the 1300L or EC-1403 cement to dry
the deice boot on B.F. Goodrich or 1/2 inch on before starting the engine, and 12 hours more
McCauley installations, before energizing the deicers.
acr2s~´•lo
60251´•8
30-60-00
Pager
Oct 7/83 A6
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
assembly.
SLIP RING Assv b. Remove the screws, nuts, and washers securing
the modular brush assembly to it’s mounting bracket.
c. Remove the assembly retaining screws and
I BRUSH MaDULE REPLACEIWI~NT(B.F. Good~ch) entire brush face contacts the copper ring. If the brushes do
not align with the slip rings throughout the entire 360
The modular brush assembly is made up of two modules, degrees of slip ring rotation, install shims (P/N 151157)
each consisting of a plastic housing with an integral brush between the brush module spacer and the mounting bracket
and spring. These modular units are stacked with a spacer until the brushes are properly aligned with the approximate
held together by screws to produce the modular brush center of the slip ring.
When a brush wears only to where 3/8 inch of brush brush modules and the slip ring surface. To prevent damage
material remains, the module containing the brush should to the brushes, the modular brush assembly should be
be replaced. When 1/4 inch of brush remains, the brush angled so that the brushes contact the slip rings at an angle
module MUST be replaced. of approximately two degrees from perpendicular, as
measured toward the direction of slip ring rotation as shown
in Figure 5.
NOTE j. Reconnect the "B", and "C" terminals of the
airplane system wire harness to the same designated
During measurement only 1116 inch of brush terminals of the modular brush assembly. Ensure that the
should from the brush module, this
protrude adjacent ring terminals are not touching.
being the normal protrusion when the brush is
installed on the airplane.
DEICER ’TIMER CHECK
Brush wear is determined by inserting a pin into a hole in Experience in the field has indicated that often the timer is
the back of the brush module. On all modules having considered defective when the source of the trouble lies
brushes with rods, the brush module should be replaced elsewhere. For this reason, the following test should be
when the pin can be inserted 15/64 inch and MUST be performed before the timer is removed as defective:
replaced when the pin can be inserted 19/64 inch. On the
rodless brushes, the module should be replaced when the a. With the wiring harness disconnected at the timer,
and the deicer switch in the ON position, check the voltage
pin can be inserted 1-5/64 inches and MUST be replaced
when the pin can be inserted 1 9/64 inches. To replace the from pin B of the harness plug to ground. If no voltage is
brushes, proceed as follows: present, the timer is NOT at fault; however, if system
30-60-00
Page9
Oc17/83
A6
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I
check the DC voltage to ground from pin C or pin D on
serials D-10404 and after, CE-1024’and after, E-2069 and To check for a short circuit, or high resistance in the brush
after, and EA-378 and after; it should indicate bus voltage module, measure the resistance from the face of the brush
for 90 seconds, zero volts for 90 seconds, bus voltage 90 to its terminal studs or receptacle pin with a low range
continuity check should be performed on the wiring from the made to correct the slip ring wobble by varying the torque
timer to the brush module holder and the propeller deicer on the attachment bolts. Using the dial indicator to follow the
terminal connections. points of maximum deviation, adjust the slip ring assembly
to the prescribed run-out limits by varying the torque of the
mounting bolts as required within a range of 40 to 100 inch-
pounds.
b. If more than 0.012 inch of adjustment is required
CAUTION for alignment, the slip ring assembly may be shimmed to
within the prescribed limits for true running by the addition of
While following the instructions of the "HEAT AN960C416L washers on the mounting bolts between the
TEST" section, move the propeller back and slip ring assembly and the spinner bulkhead. If necessary,
forth to prevent arcing between the brushes and fabricate thinner shims to the AN960 size. Again the torque
slip ring. may be varied as in step "a".
30-60-00
page 10
Oct7183 A6
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TORQUE TO 20 TO 30 IN-LB
NOTE
TORQUE 12-14 IN-LB
AN980-PD10L WASHER
(USE AS REQUIRED FOR If, in machining, the solder or brats connection
.01 CORRECT SPACING) on the underside of the slip ring is exposed,
TORQUE 8 TO 10 IN-LB
replacement of the slip ring assembly will be
AIRCRAFT WIRING necessary.
NOTE a. Insert a thin stiff feeler gage into the slot on the
side of the brush block past the back of the brushes.
The above adjustments may affect the b. Gently push the brushes into the brush block.
clearance between the brush module and slip c. If any brush has .094 inch brush orless remaining
rings; consequently, after slip ring alignment, a outside the brush block, that brush assembly needs
check should be made to ascertain that a replaced.
distance of from 1/32 to 3/32 inch is maintained
between the brush module and slip ring surface
(see Figure 5). BRUSH REPLACEMENT (McCauleyl
(Figure 7)
I SLIP RING MACHINING (B.F. Goodrich)
a. Remove the brush block from the engine as
Slip rings which have roughened or damaged surfaces, but indicated in BRUSH BLOCK REMOVAL.
which are structurally sound, can be machined and restored b. Remove the two screws in the back of the brush
3060-00
Page 11
A6 Oct 7183
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERLS
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
.094 1 NCH
I a
a
FEELER GAGE
BRUSH BLOCK
DI SASSE MBLY
iia 36-251r6
3060-00
Page 12
Oct 7/33
As
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Disconnect the lead wires from the terminal strip. Structurally sound slip rings with damaged surfaces may be
b. Disconnect the brush block mounting screws and machined to restore sen/iceability.
remove the brush block from the engine.
a. Clean the slip ring assembly with methyl ethyl
ketone before machining.
BRUSH BLOCK INSTALL4 TION (McCauleyl b. Check the assembly mounting surface flatness. It
(Figure 8) must be flat within .005 inch overall.
c. Locate the assembly concentrically in a lathe so
a. Install the brush block on the engine with the two that there is no more than .002 inch wobble or run-out over
screws, but do not tighten the screws. 360" of rotation. The assembly should be fixed in the lathe in
b. Add or remove shims (see Figure 6) to the brush the same manner as it was attached to the propeller
block mounting screws until each entire brush is in contact assembly. This will ensure that run-out held while machining
with it’s slip ring throughout 360~ of rotation, the assembly will be transferred when it is mounted on the
c. Position the brush block on the mounting bracket propeller.
so that the distance between the brush block and the face of d. Take a light cut for a smooth finish (25 to 20 micro
the slip rings is .064 .015 inch. inches).
d. Tighten the screws.
Wear or slight wobble may be removed by machining, greater. If machine vibration is noticed,it must
be corrected. Machine vibration which is not
corrected will result in a chattered finish. Feed
necessitate replacement or machining unless e. Ensure that the face surface of the slip rings are
rapid brush wear is encountered. When a new parallel and flat within .008 overall.
brush assembly is installed on slip rings with f. The slip ring holder face and the insulation around
normal wear, the brushes will rapidly seat and between the slip rings must be undercut to .050 inch to
withoutdegradation of operation or service life. .060 inch (Figure 8).
30-60-00
Page 13
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
rIZ-: 050
.060
AFTER MACHINING OF SLIP RING FACES
1:3
.435
CAljTION
WHEN UNDERCUTTING INSULATION BETWEEN RINGS,
DO NOT CUT INSIDE AND OUTSIDE DIAMETERS OF
SLIP RINGS MORE THAN .003" PAST THE ORIGINAL
UNDERCUT DIAMETERS.
36-251-7
"END"
30´•60-00
Page 14
Oct7/63 A6
C H A PT E R
LANDING GEAR
Raylheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 32 1
LANDING GEAR
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
32-00-00
32-1 0-00
..........................................................................1
Cleaning... .,,.....,,,..,5
Repairs,
Main Landing Gear Assembly. .,..,7
32-20-00
Cleaning, .................................................4
Repairs......
Nose Gear Assembly ........1
Nose Gear Shimmy Damper Servicing .................12
Nose Gear Shimmy Damper Removal .................12
Nose Gear Shimmy Damper Instaliation ................12
1
~4 32-CONTENTS Sep 30/03Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
NoseGearShimmy DamperOverhaul 12
NoseGearShimmy DamperDisassembly 13
Cleaning
Replacement Parts 14
Repairs
Nose GearShimmy DamperAssembly. 17
Nose Gear Retract Brace Assembly Check (E-1103 and After; E-l thru E-1102 With Kit
35-4012-1 Installed .........19
32-30-00
Lub~cation.............................................................................1
Manual Landing Gear ExtensionSystem. 1
RetractActuator Disassembly 10
Check of Landing Gear Safety System With Safety Switch in Test Position 14
32-40-00
Page
peS2
30/03 32-CONTENTS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
Tires ..........1
Brake Assembly
Shuttle Valve
Brake Wear and Wear Limits ......1
Gravity Bleeding
Pressure Pot Bleeding
Electric Bleeding
32-50-00
3
ns 32-CONTENTS Sep
30/03Page
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJECT PAGE
32-60-00
Main Gear
NoseGear.............................................................. 1
CE-1300, CE-1302 thru CE-1306; CJ-149 thru CJ-179; D-10097, D-10120 and After; E-llll, E-1241
thru E-2110, except E-1946 and E-2104; EA-1 thru EA-388, except EA-320). 1
Engine-Compartment-Located Landing Gear Warning Switch Adjustment (CE-1301, CE-1307 and After;
CJ-180 and After).
Pedestal-Located Landing Gear Warning Switch Adjustment (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320,
Page
peS4
30/03 32-CONTENTS
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
A24 32-LOEPPagel
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
jacks, the landing gear motor will run until the landing
wheel well, and a microswitch adjacent to the existing
throttle position warning switch in the engine compart-
gear is fully retracted and the uplimit switch is actu-
me"t.
ated, breaking the circuit to the landing gear motor.
When the landing gear position switch is placed in the Each pressure switch is connected into the pitot and
DOWN position, the circuit is completed to the down- static system. The pressure switch in the gear-up cir-
windings of the landing gear motor, and the motor will cult is actuated by the pressure differential that exists
operate until the landinggear has been fully extended between the pitot and static air system and will close
and the downlimit switch actuated, breaking the circuit with increasing pressure at approximately 90 mph
to the landing gear motor. To prevent overtravel of the IAS.
gear, the dynamic brake relay simultaneously breaks When an air speed of 90 mph IAS has been attained
the power to the motor and makes a complete circuit
with the landing gear position switch in the UP posi-
through the armature and the opposite field winding,
tion, the pressure switch in the gear-up circuit closes
The motor then acts as a generator and the resulting
and actuates relay mounted on the right-hand instru-
a
electrical load on the armature stops the gear almost
ment panel support, thus completing the circuit and
instantly.
retracting the landing gear. A diode locks the relay in
the closed position until the retraction cycle is com-
CAUTION pleted. For the preceding to occur, the microswitch in
the engine compartment must also be in the open
Do not change the of the control
position position. This microswitch is actuated by the throttle
switch to the direction of the
reverse control when the throttle is advanced sufficiently for
landing gear while the gear is in transit the manifold pressure gage to register approximately
as this could cause damage to the 18 inches Hg. Conversely, if the throttle is retarded
retract mechanism. beyond the position corresponding to approximately
32-00-00
Page 1
A17 Nov 16/94
~eechcraR
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL.
extended.
Downlimit switch. b. Replace switch-
actuatoris switch out of adjustment, a. Readjust limit switch.
internal
b. Umit switch is inoperative. b. Replace switch.
c. Dynamic brake is not working. c.Check for inoperative dynamic
brake relay or high resistence in
circuit,
5. Warning horn inoperative or a. Open or groundedcircuit. a. Check continuity.
motor.
7. Landing gear will not retract or a. Bad electrical connection. a. Run a continuity check from
extend. circuit breaker to switch.
32-00-00
Page 2
Nov 16/94 A17
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TROUBLESHOOTING
LANDING GEAR ELECTRICAL SYSTEM (Continued)
INDICATION PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
b. Landing gear motor not b. Check motor ground.
rounded.
c. Defective control circuit. c. Check items 1 thr 3.
d. Landing gear motor inoperative. d. Check brushes overhaul or
replace.
32-00-00
Page 3
the main wheel bearings and grease fittings. Refer to Chart 2, LUBRICATION SCHEDULE, in Chapter
20-00.Lubricate 12-
When removing the landing gear, take care to preserve the original adjustments at the rod-end fittings to facilitate
reassembly.
a. With the airplane on jacks, retract the landing gear until the inboard door is in the fully open position.
b. Disconnect the outboard landing gear door from the landing gear strut.
c. Disconnect the inboard landing gear door actuating rod at the forward door hinge.
d. Unsnap the canvas cover and disconnect the uplock assembly from the strut.
e. Open the brake cylinder bleed ports and pump all fluid from the system.
f. Disconnect the hydraulic lines where the flexible hose couples to the tubing on the landing gear.
i. Remove the access door in the lower surface of the wing leading edge for access to the forward hinge bolt
retaining nut and remove the nut. The rear strut brace hinge bolt is accessible by lowering the flap.
j. Remove the brace hinge bolts and associated hardware which attach the main gear to the front and rear spars.
k. Lower the main gear assembly from the airplane, being careful not to bend the skin at the edge of the wheel well.
a. Carefully position the main landing gear assembly in place against the front and rear spars.
b. Align the hinge bolt holes and install the bushings, bolts, washers and nuts. Torque each nut to 250 to 690
in.-lbs. install new cotter pins. I
NOTE
Install 100951-S-016-XF or 100951-S-032-XF washers as required between the landing gear and
the front and spars to maintain a maximum total clearance of 0.016 inch. The
rear placement of
these washers at the front or rear may help align the lift leg.
32-10-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
Overtightening the nut on the bolt that connects the lift leg to the shock strut can bind the strut or
g. Connect the uplock assembly to the strut and snap the canvas cover in place.
pcnunoN
CAUTION I
The uplock cable attach bolt must be installed with the head of the bolt pointing aft. This is to avoid
interference between the bolt and the stringer in the main gear wheel well as the landing gear is
retracted.
h. Connect the inboard landing gear door actuating rod to the forward door hinge.
i. Install the outboard landing gear door to the landing gear strut.
CAUTION I
[CAUTION
Excessive operation of the landing gear motor without proper cooling may cause damage to the
landing gear motor. Allow a short cooling time after each extension and retraction cycle.
k. Operate the landing gear and check for proper rigging of the uplock and doors.
NOTE
Refer to the OVERHAUL AND REPLACEMENT SCHEDULE in Chapter 5-10-00 for time limits and
maintenance checks of the main landing gear.
Experience in the field indicates the points of greatest wear on the main landing gear are the upper and lower
bearings in the cylinder assembly. The wear caused on the bearings during takeoff, landing and taxiing tend to result
in an oversized condition. The oversized condition of the upper bearing in the cylinder assembly will result in leakage
of hydraulic fluid through the upper bearing and O-ring. This will eventually cause fluid to seep down through the felt
pad and out the lower bearing.
When replacement of the scraper ring and all O-rings in the cylinder assembly fails to stop leaks, the oversized
condition of the bearings is probable. In such instances the landing gear should be overhauled. The following
information will aid in determining the extent of landing gear wear and whether it is possible to overhaul or necessary
to replace critical landing gear components.
2
Sep 30/Page 32-1 0-00
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
/WARNINO
ARNING I
Do not begin any disassembly of the main landing gear until all air pressure has been
released.
a. Place the landing gear in a vertical position to prevent hydraulic fluid from spilling.
b. Release the air pressure from the cylinder assembly (9) by depressing the valve core (2) (Ref. Figure 1). I
c. To prevent damage, remove all hydraulic plumbing, safety switch components, and clamps.
d. Perform the MAIN WHEEL AND BRAKE ASSEMBLY REMOVAL procedure in Chapter 32-40-00. 1
e. Remove the retaining ring (5) and retract the lower shock assembly (35) to push the orifice tube (6) out of the
cylinder assembly (9).
g. Remove the air valve assembly (3), O-ring (4), piston ring (8) and O-ring (7) from the orifice tube (6).
IWARNIN(I
WARNING I
Do not disconnect the torque knees (23 and 34) without first deflating the cylinder assembly
The torque knees provide the extension stop for the lower shock assembly, and when
(9).
disconnected, the shock assembly is free to slide out of the cylinder assembly (9).
h. Remove the nut, washers, and bolt (32) connecting the upper torque knee (23) to the lower torque knee (34).
i. Remove the upper and lower torque knees (23 and 34) by removing the upper and lower torque knee pins (21
and31), retaining pins and cotter pins.
j. Slide the lower shock assembly (35) out of the cylinder assembly (9).
CAUTION I
I causlon
The scraper seal (27) may become sharp during normal operation of the gear; care should be
exercised to avoid possible injury when removing the scraper seal.
k. Remove the scraper seal (27), felt pad (26), O-ring and retainer rings (17). The O-ring is located between two
retainers within the cylinder assembly (9). Removal of the O-ring may be simplified by using a hook,
manufactured from music wire (Ref. Figure 2). 1
I. Disconnect the columns (15) and brace (11) from the cylinder assembly (9) and from each other. Remove
bushings (12) from the brace (11).
3
32-1 0-00 Sep 30/03Page
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
2 .19. POTS.GNIRAEB
20.
21.
23.
UPPER TORQUE KNEE BORE
UPPER TOROUE KNEE PIN
13~
1417
14 18
14
28
15
19
jh
33. LOWER TOROUE KNEE BORE
34. LOWER TOR~UE KNEE 34
35. LOWER SHOCK ASSEMBLY 23 22
36. BRAZED RETAINING BOLT
37. AXLE
25\-~ 1 29
30
DETAIL A
36
37
35 31
OETAIL B cp~rcosszosa c
.Obn MUSIC
WIil~-I ~I3/32
B
14
----t( 5/ 6
DOWEL ROD
BRAZED
BEARING
O-RING
CYLINDER
DOWEL ROD
C94TC058219d C
a. Clean all parts with solvent (16, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Remove all excess solvent and wipe dry after cleaning.
b. Immerse all internal parts in clean hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00) prior to assembly.
Wear which is greater than the allowable wear tolerances. (Ref. Chart 1). I
Damage which cannot be corrected or repaired.
Screws that are severely damaged or have stripped, severely worn or scored threads.
b. Replace the following parts when main landing gear is overhauled (Ref. Figure 1): I
Cotter pins
5
A24 32-10-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
DU Bushings (12)
I Bushing (13)
Safety Wire
c. Replace the following parts on condition when main landing gear is overhauled:
Grease Fittings
Grommets
Huck Bolt and Collar (Replace if removed from the upper bearing (16).)
Hydraulic Hoses
Hydraulic Tubing
Wiring
I REPAIRS
a. Visually inspect castings for cracks and pitting; and finished surfaces for scoring, pitting, nicks, cracks, distortion
and wear. Refer to Chart 1 for tolerances to aid in determining the extent of wear. Replace all defective and
excessively worn parts.
b. If fluid leaks have been observed on top of the air valve assembly (3), check the small O-ring (4) of the valve;
then look for defects in the valve (Ref. Figure 1).
c. If the leak is from the junction of the orifice tube assembly (6) with the cylinder assembly (9) walls, check the
O-ring (7) in the orifice tube (6).
Slight scoring of shafts may be corrected by lapping carefully with a flat oil stone.
6
Sep 30/ Page 32-1 0-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
Do not exceed 10% of the component material thickness when removing nicks, burrs and
scratches.
Those parts that are scratched or have worn plating may be stripped and replated with the same type of
plating as that removed or be replaced with new parts.
NOTE
Corrosion damage requires inspection to determine the depth of penetration and the
cross-sectional area change. The damaged area must be thoroughly cleaned and the corrosion
Remove corrosion if applicable, and apply corrosion prevention materials as necessary per MIL-C-5541 or
When evidence of damage exists to steel parts, magnetic particle inspect per MIL-STD-1949.
NOTE
Do not remove paint or primer from the area to be fluorescent or dye penetrant inspected per MIL-
STD-6866. If the finish absorbs the penetrant so that bleed out prevents satisfactory inspection or
if a new finish has not cured for at least 30 days, contact the Technical Support Department of
Raytheon Aircraft Company, P.O. Box 85, Wichita, KS 67201.
When evidence of damage exists to metal parts other than steel, fluorescent penetrant inspect per
MIL-STD-6866, Type I.
NOTE
Prior to assembly, immerse all internal parts (except felt pad (26)) in hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1,
91-00-00).
a. Install the O-ring and retainer rings (17) in the upper bearing (16) of the cylinder assembly (9). Two dowel rods
may be used to work O-ring and retainers into position (Ref. Figure 1). I
7
~24 32-1 0-00 Sep 30/03Page
Raylheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Soak the felt pad (26) in SAE 1 0W30 oil and install in the cylinder (9) between the upper and lower bearings (16
and 19).
c. Slide the scraper seal (27) over the piston (28) and insert the lower shock assembly (35) into the cylinder (9).
Work the scraper seal (27) into the lower end of the cylinder assembly (9) until seated.
d. Install upper torque knee (23) to the cylinder assembly (9) and lower torque knee (34) to the lower shock as-
sembly (35) using torque knee pins (21 and 31), retaining pins and cotter pins. Install stop (22) to the upper
torque knee pin (21). Insert the center torque knee bushing (24) and connect the torque knees (23 and 34) using
bolt, washers, nut (32).
f. Install new bushings (12) into brace (11). Install brace (11) onto the cylinder assembly (9) with bolt, connector
and nut (10). Install forward and aft columns (15) to the brace (1 1 and cylinder assembly (9) using main landing
gear brace bolts (14).
g. Raise and block lower shock assembly (35) 1/4 inch from the fully compressed position and fill cylinder
assembly hydraulic
with fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00) until the top of piston (28) is covered (approximately 2 pints
of hydraulic fluid).
h. Install O-ring (4), valve core (2) and valve assembly (3) into orifice tube (6). Assemble the O-ring (7) and piston
ring (8) to orifice tube and install into cylinder assembly (9). Slowly extend lower shock assembly (35) allowing
the suction to pull orifice tube down into the cylinder assembly (9), then install retainer ring (5).
I wnR#IN~I
WARNING
As with all operations involving equipment under high pressure, exercise caution when
performing the leak test; avoid the areas directly above and below the strut.
i. Inflate the cylinder assembly (9) to approximately 100 psi using dry air or nitrogen. Coat the top of the orifice
tube (6) and air valveassembly (3) with soap suds and check for air leaks.
j. Release the air pressure; clean the soapsuds off the top of the orifice tube (6) and air valve assembly (3) with
fresh water and wipe dry.
m. Perform the MAIN WHEEL AND BRAKE ASSEMBLY INSTALLATION procedure in Chapter 32-40-00.
I n.
o.
Perform the MAIN LANDING GEAR INSTALLATION
12-20-00.
8
Sep 30/ Page 32-1 0-00
RayHheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART1
MAIN LANDING GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES I
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
Torque Knee Bore (20 0.6255 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
and 30) 0.6245 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Bushings (18 and 29) 0.5015 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.4995 corrosion. If bushings exceed wear tolerances,
replace with new bushings. Alignment ream
new bushings to specified weartolerances. Drill
CHARTI
MAIN LANDING GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
Knee Pins (21 and 31) 0.4990 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.4980 corrosion. Any sign of scratches or worn areas
which can not be repaired is cause for rejection.
If no visible wear is evident, conduct magnetic
particle inspection per MIL-STD-1949. Any sign
of cracks is cause for rejection. Replace if wear
tolerances are exceeded.
Bore (Upper) (25) 0.4440 Inspect for wear, damage and corrosion.
0.4370 Replace ii wear tolerances are exceeded.
Bushing (24) 0.3150 0.4360 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.3120 0.4330 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Bore (Lower) (33) 0.3195 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.3125 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Orifice Assembly (6) 1.560 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
1.557 corrosion. Any sign of scratches or worn areas
CHART1
MAIN LANDING GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
Internal Bearings
Upper (16) 1.8695 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
1.8650 corrosion. Replace bearing if wear tolerances
are exceeded. If replacement is required,
remove the bearing from the cylinder assembly
(9) and measure the O.D.. Select from the O.D.
dimensions below to determine the correct
replacement bearing.
32-10-00 S.PpaS3~Pagell
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 1
MAIN LANDING GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
oo-oo).
Upper 7orque Knee Attach- 0.5010 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
ment Hole 0.4995 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Hinge Bushings
Outer Hinge (12) Replace bearings when main landing gear is
I overhauled.
Inner Hinge (13) 0.6240 Replace bearings when main landing gear is
0.6230 overhauled.
Brace Bores
Forward Bolt (14) Bore 0.4395 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.4370 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Center Bolt (10) Bore 0.2520 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.2495 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Aft Bolt (14) Bore 0.4395 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.4370 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Aft bores (14) 0.4395 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.4370 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Page
peS21
30103 32-1 0-00 A24
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANU~ SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART1
MAIN LANDING GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
Lubricate the nose wheel bearings and grease. Refer to Chart 2, LUBRICATION SCHEDULE in Chapter 12-20-00. 1
NOSE GEAR REMOVAL
When removing the nose gear, take care to retain the original adjustment at the rod end fittings to facilitate
reassembly.
a. Jack the airplane and partially retract the landing gear to relieve the load on the retract rod compression springs.
b. Disconnect the drag leg at its fitting on the nose gear brace assembly.
e. Remove the cotter pins, nuts, washers, bolts, and bushings which connect the nose gear upper brace to the
wheel well structure.
f. Lower the nose gear assembly from the nose wheel well.
a. Carefully position the nose gear assembly against the nose wheel well structure.
NOTE
Use 100951S016YP washers (maximum of two per side) to obtain total end play of 0 to 0.015 inch
between the nose gear assembly and supports.
b. Align bolt holes and install bushings, bolts, washers, and nuts. Torque the nuts to 150 to 200 in.-lbs. Install new I
cotter pins.
c. Connectthelanding lightwire.
rCAUTION
CAUTION I
Excessive operation of the landing gear motor without proper cooling may cause damage to the
landing gear motor. Allow a short cooling time after each extension and retraction cycle.
1
32-20-00 Sep 30/03Page
Raytheon AirrraflCompany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
f. Operate the landing gear and check for proper rigging and nose gear adjustment. (Cycle the landing gear a min-
imum of six complete cycles.)
NOTE
Refer to the OVERHAUL AND REPLACEMENT SCHEDULE in Chapter 5-10-00 for time limits and
maintenance checks of the nose gear.
Experience in the field indicates the points of greatest wear on the nose gear are the upper and lower bearings in
the barrel assembly. The forces exerted on the bearings during takeoff and landing tend to result in an oversized
condition. The oversized condition of the upper bearing in the barrel assembly will result in leakage of hydraulic fluid
through the upper bearing and O-ring. This will eventually cause fluid to seep down through the felt pad and out the
lower bearing.
When replacement of the scraper ring and all O-rings in the landing gear fails to stop leaks, the oversized condition
of the bearings is probable. In such instances the landing gear should be overhauled. The following information will
aid in determining the extent of landing gear wear and whether it is possible to overhaul or necessary to replace
critical landing gear components.
IwnRNINal
WARNING
Do not begin any disassembly of the nose landing gear until all air pressure has been re-
leased.
a. Place the strut in a near vertical position to prevent the hydraulic fluid from spilling when the air valve assembly
(1) is removed (Ref. Figures 1 and 2).
I
b. Depress the valve core to deflate the strut and remove the air valve assembly (1).
d. Remove the snap ring (4) retaining the orifice tube (6).
e. Retract the piston and fork assembly (48) to push the orifice tube (6) out of the barrel (23).
f. Remove the orifice tube (6). Remove the O-ring (5) and piston ring (7).
g. Invert the nose gear and drain out the hydraulic fluid.
IWARNING)
WARNING
Do not disconnect the torque knees (37 and 46) without first deflating the nose gear. The
torque knees provide the extension stop for the piston and fork assembly (48). When dis-
connected, the piston and fork assembly (48) is free to slide out of the barrel assembly (23).
h. Remove the cotter pin (40), nut (41), washers (39 and 44), bushing (45), and bolt (43).
2
Sep 30/ Page 32-20-00
RBycheOn nircraff Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i. Remove the cotter pin (36), and pins (25 and 34) to disconnect the upper torque knee (37).
j. Remove the cotter pin (50), pins (42 and 47), and washers (49 and 51 to disconnect the lower torque knee (46).
k. Slide the piston and fork assembly (48) out of the barrel (23). Remove the collar (2) and shim (3).
i. Remove the lower snap ring (33), scraper (31), and adapter (32).
m. Remove the O-ring (38) and remove the felt pad (24) from inside the barrel (23). Removal of the O-ring may be
simplified by using a hook manufactured from music wire (Ref. Figure 1). I
n. Remove the nut (16), washers (17 and 19), bushing (18), and bolt (21) attaching the shimmy damper (20) to the
brace (15).
o. Remove the nut (30), washers (27 and 29), bushing (28), and bolt (26) to disconnect the shimmy damper (20)
from the barrel (23).
.Obd. MUSIC
WTR~--/ i’l3/32
$1
5/ b
DOWEL ROD
BRAZED
BEARING
O-RTNG
CYLINDER
DOWEL ROD
C94TC05B2194 C
3
A24 32-20-00 Sep 30/03Page
RayYheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CLEANING
a. Clean all parts with solvent (16, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Remove all excess solvent and wipe dry after cleaning.
b. Immerse all internal parts in clean hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00) prior to assembly.
a. Inspect all parts and assemblies for damage or excessive wear. The following conditions are cause for rejection:
I Wear which is greater than the allowable wear tolerances (Ref. Chart 1).
Screws that are severely damaged or have stripped, severely worn or scored threads.
Adapter (32)
Bushing (12)
Cotter Pins
O-Rings(5,38)
Safety Wire
Scraper (31)
Grease Fittings
Placards
REPAIRS I
a. Visually inspect castings for cracks and pitting; and finished surfaces for scoring, pitting, nicks, cracks, distortion
and wear. Chart 1 lists wear tolerances to aid in determining the extent of wear. Replace all defective and
excessively worn parts.
b. If fluid leaks have been observed on top of the air valve assembly (1), check the small O-ring of the valve; then
look for defects in the valve (Ref. Figure 2). 1
c. If the leak is from the junction of the orifice tube assembly (6) and the barrel (23), check the O-ring (5) on the
orifice tube (6).
Slight scoring of shafts may be corrected by lapping carefully with a flat oil stone.
NOTE
Do not exceed 10% of the component material thickness when removing nicks, burrs and
scratches.
Those parts that are scratched or have worn plating may be stripped and replated with the same type of
plating as that removed or be replaced with new parts.
NOTE
Corrosion damage requires inspection to determine the depth of penetration and the
cross-sectional area change. The damaged area must be thoroughly cleaned and the corrosion
When evidence of damage exists to steel parts, magnetic particle inspect per MIL-STD-1949.
NOTE
Do not remove paint or primer from the area to be fluorescent or dye penetrant inspected per
MIL-STD-6866. If the finish absorbs the penetrant so that bleed out prevents satisfactory inspection
or if a new finish has not cured for at least 30 days, contact the Technical Support Department of
,4
32-20-00 Sep
30/03Page
Raylheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
~e 26
22.
23.
24.
LOWER BEARING
BARREL
FELT PAD
48.
49.
PISTON AND
FORK ASSEMBLY
WASHER
34 25. PIN 50. COTTER PIN
27
36 P~t-- 29
30
37
38 10~2 ~--t-- 3 1
m--m--~- 32 9
39 ~c40 33 101
42 41
12
43ii;4445 t-B~
46
49
so
’t o
16 718
51
ii;
52
6
Sep 30/Page 32-20-00 A24
RayCheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART1
NOSE GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES
NOTE
Listed below are the tolerances used to determine the extent of wear in the nose gear components. Where
pertinent, permissible wear limits are given for those components. All inside-diameter (I.D.)
the and
outside-diameter (O.D.) dimensions are given in inches (Ref. Figure 2).
Torque Knee Assembly (37 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
and 46) corrosion. Any scratches or worn areas which
can not be repaired is cause for rejection.
Sep 30/03Page
7
32-20-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART1
NOSE GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM i.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
Bushing (45) 0.2505 0.31 1 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.2495 0.310 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
exceeded.
Knee Pin (42) 0.374 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.373 corrosion. Any scratches or worn areas which
can not be repaired is cause for rejection. If no
visible wear is evident, conduct a magnetic
particle inspection per MIL-STC)-1949. Any
crack is cause for rejection. Replace if wear
tolerances are exceeded.
Orifice Assembly (6) 1.449 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
P/N 35-825195 1.436 corrosion. Any sign of scratches or worn areas
(CE-748, CE-772 thru which can not be repaired is cause for rejection.
CE-979; Conduct a magnetic-particle inspection per
I CJ-149 thru CJ-155; MIL-STD-1949. Any sign of cracking is cause
D-10097, D-l 0120 thru for rejection. Check the orifice O.D. does not
D-l 0396; exceed wear tolerances. Check that orifice hole
I E-llll, E-1241 thru E-l 969; does not exceed 0.185/0.180 inches. Cadmium
EA-1 thru EA-272) plate as necessary per Fed QQ-P-416, Type I,
Class 2.
Page
8~, 32-20-00 A24
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART1
NOSE GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
Orifice Assembly (6) 1.449 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
P/N 36-820021 1.436 corrosion. Any sign of scratches or worn areas
(CE-980 and After; which can not be repaired is cause for rejection.
CJ-156 and After; Conduct a magnetic-particle inspection per
D-10397 and After; MIL-STD-1949. Any sign of cracking is cause
E-l 970 and After; for rejection. Check the orifice O.D. does not
EA-273 and After) exceed wear tolerances. Check that orifice hole
does not exceed 0.142/0.1 40 inches. Cadmium
plate as necessary per Fed QQ-P-416, Type I,
Class 2.
Bearings
-Upper 1.755 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
1.751 corrosion. Replace barrel assembly if wear
tolerances are exceeded.
Upper Torque Knee 0.3755 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
Attachment Hole 0.3745 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
9
A24
32-20-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART1
NOSE GEAR WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
Internal Bearings
Upper and Lower (8 and 22) 2.252 Replace bearings when nose gear is
2.250 overhauled. Alignment ream new bearings to
I specified wear tolerances. Drill out lubricator
holes through bearings and install lubricators.
NOTE
Prior to assembly, immerse all internal parts (except felt pad (24)) in hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1,
91-00-00).
c. Install new scraper (31), adapter (32) and secure with snap ring (33).
Add or remove
h. Install upper torque knee (37) with the pins (25 and 34), and cotter pin (36).
NOTE
Install the washers (17 and 19) above or below the bushing (18) on the brace (15) to align the
shimmy damper (20) with the lug on the barrel (23)
i. Position shimmy damper (20) and install the bushing (18), bolt (21), washers (17 and 19) and nut (16).
j. Install the bushing (28), bolt (26), washers (27 and 29) and nut (30) to connect the shimmy damper (20).
k. Slide the piston and fork assembly (48) into the barrel (23).
I
i. Connect the lower torque knee (46) with the pins (42 and 47), washers (49 and 51) and cotter pin (50).
m. Install the bushing (45), bolt (43), washers (39 and 44), nut (41) and cotter pin (40), to connect the upper and
lower torque knees (37 and 46).
n. Install new O-ring (5) and piston ring (7) to orifice tube (6). Push orifice tube (6) down into the barrel (23) and
secure by attaching snap ring (4) to the top of collar (2).
p. With the strut in the vertical position and approximately 114 inch from fully compressed, fill through the air valve
assembly (1) with approximately 500/550 cc of hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
q. Fully extend and recompress the piston and fork assembly (48) three times or until no additional fluid can be
added. Add additional fluid as required with the strut in the compressed position.
r. With the piston and fork assembly (48) compressed, install the valve core into air valve assembly (1).
32-20-00
NglYNteOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I WARUINO)
WARNING
As with all operations involving equipment under high pressure, exercise caution when per-
forming the leak test; avoid the areas directly above and below the strut.
s. To leak test, inflate the nose gear to approximately 90 psi using dry air or nitrogen. Coat the top of the collar (2)
and air valve assembly (1) with soapsuds and test for air leaks.
t. Release the air pressure by depressing the valve core in the air valve assembly (1). Clean the soapsuds from
the top of the collar (2) and air valve assembly (1) with fresh water.
u. Install the air valve cap to the air valve assembly (1).
a. Remove the nut (16), washers (17 and 19), bushing (18), and bolt (21) which attach the shimmy damper (20) to
b. Remove the nut (30), washers (27 and 29), bushing (28), bolt (26) and remove the shimmy damper (20) from
the barrel (23).
a. Install the bushing (28), washers (27 and 29), nut (30) and bolt (26) attaching the shimmy damper (20) to the
barrel (23).
b. Install the bushing (18), washers (17 and 19), nut (16) and bolt (21) attaching the shimmy damper (20) to the
nose gear brace (15). For alignment purposes, attach a 100951-X031-YN washer (19) between the damper and
the lug on the brace, and a 100951-X031-YM washer (17) under the nut.
c. Swivel the nose wheel to check the turning radius of the strut and for freedom of movement without binding or
rough spots. Adjust the nose gear steering travel adjustment bolts to stop shimmy damper piston 1/32 inch to
114 inch from maximum travel in both directions.
NOTE
Refer to the OVERHAUL AND REPLACEMENT SCHEDULE in Chapter 5-10-00 for time limits and
maintenance checks of the nose gear shimmy damper.
12
Sep 30/ Page 32-20-00 ns~
Raytheon nircraff Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
c. Remove the snap ring (2) and piston scraper (3). Force the barrel end (5) out of the barrel (6) by working the
rod (12) back and forth. Remove O-rings (4) from the barrel end (5).
piston
d. Remove all remaining hydraulic fluid by inverting shimmy damper and pumping the piston rod (12).
e. Remove the snap ring (23) and slide the piston rod (12) with the remaining parts out of the barrel (6).
f. Insert a long 6-32 screw or threaded rod into the hole at the clevis (24) end of the piston rod (12) and engage
the forward floating piston (17). Pull floating piston (17) toward clevis (24) so that the piston retaining pin (15)
can be driven-out.
g. Remove the piston retaining pin (15) and push the floating piston (17) out the open end of the piston rod (12)
and remove O-ring (16).
h. Remove the remaining compression spring (1 8) and slide the damper piston (14) off the piston rod (12). Remove
O-rings (13) from the damper piston (14).
i. Remove remaining barrel end (19) and piston scraper (22) from the piston rod (12). Remove O-rings (20) and
(21) from the barrel end (19).
CLEANING
Clean all parts with cleaning solvent (16, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Rinse and dry thoroughly after cleaning.
I CAUTION 1
For replacement, use O-rings approved for use with mineral base hydraulic fluid.
Lubricate all internal parts with hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00) prior to assembly.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
a. Inspect
cause
all parts and assemblies for
for rejection:
damage or excessive wear (Ref. Figure 3). The follo~n/ing conditions are I
Wear which is greater than the allowable wear tolerances. Refer to Chart 2, NOSE GEAR SHIMMY
DAMPER WEAR TOLERANCES AND 1NSPECTION PROCEDURES. I
Damage which cannot be corrected or repaired.
13
*24 32-20-00
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Replace the following parts when nose gear shimmy damper is overhauled:
Safety Wire
Washer (8)
REPAIRS
a. Visually inspect casting for cracks and pitting; and finished surfaces for scoring, pitting, nicks, cracks, distortion
and wear. Refer to Chart 2 for tolerances to aid in determining the extent of wear. Replace all defective and
b. All parts or assemblies may be repaired if any of the following problems exist:
Slight scoring of shafts may be corrected by lapping carefully with a flat oil stone.
NOTE
Do not exceed 10% of the component material thickness when removing nicks, burrs and
scratches.
Those parts that are scratched or have worn plating may be stripped and replated with the same type of
plating as that removed or be replaced with new parts.
NOTE
Corrosion damage requires inspection to determine the depth of penetration and the
cross-sectional area change. The damaged area must be thoroughly cleaned and the corrosion
must be removed. The deterioration caused by corrosion or removal of corrosion must not reduce
the material thickness of any component by more than 10%. Refer to Chart 2 for NOSE GEAR
SHIMMY DAMPER WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES on components.
For additional information contact the Technical Support Department of Raytheon Aircraft
Company, P.O. Box 85, Wichita, KS 67201.
Remove corrosion if applicable, and apply corrosion prevention materials as necessary per MIL-C-5541 or
When evidence of damage exists to steel parts, magnetic particle inspect per MIL-STD-1949.
NOTE
Do not remove paint or primer from the area to be fluorescent or dye penetrant inspected per
MIL-STD-6866. If the finish absorbs the penetrant so that bleed out prevents satisfactory inspection
or if a new finish has not cured for at least 30 days, contact the Technical Support Department of
When evidence of damage exists to metal parts other than steel, fluorescent penetrant inspect per
MIL-STD-6866, Type I.
12
9
14
io
16
I I
17
13
I.
2.
COTTER PIN
SNAP RING
i
3. PISTON SCRAPER
4. O-RINGS
5. BARREL END 15
6. BARREL
7. ATTACHMENT HOLE
8. WASHER
9. COMPRESSION SPRING
10. FLOATING PISTON
I I O-RING
12. PISTON ROD
W
13. O-RINGS 19
14. DAMPER PISTON SS
15. RETAINING PTN 20
ib. O-RING 212;
17. FLOATING PISTON
18. COMPRESSION SPRING 23
19. BARREL END 24
20. O-RING
21 O-RING
22. PISTON SCRAPER
23. SNAP RING
CLEVIS C94E03282874 C
24.
Shimmy Damper
Figure 3
c. insert the piston rod (12) and components into the barrel (6) and place the snap ring (23) into position.
d. Place the barrel (6) in a vise with the open end up and fill the barrel (6) and piston rod (12) with hydraulic fluid
(9, Chart 1,
91-00-00). Work the piston rod (12) up and down until bubbles stop appearing in the fluid, then refill
the barrel (6) and the piston rod (12). To eliminate the possibility of an air pocket under the barrel end (5), ensure
that the barrel (6) is completely full of hydraulic fluid. Any excess fluid will be forced into the piston rod (12) as
the barrel end (5) is inserted.
e. Replace the O-rings (4) on the barrel end (5). Insert the barrel end (5) and piston scraper (3) into the barrel (6)
and secure with snap ring (2).
f. Fill thepiston rod (12) with hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Engage the floating piston (17) with a 6-32 long
screw and
pull towards the clevis (24). At the same time, insert and push the floating piston (10) down into the
piston rod (12). This will cause hydraulic fluid to be sucked into the piston rod (12) and preventing the entry of air.
g. Install compression spring (9), washer (8) and secure with cotter pin (1). Release the 6-32 rod from the piston
(17) and remove from the assembly.
h. Check the fluid level in the shimmy damper by spreading the cotter pin (1) and inserting a 1/16-inch-diameter
wire into the piston rod (12).
Measure the distance to the top of the floating piston (10). If the distance to the
piston rod (10) exceeds 2 3/16 inches, remove the floating piston (10) and add more fluid to the piston rod (12).
i. Install shimmy damper on nose gear of the airplane. Perform the NOSE GEAR SHIMMY DAMPER
INSTALLATION procedure.
j. Service the shimmy damper. Perform the SHIMMY DAMPER procedure in Chapter 12-20-00.
CHART 2
NOSE GEAR SHIMMY DAMPER WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES
NOTE
Listed below are the tolerances used to determine the extent of wear in the
nose gear shimmy damper
components. Where pertinent, the permissible wear limits are given for those components. All inside-diameter
I (I.D.) and outside-diameter (O.D.) dimensions are given in inches (Ref. Figure 3).
Barrel (6) 0.865 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.860 corrosion. Any sign of scratches or worn areas
which can not be repaired is cause for rejection.
If localized damage exists, conduct a
fluorescent or dye penetrant inspection per
MIL-STD-6866. Any sign of cracking is cause
for rejection. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Attachment Hole (7) 0.3765 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.3745 corrosion. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
Damper Piston (14) 0.857 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.850 corrosion. Replace if there is any noticeable
ridges or grooves at O-ring seats. Replace if
wear tolerances are exceeded.
Floating Pistons (10 and 17) 0.240 Visually inspect for wear, damage and
0.232 corrosion. Replace if there is any noticeable
ridges or grooves at O-ring seat. Replace if
wear tolerances are exceeded.
Piston Rod (12) 0.253 0.3745 Visually inspect for straightness, cracks,
0.246 0.3725 scratches, corrosion or worn areas. Any signs
of wear which can not be repaired is cause for
rejection. Replace if wear tolerances are
exceeded.
CHARTP
NOSE GEAR SHIMMY DAMPER WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION PROCEDURES (CONTINUED)
ITEM I.D. O.D. WEAR TOLERANCES AND INSPECTION
PROCEDURES
NOSE GEAR RETRACT BRACE ASSEMBLY CHECK (E-1103 AND AFTER; E-l THRU E-1102 WITH
KIT 35-4012-1 INSTALLED)
a. Check outboard arm (20), inboard arm (21), attachment bolts (22), washers (23) and nuts (24) for security (Ref.
Figure 4).
b. Check the retract rod rod-ends (58) and (88) for indications of cracking and the mechanism assembly for shear
stress, wear and/or corrosion. Refer to SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE CHECKS MAINTENANCE
PRACTICES in Chapter 5-20-00.
c. Tighten any loose hardware and replace all hardware that show signs of shear stress, wear, corrosion and/or
cracking. Clean area of any corrosion before installing hardware.
19
32-20-00
Rayeheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
36
31
1
sSi
30
33
40
38 U 39
41
21
37 20
38
37
41
~9 13
29
28
39
22, 23, 24
38
41
38 19
18
14
15
DETAIL B
11
26
9’/ /y/ I- ~BC. 8
10
4 9
II /dB/ ~7
4 DETAILA 25.BOLT
26. WASHER
27. BUSHING
5/ -Y"~- 28. WASHER
29. NUT
30. DOOR ACTUATOR
SHAFT ASSEMBLY
1. RETRACT BRACE ASSEMBLY 13. AFT DRAG BRACE ASSEMBLY 31. SCREW
2. RETRACT DRAG LEG ASSEMBLY 14. DOOR ACTUATOR BRACKET AND PIN SUPPORT 32. NUT
3. BOLT 15. SCREW, WASHER, NUT 33. SPRING
4. WASHER 16. BOLT, WASHER, NUT 34. SCREW
5. NUT 17. BOLT, WASHER, NUT 35. NUT
6. COTTER PIN 18. DOOR ACTUATOR PIN ASSEMBLY 36. ROD END
7. LUBE FITTING AND BUSHING 19. BUMPER 37. DOOR ACTUATOR
8. BOLT 20. OUTBOARD ARM ROD ASSEMBLY
9. BUSHING 21. INBOARD ART 38. BALL JOINTS
10. BUSHING 22. DRAG BRACE ATTACHMENT BOLT 39. WASHER
20
Sep 30/ Page 32-20-00 A24
Raylheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
L fi 9c66
64
65
bii~"
j 6P
49 i 46 47_ ,8~751
45 42
43 64
6‘1 1 Bgc-55
57 ~h
50 48
f
6059
DETAILA
Nose Gear Retract Mechanism
(E-1103 and After; E-l thru E-1102 With Kit 35-4012-1 Installed)
Figure 4 (Sheet 2 of 3)
21
A24 32-2000
Ray~Hleon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
78 li:i
88
/I
77
86
87 B 9" ss
80
76
85
82/’i
DETAIL A
s; o-
t
B OETAILB
B
22
Sep 30/ Page 32-20-00 A24
Raylheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
LUBRICATION
Lubricate the landing gear and retract system as detailed in the Lubrication Chart in Chapter 12-20-00. Note LUBRI-
CATION OF LANDING GEAR UPLOCK ROLLERS in Chapter 12-20-00.
In the event of landing gear malfunction in flight, the gear may be manually extended by a hand crank located behind
the front spar between the pilot’s and copilot’s seats.
IW~RNINO
WARNING i
If the gear’has been extended manually for emergency reasons, the airplane must be put on
jacks and inspected before the gear controls are returned to their normal position.
pcnunoN
CAUTION I
Do not attempt to retract the landing gear using the hand crank. The manual extension system is
designed to lower the landing gear only. Refer to the appropriate Pilot’s Operating Handbook for
emergency op~rating instructions.
The landing gear should not be operated electrically with the hand crank engaged. In the event of
such operation, a teardown and magnetic inspection should be performed to check for damage to
the engagement slot in the worm shaft of the landing gear actuator.
a. Removethe cabinfrontseats.
b. Remove the access cover on top and directly behind the front carry-through structure.
d. Remove the flap motor attaching bolts and disconnect the landing gear door attaching rods at the actuator.
e. Remove the four screwssecuring the landing gear limit switch assembly on the left-hand side of the actuator
and move the switch assembly aside to permit removal of the actuator.
f. Disconnect the electrical wiring to the landing gear motor. Identify the wires for ease of reinstallation.
ICAVTIONI
CAUTION
Do not remove the shaft from the sector gear of the actuator. If the shaft is removed, teardown of
1
Az´•I 32-30-00Page
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENAN%E MANUAL
NOTE
For ease of reinstallation, note the index marks on the arm and actuator.
g. Remove the landing gear actuator access door on the bottom of the fuselage, and remove the nose gear actu-
ator arm and linkage from the actuator.
h. Remove the four actuator attaching nuts and remove the actuator.
b. Connect the nose landing gear rod and linkage to the actuator. Make certain that the index mark on the arm
c. Install the landing gear actuator access door on the bottom of the fuselage.
f. Connect the landing gear door attaching rods at the actuator. Attach the flap motor attaching bolts.
I cnunohll
CAUTION
Excessive operation of the landing gear motor without proper cooling may cause damage to the
landing gear motor. Allow a P-minute-cooling time after each extension and retraction cycle.
i. Check rigging of landing gear system. When cycling the gear, listen for unusual noises at the motor and actua-
tor. Cycle the gear a minimum of six times.
j. Install the access covers on top and directly behind the front carry-through structure.
a. Removethe rightfrontseat.
b. Remove the access plate over the motor and disconnect the electrical wiring. Identify the wires for ease of re-
installation.
c. Remove the three landing gear motor attaching bolts and remove the landing gear motor.
a. Position the landing gear motor on the actuator and install the attaching bolts. Safety wire the attaching bolts.
b. Connect the landing gear motor electrical wiring and install the access plate over the motor.
The landing gear is operated by a split-field, series-wound motor located on the forward side of the main spar car-
ry-through. One field is used to drive the motor in each direction. To prevent overtravel of the gear, a dynamic brake
relay is incorporated into the landing gear circuit and acts as a brake on the motor. When either the up or downlimit
switches activate, the relay simultaneously breaks the power circuit to the motor and makes a complete circuit
through the armature and the unused field windings, turning the motor onto a generator. The resulting electrical load
applied to the armature stops the gear almost instantly.
To check the dynamic brake relay for proper operation, it is necessary to remove the spar cover to gain access to
the actuator and limit switches.
Actuate the landing gear with the landing gear handle (either up or down). When the actuator reaches midtravel po-
sition, actuate the appropriate limit switch in the direction the actuator is traveling. The landing gear motor should
stop immediately without any noticeable coast.
a. Removethe rightfrontseat.
b. Remove the access plate which covers both the landing gear motor and the dynamic brake relay.
c. The dynamic brake relay is located slightly outboard and below the landing gear motor. Identify and disconnect
the wiring to the dynamic brake relay.
d. Remove the two screws which secure the dynamic brake relay assembly to its attaching bracket.
e. Removethedynamicbrake relay.
a. Position the dynamic brake relay on its attaching bracket and install the two attaching screws.
c. Install the access cover which covers the landing gear motor and the dynamic brake relay.
d. Installthe rightfrontseat.
b. Remove the access covers directly aft of the front carry-through spar.
c. With the airplane on jacks, partially retract the landing gear until the inboard door is fully open.
d. Remove the attaching bolts and disconnect the retract rod from the landing gear actuator retract arm.
e. Remove the attaching bolt and disconnect the retract rod from the main landing gear V-brace.
~al 32-30-00
Raytheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i1~9 I´•
d o
i
I/
GEAR INBOARD
ADJUSTMENT
MAIN GEAR
J/ MAIN GEAR
RETRACT RODS
O O
A
WHEEL SHIMMY
(G
h~------
GEAR DOOR
.010-.020
E
O GEAR O
MAIN i. UPLOCK
UPLOCK BLOCK
36--211--1
Page
ceD4
23/99 32-30-00 A21
Rayl~hean Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Position the landing gear retract rod in the main landing gear V-brace located in the wheel well.
b. Install the attaching bolt in the main landing gear V-brace and the main landing gear retract rod.
c. Position the main landing gear retract rod in the main landing gear actuator retract arm and install the attaching
bolts.
d. Install the access covers immediately aft of the front carry-through spar.
Read the entire landing gear rigging procedure before any attempt to rig the landing gear system. Physically locate
each item while reading through the rigging instructions. When any part of the landing gear system requires rigging,
it is recommended that ALL of the rigging steps be accomplished in the order shown.
CAUTION I
I cnlmoru
Do not change the position of the control switch to reverse the direction of the landing gear while
the landing gear is in transit, as this could cause damage to the landing gear retract mechanism.
After the airplane is placed on jacks, but before beginning to rig the landing gear, start the retraction cycle enough
to break the downlock tension. Apply a sharp load by hand against the nose landing gear strut. Approximately a half
to one inch of movement under this load by the main landing gear wheels is a good indication that the landing gear
actuator needs to be overhauled and/or adjusted.
cnunon i
I CAUTION
Battery voltage is not sufficient to landing gear during the rigging procedure. A
properly cycle the
28.25 landing gear during rigging. If an external
0.25 volt power supply should be utilized for the
power supply is not available on the airplane, jumper cables may be used between the battery and
the power supply. Be sure of the polarity before connecting the power supply to the battery.
Excessive operation of the landing gear motor without proper cooling may cause damage to the
landing gear motor. Allow a Fminute-cooling time after each extension and retraction cycle.
Whenever the landing gear mechanism or doors are removed or disconnected, retract the landing gear and check
the rigging. The following procedure for rigging the landing gear was written on the assumption that the entire land-
ing gear is out of rig.
IWARNINO
WARNING i
To prevent possible injury, the emergency landing gear actuator hand crank must always be
disengaged when operating the landing gear electrically.
5
pal 32-30-00
Rayl~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I CAUTION I
Overtightening the nut on the bolt connecting the drag leg to the shock strut can bind the strut or
b. Lengthen the main landing gear retract rods sufficiently to prevent excessive tension on the nose gear
and nose
danger of the V-brace on the main landing gears damaging the skin when the land-
retract rods and to eliminate the
ing gear is retracted. Damage to vital parts may result if abnormal loads are applied to the landing gear retract sys-
tem. By lengthening the main and nose gear retract rods, such danger is removed.
c. Insert the landing gear retract arm/retract rod attach bolt pointing aft.
d. Disconnect the uplock cables at the brackets, leaving the springs attached. If the springs are disconnected, the
uplock arm may damage the wing skin upon retraction of the gear. Place the uplock block in the lower position.
f. Disconnect the nose landing gear door linkage at the attaching point on the nose landing gear door. Unscrew
the nose landing gear door links from the upper ball joint.
g. Remove the bolts attaching the main landing gear outboard door links at the main strut. Remove the actuator
rod to the inboard main landing gear door by unscrewing from the inboard rod ends and removing the bolt in the
door bracket.
h. Screw the stop bolts into the main gear V-brace assembly until approximately four or five threads are showing.
[CAMON
CAUTION 1
When running the landing gear electrically before the switches are reset, or for the first time after
resetting the switches, run the landing gear with extreme care to make sure the switches open the
electrical circuits before the sector gear hits the internal stops in the gearbox. The sector gear
should not be touching the stop when the motor stops. Serious damage may result if the internal
stops are hit by the sector gear. When checking the dynamic brake system, actuate one of the limit
switches and the motor should stop immediately.
On airplanes with a 5-amp push-pull landing gear control circuit breaker, use this circuit breaker to
"bump" the landing gear. On earlier airplanes without the damp push-pull circuit breaker, manually
operate the limit switches and use the 30-amp landing gear motor circuit breaker to "bump" the
landing gear. When using the 30-amp circuit breaker, use extreme care because the dynamic brake
is inoperative.
i. Run the gear about two thirds up, then stop and "bump" the landing gear the remaining distance to either the
limit switch setting or to the internal stop by intermittent operation of the LDG GEAR circuit breaker. With the actuator
in the retracted position, check that the hand crank will rotate 1/8 to 1/4 turn (5/8 to 3/4 turn on new, or white actu-
ators) before reaching the internal stop of the actuator.
Dec 32-30-00
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
A new actuator may be installed on earlier airplanes as a spare. The new actuator may be identified
by white epoxy paint on the upper actuator arm, and the upper and lower actuator housing. When
the new actuator is installed as a spare on earlier airplanes, the actuator should be adjusted by us-
ing the 518 to 3/4 hand crank turns remaining after the motor has stopped. If this clearance is not
obtained, adjust the uplimit switch. To adjust the uplimit switch, lower the landing gear 518 to 3/4
turns of the emergency hand crank, and adjust the switch by turning the screw in the actuator in or
out to increase or decrease travel so that it just breaks the circuit.
j. Extend the landing gear and check the hand crank. There should be 1/8 to 1/4 turn (or 5/8’ to 314 turn on the new
(or white) actuators) between the extended position and the internal stop. The downlimit switch adjustment is ac-
complished by bending the switch actuator arm tab so that it just breaks the circuit. On newer actuators, there is an
adjustment screw for use when adjusting the downlimit switch.
NOTE
On airplane serials CE-959 and after, CJ-156 and after, D-10380 and after, E-1879 and after, and
EA-247 and after, the landing gear will retract slightly slower than on previous serials because the
motor used runs slower in the retract cycle.
Allow 2 minutes of cooling time between each extend and retract cycle
k. Extend and retract the landing gear two or three times to assure that the switches are correctly set and the dy-
namic brake is operating correctly. Check the hand crank each time to ensure proper adjustment.
NOTE
It may be necessary to make a closer setting of the limit switches, but there should never be less
than 118 of a turn (5/8 of a turn with the new (or white) actuators) on the hand crank in either the
extended or retracted position.
i. Adjust the main landing gear retract rod (either right or left) to maintain a minimum of I/l&inch clearance be-
tween the joint (knee) of the V-brace and the lift leg and the top wing skin with the landing gear fully retracted. The
main landing gear should retract only far enough to clear the inboard door while maintaining the minimum clearance
of I/l&inch. To decrease the clearance between the knee and the top wing skin, shorten the retract rod; to increase
clearance, lengthen the retract rod.
m. When the proper setting is obtained, leave the landing gear in the retracted position and screw the upper stop
bolt down against the main strut. To assure a firm seating, insert a 0.003inch feeler gage under the bolt head and
adjust the bolt until a firm, steady effort is required to pull the feeler gage from under the bolt head. With the feeler
gage removed, screw the bolt down an additional 314 turn. Tighten the locknut securely.
NOTE
Refer to service instructions No. 0448-211, Rev, 1, entitled Landing Gear Main Gear Retract
Mechanism Installation of Uplock Roller Lubricating Bolt Assembly.
n. Check the uplock roller for free movement and a maximum clearance of 0.010 to 0.020 inch between the roller
and the uplock block. If this clearance is not correct, the uplock block must be adjusted. To adjust, loosen the block
retaining bolts and adjust the clearance between the roller and the uplock block. The uplock bracket and the block
are serrated and the serrations must be interlocked.
7
na 32-30-00 Dec 23/9 Page
Raylheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
o. Extend the landing gear and attach the uplock cable to the bracket.
I CAUTION I
The attach bolt on the
uplock cable must be installed with the head of the bolt pointing aft. The bolt
must be installed in this position to avoid interference between the bolt and the stringer in the wheel
well when the landing gear is fully retracted.
p. Retract the landingintermittently as in step i and observe the locking action of the uplock bracket. Starting
gear
to lock too soon is an indication that theuplock cable is too tight. The cable should be adjusted for a tension of 52.5
10 0 pounds in the up position. The tension is adjusted at the outboard end of the cable. If sufficient adjustment
is not obtainable at the cable eye, additional adjustment may also be made at No. 3 wing rib by moving the cable
housing inboard or outboard.
q. Extend the landing gear and check the force required to deflect the main landing gear knee joint. With the land-
inggear in the down position, it should take 45 to 60 pounds of force to deflect the knee joint. To increase tension,
add 100951S063XP washers under the inboard end of the spring as required. Maintain a total minimum gap of 0.06
inch between the spring coils. (The total gap is the sum of all the gaps between the coils.)
NOTE
If unable to obtain
adequate spring tension, check for worn spherical bearing in the retract linkage.
Wear in the spherical bearing has the effect of shortening the entire linkage, causing the rod end
spring to compress and stack, leaving nothing for spring adjustments. New bushings will shorten
the linkage, again permitting adjustment of the spring.
A minimum of 55 pounds of deflection force is required at the union of the V-brace and the drag leg assembly
on the nose gear with the landing gear in the fully down position. To obtain the required force, adjust as follows:
1. Lower the landing gear to just short of the fully down position with no tension on the V-brace and with the
wheels clearing the floor.
2. A maximum of three 100951DD064XM washers may be added to the end of the spring on the forward re-
tract rod.
3. If the additional washers did not provide the required minimum deflection force, the rod end on the forward
retract rod may be adjusted (shortened or lengthened) to obtain the required deflection force.
4. After the adjustment, check that the retract spring does not stack at any point during full travel of the nose
gear.
CAUTION I
1 CAUTION
Do not adjust the rod end bearing out more than a maximum of 0.25 inch as measured between the
nut and the end of the threads on the rod end bearing.
s. With the noselanding gear in the fully retracted position and the landing gear doors disconnected, a force of 30
to 35 pounds applied downward at the center line of the tow pin shall be required to move the strut off the bumper.
If this force is not obtained, adjust the rod ends on the aft nose gear retract rod. With the nose wheel in the fully
Page
32130-00 A21
Raytheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
retracted position and both doors fully rigged, a minimum force of 20 pounds, applied as noted above, shall be re-
.quired to move the strut 0.12 inch (at the tow pin) measured along the line of force application.
t. Unscrew the attaching landing gear on the outboard door to ensure that the door is not damaged
link of the main
when retracted. Connect outboard door linkage and retract landing gear slowly, checking to ensure that clearance
is maintained between the door and the landing gear. After checking to see that the door is not too tight, run the
landing gear down and adjust the linkage as required; continue this procedure until a snug, firm fit is obtained when
the door is completely closed.
u. Connect the main landing gear inboard door linkage, retract the landing gear slowly and check for clearance
between the door linkage and the root rib. Run the landing gear to the 314 extended position and adjust to maintain
1/4 inch of maximum clearance between the tire and the inboard door with slack removed from the door linkage.
Continue this procedure until the door closes tightly in both the up and down positions. Adjust doors by varying the
length of the push-pull linkage rods. Disconnect the rods at the clevis fittings to make this adjustment.
CAUTION I
I CAUTION
Install the pushrod attaching bolt for the main landing gear door in the door linkage bracket with the
head to the aft. If installed wrong, the bolt may catch on the fuselage skin and root rib of the wing,
causing damage to the landing gear retract mechanism orpreventing the landing gear from retract-
ing.
Connect the nose landing gear door linkage and rig the nose door. Check closely to see that the right hand aft
hinge clears the tire. Adjust the nose landing gear doors by varying the length of the~push-pull linkage rods in the
nose wheel well. With the landing gear retracted, the doors should have a slight tension on them from the actuator
w. Check the landing gear safety switch for the proper adjustment on the right and left main landing gear. Measure
3/4 inch down on the piston from the bottom of the shock strut cylinder and mark the piston with a piece of tape
(Figure 1, Detail D). Raise the wheel with a small jack, compressing the shock strut, until the tape is even with the
lower edge of the cylinder. Adjust the switch actuating arm at the clevis so the switch is actuated as the tape touches
the end of the cylinder. Remove the small jack from the wheel. Pull Landing Gear Motor circuit breaker. Disconnect
the left safety switch operating arm at the torque link and position to simulate an "on ground" position. Select "Gear
Up", check for audible warning. Select "Gear Down". Connect the safety switch operating arm. Repeat the process
with the right landing gear safety switch. On airplane serials CJ-180 and after, CE-1301, CE-1307 and after, E-2458,
E-2468 and after and EA-488 and after, check the landing gear retract-prevent switch for proper operation per Chap-
ter32-60-00.
x. Check the landing gear position lights. The lights are mounted on the sub panel. Three green lights, one for each
gear, are illuminated whenever the landing gears are down and locked. The red light illuminates any time one or all
of the landing gears are in transit or in any intermediate position. Ail of the lights will be out when the gears are up
and locked.
z. On airplane serials CE-1301, CE-1307 and after, CJ-180 and after, E-2458, E-2468 and after, EA-488 and after,
check the throttle retract-prevent switch for proper operation as instructed in Chapter 32-60-00.
aa. Safety all bolts, tighten all lock nuts and remove the airplane from the jacks.
9
A21 32-30-00
Raytheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Cut the
safety wire and remove the bolts (34) and washers attaching the retract motor (1) to the upper actuator
housing (35). Remove the spur and pinion gear (2) from the landing gear motor.
b. Remove the snap ring (3), the worm drive gear (4) and the woodruff key (39) from the worm gear shaft (19).
c. Remove the cotter pin, nut, washers, support plate (37), snap ring (5) and the actuator retract arm (6) from the
actuator drive shaft (7). Push the shaft out of the actuator assembly in the direction of the arrows.
d. Remove the snap ring (27) and the actuator retract arm (28) from the actuator drive shaft (7).
e. Remove the cotter pin, nut, washers and bolt (9). Cut the safety wire and remove the screws (8) and washers
attaching the lower actuator housing (36) to the upper actuator housing (35).
f. Index mark bothhousings. Carefully separate both housings and remove the actuator worm sector (10), the sec-
tor gear stop assembly (32) and the spacer (33).
g. Remove the seal (25) and the bearings (26) from the upper and lower actuator housings (35 and 36).
h. Cut the safety wire and remove the screws (15) and washers attaching the hand crankshaft housing (16) to the
upper actuator housing (35).
i. Using a spanner wrench, remove the retainer nut (17) and remove the worm gear shaft (19) in the direction of
the arrows.
j. Remove the cotter pin and loosen the locknut (21) enough to enable the bearing (20) to slide down the worm
gear shaft (19) and remove the split bushing (18).
k. Remove the bearing (20) and the locknut (21) from the worm gear shaft (1 9).
i. Remove the seal (22) and the bearings (23 and 24) from the upper housing (35).
m. Remove the bearing (29) and the grease fill plug (30), with the ball check (31), from the upper actuator housing
(35).
n. Remove the screw (11), washer and the nut attaching the actuator hand crank (12) to the engaging shaft (38)
for the hand crank.
o. Remove the spacer (13) and the O-ring seal (14) from the hand crank engaging shaft (38) and remove the shaft
from the hand crank shaft housing (16).
Dec 32-30-00 nn
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
15. SCREW
21. LOCKNUT
SEAL
23.
.2GNIRAEB
’F",,, 24. BEARING
25. SEAL
26. BEARING
29. BEARING
30. GREASE FITTING PLUG
31 35
31. BALL CHECK
11. SCREW
13. SPACER
Clean all parts with PD680 solvent (16, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Check all bearings and bushings for cracks and exces-
sive wear. Check all gears for cracks, chips, missing teeth, nicks and wear. Check the housing for cracks, wear and
damage. Replace all worn or damaged parts and seals during assembly.
RETRACTACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
FIGURE 2
a. Fully thread the locknut (21) on the worm gear shaft (19) and slip the bearing (20) on the shaft with the shield
side of the bearing toward the slotted end of the worm gear shaft. Install the split bushing (18) on the shaft and tight-
en the locknut (21) against the bearing (20) and install a new coffer pin.
NOTE
Cut the ends of the coffer pin so that 0.12 to 0.19 inch will protrude beyond the locknut (21). Bend
the cotter pin ends tightly across the nut.
b. Install the bearings (23 and 24) and the seal (22) into the upper actuator housing (35).
I CAUTION I
Do not damage the seal (22) while installing the worm gear shaft (19).
e. Lubricate the threads of the retainer nut (17) with a light coating of th read lube (43, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and install
in the upper actuator housing (35) with a spanner wrench. Stake the nut in three places.
f. Place the hand crank engagement shaft and spring (38) in the hand crank shaft housing(l6) and install the 0-
ring seal (14).
g. Position the hand crank housing (16) in the mounted position. Maintain a clearance of 0.001 to 0.015 inch be-
tween the hand crank engaging shaft (38) and the worm gear shaft (19) with the worm gear fully seated in its thrust
bearing in the direction of the arrows. Coat the mating surfaces of the hand crank housing (16) and the upper actu-
ator housing (35) with sealer (44, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and secure with screws (15) and safety wire.
NOTE
io maintain the specified clearance, the actuator hand crank(l2) may be faced off and/or additional
spacer (13) may be added or removed.
h. Position the actuator hand crank (12) and the spacer (13) on the hand crank engaging shaft (38) and secure
with the screw (11), washer and nut.
i. Install the bearings (26) and the seals (25) in the upper and lower actuator housings (35 and 36).
Page
32-30-00 A21
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
Coat the outside diameters of the seals (25) with sealing compound (45, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
j. Align the double tooth of the spline of the actuator retract arm (28) with the space on the spline on the actuator
drive shaft (7). Install the arm on the shaft with the snap ring (27).
NOTE
If the landing gear retract actuator is to be installed in the airplane, the retract actuator arm (28) and
the snap ring (27) should be sacked and tied until after the installation of the landing gear actuator
in the airplane.
k. Slide the actuator drive shaft (7) into the lower actuator housing (36) in the direction opposite to the arrows. In-
stall the spacer (33).
i. Align the space of the spline on the actuator drive shaft (7) with the double center tooth of the spline of the ac-
tuator worm sector (10). Install the actuator worm sector (10) on the shaft.
m. Coat the mating surfaces, and the machined surfaces where the bolt (9) is installed, on the upper and lower
actuator housings (35 and 36) with sealer (44, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
n. insert bolt (9) through the lower actuator housing (36) and position the sector gear stop assembly (32) over the
bolt.
o. Align the index marks made during the disassembly, and position the upper´•actuator housing (35) over the lower
actuator housing (36). Install washers and screws (8) and safety wire.
p. Install the washer and nut on the bolt (9) and tighten. Secure the nut with a new cotter pin.
q. Align the space of the spline of the actuator drive shaft (7) with the double tooth of the spline on the actuator
retract arm (6). Install the arm on the shaft with the snap ring (5). Install washers, upper landing gear support plate
(37), nut and a new cotter pin.
r. Install the woodruff key (39) in the keyway of the worm gear shaft (19).
s. Install the worm drive gear (4) on the worm gear shaft (19) with the snap ring (3). Install the spur and pinion gear
(2) in the upper actuator housing (35), making sure the teeth engage those of the worm drive gear (4).
t. Lubricate that portion of the upper actuator housing (35) containing the spur and pinion gear (2) and the worm
drive gear (4) with approximately one ounce of MIL-G81322 grease (46, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Fill to within 0 0.10
inch of the housing center line.
u. Install the retract motor on the upper actuator housing (35) with bolts (34) and washers, and safety wire.
v. Lubricate the actuator assembly, through the grease fill port, with one half pint of grease (47, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
When properly filled, the oil level on a dip stick inserted through the filler port will be approximately 1/4 inch.
w. Install the ball check (31) and the grease fill plug (30) in the upper actuator housing (35).
To ensure proper operation and break-in of the actuator, the following functional test procedure must be complied
with prior to installation of a newly overhauled actuator in the airplane.
32-30-00
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Operate the landing gear retract actuator for five retract and extend cycles with the actuator mechanically loaded to
an equivalent of 20 amps in both directions. The motor terminal voltage shall be maintained at 28 ~c_0.03 volts.
The noise output shall not deviate excessively from the average of other accepted actuators in respect to amplitude
and frequency.
After the functional test procedures have been performed, place a functional test stamp approximately 1.5 inches
inboard of center line of the lubrication fill hole.
No maintenance is required for the landing gear safety system, other than replacing defective units or checking the
wiring
electrical for condition, security of attachment, and tightness of electrical connections. The switches are pre-
set and adjustment will not normally be required; however, should the system fail to function properly, the following
checks and adjustments may be accomplished.
CHECK OF LANDING GEAR SAFETY SYSTEM WITH SAFETY SWITCH IN TEST POSITION
b. Place the battery master switch ON. The landing gear circuit breaker may be either IN or OUT.
c. landing gear safety system switch in the momentary fully up (test) position. Noise or movement of the
Place the
solenoid in the landing gear position switch indicates that the automatic landing gear extension part of the system
is functioning properly. The on-off switch returns normally to the ON position unless the pilot intentionally places the
switch in the OFF position.
The microswitch cannot be accurately adjusted on the ground. Before the safety system microswitch is adjusted, it
must be ascertained that the throttle warning horn switch is properly adjusted. See ENGINE-
COMPARTMENT-LOCATED LANDING GEAR WARNING SWITCH ADJUSTMENT or PEDESTAL-LOCATED
LANDING GEAR WARNING SWITCH ADJUSTMENT in this chapter for proper setting of the throttle warning horn
switch. The safety system microswitch may then be adjusted as follows:
a. With theairplane in flight, mark the throttle control at the control panel when the manifold pressure gage regis-
ters approximately 18 inches of Hg.
b. With the airplane on the ground, move the throttle until the mark on the control is aligned with the control panel
just as it was when the mark was made while the airplane was in flight.
c. Adjust the microswitch until the cam clicks the switch closed with the throttle in the position indicated in the pre-
ceding step.
The pressure switches are preset and will not normally require adjustment. Because of the built-in tolerance of these
switches, they should not be tampered with unless radically out of adjustment, that is unless the switch in question
an airspeed within 2 mph above or below the setting recommended for it. Even then the system
fails to actuate at
plumbing and electrical wiring should be checked to ascertain that the source of trouble is not something other than
improper adjustment of the pressure switches.
b. With the master switch ON, the landing gear circuit breaker ON, and the landing gear warning circuit breaker
OFF, advance the throttle to its maximum position.
e. Clamp a section of soft rubber hose over the pitot head inlet, making certain that the connection is airtight.
f. Crimp the end of the tubing and roll it up until the airspeed indicator registers 90 mph. The landing gear will start
retracting immediately if the pressure switch is properly adjusted.
I CAUTION I
To avoid rupturing the diaphragm of the airspeed indicator, the rubber tubing must be rolled slowly.
g. If the landing gear failed to retract in the preceding step, turn the master switch OFF and adjust the pressure
switch (upper switch of the two installed in the left main wheel well) as follows:
1. Secure the rolled up tubing so that it will hold the airspeed indicator reading at 90 mph.
2. Connect a continuity tester across the contacts of the pressure switch, then turn the adjustment screw until
the switch closes at the 90 mph ´•reading on the airspeed indicator.
h. Turn the master switch on and roll up the rubber tubing until the airspeed indicator registers 130 mph, then se-
cure the tubing so that the airspeed indicator will hold that reading.
j. Slowly bleed off pressure until the airspeed indicator registers 120 mph. The landing gear will extend immedi-
ately if the pressure switch is properly adjusted.
k. Should the landing gear fail to extend, turn the master switch OFF and adjust the pressure switch (lower switch
of the two in the left main wheel well) as follows:
1. Secure the rolled up tubing so that it will hold the airspeed indicator reading at 120 mph.
2. Connect a continuity tester across the contacts of the pressure switch, then turn the adjustment screw until
the pressure switch closes at the 120 mph reading on the airspeed indicator.
I. Turn the master switch ON and check the landing gear safety system through the complete cycle of operation.
n21 32-30-00
Raytheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
35-223-5
Page
ceD61
23/99 32-30-00 A21
aeechc~ft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WHEELS AND BRAKES DESCRIPTION tons in thepiston housing forces the two brake iinings
AND OPERATION against the rotating brake assemblies. The pistons are
sealed against leakage with O-rings.
MAIN WHEEL ASSEMBLIES
SHUTTLE VALVE
The airplanes are equipped with two Cleveland 6:00 X
6 main wheel assemblies.
On airplanes with dual brake systems, the earlier air-
32-40-00
Page 1
INLET ~LINING
PLATE
AIVETSTORQUE INSULATOR
OUTLET
BRAKE ASSEMBLY
IDETAIL C
DETAIL B
BRAKE RESERVOIR
PARKING BRAKE
VALVES
jj
PRESSURE LINE BLEEDER HOSE
i ii C
SOURCE OF COMPRESSED AIR E
FOR PRESSURE BLEEDING
POT
C94CE32B1990
ElrakeSystem
Figure 1
32-40-00
Page 2
Nov 16194 A17
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TROUBLESHOOTING
BRAKE SYSTEM
aged wheel parts. Replace tires showing breaks, blis- Removal of the wheel only does not
ters or excessive wear, necessitate disconnection of the line.
Tires in service grow due to shock loads dur- d. Remove the cotter pin, wheel retaining nut,
slightly
is balanced
washer and spacer. Slide the wheel and inner spacer
ing landings. Normally, this growth by
off the axle.
tread wear so there is no increase in tire diameter.
e. The brake disc assembly can be removed by
Beech Aircraft Corporation cannot recommend the the six bolts which join the wheel halves.
removing
use of recapped tires. The tires may pass the retrac-
32-40-00
Page 3
A17 Nov 16/94
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
MAIN WHEEL INSPECTION AND g. Inspect the brake disc assembly for cracks,
CLEANING excessive wear, or scoring, rust and corrosion.
Remove rust and blend out small nicks with a fine
emery cloth. The brake disc should be replaced when
bristled brush may be used to remove hardened aged or excessively worn they should be replaced.
grease, dust, and dirt.
CAUIION
Gasoline and dry cleaning fluids are
Do not spin the bearings with com- unsuitable as cleaning agents because
pressed air as this will cause damage, they will damage O-rings.
b. Visually inspect bearing cups and cones for nicks,
scratches, water stains, galling, heat discoloration, b. Clean dirty and greasy surfaces with denatured
roller wear, cage damage, and cracks or distortion, alcohol.
Replace if damaged or worn. c. Inspect entire brake assembly for cracking, nicks,
c. Inspect the wheel
bearing grease for contamina- corrosion, damaged threads, etc. Check cylinder walls
tion and solidification at each periodic maintenance for scoring or excessive wear.
inspection, d. Carefully inspect pistons for nicks or burrs which
d. Inspect wheel halves for cracks, corrosion and might damage the O-rings. Remove nicks and burrs
other damage. Cracked and badly corroded castings with fine crocus cloth, then thoroughly clean.
should be replaced. Small nicks, scratches or pits can
e. Inspect all brake linings for cracks. Linings should
be blended out using fine (400-grit) sandpaper.
be replaced if they are worn 3/32 inch above the riv-
e. Inspect snap rings and grease seals for deteriora- ets.
tion and wear; replace if damaged or deformed.
Lightly saturate the felt seals with 10W30 oil (remove MAIN WHEEL AND BRAKE ASSEMBLY
excess by pressing lightly). Coat the sides and outer INSTALLATION
diameter with same type of grease as that used on the
a. Clean and repack wheel bearings as indicated in
bearing.
MAIN WHEEL INSPECTION AND CLEANING in this
f. Inspect bearing cups for looseness, scratches, pit- chapter. Replace any damaged grease seals, and be
ting, corrosion, evidence of overheating. Coat the
or
sure the grease seal retaining rings and snap rings
bearing cups with bearing grease. Repack with either are in place before reinstalling the wheel.
Aero Shell No. 5 or other greases per MIL-G-81322
b. Install inner spacer, wheel, outer spacer, washer,
(46, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
retaining nut and cotter pin.
NOTE
At least one 100951X100VY or
Aero Shell No. 5 grease is not compat- 100951X050VY washer shall be
ible with other greases covered by MIL- installed between the outer spacer and
G-81322. Use only Aero Shell No. 5 or wheel retaining nut to permit free rota-
one of the other greases; do not mix. tion of the wheel
32-40-00
Page 4
Nov 16/94 A17
Beechc~ft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
c. Install the brake cylinder assembly by inserting b. Visually inspect bearing cups and cones for nicks,
the two guide pins into the torque plate. scratches, water staining, galling, heat discoloration,
roller wear, cage damage, and cracks or distortion.
NOTE
Replace if damaged or worn.
If the torque plate has been removed, it
should be reinstalled so that the guide c. Inspect the wheel bearing grease for contamina-
pin holes are positioned aft and centered tion and solidification at each periodic maintenance
above and below the horizontal center- inspection.
line of the axle. The torque plate nuts d. Inspect wheel halves for cracks, corrosion, and
are to be torqued to 100 to 140 inch- other damage. Cracked or badly corroded castings
pounds. should be replaced. Small nicks, scratches, or pits can
d. Torquetheaxle nutasfollows: be blended out using fine (400-grit) sandpaper.
1. Check for burrs rough threads on the axle
or e. Inspect the snap rings and grease seals for dete-
and retaining nut.Apply bearing grease to the axle rioration and wear; replace if damaged or deformed.
threads and the bearing surface of the nut. Lightly saturate felt seals with 10W30 oil (remove
2. While rotating the wheel, tighten the axle excess by pressing lightly). Coat the sides and outer
retaining nut to 180 to 240 inch-pounds to ensure that diameter with the same type grease as that used on
3. Back off the axle retaining nut to zero torque. f´• Inspect bearing cups and cones for looseness,
the
4.Retighten the nut with fingers to remove end scratches, pitting, corrosion, or evidence of overheat-
play in the
bearings, ing. Coat the cups and cones with bearing grease.
5. Torque the axle retaining nut to the next key-
Repack with either Aero Shell No. 5 grease or other
greases per MIL-G-81322 (46, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
ing position and install the cotter pin.
e. Bleed the brake system if necessary,
NOSE WHEEL INSPECTION AND g. Inspect the wheel bolts for cracks, corrosion or
32-40-00
Page 5
A17 Nov 16/94
Qeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1. Check for burrs or rough threads on the axle c. Disconnect the two brake hydraulic lines at each
and retaining nut. Apply bearing grease to the axle master cylinder and mark the lines to assure correct
threads and bearing surface of the nut. reinstallation.
2. While rotating the wheel, tighten the axle d. Remove the master cylinder attaching bolts and
retaining nut to 150 200 inch-pounds to insure that nuts and remove the master cylinder.
the bearings are properly seated.
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
3. Back off the axle retaining nut to zero torque.
INSTALLATION
4. While rotating the wheel, retorque the axle
retaining nut to 30 inch-pounds and check for align- a´• Place the cylinder in position beneath the brake
ment of the locking holes. pedal and install the attaching bolts and nuts.
If not at b´• Connect the two hydraulic lines to the cylinder.
5. a locking position, continue tightening
the axle nut to the first The inlet port is the upper port.
locking locking position and
install the cotter pin. c. Replenish the hydraulic fluid and bleed the brake
system.
RELINING THE BRAKES
d. Install the floorboard and floor mat.
Remove the four bolts that attach the the best adjustment since it will prevent the pedals
a. backplate
to the cylinder assembly,
from hitting the firewall in their extreme forward posi-
assembly
tion. Linkage adjustment is obtained by removing the
NOTE clevis from the rudder pedal and turning the clevis on
or off the piston rod as required. After both pistons are
The hydraulic brake line does not have
to be disconnected to remove the brake adjusted to the same length, tighten the jam nuts.
linings. BRAKE MASTER CYL~NDER
b. Remove the backplate assemblies from the DISASSEMBL Y
inboard side of the brake disc and seperate the pres-
sure plate assembly from the cylinder assembly.
(Figure 2)
a. Remove the snap ring (1) and pull the assembled
c. Place the backplate assembly on a table with the
piston out of the brake cylinder (2).
lining facing down and punch or-drill out the rivets that
attach the linings to the backplate. b. Remove the clevis (3) from the piston (14) and the
d. The
check nut (4); this will free the washer (5), piston
linings on the pressure plate may be removed
guide bushing (6), retainer O-ring (7) and the rear seat
by using the same procedure as used on the back-
washer (8) from the piston (14).
plate.
Place the
c. Remove the cotter pin (9) from the collar (1 0) and
e. new \inings on the backplate and install the collar from the
the rivets. Set the rivets with the
pull piston.
punch until the lining
is firmly against the backplate. d. Remove the cotter pin (11) from the plunger end
of piston to free the flow lock piston (12). The return
f. The rivets on the pressure plate may be set by
spring (13) will fall free of the cylinder with the piston
using the same procedure as used on the backplate. removed.
32-40-00
Page 6
Nov 16/94 A17
QeechcraR
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
reassembly. Lubricate all parts with MIL-H-5606 b. Remove the floorboards forward of the pilots
hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00) prior to assem- seats.
bly. Reassemble the cylinder. c. Loosen the set screw in the cable attach fitting
through the piston and the flow lock piston. cable attach fitting, tighten and safety wire the set
Remove the attach bolts, and the valve. c. Remove the cam lever assembly (4) by grasping
a. remove
the lever and rotating the cam lever assembly counter-
PARKING BRAKE VALVE INSTALLATION clockwise while pulling outward to prevent scoring of
the cam lever assembly surface.
a. Place the parking brake valve in position under
the floorboards, forward of the pilot’s and copilot’s PARKING BRAKE CLEANING AND PARTS
seats. Install the attach bolts.
REPLACEMENT
b. Connect the hydraulic lines to the same ports from
Clean all parts with PD680 Solvent (16, Chart 1,
which they were removed.
91-00-00). Check all parts foy cracks, corrosion, dis-
c. Connect the parking brake cable. Adjust the park- tortion and wear. Replace all washers and seals at
ing brake as covered in PARKING BRAKE ADJUST-
reassembly. Lubricate all parts with hydraulic fluid (9,
MENT in this chapter.
Chart 1,91-00-00) prior to assembly. Reassemble the
d. Bleedthe brakesystem. parking brake valve.
e. Install the floorboards forward of the pilot’s-and
PARKING BRAKE VALVE ASSEMBLY
copilot’s seats.
a. Install the cam lever (4) with the new O-rings (9)
PARKING BRAKE ADJUSTMENT
by grasping the lever and rotating clockwise while
a. Place the parking brake control in the OFF (valve pushing inward to prevent scoring of the cam lever
OPEN) position. assembly surface
32-40-00
Page 7
A17 Nov 16/94
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE NiANUAL
b. Connect the retaining ring (10), to the end of the Use only MIL-H-5606 hydraulic fluid (9, Chart 1,
cam lever assembly (4). 91-00-00) in the brake system, and ensure that no dirt
Install the or foreign matter is allowed to get into the brake sys-
c. pin (3), seal (2), O-ring (8), steel ball
tem. Dirt under seals results in leaks or clogging of the
(6), and spring (1) in each of the two side-by-side fit-
ting orifices on the valve body. Install an O-ring (7), on c0mpensating ports in the master cylinders resulting
each fitting (13), and install the fittings. in brake locking. Beech Aircraft recommends the use
of a pressure pot for bleeding the brakes. If the pres-
BLEEDING THE BRAKE SYSTEM sure pot bleeding method is not available, electric
16 14 12
7 10 2
456
:1 7. RETAINER O-RING
9. COTTER PIN
3 1 15 8
10. COLLAR
i. SNAP RING 11. COTTER PIN
2. CYLINDER 12. FLOW LOCK PISTON
3. CLEVIS 13. RETURN SPRING
4. CHECK NUT 14. PISTON
5. WASHER 15. O-RING
6. PISTON GUIDE BUSHING 16. VALVE SPRING
32-40-00
Page 8
Nov 16/94 A17
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I WARNING
WUIIING I c.
.mpedal
etsy
Hold the
sdna
depressed position
in the
close the bleeder port at the brake assembly.
Whenever the brakes are to be d. Release the brake pedal.
released, make sure the airplane is on e. Repeat steps a through d until no more bubbles
level ground and the wheels are
appear in the drained fluid.
checked.
f. Open the bleeder port of the brake assembly on
This method of is done from the master cyl-
bleeding the other landing gear and repeat steps b through e.
inder down to the brake assembly. The brake fluid
reservoir must be kept full during the bleeding opera- NOTE
tion. Since the pilot’s and copilot’s master cylinders On serials prior to CE-839, CJ-150,
are plumbed in series (except on EA-1 and EA-2), the D-10209, E-1432 and EA-3, the copilot’s
entire system is bled by operating the pilot’s brake master cylinder will have to be bled
pedals in the following manner: separately. Repeat steps a through f for
the copilot’s brakes.
NOTE
g. Tighten the bleeder ports of the brake assemblies.
Make provision for catching the drained
hydraulic fluid.
h. Check the brake reservoir fluid level and add
a. Open the bleeder port of the brake assembly on hydraulic fluid MIL-H-5606 (9, Chart 1, 91-00-00) as
u: 1
1. Spring
2. Seal
3. Pin
4. Cam Lever Assembly
5. Valve Body
6. Steel Ball
7. O-Ring
8 1 1 8. O-Ring
2 )4 _9
9. O-Ring
G~ 11 10. Retaining Ring
Roll Pin
,11. 13. Fitting
502211~
32-40-00
Page 9
TO BRAKE
11~2
TO BRAKE
i. RESERVOIR
2. SHUTTLE VALVE
3..PARKING BRAKE VALVE
4. MASTER CYUNDER C93EA32B00tl
32-40-00
Page 10
Nov 16/94 A17
aeechcraR
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i 1
i
35´•219-24
32-40-00
Page 11
i. Check the brakes for proper operation. When the k. Remove the bleeder hose from each landing gear.
brake pedals are depressed, there must be no spongy i. Close the bleeder port of each brake assembly.
feeling and the pedal pressure equal on both brakes.
m. Connect the fluid reservoir supply line to the res-
p. Check the
operation of the brakes. There must be
Whenever the brakes are to be no soft spongy feeling at the brake pedals and the
or
released, make sure the airplane is on pedal pressure must be equal on both brakes.
level ground and the wheels are
checked. ELECTRIC BLEEDING
The hookup for electric bleeding is nearly the same as
Pressure bleeding
is the most efficient method of
pressure pot bleeding except the pressure pot bleeder
bleeding the brakes. This procedure involves attach-
is replaced with an electric bleeder (refer to Figure 1).
ing pressure pot
a to the brake assembly bleeder port
and back bleeding the system to the fluid reservoir.
c. Disconnect the fluid supply line from the reservoir, Whenever the brakes are to be
and attach a hose to the supply line, released, make sore the airplane Is on
level ground and the wheels are
d. Place the end of the hose in a clean container to chacked.
collect the brake fluid overflow.
a. Remove the cap from the brake fluid reservoir.
e. Open the bleeder port of each brake assembly, b. Remove the brake fluid from the reservoir.
f. Install
bleeder hose
a (shown in Figure 1) onto
c. Disconnect the fluid line from the reservoir,
supply
each brake bleeder port,
and attach the electric bleeder fluid return line to the
g. Connect the bleeder hose assemblies (shown in
supply line.
Figure 1) to the pressure lines of the pressure pot.
d. Open the bleeder port of each brake assembly.
NOTE _
e. Connect the infusion line on the electric bleeder to
On serials each brake bleeder port (Figure 1).
prior to CE-839, CJ-150,
D-10209, E-1432 and EA-3 (airplanes NOTE
with shuttle valves in the brake system)
depress the pilot’s brake pedals to actu- On serials prior to CE-839, CJ-150,
ate the shuttle valve to bleed the pilot’s D-10209, E-1432 and EA-3 (airplanes
brakes, then proceed through step j. with shuttle valves in the brake system)
After the pilot’s brakes are bled, depress depress the pilot’s brake pedals to actu-
the copilot’s brake pedals to actuate the ate the shuttle valve to bleed the pilot’s
shuttle valve to bleed the copilot’s brakes, then proceed through step h.
brakes and follow steps g through j. After the pilot’s brakes are bled, depress
the copilot’s brake pedals to actuate the
h. Apply a constant pressure of not more than 30 shuttle valve to bleed the copilot’s
pounds to the pressure pot. Open the pressure pot brakes and follow steps f through i.
control valve.
f. Activate the bleeder and set the relief valve to
i. Bleed the system until the draining fluid is free of
bubbles.
approximately 15 pounds; this may be ascertained by
observing the pressure gage prior to opening the elec-
j. Close the pressure pot valve. tric bleeder control valve.
32-40-00
Page 12
Nov 16/94 A17
aeechcraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g. Open the electric bleeder control valve and j. Disconnect the fluid return line from the brake fluid
observe the returning fluid through the in-line sight reservoir supply line.
glass.
k. Connect the fluid reservoir supply line to the res-
NOTE ervoir.
Pumping the pilot’s and copilot’s pedals i. Check the brake fluid level and add MIL-H-5606
during the bleeding process may help to hydraulic fluid (9. Chart 1, 91-00-00) as required to
dislodge any air bubbles trapped in the obtain a full reading
master cylinders.
h. When the returning fluid shows no further evi-
m´• I"stallthecaponthe reservoir.
dance of air bubbles, close the electric bleeder control n. Check the operation of the brakes. When the
valve, brake pedals are depressed there should be no
i. Disconnect the fluid infusion line from the bleeder spongy feeling and the pedal pressure should be
port. Close the bleeder port valves, equal on both brakes.
32-40-00
Page 13
A17 Nov 16/94
~eechrraft
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
STEERING MAINTENANCE PRACTICES b. Turn the nose wheel to the extreme left turn posi-
tion: the adjustment bolts must be clear of the stops
The nose wheel should be parallel to the fore and aft
with the nose wheel in this position.
centerline of the airplane with the rudder
pedals in the
neutral position. Loosen the nose gear steering act- c. Place tape around the aft end of the shimmy
uator arm at the aft end and screw the end fitting
damper piston rod at a point 1/32 to 114 inch from the
either in or out to make the adjustment,
scraper ring.
NOSE WHEEL TRAVEL STOP d. Turn the locknuts on the adjustment bolts so that
ADJUSTMENT the nose wheel is turned and the tape on the piston
rodjust contacts the scraper ring. Tighten the locknuts
The travel stop must be adjusted so that the nose
securely.
wheel travel is stopped when the shimmy damper is
1/32 to 114 inch from its maximum travel. e. Repeat preceding steps b, c and d, except turn
the nose wheel to the extreme right, and place the
If adjustment is required, the following procedure is
tape on the forward end of the piston rod.
recommended:
32-50-00
Page 1
A17 Nov 16/94
Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The landing gear position lights are mounted on the right subpanel on early serial number airplanes. On airplane
serials E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, and EA-389 and After, the landing gear position lights were
I
moved to the left side of the pilot’s subpanel. Three green lights, one for each gear, are illuminated whenever the
landing gear is down and locked. The red light illuminates any time any portion of the landing gear is in transit or at
any intermediate position. All of the lights will be extinguished when the landing gear is up and locked.
The landing gear position lights on the instrument panel are operated by the up-indicator switches and
down-indicator switches on each gear.
Before making the following adjustments, place the airplane on jacks instructed in Chapter 7-00-00, LIFTING
I
as
AND SHORING MAINTENANCE PRACTICES.
MAIN GEAR
With the landing gear down and locked, adjust the downswitch, located on the forward side of the main gear V-brace,
sothat the overtravel of the switch plunger is 0.05 in. after the switch is actuated to the ON position. With the landing I
gear in fully up position, adjust the up-switch, located inboard of the fon~vard side of the main landing gear V-brace,
that the overtravel of the switch plunger is 0.05 in, after the switch is actuated to the ON position.
so
I
NOSE GEAR
With the landing gear down and locked, adjust the down-switch, located on the right hand side of the wheel well, so
that the overtravel of the switch plunger is 0.05 in. after the switch is actuated to the ON position. With the landing
I
gear in the up position, adjust the upswitch, located on the right-hand side of the wheel well, so that the
fully
overtravel of the switch plunger is 0.05 in. after the switch is actuated to the ON position. Check the instrument panel
I
to be sure the indicator lights correspond to the landing gear position.
Recheck the switch adjustment and remove the airplane from the jacks.
NOTE
The following steps must be made by pulling the throttle control back. Incorrect settings may occur
if the throttle control is pushed fonnrard to check the switch adjustment.
If the altitude referenced in the following step cannot be obtained, use Table 1 for alternate altitude settings.
a. With the airplane in flight at 100 to 110 knots with 3,000 100 ft of pressure altitude (5,000 100 ft pressure I
altitude with the propeller at 2,400 rpm on EA serials) and the landing gear retracted, retard the throttle to obtain
12 ~1 in. of Hg in manifold pressure (15 ~1 in. of Hg on EA serials). The landing-gear-up warning horn should I
sound at this manifold pressure, but not before.
b. If the horn did not sound under the conditions established in Step a., measure and note the distance from the I
throttle to the subpanel.
I e. and locate the gear warning (throttle) switch. Referto the Chapter 32-30-00 LANDING
Open the engine cowling
GEAR SAFETY SYSTEM AND THROTTLE WARNING HORN MICROSWITCH illustration in the Landing Gear
Safety System Maintenance and Adjustment section.
f. Loosen the upper switch bracket and slide the bracket until the gear warning switch closes as indicated by a
clicking sound.
I h. Repeat Step a. to check the warning horn adjustment. If the adjustment is incorrect, repeat Steps a. thru g..
i. Working with the throttle control, check that the switch actuator roller rides up smoothly on the throttle control
actuator and operates without catching or hanging on the tapered end. Readjust if the switch roller hangs up or
does not operate smoothly during the throttle control movement from idle to full power travel. Ensure full th rottle
travel and ease of movement.
NOTE
The landing gear retract-prevent switch may be checked and/or adjusted at the same time the
landing gear warning switch is being adjusted because of the similarity of the adjustment.
Accomplish the instructions under the ENGINE-COMPARTMENT-LOCATED
RETRACT-PREVENT SWITCH ADJUSTMENT heading.
I b. Inspect the landing gear warning switch for proper installation (Ref. Figure 1). The switch plunger is NOT to be
under the dimple in the switch actuator arm.
d. Inspect the plunger and switch actuator arm. The switch plunger should be touching the switch actuator
switch
arm. If the switch plunger and the switch actuator arm are not touching, mark the position of the upper switch
I bracket on the throttle control housing. Remove the switch actuator assembly from the upper switch bracket and
bend the switch actuator arm so that, when installed, the switch actuator arm will be touching the switch plunger.
I e. If removed, return the upper switch bracket to the position noted in Step d..
NOTE
The following checks must be made by pulling the throttle control back. Incorrect settings may occur
if the throttle control is pushed forward to check the switch adjustment.
If the altitude referenced in the following step cannot be obtained, use Table 1 for alternate altitude settings.
2
Sep 30/ Page 32-60-00
Ray~h´•on AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE 1
ALTITUDE COMPENSATION
f. With the at 100 to 110 knots with 3,000 ft pressure altitude and the landing gear retracted, retard
airplane flying
the throttle to obtain manifold pressure of 12
a 1 in, of Hg. The landing-gear-up warning horn should sound I
and the annunciator light should flash at and below this manifold pressure, but not above it.
g. If the switch adjustment is wrong, retard the throttle to obtain 12 1 in. of Hg manifold pressure. I
h. Measure and note the distance from the subpanel to the throttle control.
NOTE
The landing-gear-up warning horn will sound and the GEAR UP warning annunciator light will flash
at full flaps with the landing gear in the up position.
k. Open the engine cowling and locate the warning switch (Ref. Figure 1). I
i. Loosen the upper switch bracket and slide the bracket until the switch closes as indicated by a clicking sound.
n. Working with the throttle control, check that the switch actuator roller rides up smoothly on the throttle control
actuator and operates without catching or hanging up on the tapered end. Readjust if the switch roller hangs up I
or does not operate smoothly during the throttle control movement from idle to full power. Ensure full throttle
travel and ease of movement.
3
32-60-00 Sep 30/03Page
Ray~bdOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
p. Repeat the flight check of the switch setting at the airspeed and altitude of the first check. The landing gear
warning horn should sound and the gear warning annunciator light on the instrument panel should flash at
settings below the manifold pressure being used to adjust the switch. If necessary, readjust the switch as
previously instructed.
PEDESTAL-LOCA TED L4NDING GEAR WARNING SWITCH ADJUSTMENT (E- 1946, E-2 1 04,
E-2111 AND AFTER; EA-320, EA-389 AND AFTER)
NOTE
The landing gear warning switch may be checked and/or adjusted at the same time as the landing
gear retract-prevent switch because of the similarity of the adjustment. Perform the
PEDESTAL-LOCATED LANDING GEAR RETRACT-PREVENT SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
I procedures.
The following checks must be made by pulling the throttle control back. Incorrect settings may occur
if the throttle control is pushed forward to check the switch adjustment.
If the altitude referenced in the following steps cannot be obtained, refer to TABLE 1, ALTITUDE COMPENSATION.
I a. With the
the
airplane flying at 100 to 110 knots with 3,000 ft pressure altitude (5,000 ~t 100 ft pressure altitude with
propeller at 2,400 rpm on serials EA-320, EA-389 and After) and the landing gear retracted, retard the
throttle to obtain 12 1 in. of Hg manifold pressure (15 ~t 1 in. of Hg on serials EA-320, EA-389 and After). The
landing gear up warning horn should sound (the gear warning annunciator light should flash also on serials
1 E-2458, E-2468 and After and EA-488 and After) at and below this manifold pressure. Mark this throttle position
on the pedestal.
On serials E-2761 and After, advance the throttle to above 13 in. Hg (above 16 in. Hg on serials EA-320, EA-389
I" and After). Lower the flaps to fully down and the warning horn should sound and GEAR UP annunciator light
should flash.
c. After landing the airplane and shutting down the engine, set the throttle at the position marked on the pedestal
in Step a..
e. Loosen the retaining nuts on the cam located on the end of the actuator rod arm for the landing gear warning
I switch (Ref. Figure 2).
f. Adjust the cam so that the switch closes, indicated by a click, with the throttle control at the top position noted
I in Step a..
I j. Repeat the check of the switch setting at the airspeed and altitude stated in Step a.. If necessary, readjust the
switch as previously instructed.
INCORRECT
CONFIGURATION\ _--~- DIMPLE IN ARM
ROLLER
SWITCH
ACTUATOR ARM ‘SWITCH PLUNGER
CORRECT
CONFIGURATION
SWITCH
DIMPLE IN ARM
ROLLER
SWITCH
THROTTLE
DETAIL A
CONTROL HOUSING TYPICAL FOR BOTH SWITCHES
UPPER SWITCH
(GEAR WARNINGI
O
LOWER
SWITCH BRACKET
O
ACTUATOR
//e
(RETRACT-PREVENT)
5
A24
32-60-00 Sep 30/03Page
RayiRec~ nircra~t Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
The landing gear warning switch may be checked and/or adjusted at the same time the landing gear
retract-prevent switch is being adjusted because of the similarity of the adjustment. Accomplish the
instructions under the ENGINE-COMPARTMENT-LOCATED LANDING GEAR WARNING
SWITCH ADJUSTMENT heading.
I b. Inspect the switch for proper installation (Ref. Figure 1). The switch plunger is NOT to be under the dimple in
the switch actuator arm.
d. Inspect the switch plunger and switch actuator arm. The switch plunger should be touching the switch actuator
arm. If the switch plunger and the switch actuator arm are not touching, mark the position of the lower switch
I bracket on the throttle control housing. Remove the switch actuator assembly from the lower switch bracket and
bend the switch actuator arm so that, when installed, the switch actuator arm will be touching the switch plunger.
I e. If removed, return the upper switch bracket to the position noted in Step d..
NOTE
The following checks must be made by pulling the throttle control back. Incorrect settings may occur
I If the altitude referenced in the following step cannot be obtained, refer to TABLE 2, ALTITUDE COMPENSATION.
f. With the airplane flying at 100 to 110 knots with 3,000 rt 100 feet of pressure altitude and the landing gear
extended, the landing gear must not retract at any manifold pressure below 17 1 in. of Hg. It is acceptable to
I initially check thisby advancing the throttle from a manifold pressure below 17 in. of Hg with the landing gear
down and the cockpit landing gear position switch in the up position.
I g. If the retract-prevent switch adjustment is wrong, retard the throttle control to obtain 17 ~t 1 in. of Hg manifold
pressure.
h. Measure and note the distance from the subpanel to the throttle control.
NOTE
There is alatching relay in the circuit which allows the landing gear to fully retract once retraction
starts. Retarding the throttle should not stop the landing gear in midtravel.
j. Open the engine cowling and locate the switch (Ref. Figure 1).
I k. Place the throttle at the distance from the subpanel measured in Step h..
I. Loosen the lower switch bracket and slide the bracket until the switch closes as indicated by a clicking sound.
Sep 32-60-00
Raylheon Aircraft company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
n. Working with the throttle control, check that the actuator roller for the retract-prevents switch rides up smoothly
on the throttle control actuator and operates without catching or hanging up on the tapered end (Ref. Figure 1). I
Readjust if the switch roller hangs updoes not operate smoothly
or during the throttle control travel from idle to
full power. Ensure full throttle travel and ease of movement.
o. Closethe enginecowling.
p. Repeat the flight check of the retract-prevent switch setting at the airspeed and altitude stated in Step f.. If I
necessary, readjust the switch as previously instructed.
LANDING GEAR
RETRACT-PREVENT
SWITCH CAM ROD
LANDING GEAR
RETRACT-PREVENT
SWITCH
LANDING GEAR WARNING
HORN AND ANNUNCIATOR
LIGHT SWITCH
OPTIONAL AIR
CONDITIONING
SWITCH
LANDING
GEAR RETRACT- C´•.~ Y~ Y/
PREVENT
SWITCH CAM
LANDING GEAR
WARNING HORN
AND LIGHT
SWITCH CAM
LOOKING
DOWN
33-1o8-002 C
TABLE 2
ALTITUDE COMPENSATION
1,000 ft 19 in. Hg
2,000 ft 16 in. Hg
3,000 ft 17 in. Hg
4,000 ft 16 in. Hg
5,000 ft 15 in. Hg
6,000 ft 14 in. Hg
7,000 ft 13 in. Hg
NOTE
The landing warning switch may be checked and/or adjusted at the same time as the landing
gear
Perform the
gear retract-prevent switch because of the similarity of the adjustment.
PEDESTAL-LOCATED LANDING GEAR WARNING SWITCH ADJUSTMENT procedures.
NOTE
The following checks must be made by pulling the throttle control back. Incorrect settings may occur
If the altitude referenced in the following steps cannot be obtained, refer to TABLE 2, ALTITUDE COMPENSATION.
a. With the airplane flying at 100 to 110 knots with 3,000 100 ft of pressure altitude (5,000 100 ft pressure
altitude with propeller at 2,400 rpm on serials EA-320, After) and the landing gear extended, the
EA-389 and
landing gear must not retract at or below a manifold pressure of 16 in. Hg. It is acceptable to initially check this
by advancing the throttle from a manifold pressure below 16 1 in. Hg with the landing gear down and the
landing gear position switch in the cockpit in the gear-up position.
b. Mark the position of the throttle control on the pedestal with the throttle retarded to the appropriate manifold
pressure.
NOTE
There is alatching relay in the circuit which allows the landing gear to fully retract once retraction
starts. Retarding the throttle should not stop the landing gear in midtravel.
9
32-60-00 Sep 30/03Page
RBYBCOn nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I d. Place the throttle control at the mark made on the pedestal in Step b..
e. Removethe pedestalsidecovers.
f. Loosen the retaining nuts on the cam located on the end of the actuator rod for the gear retract-prevent switch
I (Ref. Figure 2).
g. Adjust the cam so that the switch closes, indicated by a click, with the throttle control at the position noted in
I Step b..
h. Retightenthecam retainingnuts.
I k. Repeat the flight check of the switch setting at the airspeed and altitude stated in Step a.. If necessary, readjust
the switch as previously instructed.
Page
32’60-00 Pi24
CHAPTER
LIGHTS
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
INTERIOR 33-20-00
Maintenance Practices ..1
Instrument Post Light Bulb Removal ........1
instrument Post Light Bulb Installation ................._
............1
Instrument Wedge Light Tray Removal ............1
Instrument Wedge Light Tray Installation ............1
Electroluminescent Panel Removal ........._ ........._
............1
Electroluminescent Panel Installation ..............1
individual Warning and Position Light 8ulb Removal ............1
Warning and Position Light Bulb Removal (Landing Gear,
Alternator, and Baggage Door) ...........1
Warning and Position Light Bulb Installation (Landing Gear,
Alternator, and Baggage Door) ............1
Glareshield Floodlight Bulb Removal ..............1
Glareshield Floodlight Bulb Installation ............1
Passenger Reading Light Bulb Removal ............1
Passenger Reading Light Bulb Installation _
............1
Compass Light Bulb Removal .........,.2
Compass Light Bulb Installation ..................2
Trim Tab Light Bulb Removal ............2
Trim Tab Light Bulb Installation ............2
Courtesy Light Bulb Removal .....2
Courtesy Light Bulb Installation .....2
Map Light Bulb Removal ...........2
Map Light aulblnstailation ........2
Cabin Overhead Light Bulb Removal
(Prior to C-993, CJ-156, C-10347, 8-1783, EA-171) .....2
Cabin Overhead Light Bulb Installation
(Prior to CE-933, CJ-146, D-10347, E-1783, EA-171)............ ....2
Cabin Overhead Light Bulb Removal (CE-933and after,
CJ-156 and after,
D-10357 and after, E-1783 and after,
EA-171 and
after) ............2
Cabin Overhead Light Bulb Installation (CE-933 and after,
CJ-156 and after, D-10347 and after, E-1783 and after,
EA-171 and after) ............2
Cabin Overhead Light Bulb Removal ................2
Cabin Overhead Light Bulb Installation ............2
EXTERIOR.......................................................33-40-00
Description and Operation ..........1
Strobe
Lights ............1
Step Light Optional. ............1.
Troubleshooting Exterior Lights ´•2
Maintenance Practices ............3
Lights ............3
Power Supply Unit Removal ...........3
Power Supply Unit Installation ............3
33-CONTENTS
Page 1
S´•p 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 33 LIGHTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE
SUBJECT
"END"
33-CONTENTS
Page 2
Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINtENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 33
CHAPTER
SECTION
SU&IECt PACE DATE
"END"
1&EFFECTIVITY
Page 1
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINtENANCE MANUAL
INTERIOR MAINTENANCE PRACTICES separately. If the acrylic face panel or the printed circuit
board becomes damaged, the whole unit must be replaced.
INSTRUMENT POST LIGHT BULB REMOVAL
a. Remove the attaching screws located on each
Individual post lights, located adjacent to the instruments on side of the face panel.
the instrument panel may have bulbs removed as follows: b. Disconnect the wiring running from the printed
circuit board at the splice.
a. Pull the light shield from the post light assembly. c. Pull the assembly from the subpanel.
b. Remove the bulb from the post light assembly.
ELECTROLUMINESCENT PANEL INSTALLA TION
INSTRUMENT POST LIGHT BULB INSTALLATION a. Reconnect the wiring at the splice.
b. Place the panel assembly in place in the subpanel
a. Install the bulb in the post light assembly. and secure it with the attaching screws.
a. Remove the screws that secure the instrument a. Replace the bulb in the light assembly.
panel in place and tilt the instrument panel aft to gain b. Install the light shield on the light assembly.
access to the instruments.
b. Remove the screws that attach the light tray to the a. Replace the bulb in the light assembly.
instrument bezel. b. Install the glareshield and secure with the attach
screws.
a. Install the new light tray and secure in place with b. Remove the bulb.
the attach screws.
Three electroluminescent panels provide lighting for the a. Replace the bulb in the light assembly.
instrument subpanel. The electroluminescent
lamp is an b. Install the aluminum light cover on the light
integral part of the finished panel and cannot be replaced assembly.
33-20-00
Page 1
May 9180
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Replace the bulb in thelight assembly. CABIN OVERHEAD LIGHT BULB INSTALLATION
b. Instsll the light assembly into the instrument (Prior to CE-933, CJ-156, 0-10357, E-1783, EA-171) I
panel.
a. Replace the bulb in the light assembly.
b. Reinstall the overhead panel assembly.
COURTESY LIGHT BULB REMOVAL c. Reinstall the fresh air vents and vent knob.
"END"
33-20-00
Pagd2
Jan 28/81
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SEAIES
MAIMENANCE MANUAL
EXTERIOR DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION sufficiently, the lamp will go out while the capacitor begins
recharging for the next cycle.
STF~OBE LIGHTS
Flashing strobe lights are mounted on each wing tip and are STEP LIGHT OPTIONAL
available on the tail The system is activated by a
cone.
circuit breaker switch mounted on the instrument subpanel. On serials E-2104, E-2111, and after; and EA-320, EA-389
The strobe lights are powered by a power supply unit and after,a step light may be mounted in the fuselage just
located in the baggage compartment. A transistorized circuit forward of the step and aft of the right wing trailing edge.
in the power supply unit steps up the voltage of the airplane The switch is mounted in the top of the forward door frame.
electrical system to the level (approximately 400 volts) In some installations, the aft door ajar switch will activate
required to operate the strobe lights. The stepped-up- the step light as well as perform its annunciator function.
voltage is stored in a capacitor until released to the strobe The timer is located on the forward side of the forward spar
lights. The current from the power supply unit is conducted carry through, and the five amp fuse is located on the right
to the flashtube of the strobe light by a specially shielded side forward of the firewall.
33´•40-00
Pagel
Ag Sgp 271%]4
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAIMENA#CE MANUAL
TROUBLESHOOTING
EXTERIOR LIGHTS
STROBE LIGHTS
1. Lights inoperative. a. Circuit breaker tripped. a. Check for short circuit. Reset circuit
breaker.
2. One bulb does not light. a. Bulb burned out. a. Replace bulb.’
TAIL LIGHT, TAIL NAV/STROBE LIGHT, LANDING LIGHT, AND TAXI LIGHT
light. Circuit breaker switch tripped. Check for short circuit. Reset circuit
1. Lamp fails to a. a.
breaker.
3340-00
PageP
A9
Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CA UTION
POWER SUPPLY UNIT REMOVAL
An incorrecthook-up of the wires in either the
CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; 0-10097, D- power input or between the strobe light
10120 and after; E-llll, E-1241 to E-1370 assemblies and the power supply will cause a
reversal of polarity that results in serious
component damage and failure. Care must be
taken to ensure that the red wire is connected to
WARNING positive power and the black wire is
connected ground. Make sure that the
to
High voltage is involved in the circuit between connectors are properly assembled and that
the power supply and strobe light assemblies. whiteired, white/black, and whiteiyellow wires
Although a bleed-off resistor is incorporated in are connected properly. The shields for the wing
the power supply circuit, turn the control switch and tail light cables should be grounded to the
far the strobe lights OFF and allow at least 10 airplane structure at the power supply. Refer to
minutes to elapse prior to disconnecting the the WIRING DIAGRAM MANUAL PIN 35-
cables at the power supply or strobe light 59()102-9 to ensure a correct hook-up of the
assemblies and before handling either of these components in the strobe light system.
units in any way. Failure to observe these
precautions may result in physical injury from a. Position the power supply unit in the airplane and
electrical shock. secure with the screws, washers, and nuts.
b. Connect the electrical wiring to the power supply.
c. Install the floorboard on the RH side of the
a. Remove the floorboard on the RH side of the baggage compartment.
baggage compartment.
b. Disconnect the electrical wiring to the power E´•1371 and aftec EA-I and after
supply.
c. Remove the screws, washers, and nuts anchoring a. Place the power supply in its proper location and
the module to the support structure. install the screws which hold it in place.
d. Remove the power supply from the airplane, b. Connect the electrical wiring to the power supply
adhering to the caution indicated for the above earlier
E- 1371 and after; EA-I and after serializations.
c. Place the access cover in place and install the
screws and washers.
d, Reinstall the carpet.
WARNING
WING STROBE LIGHT REMOVAL
Observe the warning precautions given in the
removal instructions for the earlier WARNING
serializations.
High voltage is involved in the circuit between
the power supply and strobe light assemblies.
a. Locate the access cover in the floorboard, aft of Although a bleed-off resistor is incorporated in
fuselage station 170, on the right side of the airplane, in the the power supply circuit, turn the control switch
baggage compartment. for the strobe lights OFF and allow at least 10
b. Remove the 4 screws and washers from the cover minutes to elapse prior to disconnecting the
and remove the cover, cables at the power supply or strobe light
c. Disconnect the electrical wiring from the power assemblies and before handling either of these
33-40-00
Page 3
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Remove the transparent´•shield covering the wing retainer and remove the retainer.
tip lights. c. Rotate the bulb counterclockwise to remove.
e. Remove the clear filter cover from the strobe light c. Install the transparent shield and secure with
housing assembly, screws.
NOTE N()TE
Place a clean cloth around the flashtube to keep Before installing the transparent shield on the
fingers from coming in,contact with the glass. wing, apply Presstite 176 sealer around the
shield to ensure moisture cannot enter the light
compartment.
f. Carefully remove the flashtube from the contact
assemblies.
TAIL STROBEINAV LIGHT REMOVAL
WING STROBE LIGHT INSTALLATION
WARNING
CAUTION
High voltage is involved in the circuit between
Observe the caution procedure stated in the power supply and strobe light assemblies.
POWER SUPPLY UNIT INSTALLATION in this Although a bleed-off resistor is incorporated in
chapter. the power supply circuit, turn the control switch
for the strobe lights OFF and allow at least 10
minutes to elapse prior to disconnecting the
a. Replace the flashtube if necessary. cables at the power supply or strobe light
assemblies and before handling either of these
units in any way’. F.ilure to observe these
NOTE precautions may resu t in physical injury from
electrical shock.
Place a clean cloth around the flashtube to keep
fingers from coming in contact with the glass.
a. Remove the tail :one and light shield to gain
bracket on the strobe light housing and secure with the the bulb if it needs to be replaced.
screws and nuts. d. If the flashtube assembly needs replacement,
d. Reconnect the wiring and secure the strobe light remove the screws on the backside of the
light assembly
assembly to the airplane with the alien head screws, and remove the light assembly from the tail cone.
e. Reattach the transparent shield to the wing tip.
TAIL STROBE/NAV LIGHT INSTALLATION
WING NAVIGATION LIGHT REMOVAL
a. Replace the flashtube assembly and secure to the
a. Remove the attaching screws from the tail cone with the screws in the backside of the light
transparent shield and remove from the wing tip. assembly.
b. Remove the screw from the navigation light bulb b. Replace the bulb if necessary.
33-40-00
Page4
A9
Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TAIL NAVIGATION LIGHT REMOVAL c. Reconnect the wiring to the back of the light and
secure with screws.
a. Remove the outer light shield to gain access to d. Install the light assembly on the lower portion of
the bulb. the nose bug and secure with screws.
TAIL NAVIGATION LIGHT INSTALLATION a. Remove the screw from the lens retaining clanlp.
Remove the lens.
a. Replace the bulb in the holder. b. Remove the bulb by rotating counterclockwise.
b. Place the inner bulb shield over the bulb.
c. Reinstall the outer light shield on the tail cone. UPPER ROTATING BEACON INSTALLATION
33-40-00
Page5
A9 Sep 27184
BEECHCRAFT
8084824 SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHART 1
LIGHT BULB REPLACEMENT
(P10097, 0-10120 and after; CE-748, (E1946, E-2104, E-2111 and atter;
CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; EA-320, EA-389 and after)
E-llll, E1241 through E-2110 except
E-1946 and E-2104; EA-1 through EA-388 except EA-320)
"END"
33-40-00
PageG
Sep 27184 69
CHAPTER
NAVIGATION
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
34-1 0-00
Pitot System
AirSystem
Normal Static ´•1
34-40-00
Weather Radar
Radar Antenna Removal ......1
34-CONTENTS . ~:Pagel
RayYheon AiKlaft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1
A25
34-LOEP Mar 31/04Page
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
PITOTSYSTEM
The pitot system provides a source of impact air for operation of the airspeed indicator. The pitot mast is located
under the leading edge of the left wing outboard of WS 122.75 on serials D-10097, D-10120 and After; CE-748,
CE-772 and After; CJ-1149 and After; E-llll, E-1241 thru E-1370. At serials E-1371 and After; EA-11 and After
the pitot mast is located outboard of WS 191.0. The pitot head is provided with an electric heating element which is
turned on and off with a switch on the instrument panel. The switch should be on when flying in visible moisture. It
is not advisable to operate the pitot heating element on the ground except for testing or for short intervals of time to
remove ice and snow (Ref. Figures 1 and 2). 1
NORMAL STA TIC AIR SYSTEM
The normal static system provides a source of static air to the flight instruments through a flush static fitting on each
side of the airplane aft fuselage. On airplanes D-10097, D-10120 and After; CE-748, CE-772 and After; CJ-1149
and After; E-llll, E-1241 thru E-1370, aft of the rear closure bulkhead (rear seat panel) is a drain line, located at
the low point of the static system. On E-1371 and After; EA-11 and After the drain is located under the airplane below
the front edge of the pilot’s side window (aft of FS 58). The drain may be accessed through the fuel strainer access
door. They are provided to drain moisture accumulations from the system. The drain plug should be removed and
the moisture drained from the plastic line every 100 hours and/or after exposure to visible moisture or sand and dust,
either in the air or on the ground.
An optional emergency static source may be installed to provide air for instrument operation, should the static ports
become clogged. The emergency static control valve is located on the left side panel below the instrument subpanel
at approximately FS 65. The static air control valve is a two-position valve with both OFF NORMAL and an ON
EMERGENCY position. The valve handle is red in color and operation instructions are on a placard near the valve.
For further information regarding the emergency static air source system, refer to the respective pilots operating
handbook.
Chart 1
I Troubleshooting Pltot And Static Pressure System
INDICATION PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
2. Circuit breaker keeps tripping, a. Grounded wire. a. Remove ground from positive
lead.
3. Instruments inoperative or erratic a. Lines clogged. a. Open drain valve, allow lines to
in operation. drain. Disconnect the lines at the
instrument panel and blow out lines
with low air pressure.
Page
ra31104
M2 34-10-00 A25
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
A functional test of the pitot system can be made by using an observer in the cabin to watch the airspeed indicator
while air pressure is built up artificially by using a section of soft rubber tubing as follows:
a. Clamp the rubber tubing over the pitot head inlet, making certain that the connection is airtight.
CAUTION: To avoid rupturing the diaphragm of the airspeed indicator, roll up the rubber tubing slowly.
b. Crimp the end of the tubing and slowly roll it up until the airspeed indicator registers approximately 100 knots. I
c. Secure the rolled up tubing so that it will hold the airspeed reading.
d. If there is no decline in the reading after several minutes, there is no leak in the pitot system.
e. If a decline in the reading of the airspeed indicator is observed, check the pitot system plumbing for leaky hoses
and loose connections.
CAUTION: Flelease the air pressure slowly by unrolling the rubber tubing; a sudden release of the air pressure may
damage the airspeed indicator.
Before the pitot system is checked for leaks, the hose sections should be visually inspected for signs of deterioration.
There are two sections of hose in the pitot system: one hose at the pitot mast, accessible by removing the inspection
door adjacent to the mast, and the other hose behind the floating instrument panel which connects the pitot line to
theairspeed indicator, accessible through the access door in the left side of the firewall. Hoses that are cracked or
hardened should be replaced with rubber hose (14, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Anytime a hose is replaced, repeat the
PITOT SYSTEM PRESSURE CHECK. I
STA TIC SYSTEM CHECKS
Proper functioning of the static air system is vital to safety of flight, particularly on instrument flight. Correct
maintenance of the system should be performed as required.
The amount of attention required by the static system will depend largely on operating conditions. Extremes of
humidity or precipitation, or of dry, dusty conditions, should be signals for increased emphasis on static systems
check, since both are favorable to accumulations of foreign matter in the ports and lines.
CAUTION: Never blow air through the line toward the instrument panel; to do so will seriously damage the
instruments. When blowing back through the line from the instrument panel, make sure that no air is
blown into the instruments.
Blow LOW pressure air through the lines from the disconnected lines at the airspeed indicator, altimeter and vertical
speed indicator to the static ports. Cover each static port separately when blowing to insure that each line is clear.
Instrument error or possible damage could result if even one port is clogged with dirt or foreign matter.
34-1 0-00
RBy~heOn nircraft Company
BONANUI\ SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The static system, altimeter instrument, and all ATC transponders must be tested and inspected at twenty four
month intervals in compliance with the requirements specified in FAR Parts 91.170 and 91.177 under Title 14 of the
Code of Federal Regulations.
CAUTION: To avoid damaging the airspeed indicator, the indicator should be removed from the system and the
lines capped or an equal pressure should be applied to the pitot side of the indicator while leak testing
the system.
Check the hoses connecting the static air line to the instrument plumbing and the tygon tubing which forms the static
air line drain. Hoses which are cracked, particularly at the bends or connection points, or which have become hard,
The outside air temperature gage is mounted in the left side panel beneath the storm window. The pointer registers
on a dial calibrated in degrees over a range of -70 to +150"F (-50 to +60"C).
CAUTION: Tape the gage to the molding or have an assistant hold the gage to prevent it from falling.
b. When removing the gage, use care to avoid damaging the stem.
Inspect the sunshield for dents, plugged openings and any misalignment that would allow contact with the stem.
Inspect the nut and stem base for stripped or damaged threads. Inspect rubber washers for peeling, cracking and
resiliency. Inspect the index markings on the gage for legibility. Inspect the pointer for chipped or peeling paint.
Replace defective parts.
a. Install the mounting washer, boss and gage into the left side panel molding.
CAUTION: Tape the gage to the molding or have an assistant hold the gage to prevent it form falling.
Page
ra31104
M4 34-1 0-00 A25
Ray~hgOn AiKrait Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
OPTIONAL EMERGENCY
STATIC AIR SOURCE
PITOT LINE
Q
PITOT MAST AND HEAD
DETAIL A EA34B
034922FIR
OPTIONAL EMERGENCY
STATIC AIR SOURCE
0’
STATIC LINE
STATIC LINE DRAIN
ER34B
5
A25 34-1 0-00 Mar 31/04Page
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
INDEPENDENT POSITION DETERMINING antenna bay of all fuel fumes before the antenna comes
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION on.The special fiberglass covering of the radar antenna is
manufactured of three layers of 181 Volan, Epon 828 resin,
WEA THER RADAR Furane 951 hardener, Flex-T flexolizer. Any area of the
fiberglass through which the radar will either transmit or
The weather scout 1 consists primarily of two items: the receive should NOT be repaired.
indicator in the radio section of the instrument panel, and
the antenna in the outboard section of the right wing. INDEPENDENT POSITION DETERIWINING
There is also supporting equipment, such as a larger MAINTENANCE PRACTICES
capacity engine driven air pump, electrical wiring,
plumbing, etc. When the radar unit is turned on, there is a WEATHER RADAR
30 to 40 second warm-up period with the word WAIT
displayed on the screen. After WAIT disappears from the RADAR ANTENNA REMOVAL
screen, there is a delay approximately four minutes
of
before the radar will function. ~lt is required that ventilation a. Locate the antenna in the outboard leading edge
air be pumped through the antenna bay for approximately of the right wing.
4.5 minutes before the antenna will energize.) b. Remove the fiberglass antenna cover from the
wing leading edge.
c. Remove the four bolts (2 on each end) from the
WARNING antenna.
d. Pull the inboard end of the antenna forward untir
When the radar is on, personnel should not be the connectors on the outboard end are accessible.
within three feet of the radar antenna. This e. Disconnect the electrical connector, then
includes the complete 180" are in front of the disconnect the air line connector.
antenna. The eyes, reproductive and other vital f. Remove the antenna.
organs of the body are particularly vunerable to
radiation damage. RADAR ANTENNA INSTALLATION
34-40´•00
Pagel
Oct 10/86
BEECHCRAFT
BONAN;LA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
RADAR I I INSTRUMENT
INDICATOR I I I I AIR PUMP
STA. 66.00
POLYETHYLENE
TUBING AROUND
RADAR WIRE BUNDLE
g, VENT TUBE tz~--´• --mz~-- STA. 122.750
fs
38´•603-34
Radar Schematic
Figure 1
"END"
34-40-00
Page2
Oct 10180
C H A PT E R
O~YG EN
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 35 OXVCEN
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
GENERAL 35-00-00
Description and Operation ........1
Maintenance Practices ............2
Oxygen Low Pressure Test Procedure (D-10097, D-10120 and after;
CE-748, CE-772 and after, E-llll, E-1241 through E-2110
except E-1945 and E-2104; EA-1 through EA-388 except EA-320 .......2
Oyxgen High Pressure Test Procedure (D-10097, D-10129 and
after; CE-748, CE-772 and after, E-1111,E-1241 through
E-2110 Except E-1945 and E-2104; EA-1 through EA-388
except EA-320) ...........2
Oxygen Low Pressure Test Procedure (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111
and after; EA-320, EA-389 and after) ............2
Oxygen High Pressure Test Procedure (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111
and after; EA-320, EA-389 and after) ............2
Oxygen System Purging ........3
Oxygen Cylinder Removal (D-10097, D-10129 and after;
CE-748, CE-772 and after; E-l111, E-1241 through
E-2110 except E-1946 and E-2104; EA-1 through
EA-388 except EA-320) ..6
Oxygen Cylinder Installation (D-10097, 0-10120 and after;
CE-748, CE-772 and after, E-llll, E-1241 through
E-2110 except E-1946 and E-2104; EA-1 through
EA-388 except EA-320) ........6
Oxygen Cylinder Removal (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and after;
EA-320, EA-389 through EA-439) .........6
Oxygen Cylinder Installation (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and after;
EA-320, EA-389 through EA-439) ..6
Oxygen Cylinder Removal (EA-320, EA-440 and after) ...............7
Oxygen Cylinder Installation ~EA-320, EA-440 and after)........... ............7
Oxygen Control Cable Adjustment (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111
and after; EA-389through EA-439) :............7
Oxygen Control Cable Adjustment (EA-320, EA-440 and after) .........8
Oxygen Cylinder Retesting .......8
"END"
3S-CONTENTS
Page 1
S´•p 27/84
BEECHCRAR
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 35
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
SS-EFFECTIVITY
Page I
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAm
BONANZA SERIES
MAIMENANCE MANAUL
GENERAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION automatically dump the oxygen any time the cylinder
pressure reaches between 2500 and 2775 psi. There is an
The optional oxygen system in the Bonanza series airplanes indicator (placarded OXY, H.P. Relief) under each wing
(except EA-320, EA-440 and after) has an oxygen cylinder which will rupture any time the dump system is activated.
attached to the floor in front of the spar carry through. The
filler valve is attached to the spar cover below the copilots The shut-off valves(valve) are(is) controlled by a push-pull
seat. The oxygen console to the left of the pilot contains the knob (Figure 4) in the pilots subpanel. The oxygen pressure
pilot’s outletand the pressure gage. On some airplanes gage and pilots outlet are located in the pilots left side panel
~prior to E-2111, except E-1946, E-2104; and prior to EA- while the copilots outlet is located in the right side panel.
389 except EA-320), the oxygen console also contains a The five passenger outlets are located in the headliner near
shutoff valve and the pressure regulator mounted on the the center of the airplane. The oxygen masks for the pilot
back of the console. This system also has a shutoff valve (except on EA-320, EA-389, and after) and copilot are
mounted on the oxygen cylinder. On serials E-194f~ E- stowed in a box under their seats. At serials EA-320, EA-
2104, E-2111 and after; and EA-320, EA-389 and after, 389 and after, the mask for thepilot may be stowed in a
there is one cable operated shutoff valve mounted on the place he considers convenient. The third and fourth seat
oxygen cylinder. The push-pull knob for this shutoff valve is oxygen masks are stowed in a box attached either to the
in the subpanel below the pilot’s control column. On serials front or rear of the rear spar, depending on the seating
EA-320, EA-440 and after the oxygen filler valve, arrangement. The oxygen masks for the fifth and sixth seats
cylinder(s), shutoff valve(s), and regulator(s) are mounted in are stowed in a box attached to the bottom of their seats.
the wing(s) outboard of wing station 66. Access to the filler valve and pressure gage is gained by
removing the access panel located on top of the left wing aft
The oxygen system in the Bonanza Series airplanes may be of the main spat outboard of Wing Station 66. The access
equipped with oxygen outlets for either 3, 4, or 5 panel is held in place by six Dzus fasteners.
passengers and the pilot, On earlier airplanes the oxygen
outlets are all in the sidewalls of the airplane. On serials CE- A 49.8-cubic foot oxygen cylinder is the normal optional
919, CE-923, CE-925, CE-927, CE-929 and after; CJ-156 system on all Bonanza’s except EA-320, EA-J40 and after.
and after; 0-10348, 0-10353 and after; E-1422, E-1551, E- At serial E-1241 and after, and EA-2 through EA-388, a
1569, E-1581, E-1594 and after; EA-21, EA-28, EA-33 and 76.5-cubic foot optional cylinder is offered. At serials EA-
after, the oxygen outlets for the pilot and copilot are in the 320, EA-440 and after, either a ´•Qe-cubic foot or 98-cubic
sidewall, while the other outlets are in the headliner near the foot system is offered. The cylinder should be filled to a
center of the airplane. The oxygen masks for the pilot pressure of 1850 50 psi at temperature of 70 degrees F.
a
(except on E-1946, E-2104, E-2111, and after; EA-320, EA- This pressure may be increased 3.5 psi. for each degree of
389, and after) and the copilot are stowed in a box under temperature increase, or lowered 3.5 psi. for each degree of
their seats. At serials E-1946, E12104, E-2111, and after; temperature decrease. The pressure gage is connected
EA-320, EA-289, and after, the mask for the pilot may be directly to the oxygen cylinder and indicates the supply (psi.)
stowed in a place he considers convenient. The third and of oxygen available. The altitude compensated pressure
fourth seat oxygen masks are stowed in a box attached regulator limits system operation to above 8,000 feet, where
either to the front or rear of the rear spar, depending upon its sensing element meets increases in altitude with
the seating arrangement. The oxygen masks for the fifth increased oxygen flow. When the system is not in use, shut
and sixth seats are stowed in a box attached to the bottom off the control valve to prevent oxygen loss. For system
of their seats, servicing refer to Chapter 12.
Mounted on the end of each cylinder is the altitude valves slowly. Make sure the oxygen shut-off
compensating regulator, overboard dump, and the shut-off valve is in the closed position. Inspect the filler
valve. The cylinders are mounted in the wing aft of the main connection for cleanliness before attaching it to
spar outboard of wing station 66. The filler valve and a the filler valve. Keep tools, hands and
pressure gage are mounted in the top of the wing outboard components clean, as fire or explosion may
of wing station 66 and aft of the main spar. There is an occur when pure oxygen comes in contact with
ov’erboard dump system on each cylinder which will organic material such as grease or oil.
35-00-00
Paget
A9
Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
B0NAN2A SERIES
MAIMENANCE MANAUL
a. Check to make certain the system is charged to Keep fire, cigarettes and sparks away from the
1500 psi. or higher, vicinity of the oxygen cylinder. Hands, clothing
b. Make sure the shut-off valve on the oxygen and tools should be clean. Oil and grease will
console is turned off. ignite upon contact with pure oxygen under
c. Turn off the oxygen supply at the oxygen cylinder. pressure.
35-0090
PageP
Sep 27/84 A9
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANAUL
CENTER
SEATOUTLET
AFT SEAT OXYGEN
OVTLETS1~ ~T PRESSURE
GAGE
PILOT’S
OUTLET
PRESSURE REGULATOR
(BACK SIDE)
5;
OXYGEN
SHUT-OFF
VALVE
i
OXYGEN CY~INDER
COVER ASSEMBLY
CENTER SEAT
OUTLET
6,,p, C~i ~i
RH FRONT SEAT RECHARGE NOZZLE
OUTLET 36-452-1
35-00-00
p91ge3
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
NIAIMENANCE MANAUL
OXYGEN
PRESSUREPILOTS OUTLET
GAGE
OXYGEN
Is SHUTOFF
E-1946. E-2104. E-2111. and
after; EA-389 thru EA-439
VALVE
OXYGEN CYLINDER i)ETAIL E
COVER ASSEMBLY
C~
RECHARGE NOZZLE
MANIFOLD OUTLET
DETAIL A
DETAIL C
b
O
OUTLET
DETAIL B
TO PUSH-PULL
KNOB
Oxygen System (CE-glS, CE-923, CE-925, CE-92’1, CE-929 and after; CJ-158 and after;
0-10348, 0-10353 and after; 0-1422, 0-1551, 0-1589, 0-1581,
0-1594 and after; EA-21, EA-28, EA133 through EA-439 except EA-320)
Figure 2
35-OMK)
Page4
Sep 27/84 A9
BEECHCIRAA
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANAUL
GAGE
OVERBOARD
OVERBOARD
DUMP
DUMP
3rd,4th
5th,6th
SEAT OUTLETS
836TC-340-2
Oxygen System
(EA-320, EA440 and atter)
Figure 3
Offensive odors may be removed from the oxygen system grease and oil stains, for these contaminants
by purging. The system should also be purged any time the willignite upon contact with oxygen.
lines are left open and subject to contamination. Purging is
accomplished by connecting a recharging cart into the a. Connect a line from a recharging cart to the
system and permitting oxygen to flow through the lines and oxygen filler valve.
outlets until any offensive odors have been carried away, b. Slowly
open the oxygen supply.
The following steps outline the procedures recommended c. open the valve which allows oxygen to flow
Slowly
for purging the oxygen system. through the mask outlets
d. Plug in an oxygen mask at each outlet in the
cabin and cockpit.
WARNING a. Open all doors and windows.
f, Set the cart pressure regulator to deliver 50 psi to
Avoid making sparks and keep all burning the system.
cigarettes or fire away from the vicinity of the g, Allow system to purge for one hour and check for
airplane when the outlets are in use. Inspect the the presence of odor. If the odor is still present, continue
filler connection for cleanliness before attaching purging for one additional hour. If the odor is still present
it to the filler valve, Make sure that your hands, after the second hour of purging, replace the supply
tools, and clothing are clean, particularly from cylinder.
35-0040
Page5
A9 Sep 27184
BEECHCRACT
BONAN~A SERIES
MAIWTENANCE MANAUL
OXYGEN CYLINDER REMOVAL (0-10097, 0-10120 OXYGEN CYLINDER REMOVAL (E-1946, E2104, E-
through EA-388 except EA-320/ a. Make certain the system is turned off.
b. Remove the pilot’s and copilot’s seat. (See PILOT
WARNING AND COPILOT SEAT REMOVAL in Chapter 25-00-00.)
c. Remove the spar cover.
Keep fire, cigarettes and sparks away from the d. Disconnect the control cable from the oxygen
vicinity of the oxygen cylinder. Hands, clothing valve.
and tools should be clean. Oil and grease will
ignite upon contact with pure oxygen under
pressure. WARNING
3590-00
PageG
Sep 27184 Ag
BEECHCRAW
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANAUL
when the lines are connected, especially the wing and connect the clamps.
high pressure line. b. Check to be certain the cylinder is in the proper
position and tighten the clamp wing nuts. Safety wire the
nuts.
d. Connect the control cable to the oxygen valve, c. Remove the caps or plugs from the connection
e. Check for leaks as indicated in OXYGEN LOW points and install the oxygen lines.
PRESSURE TEST PROCEDURE (E-1946, 8-2104, E-2111
EA-369, and after) and in OXYGEN
and after; EA-320,
HIGH PRESSURE TEST PROCEDURE (E-1946, 8-2104,
E-2111, and after; EA-320, EA-389 and after).
Install the spar cover.
f. CAUTION
Install the pilot’s and copilot’s seats. (See PILOT
g.
AND COPILOT SEAT INSTALLATION in Chapter 25-00- If there is oxygen in the cylinder, there will be
35-00-00
Page7
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECMCRACT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANAUL
OXYGEN CONTROL CABLE ADJUSTMENT (EA- 4,388 pregESuliZations, whichever occurs first. When the
320, EA-440 and after) service life of the cylinder is complete, the cylinder must be
discarded.
The control cable(s) may be adjusted either in the wing(s) at
the valve(s) or at the push-pull knob (Figure 4) just forward SUB PANEL
of the instrument subpanel. Coarse adjustments may be
made at the valve(s) by repositioning the cable, cable
housing, or both. The valve(s) is located on the cylinder
above an access panel outboard of Wing Station 66 and aft
of the main spar. Finer adjustment of the system cables
may be made at the push-pull knob (Figure 4) just forward
of the instrument subpanel. On the two cylinder system both
valves should turn off or on simultaneously.
CONTROL
OXYGEN CYLINDER I;7ETESTING
CABLES
Oxygen cylinders used in the airplanes are the light weight
8361C-340-3
type, stamped "3 Hf" on a plate on the side of each
cylinder. Each oxygen cylinder must be hydrostatically
tested every three years and the test date stamped on the Oxygen Shut-Otf Csntrol
cylinder. The cylinder has a service life of 24 years and/or Figure 4
"END"
35-0090
88088
Sep 27/84 A9
C H A PT E R
PNEUMATIC
ttaYtbeea Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 36 PNEUMATIC
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
36-00-00
36-5011 Installed)
Servicing
Low InstrumentAir Pressure. ......6
AirFilterRemoval (Intake) ........6
Standby Pressure Regulator Adjustment (CE-1056 and After; CJ-156 and After; E-2180 and After;
EA-422 and After; and Airplanes With Kit No. 36-5009 or 36-5011 Installed) ......10
Pressure Regulator Adjustment ...11
CHAPTER 36 PNEUMATIC
INSTRUMENTAIR SYSTEM
The instrument air pressure system provides air for operation of the directional gyro and horizon gyro. Air is drawn
through an inlet air filter mounted on the rear engine baffle by the dry air pump. The air is then routed through the
air pressure regulator and inline filter to the gyros. The regulator, which is located near the inline filter on the rear
engine baffle, should be adjusted to a pressure of 5.0 in. Hg. as indicated on the cockpit gage (Ref. Figure 1).
Instrument air pressure is monitored by the instrument air gage located in the upper right side of the instrument
panel. (At serials E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After; EA-320, EA-389 and After, the pressure gage is in the left side
of the instrument panel.)
STANDBY INSTRUMENT AIR SYSTEM (CE- 1 056 AND AFTER; CJ- 156 AND AFTER; E-2 180
THRU E-2216 IF INSTALLED, E-22 17 AND AFTER; EA-422 THRU EA-442 IF INSTALLED,
EA-443 AND AFTER; AND AIRPLANES WITH KIT NO. 36-5009 OR 36-501 1 INSTALLED)
CAUTION: Never use an air pump which has been dropped or mishandled.
A standby instrument air pressure system is provided to supply instrument air in the event the primary instrument
air pressure system fails. The system incorporates a pressure pump which is driven by an electric motor, a pump
intake filter which is mounted on the underside of the engine, an inline filter and a pressure regulator. The standby
system is controlled by an ON/OFF toggle switch, placarded STANDBY GYRO P, located on the LH subpanel.
When the system is activated, a solenoid valve, mounted in the pressure supply line just aft of the firewall fitting,
automatically isolates all air driven instruments except the directional gyro and the horizon gyro. The standby air
pressure system is plumbed into the primary system ducting by use of a manifold with check valves to prevent
backfiow.
36-00-00Pagel
ttsYttresn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i
J
I/ OVERBOARD
MANIFOLD
L-------------~
INLINE FILTER INLINE FILTER
TEST TEST
GAGE 1 GAGE
PRESSURE I PRESSURE
REGULATOR 1 I REGULATOR
Ew3as
035240AA.AI
Page
ra31/04
M2 36-00-00 A25
Rayfheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
~-_ N
i AISRTClFNPLBTYER
es~
VIE\J A
035168AR
3
36-00-00 Mar 31/04Page
RayfkgMI AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOSE LANDING
GEAR KEU
I) I r’
I\
FILTER
,~B
REGULATOR
CHECK VALVE
ASSEMBLY
ENGINE DRIVEN
AIR LINEINSTRUMENT
PUMP
MOTOR
DETAIL A
E~368
Page
ra31/04
M4 36-00-00 A25
Raltheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
PNEUMATIC- TROUBLESHOOTING
Chart 1
Troubleshooting Instrument Air System
INDICATION PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
1. Zero indication on instrument a. Hole in gyro plumbing, line a. Inspect plumbing, replace or
gage, plugged, filter plugged or plumbing connect lines or replace filter as
disconnected. necessary.
gYro. necessary.
Note: Troubleshooting procedures for the primary and standby air pressure systems are the same.
5
A25 36-00-00 Mar 31/04Page
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SERVICING
Impurities and foreign matter are removed from the air by two pressure system filters. The intake filter is located on
the top of the engine, ahead of the pressure pump. This filter should be replaced annually or every 300 to 500 hours
of service time depending upon operating conditions. The filter element must not be subjected to solvents and must
be replaced if this occurs. Always reinstall the filter cover with the opening facing down. The inline filter is located
between the pressure regulator and the instruments. The frequency of replacing this air filter will depend upon
service conditions; however, they should be checked approximately every 100 hours of operation and replaced
every 300 hours of operation, or sooner if conditions warrant.
The intake filter for the standby system is located on the underside of the engine attached to the keel
instrument air
structure. The inline filter is mounted in the RH engine compartment between the pressure regulator and the
instruments, at FS 28.25 to 30.75. The intake filter should be replaced every 500 hours or on condition and the inline
filter should be replaced every 300 hours or on condition.
When operating in localities where there is a great amount of dust or sand in the air, the filters should be replaced
at more frequent intervals. Under extremely dusty conditions, it may be necessary to inspect the filters daily. A
clogged filter reduces air flow and slows up the rotor, causing improper gym indication due to a loss of gyroscopic
inertia.
If the pressure pump has failed or operation of the instruments indicates a fluctuation of the system pressure or a
decrease in system pressure, check for excessive pressure, a partial restriction in the lines, a filter partially
obstructed, or pressure loss resulting from loose connections. These conditions may be checked by:
NOTE: Use a dry, low pressure air source (10 psi maximum) for this test. If air flow resistance in the filter removed
from the airplane exceeds that of the new filter by more than 1.0 psi, replace the filter.
a. Removing the inline filter from the system and checking it for obstructions by comparing the resistance to flow
with a new filter.
With the whenever any components are replaced in the pressure system,
discrepancy repaired, or adjust the
pressure, refer to PRESSURE REGULATOR ADJUSTMENT procedure.
I a. Gain access to the filter by opening the left engine cowling (Ref. Figure 3).
Page
6~’31"1w 36-00-00 nns
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FILTER COVER
MOUNT
CARTRIDGE
NUT SPACER
NUT
jj
LOCK
WASHER
WASHER
WASHER
FILTER FILTER RETAINER
BASE WING NUT AND
WASHER
m5239AAA1
b. Install the spacer and cover. The cover should be installed with the cover opening facing down.
NOTE: The standby system intake filter is mounted on the underside of the engine attached to the keel structure.
7
A25 36-00-00 Mar 31/04Page
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAlhiTENANCE MANUAL
b. Install the spacer and cover. The cover should be installed with the cover opening facing down.
d. Closethe enginecowling.
c. Remove the nut and washer which hold the filter in place.
b. Installthe inletandoutlethoses.
c. Closethe enginecowling.
c. Remove the nut and washer which hold the filter in place.
d. Remove thefilter.
c. Closethe enginecowling.
Page
raM8
31104 36-00-00 nea
Ral~heon AiKlaft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
c. Remove the nut and washer which secure the regulator in position.
d. Removethe regulator.
b. Installthe nutandwasher.
d. Closetheengine cowling.
c. Remove the nut and washer which secure the regulator in position.
d. Removethe regulator.
a. Placetheregulatorin position.
d. Closetheengine cowling.
9
A25 36-00-00 Mar 31/04Page
Raylheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
STANDBY PRESSURE REGULA TOR ADJUSTMENT (CE- 1 056 AND AFTER; CJ- 156 AND
I AFTER; E-2180 AND AFTER; EA-422 AND AFTER; AND AIRPLANES WITH KIT 36-5009 OR
36-501 1 INSTALLED)
NOTE: This procedure is performed with the engine NOT running and the primary instrument air system turned off.
I b. Install a test gage (0-10 psi) in the outlet side of the pressure regulator.
NOTE: During this procedure, battery voltage must be maintained at 28.5 ~0.3 volts. It is recommended that an
c. With the engine NOT running, and the primary instrument air system OFF, turn ON the standby air pump circuit
breaker switch in the LH subpanel.
1.. Adjust the pressure
mounted in the instrument
regulator to provide 5.0 +0.1/ -0.2 in. Hg as indicated on the instrument air pressure gage
panel.
NOTE: Rotate the adjusting screw clockwise to increase the pressure and counterclockwise to decrease the
pressure.
CAUTION: At no time should the gage installed in the outlet side of the pressure regulator indicate more than 5.0
I psi. If this is not enough air pressure for satisfactory instrument operation, the system has a leak,
blockage or restriction which must be repaired immediately.
e. Turn the standby air pump circuit breaker switch on the LH subpanel to OFF.
NOTE: When this procedure is completed, adjust the primary instrument air system, refer to PRESSURE
REGULATOR ADJUSTMENT procedure.
page
1036-00-00 n25
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: When performing this procedure on airplanes with the standby air pressure system installed, ensure that the
standby air pressure system is turned OFF.
b. Install a test gage (0-10 psi) at the outlet side of the pressure regulator.
c. Adjust the pressure regulator to 5.0 +0.1/ -0.2 in. Hg as indicated on the instrument air pressure gage mounted
in the instrument panel with the engine operating at 2,300 rpm. Rotate the adjusting screw on the pressure
regulator clockwise to increase the pressure and counterclockwise to decrease the pressure.
CAUTION: At no time should the gage installed in the outlet side of the pressure regulator indicate more than
5 O psi. If this is not enough air pressure for satisfactory instrument operation, the system has a leak,
blockage or restriction which must be repaired immediately.
d. Check the instrument air pressure gage in the instrument panel. With the engine operating at 800 rpm, the
nw 36-00-00
CHAPTER
BEECHCRAFI
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
GENERAL 39-00-00
Description and Operation .......1
"END"
39-CONTENTS
Page: 1
M´•y WSO
BEECHCRAR
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 39
CHAPTER
SECTION
SVBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
39-EFFECTIVITY
Page 1
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
GENERAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION receiving equipment. (4) The stationary right panel which
contains indicators, switching, and the glove box. (5) The
upper left subpanel, located below the left floating panel and
The instrument panel on the airplane is divided into seven above the left subpanel contains autopilot control switching,
general groupings: (1) A
floating panel, located on the upper OMNI indicators, and the flap position indicator. (6) The
left corner of the instrument panel, which contains those lower left subpanel contains the heater and air controls for
instruments necessary to sustain flight. (2) The center cabin temperature, ignition switch, circuit breaker switches,
stationary panel which contains instruments that indicate the light controls, flap control, and fuel pump controls. (7) The
various monitoring systems of the engine. (3) The avionics lower right subpanel contains the landing gear control and
and radio rack, located to the right of the engine instrument indicating lights, and the standard and optional circuit
panel, which contains various optional avionics and radio breakers.
"END"
340090
Pegel
Allay 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
GLARESHIELD REMOVAL
REMOVAL OF THE ENGINE INSTRUMENT
a. Remove the attach screws at each end of the CLUSTER PANEL
glareshWd.
b. Lift the glareshield gently to detach it from the a. Remove the glareshield.
veicro hook and pile which secures it at its top side. b. Disconnect the harness connector on the back of
c. Disconnect the electrical quick disconnects for the engine instrument cluster.
both the compass and the glareshield lights, c. Remove the screws securing the instrument
d. Disconnect the defroster heat duct. cluster to the instrument panel. Support the cluster
e. Remove the glareshield. assembly while removing the screws to prevent dropping it.
d. Remove the cluster from the panel.
GLARESHIELD INSTALLATION
i INSTALLATION OF THE ENGINE INSTRUMENT
a. Place the glareshield in position and connect the CLUSTER PANEL
defroster heat duct.
b. Connect the electrical quick disconnects for both a. Place the engine instrument cluster panel in the
the compass and the glareshield lights. proper position in the instrument panel.
c. Install the attach screws at each end of the b. Secure the instrument cluster to the instrument
glareshield, panel with the screws.
39iMK)
Pagel
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINfENANCE MANUAL
ENGINE
FLIGHT INSTRUMENT INSTRU- RADIO I RIGHT
PANEL MENT AND I PANEL
PANEL AVIONICS AND
RACK GLOVEBOX
35392-a56
a. Slide the radio/avionics component you wish to obtained from the underside of the instrumentpanel. Before
install on its proper shelf, starting procedures, ensure that
any removal or installation
b. Make sure the component is seated all the way the battery switch is in the OFF position, the battery is
back in the shelf to make itselectrical connection, disconnected, and that the external ground power unit is
c. Tighten the Alien screw which retains the disconnected. When removing any of the components for
in the shelf. maintenance purposes, tag and identify any wires removed
component
to facilitate reinstallation of the components.
39-10-00
Pa9eP
Oc17/83 A6
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
osO
IIREPI~O )LTIIRR
8
QwnrrruRn*"’
cooRaw~roR
00 O
o ,fp~
LC: i
1(1HP8
r- ´•-~r
O O
o o
m o
OQOO~OQQOQOQQ000000
PEOEITIL
I
instrument and Control Panel
2111 and after
(Serlals E-1946, 8-2104,
and EA-320, EA-389 and after)
Figure 2
"888"
39-1 0-00
Page3
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANXA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ELECTRICAL AND ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT installed by a zone number. The airplane zoning diagram,
RACKS MAINTENANCE PRACTICES which is repeated in Figure 1, shows the various zones of
the lists of components, and the illustrations
airplane. The
lists showing on the following pages, identify
their installation
diagrams and the accompanying equipment
The circuit
in Wiring Diagram Manual identify each electrical
the these components by the reference designator, shown in
component with a reference designator. Further, the parenthesis assigned each component in the Wiring
equipment list identifies the area in which the component is Diagram Manual, (P/N 35-590102-9).
140 Firewall to Main Spar 300 AFT FUSELAGE AND EMPENNAGE (Cont’d)
150 Main Spar to Rear Spar
160 Ah of Rear Spar 361 (362) Elevator
370 Tail Cone
200 FORWARD FUSELAGE
410 ENGINE COMPARTMENT
221 (222) Firewall (Attached to or
Accessible from FoMard Side) 500 (600) WING AND CONTROL SURFACES
231 (232) Firewall to Instrument
Panel 531 (631)
Wing, Inboard Leading Edge
240 Instrument Panel and 532 (638Wing, Inboard-Aft of Main
Subpanel Spar
251 (252) Cabin (Floor Line to 533(633) Flap
Headliner) 541 (641) Wing, Outboard-Leading Edge
253 Cabin Headliner Area 542 (642) Wing, Outboard-Aft of Main
270 Main Spar Carry-Through Spar
Structure 543(643) Aileron
280 Rear Spar Carry-Through 550 (650) Wing Tip
Structure
700 GEAR DOORS AND WHEEL WELLS
392090
Pagsl
May 9/80
BEECHCRAF~
BONA~UA SERIES
MAINTENANCE klANUAC
710
532 531
541 831 632
641
550
650
542 543
643 642
351 352
361 362 330
251
240 820 253 830 310 320
(252) 340
221
410 (222)´•
(232)
370
-I
160
Indicates Right Side 140 270 150 i80
35´•607-22
39´•2090
Pag~ 2
M~y 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAIMENANCE MANUAL
AREA BETWEEN THE FIREWALL AND For maintenance coverage of the voltage regulator, refer to
INSTRUMENT PANEL AIRPLANE ZONES 231 Chapter 24 of the Maintenance Manual. The electrical
AND 232 equipment junction box contains the flap position PC
r;-
r--i
i, I ’I ;I\ /---VOLTAGE
R"ULATOR
o o II
CONNECTOR
DETAIL A 35-351-6
39-20QO
Page3
May 9/39
BEECHCRAFT
BONAN2A SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CONNECTORS AND
SOCKETS
STALL WARNING
HORN
WIRE
HOUSING
35-3513
DETAIL A
392090
Pe~4
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONAI~ZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUEL
QUANTrTY PCB’S
MANIFOLD PRESSURE
SWITCH (EA-I I1´•IRU fA-272 excepi EA-242)
MANIFOLD
I PRESSURE
DETAIL B
35´•351-i
Left Center Area BenNeen Firewall and Instrument Panel Lone 231
Figure 2 (Sheet 3 of 3)
3920´•00
PageS
A4 Jan 20/82
BEECHCRAFT
BONA~IZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
AREA WHICH INCLUDES THE FORWARD, RIGHT located in tone Adjustment and pictorial coverage of
410.
SIDE OF THE FIREWALL, THE ENGINE these switches is found in Chapter 32 of the Maintenance
COMPARTMENT; AND THE NOSE LANDING GEAR Manual. All major engine electrical components i.e.,
WELL AIRPL4NE ZONES 222/410/710 alternator, starter, etc., will be shown in the 10-520 or
(Figure 3) TSIO-520 Series Aircraft Engines Overhaul Manual, FORM
X-30039A or X-30042. The following components are
The electrical components located in the above areas and located in airplane zones 222 and 410:
zones mounted with nuts, bolts, screws, or clamps.
are
Prior toperforming any maintenance on these components, Fuse blocks, both Standard and
ensure that the battery switch is OFF, the battery is Optional (222) (Fi5, F16, XF15)
disconnected, and that the external power source (if Battery (222) (BT10)
installed) is disconnected. When removing these Shunt (222 (R34)
components for maintenance purposes, tag and identify Current Limiters (222) (F1, F2, XFi, XF2)
any wires removed to facilitate the reinstallation of the Capacitor Filter (222) (Cli)
components. Optional External Power Relay (222) (K12)
Optional External Power Receptacle (410) (J32)
The nose landing gear uplock and downlock switches are Starter Relay (222) (K14)
located in the nose wheel well, and are mounted on the Battery Master Relay (222) (K15)
right, outboard side of the wheel well keel. These switches Alternator Out Sensor (222) (A16)
work in conjunction with the indicator lights on the right Throttle Warning Horn Switch (410)
subpanel to indicate nose landing gear position. (S41) Chapter 32
Optional Landing Gear Safety Switch
For maintenance coverage of the battery, refer to Chapter (410) (S34) Chapter 32
12 of the Maintenance Manual. The throttle warning horn Avionics Master Relay (222)
switch (S41) and the optional landing gear safety switch Switch, Nose Landing Gear Uplock (710) (S62)
(S34) are located on the throttle control shaft and are Switch, Nose Landing Gear Downlock (710) (S63)
39´•2040
PegaB
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUSE
BLOCK
SPARE
STACKED
FUSE STANDARD
CURRENT
BLOCK FUSE
LIMITERS
BLOCK STARTER RELAY
SMUNT
EXTERNAL
POWER
RELAY
BATTER~ I /--BATTERY MASTER RELAY
AVIONICS
MASTER
RELAY
CAPACITOR
CURRENT
LIMITERS DETAIL A
OPTIONAL
EXTERNAL
POWER
RECEPTACLE
35-351-2
392040
Page7
May 9/80
BEECHCAAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
MAGNETOS
LANDING LIGHT
THROTTLE WARNING
HORN SWITCH
I h !\-EXTERNAL
POWER
RECEPTACLE
TO CYLINDER HEAD
TEMP BULB
~e
TO TAXI LIGHT
"---1----~----
LANDING GEAR
OOWNLOCK SWITCH
LANDING GEAR
UPLOCK SWITCH
35´•351-5
s920´•0o
Pege8
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
AREA BENEATH THE FLOOR FROM THE used for high boost pump. On serials CJ-149 and after,
FIREWALL TO THE MAIN SPAR AND FROM THE two auxiliary boost pumps are used: Reference designator
MAIN SPAR TO THE REAR SPAR AIRPLANE (B11) for high boost and reference designator (812) for low
ZONES 140 AND 150 boost. On serials EA-1 and after, a single pump with both
(FIgure, 4) high and low speeds is used. The pump used on EA-1 and
after is reference designator (813).
The electrical components located from the firewall to the
main spar, and from the main spat to the rear spar are The flight dimming transistor bracket assembly contains
mounted with nuts, bolts, screws, and clamps. Prior to four dimming transistors and is located in zone 150 (left
performing any maintenance on these components, ensure side). For adjustment of the landing gear uplimit and
that thebattery switch is OFF, the battery is disconnected, downlimit switches, refer to Chapter 32 of the Maintenance
and that the external power source (if installed) is Manual. The following components are located in airplane
disconnected. When removing these components for zones 140 and 150:
maintenance purposes, tag and identify any wires removed
to facilitate the reinstallation of the components. Auxiliary Fuel Boost Pump (140) (811,
812, or 813) See above.
Light Dimming Transistor Bracket Assembly
(150) (A21)
CAUTION Glareshield Light Dimming Transistor
(150) (Q1)
Make sure the grommets are installed in the Subpanel Light Dimming Transistor
area of the main spar through which the wire (150) (02)
harness passes, so chafing of the harness will Eng Inst and Avionics Console Light
not occur. Dimming Transistor (150) (03)
Flight Instrument Light Dimming
Transistor (150) (04)
The auxiliary fuel pumps are located forward of the main Inverter (150) (MG1)
spar; all other components in this figure are located aft of Flap Motor (150) (822)
the main
spar. There are three different auxiliary fuel Landing Gear Motor (150) (821)
pumps used in the Bonanza Series airplanes: On serials Dynamic Brake Landing Gear Relay (150) (K17)
CE-743, CE-772 and after; D-10097, D-10120 and after; E- Landing Gear Uplimit Switch (150) (S39)
1111, E-1241 and after, a reference designator (B11) is Landing Gear Downlimit Switch (150) (S40)
39-20-00
PageS
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
AUXILIARY FUEL
BOOST PUMP ~B11 OR 813)
O AUXILIARY FUEL
GEAR MOTOR
~t I
II
b/ --+i
LJ’
II
II
b,
a
LIGHT DIMMING TRANSISTOR
BRACKET ASSEMBLY LDYNAMIC BRAKE LANDING
GEAR RELAY
35--352--1
Area Benaath the Floor From the Frrewall to the Rear Soar Zonee 140/150
Figure 4
392000
Pag´•lO
Mey 9180
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
AREA WHICH INCLUDES THE WINGS AND MAIN approximately WS 40.00. It is accessible through the
LANDING GEARS AIRPLANE ZONES 531 THRU landing gear wheel well forward of the wing spar. The
rear
650, AND ZONES 730 AND 740 flap limit switches are accessible forward of the left flap
(Figure 5) and may be serviced with the flaps lowered. The flap
switches are located at approximately WS 33.00. For flap
The electrical components located within the‘wings and limit switch adjustment refer to Chapter 27 of the
main landing gear wheel wells are mounted with nuts, I
Maintenance Manual. At airplane serials D-10179 and
bolts, screws, clamps, and rivets. Prior to performing any I after, CJ-150 and after, CE-816 and after, E-1371 and
maintenance oncomponents, ensure that the battery
the after, and EA-1 and after the airplanes are equipped with
switch is OFF, the battery is disconnected, and that the 14 degree and 16 degree approach flap limit switches in
external power source (if installed) is disconnected. When addition to the uplimit and downlimit flap switches of prior
removing the components for maintenance purposes, tag airplane serials.
and identify any wires removed to facilitate the
reinstallation of the components. A landing gear safety switch (squat switch) is located on
the strut of each main landing gear. The safety switches
Each wing contains two fuel level transmitters which are provided to prevent inadvertent retraction of the landing
provide fuel quantity information to their respective fuel gear on the ground. The switches open the control circuit
quantity indicator on the engine instrument panel. The when the struts are compressed. The landing gear safety
inboard fuel quantity transmitter for each wing is located at switches also serve to control the position of the
approximately WS 43.00, and the outboard transmitter is retractable air conditioner condenser. When the airplane is
located at approximately WS 97.00. on the ground and the air conditioner is turned on, the
condenser extends to the ground extension position.
The heated pitot tube is mounted on the left outboard wing
rib at approximately WS 125,00. The pitot tube heat The electrical components ace located in the area
following
element wires are routed with the tube air line. When the which includes the wings and main landing gear. This area
pitot tube is removed for maintenance purposes, be sure to includes airplane zones 531 thru 650, and zones 730 and
cap the end of the air line to prevent entry of foreign 740:
material. Remove the cap upon reinstallation of the tube.
The stall warning switch is located on the left outboard StallWarning Switch (531) (S43)
wing leading edge at approximately WS 140.00. Heated Pitot Tube (531) (HR23)
Adjustment coverage of the stall warning system is located Transmitter, LH Inboard Fuel (531) (R29)
in Chapter 27 of the Maintenance Manual. The stall Transmitter, LH Outboard Fuel (531) (R21)
warning switch is removable by screws located around the Transmitter, RH Inboard Fuel (631) (R22)
perimeter of the mounting bracket. Transmitter, RH Outboard Fuel (631) (R23)
Switch, LH Landing Gear Uplock (730) (S60)
The landing gear uplock and downlock switches, a pair for Switch, LH Landing Gear Downlock (730) (S61)
each main landing gear, are located in the wheel well on Switch, AH Landing Gear Uplock (740) (564)
wing spar at WS 45.00 for the gear
the ah side of the front Switch, RH Landing Gear Downlock (740) (S65)
up switch, and at WS 52.00 for the gear down switch. Flap Position Transmitter (730) (MT2)
These switches work in conjunction with the indicator lights Switch, Flap Uplimit (533) (S50)
on the right subpanel to indicate landing gear position. Switch, Flap Dawnlimit (533) (S51)
Switch, 14 Degree Flap Limit (533) (S76)
The electrical flap position transmitter and the flap limit Switch, 16 Degree Flap Limit (533) (S47)
switches are located within the left wing. The flap position Switch, RH Landing Gear Safety (740) (S36)
indicator is mounted at the left flap actuator at Switch, LH Landing Gear Safety (730) (S37)
392090
Pagall
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
APPROACH
FLAP
STALL UPCIMIT
SWITCHES
WARNING FLAP
LH ONLY
SWITCH HEATED SWITCH
LH ONLY PITOT TUBE LH ONLY
FUEL TRANSMITTERS
LH ONLY
FUEL TRANSMITTER
EA-242. EA´•273 AND
LANDING GEAR
DOWNLOCK SWITCH
NOTE LANDING GEAR
UPLOCK SWITCH
DOTTED LINES INDICATE
EA-242. EA-273 AND AFTER. FLAP POSITION LDOWNLIMIT
AT THE SAME EFFECTIVITY TRANSMITTER FLAP
THE PITOT MAST IS MOVED LH ONLY SWITCH
TO THE WING TIP. LH ONLY
35-355-11
Area Which Includes the Wings and Main Landing Gear (Lett Wing
Shown) Zones 531 thru 650 and Zones 730 and 740
Figure 5
"END"
3820-00
Pags12
Jan 20102 A4
CHAPTER
STANDARD
PRACTICES-
STR U CT U R E S
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 51 STRUCTURES
~ABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
"END"
51-CONTENTS
Page 1
A12 Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 51
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
51-EFFECTIVITY
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The airplane is all metal with a semimonocoque type Structural Integrity of V35B and V35B-TC airplanes is
construction. Stresses are carried by both the skin improved by installation of Kit No. 35-4016-7 S. The
and stiffener members of the fuselage, wings, and kit will provide additional support to the leading edge
empennage. The airplane has primarily a riveted of the stabilizers, and can be installed without
structure. Field repairs to skins and stiffener mem- removal of the stabilizer.
bers may be accomplished with standard materials
and hand tools. The basic structure of the airplane is SECONDARYSTRUCTURAL COMPONENTS
the fuselage, which is constructed of bulkheads
strengthened with longerons, stringers, and skin In the event of damage, thefollowing secondary
panels. structural components would require immediate
attention, but would not necessarily endanger the
The wing sections are attached to the fuselage safety of the airplane and/or the passengers.
g. Auxiliary members used to strengthen or d. Do not countersink deeper than 75% of the
support other members carrying direct loads material thickness.
51-00-00
Page 1
Ale Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
f. Brush the
repaired area with an even coat
c. Prepare the MIL-R-7575 resin (24, Chart 1, of resin. After the
patches have cured for 24 hours at
91-00-00) for the patch in accordance with the man- temperatures between 230C ~750F) and 660C (1500F),
ufacturer’s instructions. Make sure that your hands blend the patch into the contour of the part with fine
are free of oil, grease, and dirt when handling the sandpaper. Paint the repair to match the rest of the
resin. part.
"END"
51-00-00
Page 2
Oct16/92 A16
CHAPTER
DOORS
Raynnton Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 52 DOORS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
52-00-00
52-1 0-00
52-30-00
CHAPTER 52 DOORS
1
A27 52-LOEP Mar 31 05Page
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
GENERAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION which furnish access to the cabin area. The doors are located
on the right side of the fuselage between FS 124.55 and FS
CABIN DOOR utility door contains a window, with the forward
170.00. Each
door being hinged on the forward side and the aft door being
The airplane isprovided with a cabin door which furnishes hinged on the aft side. Each utility door has a folding door
access to the flight compartment. The door is located on the stop located at the bottom edge of each door.
right side of the fuselage between FS 58.00 and FS 100.00
on the Model A36 series
airplanes, and between FS 68.00 The forward utility door contains an outside D-ring latch
and FS 104.90 the Model 33 and 35 series airplanes,
on handle with lock and tumbler assembly and an inside latch
a
Each door is hinged on the forward side of the door at two handle. The forward door contains three latches: two pin-type
points, and a door stop is located on the bottom edge of latches, one on the top and one on the bottom edges of the
each door. door, and a bayonet latch which makes contact with the
striker plate on the aft door. The movement of the three
The cabin door is provided with an aft outside and forward latches is controlled by a bell crank assembly. The aft utility
inside door handle. The outside handle contains the cabin door contains a lever type handle on the front edge, inside of
door lock and tumbler assembly. The door contains three the door. The door contains two hook type latches which
latches: a hook latch the upper edge of the door, a sliding
on each engage a striker plate lip at the top and bottom of the
bolt latch on the aft side of the door, and a pin type latch on door sill. The movement of the two latches is controlled by a
the lower edge of the door. A cable assembly connects the bell crank assembly.
movement of the upper latch, and a bell crank assembly
controls the movement of both the aft and lower pin latches.
An optional courtesy light is installed in the door above the
window. The wiring for the courtesy light exits the door above BAGGAGE DOORS
the upper door hinge. (CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; D-
10097, 0-10120 and after)
CABIN DOOR QUIC~ RELEASE MECHANISM
(C~-149 and after onlyl Bonanza airplanes other than the A36 series are provided
with optional (small or large) baggage door for cargo
an
The cabin door can be instantaneously jettisoned by a quick storage. The doors ate located on the right side of the
release mechanism in the event of an emergency. The quick fuselage. The small door is located between FS 131.00 and
release mechanism actuates the door latches through a lever FS 151.00, and the large door is located between FS
and cam arrangement. To prevent accidental activation of 131.00 and FS 170.00. Either door is hinged on the forward
the mechanism the red handle that actuates the release is side. The small baggage door has a stop rod on the forward
secured to the escutcheon on the door by an aluminum catch inboard side of the door near hinge, and the large
the door
and a single strand of safety wire. The wire breaks and the door has a scissors type door stop connecting the top of the
aluminum catch straightens out to release the handle when door sill to the top of the baggage door.
the latter is pulled. The cam on the lever to which the handle
is attached then rotates to actuate the link that unlatches the
upper and lower door latches. Simultaneously, an actuator The small baggage door contains a combination latch and
on each end of the quick release lever rotates and, through lock mechanism located on the aft side of the door. The latch
interconnecting links, withdraws the retai/lers that lock the makes contact with a striker plate on the door sill. This is the
upper and lower hinges in place around the hinge pins. This only latching device baggage door. The large
on the small
completely releases the door from the fuselage, baggage door contains an outside and inside D-ring latch
handle. A lock assembly is provided and is located beside the
WTILIjY DOORS handle. The large baggage door contains three pin type
(E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-I and after) latches located on the aft edge and the top and bottom edges
of the door. The movement of the three latches is controlled
The A36 series airplanes are provided with two utility doors by a bell crank assembly.
"END"
52-00-00
Pagel
May 9/80
RBytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CABIN DOOR REMOVAL (E- I 11, E-1241 AND AFTER; EA-?1 AND AFTER; CE-748, CE-772
AND AFTER; D-10097, D-10120 AND AFTER)
a. Remove the inboard door handle.
d. If the optional courtesy light is installed, disconnect the wire splice which is located behind the right side of the
instrument panel.
e. With the door open, insert a screwdriver between the door stop and the bottom of the door(Ref. Figure 1).
Slowly close the door while applying a downward pressure on the door stop until the stop is released from the
door.
g. Remove the remaining screws which secure the door frame to the hinges.
NOTE: At the upper hinge, four screws are located aft of the hinge cover; on the lower hinge, three screws are aft
of the hinge cover.
h. Carefully remove the door by pulling the door directly away from the hinges.
NOTE: Shims have been installed between the hinges and the door to obtain a proper fit. The shims should be
retained and the number of shims installed, where removed, under each hinge when the door is
same
reinstalled. Door assembly may be adjusted up or down and forward or aft by sliding door on hinges. Adjust
inboard or outboard by changing shims to inboard or outboard side of hinges. Do not omit hinges. I
CABIN DOOR INSTALLA TION I
E-1241 AND AFTER; EA-? 1 AND AFTER; CE-748,
(E-?
CE-772 AND AFTER; D-10097, D-10120 AND AFTER)
a. If the door is new, place the door in position and mark the door hinge tab and perimeter of the door frame where
any excess material needs to be removed. Remove the excess material to obtain the best fit prior to installing
the seal.
b. On a new door, install new door seals around the inside edge of the door frame. Check the old door for reference
to a new door seal location.
c. Place the door in position, making sure the upper and lower door hinge shims are in place. The same number
of shims should be used on installation of the door as when the door was removed. The shims serve to keep
the door flush to the fuselage.
d. Attach the four phillips screws aft of the upper door hinge which secure the door frame to the hinge. Attach the
three phillips screws aft of the lower door hinge.
e. Attach the upper and lower hinge cover plates; each is attached with two phillips screws.
f. Install the door stop in the channel located on the bottom edge of the door.
NOTE: The upper door hook latch bracket, located in the door sill above the door, should be preset flush with the
door sill.
1
n27 52-1 0-00 M,pa3jl eg:Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g. If the door contains the optional courtesy light installation, feed the wire from the courtesy light to the location
behind the right side of the instrument panel by routing the wire above the door hinge to behind the panel. Splice
the courtesy light wire to its connecting wire.
k. If adjustments to the installed door are required, refer to CABIN DOOR ADJUSTMENT.
I CAUTION: Support the door to avoid damaging the wing when the quick release frees the door.
To remove the door, cut safety wire securing the quick release handle (red) in place and straighten out the aluminum
catch. Pull the handle that disengages the hinge pin retainers and remove the door.
Lj~ib
55-l(Y9*
Page
raM2
31105 52-~ 0-00 A21
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
If any of the following conditions exist, check and adjust the cabin door latching mechanism:
a. Ensure that the door’s internal latch mechanism is not binding and/or preventing proper door closing as follows:
i. With the door in the open position, operate the latching mechanism several times to ensure that the internal
mechanism is operating smoothly and properly.
2. With the door still in the open position, rotate the inside door handle counterclockwise as far as possible.
Mark the inside handle escutcheon plate at the edge of the blade protruding from the inner forward end of
the handle.
3. Place the latch in the open position and then close and latch the door. Check to see that the handle rotates
to theposition that was marked in the previous step. If the handle does not line up with the mark, open the
door and remove the door upholstery. Inspect the latchirig mechanism to determine the reason for the
interference and make the necessary adjustments.
NOTE: The areas of possible interference are where the lower pin, the upper latch hook, and the aft latch bolt
engage in the door frame.
b. The latches may require adjustment to ensure positive door locking as follows:
1. UPPER LATCH There are three points that should be inspected and/or adjusted on the upper latch.
a) Check to ensure that the upper latch mechanism is over center when the door is latched. This can be
accomplished by using a small inspection mirror to see that the upper operating link is against the
adjustment screw and the forward edge of the upper operating link is forward of the forward edge of the
lower operating link. If the latch mechanism is not over center when the door is latched, adjust the over
center stop screw (Ref. Figure 2, Sheet 1).
b) Check to ensure that the upper latch hook pin is positioned so that it is almost touching the aft portion
of the hook without riding on the hook. If the upper hook does not properly engage the pin, move the
pin forward or aft tit has four positions) to obtain proper adjustment.
c) Check for proper adjustment of the door upper latch bracket in the door sill above the door. If the door
does not fit properly in the frame (inboard/outboard) when closed and latched, leaving a noticeable gap
between the door and the frame, the upper latch bracket needs to be adjusted in to create more tension
on the door. This can be accomplished by adjusting the forward tension screw.
2. LOWER LATCH pin should be adjusted in the latched (closed) position so that the
The lower aft latch
shoulder (straight sided) portion of the
pin has extended through both the striker plate and the door opening
frame to a minimum of 0.05 in. (0.13 cm) above the tapered area of the pin. The latch pin must engage a I
3
ns-I 52-~ 0-00
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
I minimum of 0.33 in. (0.84 cm) below the lower surface of the door opening frame (Ref. Figure 2, Sheet 2).
Adjust latching pin as follows, so that it just clears the striker plate when the latch is in the unlatched
the
(open) position, and does not interfere with door opening.
NOTE: The amount of the from the door with the latch mechanism open will
latching pin protruding depend
on the gap between the bottom of the door and the door frame in the fuselage.
I NOTE: It may be necessary to shorten the pin guide by grinding a maximum of 0.2 in. (0.51 cm) off the top
of the pin guide in order to obtain enough travel to make this adjustment.
c) For E-2711, E-2728 and After; EA-537 and After, and prior airplanes with Kit’36-4007-1 installed,
perform the following steps, proceed to Step d. for all other airplanes.
1) Adjust turnbuckle so the latching pin will extend a minimum of 0.85 in. (2.16 cm) through door pan
when the latching mechanism is in the over center (latched) position. The latching pin may extend
I up to 0.18 in.(0.46 cm) out of the door pan when the latch mechanism is in the unlatched position
(Ref. Figure 3).
2) With the door latched. Point C (center of the clevis pin) is to be 0.03 in. (0.OS cm) to 0.15 in. (0.38
cm) forward of a line lover center) between points A and B.
3) Install in the upper hole or in the hole below this one in the lower arm of the bellcrank. The
a screw
extension may be rotated or turned over as required to obtain the over center dimension as noted
in Step 2. The extension will provide up to 13 different positions using different hole combinations.
4) Tighten the screws in lower arm of bellcrank that are holding the extension.
d) Safety theturnbuckle.
3. AFT LATCH BOLT Check to ensure that the aft latch bolt provides a pre-catch and protrudes into the
socket on the aft door frame as far as possible without bottoming out. If adjustment is required, proceed as
b) Disconnect the lower aft latch pin mechanism from the operating tube.
c) Rotate the tube to allow the bolt to protrude the proper distance.
I NOTE: When this is done, the outside handle may protrude up to 0.25 in. (0.64 cm) into the air stream, which
is acceptable.
d) Connect the lower aft latch pin mechanism to the operating tube. Connect the operating tube to the
inside door handle.
NOTE: The aft latch bolt can be adjusted inboard or outboard by loosening the four retaining screws on the
aft side of the door and moving the bolt inboard or outboard as necessary, and then tightening the
four screws.
A A
~C_1
WARNING
VERIFY DOOR IS PROPERLY
LATCHED BEFORE TAKEOFF
VIEW LOOKING,OUTB
AT RH SIDE OF CAB
__
DOOR UPPER
LATCH BRACKET UPPER LATCH HOOK PIN SHOULD BE ALMOST
TOUCHING THE AFT PORTION OF THE HOOK
WITHOUT RIDING ON IT.
FWD
C9101555
LOOKING FROM ABOVE
VIEW ROTATED 180"
5
A27 52-~ 0-00 Mar 31/05Page
Ral~heon AiKlaR Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TURNBUCKLE
SAFETY WIRE
PIN GUIDE
D
STRIKER PLATE
LOWER AFT LATCH PIN
AFI
VIEW B
CLEVIS PIN
LOOKING OUTBOARD
TRIKER PLATE
DOOR OPENING
FRAME
PIN/
GUIDE
VIEW D C91001556
Page
raY6
31105 52-~ 0-00 A27
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
BOLT
OPERATING
TUBE
VIEW C
cs 01557
INSIDE DOOR LOOKING OUTBOARD
7
A27
52-1 0-00 Mar 31/05Page
Raydheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CABIN DOOR
POINT C
CENTER OF PIN
POINT B
CENTER OF PIN
0.85 IN.
I
i
LOOKING OUTBOARD
DETAIL B
EXTENSION
(TH-1665 AND AFTER AND AIRPLANES
WITH KIT 36-4007-1 OR 36-4008-1 INSTALLED) 0.03 TO 0.15 IN.
POINT C
CENTER OF PIN
DETAIL E
Cabin Door Lower Linkage Adjustment
(E-2711, 5-2728 and After; EA-537 and After, and prior Airplanes with Kit 36-4007-1 Installed)
Figure 3
Page
raM8
31 105 52-1 0-00 A27
RBytheoR Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
When a lock on the baggage compartment door, cabin door or ignition is broken or worn, it is not necessary to install
a full set of replacement locks with a new key. A new tumbler can be readily converted tone time), for use with an
old key. To fit a new tumbler to a key proceed as follows:
b. With key in the unlocked position, examine the top of the lock barrel where the slots for the tumbler are located.
c. Note that one or more tumblers are protruding through the slot.
d. With a fine file, remove the raised portion of each of these tumblers. The key will now operate the new lock.
e. Loosen the upholstery panel on the cabin door to gain access to the handle mechanism through the cutout in
the channel under the latch assembly.
f. Remove the lower aft screw from the external door handle fairing directly under the lock mechanismand remove
the pin from the handle through the cutout in the door channel.
NOTE: Both the extreme aft screw and the lower aft screw of the outside latch housing serve as retainers. The
extreme aft screw secures the door handle spring in position, and the lower aft screw retains the sliding bolt
latch pin in position.
g. Remove the aft screw from the external door handle fairing. This will free the handle spring and allow the handle
to be disengaged from the actuating assembly.
h. After fitting the new lock to the key, install the lock barrelin the unlocked positioninto the handle.
i. Bevel the edges of the square hole in the locking cam (beveled edge must face outland place the cam on the
end of the lock barrel. The locking lug on the cam must be in line with the handle.
j. Cover a steel plate with cloth to prevent marring the latch handle and peen the end of the lock barrel until the
locking cam is firmly riveted in place.
a. Remove the inside door handle and the machine screws on the upper door facing.
c. Remove the bolt securing the teleflex cable to the upper door latch.
d. Remove the bolt securing the lower end of the cable to the lower actuating arm.
NOTE: Attach a length of safety wire to the lower end of the cable before removing it from the door and leave the
wire in the cable track as a means of positioning the new cable.
e. Grasp the upper end of the cable with vise grip pliers and pull it out through the upper latch opening. Remove
the safety wire from the cable.
NOTE: Braze or silver solder two AN340-832 nuts to two new AN742-4 clamps.
9
52-~ 0-00
Rayt~on AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
f. Prior to installing the upper clevis, place one of the newly prepared clamps between the shoulders on the lower
end of the cable housing and attach the safety wire remaining in the door to the upper end of the cable housing.
g. Pull the housing into position by gripping it with vise grip pliers below the shoulder at the lower end. Pull on the
safetywire attached to the upper end while tapping on the vise grip pliers to drive the housing through the door
channel.
h. Align the lower clamp with the hole in the door facing and secure it with a machine screw, then install the upper
clamp in place on the housing and secure it in the same manner.
i. Install the upper clevis and attach the cables to the upper and lower latch connections.
j. Adjust cable tension by varying the cable length at either latch connection.
NOTE: It may be necessary to place the interior cabin door handle in the unlatched position to access both screws
that secure the door handle.
a. Remove the two screws that secure the interior door handle base plate.
b. Slide the interior door handle from the shaft, maintaining the same orientation of the door handle with respect
to the shaft (Ref. Figure 4).
c. Rotate the door handle 90" clockwise, maintaining the base plate in the same position.
NOTE: Interior door handle configuration of some airplanes may differ from that shown in Figure 4. Initial setup
is important to confirm proper movement and operation of the latching points.
d. Remove the necessary hardware and adjust clevis as required to position the inside door shaft assembly to
approximately 30" below horizontal when in locked position.
f. Slide the interior door handle over the shaft and secureusing the screws removed in Step a..
CAUTION: Rotation of the interior door handle without depressing the handle lock release button should not result
in unlatching of the door.
h. Rotate the interior door handle clockwise without depressing the handle lack release button. If the door remains
latched, proceed to Step g.. If the door becomes unlatched, repeat Steps a. thru e..
i. V~th the door latched, depress the handle lock release button while rotating the door handle clockwise. The door
should unlatch.
Page
10ZB,:~, 52-~ 0-00 n27
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CORRECT STEP
INCORRECT
INSTALLATION INSTALLATION
BASE
PLATE FREE-PLAYx
up
STEP
DETAIL A
FWD i FWD I
;FREE-PLAY+
A
I
EDGE
NOTE:
FREE-PLAY TRAVEL OF THE COPILOT’S
FORWARD DOOR HANDLE WHEN IN LATCHED POSITION
DOOR
EDGE COPILOT’S DOOR HANDLE
UP ii i UP
BASE
PLATE
STEP
FWO /I ii AFT
DETAIL B
FREE-PLAY*
/B
NOTE:
xFREE-PLAY TRAVEL OF THE
UTILITY DOOR HANDLE WHEN
IN LATCHED POSITION
FREE-PLAYx
TH528
UTILITY DOOR HANDLE 992572AA
Interior Crew Door Handle and Interior Utility Door Handle Installation and Orientation
Figure 4
11
A27 52-~ 0-00 Mar 31 05Page
Raytheon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
UTILITY DOOR REMOVAL (E- 1 I I I, E- 124 1 AND AFTER; EA- I AND AFTER)
a. With the doors open, remove the screws that attach the scissors door stop to the door sill.
b. Support the doors and remove the hinge pins by pulling straight up.
UTILITY DOOR INSTALLA TION (E- I I 1 I, E- 1241 AND AFTER; EA- I AND AFTER)
a. Support the doors and install the hinge pins.
b. Install the screws that attach the scissors door stop to the door sill.
If the utility door does not close properly or permits air leaks while completely closed, several adjustments may be
made to assure
proper sealing of the door. After determining the origin of the air leakage as to whether it is from
around the forward half of the utility door or the aft half of the door, make the following adjustments as necessary:
a. Adjustments of the aft door may be performed by removing the upholstery paneling and shortening or length-
ening the door latch connecting tube assembly.
NOTE
By shortening the connecting tube assemblies, the door will be pulled tighter against the door seal.
b. To adjust the length of the connecting tube assembly, remove the cotter key, washers and pin. Turn the pin eye
"in" to shorten the tube assembly and turn the pin eye "out" to lengthen the tube assembly.
c. After the desired length has been set, install the pin, washers and cotter key.
a. If air leakage is found around the forward half of the door, the necessary adjustments may be made at the aft
door latch striker plates, located slightly above and below the upper and lower door sill of the aft door.
b. Fortighter fit, loosen the screws on the upper and lower striker plates on the aft door and move them inboard.
a
By moving the plates inboard, the aft door will adjust inboard thus pulling inward the forward door when it is latched.
If the forward door does not open freely, the door latch pins may not be retracting enough. This may be corrected
by the following adjustments:
a. Removethe upholsterypaneling.
b. Removethecotterkeys, pinsandwashers.
c. Loosen the pin eye jam nut and turn the pin eye "in" to shorten the tube assemblies; turn the pin eye "out" to
lengthen the tube assemblies.
d. After the desired length has been set, tighten the pin eye jam nut. Install the pins, washers and cotter keys.
Refer to Section 52-10-00, INTERIOR CABIN DOOR HANDLE for the removal, installation and checkout instruc-
tions for the interior utility door handle.
LARGE BAGGAGE DOOR REMOVAL (CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; CJ- 149 AND AFTER;
D-10097, 0-10120 AND AFTER)
a. On the large type door, unlatch the door and remove the scissors type door stop at the top of the door.
b. Removethedoorhinge pin.
a. Installthedoorhinge pin.
b. Install the scissors type door stop at the top of the door.
SMALL BAGGAGE DOOR REMOVAL (CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; CJ- 149 AND AFTER;
D-10097, D- 10120 AND AFTER)
a. On the small door, unlatch the door and remove the door hinge pin while carefully holding the door in position.
b. Disconnect the door stop rod from the door at the door.
b. While carefully holding the door in position, install the hinge pin.
BAGGAGE DOOR ADJUSTMENT (CE-748 CE-772 AND AFTER; CJ- 149 AND AFTER;
D- 10097 0-10120 AND AFTER)
If the large baggage door does not open freely, the door latch pins may not be retracting enough. This may be cor-
a. Removethe upholsterypaneling.
c. Loosen the pin eye jam nut and turn the pin eye "in" to shorten the tube assemblies; turn the pin eye "out" to
lengthen the tube assemblies.
d. After the desired length has been set, tighten the pin eye jam nut. Install the pins, washers and cotter keys.
Page
2~’2’3199 52130100 A21
Ray~heon Aircraft
BEECH BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
If additional inward tension for a tighter fit of the door is required, adjust inward the three striker plates on the door
sill (large door), or inward on the single latch mechanism contact plate on the door sill (small door).
3
A21 52-30-00 Dec 23/99Page
CHAPTER
FUSELAGE
Raycheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 53 FUSELAGE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
53-1 0-00
53-30-00
Fuselage Access Openings (CE-748, CE-772 and After, CJ-149 and After) ........1
Fuselage Access Openings(E-llll, E-1241 and After, EA-1 and After). ..........3
Fuselage Skin Thickness (CE-748, CE-772 and After, CJ-149 and After) ..........4
Fuselage Skin Thickness(E-llll, E-1241 and After, EA-1 and After) ............8
Page 1
CHAPTER 53 FUSELAGE
1
A26 53-LOEP Sep 30/04Page
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
This procedure provides inspection and repair information relating to the forward wing spar structure at the forward
and aft frames.
NOTE: The areas identified in Figure 1 should be inspected for cracking at the intervals specified for non repaired
structures by Chart 1 using the following inspection procedure:
a. Remove the carry-through cover to obtain access to the forward spar carry-through structure. Refer to the
FORWARD CARRY-THROUGH SPAR COVER REMOVAL procedure in 25-00-00.
b. Thoroughly clean the forward and aft frames (webs) of the forward spar carry-through structure in the areas
d. Perform a fluorescent or dye penetrant inspection of the cleaned area per MIL-STD-6866 and inspect for
evidence of cracks.
e. If cracks are discovered, determine the crack size and method of repair as outlined in the WING FORWARD
SPAR CARRY-THROUGH STRUCTURE REPAIR/INSPECTION procedure.
f. If no cracks are noted, install the carry-through cover. Refer to the FORWARD CARRY-THROUGH SPAR
COVER INSTALLATION procedure in 25-00-00.
NOTE: The areas identified in Figure 1 should be inspected for cracking at the intervals specified for repaired
structures by Chart 2 using the following inspection procedure:
a. Remove the carry-through cover to obtain access to the forward spar carry-through structure. Refer to the
FORWARD CARRY-THROUGH SPAR COVER REMOVAL procedure in 25-00-00.
b. Thoroughly clean the forward and aft frames (webs and reinforcing doubler) of the forward spar carry-through
structure in the areas shown in Figure 1 with solvent (26, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
d. Perform a fluorescent or dye penetrant inspection of the cleaned area per MIL-STD-6866 and inspect for
evidence of cracks.
e. If cracks are discovered in the doubler or the existing web face, the crack has progressed beyond the doubler
profile; contact the Technical Support Department at Raytheon Aircraft Company for further instructions.
f. If no cracks are noted, install the carry-through cover. Refer to the FORWARD CARRY-THROUGH SPAR
COVER INSTALLATION procedure in 25-00-00.
1
53-1 0-00
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
INSPECTION
AREA
op
oso´•0
8
´•8 3
98 a
aa oo
~O
:O O
aa
u i Oe~ I
"e~
eg
a as
"ae
O
jl
IIa
a\o
a
a
a
a,
a
’Oso,,.~
a
a
aaa
B
Qis
a,
INSPECTION a_s
BEND AREA o
RADIUS AFT WEB
TYPICAL
TYPICAL
CRACK
CRACK
LOCATIONS
LOCATIONS
INSPECTION
INFECT FOR CRACKS AROUND HUCKBOLTS,
AREA
BETWEEN HUCKBOLTS, AND ALONG THE
RADIUS OF THE CARRY-THROUGH WEB
D
IN THE INSPECTION AREAS.
INSPECTION
nREa
~p´•´" O 80
6"
aa o
O e b ~ O O
PD O O
o
QO Q a
a
8 00
TYPICAL Q
CRACK aa
LOCATIONS a
daa
a aa6
a a ba
a
aaaa
e _I~,. o´•´•´•6
a
QQ,QQ’ AREAINSPECTION
FORWARD WEB EA53B
W2364AAAI
2
Sep 30/4Page 53-1 0-00 A26
RBYtheOll AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: The extent of repair/inspection is limited to cracking in the radius of the web flange and cracks in the web
face around the fasteners in the lower forward spar cap.
The following procedure should be performed to repair/inspect cracks in the bend radius (Ref. Figure 1):
CAUTION: Caution must be used during the stop drilling operation. Do not drill into the spar cap, skin or any other
structure. A thin stainless steel sheet may be used to prevent damaging adjacent structure.
a. A crack exceeding 4.0 inches in length must be repaired PRIOR TO FURTHER FLIGHT per the applicable kit
listed in Chart 3.
b. A crack up to 4.0 inches in length must be stop drilled with a #30 drill bit at the crack ends. The area must be
repaired per the applicable kit listed in Chart 3 within the next 100 flight hours, 12 months or the next scheduled
inspection, whichever occurs first.
The following procedure should be performed to repair/inspect cracks in the web face around the huck-bolt fasteners
(Ref. Figure 1):
CAUTION: Do not stop drill, due to the possibility of damaging structure behind web face.
a. A crack passing through two fasteners and extending beyond for more than 0.5 inch on either end shall be
repaired PRIOR TO FURTHER FLIGHT per the applicable kit listed in Chart 3.
b. Any other crack shall be repaired per the applicable kit listed in Chart 3 within the next 25 flight hours, 12 months
or the next scheduled inspection, whichever occurs first.
a. If cracks are found in both the forward and aft frames on the same side of the airplane, in either the web face
and/or the bend radius, and any of the cracks are more than 1.0 inch long, a repair shall be made PRIOR TO
FURTHER FLIGHT.
b. If cracks are found in both the forward and aft frames on the same side of the airplane, in either the web face
and/or the bend radius, and all of the cracks are less than 1.0 inch long, a repair shall be made per the applicable
kit listed in Chart 3 within the next 25 flight hours, 12 months or the next scheduled inspection, whichever occurs
first.
c. If a fuselage skin crack is discovered around the opening for the lower forward carry-through fitting, an external
skin doubler may be required. Contact the Technical Support Department at Raytheon Aircraft Company for
further instructions.
d. Install the carry-through cover. Refer to the FORWARD CARRY-THROUGH SPAR COVER INSTALLATION
procedure in 25-00-00.
3
n2s 53-1 0-00Page
RBy~heOn AsKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
I Inspection Program For Non Repaired Structures
AIRCRAFT INITIAL FREQUENCY OF
I SERIAL NO. INSPECTION INSPECTION
I Model F33A (CE-748, CE-772 thru CE-1192) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
I Model V35B (D-10097, D-10120 thru D-10403) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
Model A36 (E-llll, E-1241 thru E-2397) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
Model A36TC (EA-I1 thru EA-272, except EA-242) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
Model B36TC (EA-242, EA-273 thru EA-471)
Chart 2
I Inspection Program For Repaired Structure
AIRCRAFT AFTER DOUBLER I FREQUENCY OF
I SERIAL NO. INSTALLATION INSPECTION
Model F33A (CE-748, CE-772 thru CE-1192) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
I Model V35B (D-10097, D-10120 thru D-10403) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
Model A36 (E-llll, E-1241 thru E-2397) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
Model A36TC (EA-11 thru EA-272, except EA-242) 1,500 HOURS 500 HOURS
Model B36TC (EA-242, EA-273 thru EA-471)
4
Sep 30/4Page 53-1 0-00 A26
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
~Chart 3
Forward Spar Carry-Through Structure Repair Kits I
AIRCRAFT PART OUANTITY
SERIAL NO. NUMBER KIT DESCRIPTION PER AIRCRAFT
Model F33A (CE-748, CE-772 and After) 36-4004-5 FORWARD SPAR 1 REQUIRED
Model F33C (CJ-149 thru CJ-179) CARRY-THROUGH
Model V35B (D-10097, D-10120 thru D-10403) STRUCTURE
Model A36 (E-llll, E-1241 and After) REINFORCEMENT
Model A36TC (EA-11 thru EA-241, EA-243 thru (FORWARD FRAME)
EA-272)
Model F33A (CE-748, CE-772 and After) 36-4004-7 FORWARD SPAR 1 REQUIRED
Model F33C (CJ-149 thru CJ-1 79) CARRY-TH ROUGH
Model V35B (D-10097, D-10120 thru 0-10403) STRUCTURE
Model A36 (E-llll, E-1241 and After) REINFORCEMENT
Model A36TC (EA-11 thru EA-241, EA-243 thru (AFT FRAME)
EA-272)
Model B36TC (EA-242, EA-273 and After) 36-4004-9 FORWARD SPAR 1 REQUIRED
CARRY-THROUGH
STRUCTURE
REINFORCEMENT
(FORWARD FRAME)
Model B36TC (EA-242, EA-273 and After) 36-4004-11 FORWARD SPAR 1 REQUIRED
CARRY-THROUGH
STRUCTURE
REINFORCEMENT
(AFT FRAME)
5
A26 53-1 0-00 Sep 30/04Page
BEECHCRAFT
BONAN;ZA SER6S
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
3 2
5 1
4 5 6
7 5
33´•13-15
Fuselage Access Openings (CE-t48, CE-772 and atter; CJ-149 and atter)
Figu~e
53-3MK)
Page 1
Uay 9(80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TS
1 3 4
O
5 2
87 6
53-30-00
page 2
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
3 2
~70 o~ D
2 456
7 8
3&1517
Fuselage Access Openings (E-llll, E-1241 and alter; EA-1 and alter)
Figure 3
53-30-00
Page 3
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
THICNESS
NUMBER MA TEFIIAL ININCHES
1. 2024-T3 .020
2. 2024-73 .025
3. 2024-73 .032
4. 2024-742 .020
5. 2024-742 .032
7. 6061-76 .025
8. 6061-76 .040
Fuselage Skin Thickness (CE-748, CE-n2 and after; CJ-149 and atter)
Figure 4 (Sheet 1 of 2)
53-30-00
Page 4
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
9 3 3 7 6 8
3 1 3
;I i 3 e 2 7 6 8
1 3 3i3 19
i 8 4i 7 4 3 1 3 7
32 5 i
293 1 1
2 9 1 i
33-13´•18
Fuselage Skin Thickness (CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after)
Figure 4 (Sheet 2 of 2)
53-30-00
Page 5
May 9/80
BEECHCFIAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
THICKNESS
NUMBER MA TERIAL ININCHES
1. 2024-73 .020
2. 2024-73 .025
3. 2024-73 .032
4. 2024-742 .020
6. 6061-76 .025
7. 6061-76 .040
53-3090
Page 6
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
s 3 3 3
s 8 2 3 3 j
1 4 3 3 3
7 3 2 3 3 i
3 3 3 3 4
6 1 3 3 32 223
1 1 1 8
1 3 8
36-13-19
53-30-00
Page 7
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
THICKNESS
NUMBE~ MA TERIAL ININCHES
1. 2024-T3 .020
2. 2024-T3 .025
3. 2024-T3 .032
4. 2024-T3 .040
5. 2024-T3 .063
6. 2024-T4 .032
7. 2024-T42 .020
8. 2024-f42 .032
9. 6061-T4 .025
Fuselage Skin Thicknesa (E-llll, E11241 and after; EA-1 and after)
Figure 6 (Sheet 1 ot 2)
53-30-00
Page 8
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i? 3 1 3 5 7 3 1 1.2 1
~10
i s s 9 s 3 3 1 i i:6
4 5 1 13 2
1 1 1 1 3 13 2 10
l~o 1~1 1? 2 5 3 1 3
11 2 3 1 3
‘Ip a 2 a 1? a 7 5 3 i 3 12
Fuselage Skin Thickness (E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1 and after)
Figure 6 (Sheet 2 of 2)
"END"
53-30-00
Page 9
May 9/80
CHAPTER
STABILIZERS
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 55 STABILIZERS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
55-00-00
55-10-00
Horizontal Stabilizer Removal ~CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; E-llll, E-1241 and aqer; EA-1 and
after) 1
Horizontal Stabilizer Installation (CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1
and after)
Stabilizer Removal (D-10097, D-10120 and after) 1
Stabilizer Installation (0-10097, D-10120 and after) 1
55-20´•00
Balancing The Elevator (CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1 and after) 1
Checking Balance 1
Check Balance By Force Measurement 1
Balancing Procedure Force Measurement Method _
1
Check Balance By Counterbalancing 3
Balancing Procedure Counterbalancing Method 3
Balancing the Ruddervator (D-10097, D-10120 and after) 4
Checking Balance 4
Checking Balance By Force Measurement 4
Balancing Procedure Force Measurement Method 4
Check Balance By Counterbalancing 5
Balancing Procedure Counterbalancing Method ..........5
55-30-00.
Vertical Stabilizer Removal (CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1 and
after) 1
Vertical Stabilizer Installation (CE-748, CE-772 and after, CJ-1$S and after; E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1 and
after) 1
55-40-00
Balancing The Rudder (CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1 and after) 1
Checking Balance 1
55-CONTENTS
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
"END"
55-CONTENTS
Page 2
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 55
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
55-EFFECTIVITY
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIEB
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ri ii_
9 /8
4
~z
12
55-0090
Page 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINtENANCE MANUAL
1 ~-8
M
5
6
(UPPER AND LOWER)
(COVER)
6’ 12
36-1317
55-0060
Page 2
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFF
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
THICKNESS
NUMBE~ MA TEF~AL IN INCHES
5. 2024-’7 .020
6. 2024-T3 .020
7. 6061-T4 .020
6. 2024-T .032
9. 2024-T3 .032
NOTE
Skin thickness for the left side of the empennage are the same as the right
side.
55-0090
99993
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
NIAINTENANCE MANUAL
a
a
1~3+---4
1
s
1. Stabilizer
2. Stabilizer Tip
3. Ruddervator Worn
4. Ruddervator
5. Stabilizer Hinge
6. Ruddervator Tab
7. Stabilizer Rear Soar
8. Stabilizer Front Spar
36-131´•6
55-0090
Page 4
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONAEUA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
o
Q
4
1´•
(COVER)
36131-5
EMPENNAOE SKIN THICKNESS
THICKNESS
NUMBER MATERIAL IN INCHES
2. 2024-T3 .020
3. 2024-T4 .020
4. 2024´•T3 .025
5. 2024-f3 .040
6. 6061-T6 .040
7. 6061-T6 .050
"END"
55-00-00
Page 5
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
raereht
bolts and the elevator center
spar.
hinge bracket on
STABILIZERAND AFTL~R) REMOYBL ~-10097.
D-1U1201
e. Disconnect the trim tab pushrods. NOTE
f. While supporting the stabilizer, remove the already installed, kits are available
If not
attach bolts at the front spar. to provide additional support to the stabi-
lizer leading edge on V-tail Bonanzas.
Remove the stabilizer. ’Refer to Chapter 51-00-00.
g.
NOTE
d. Remove the attach bolts at the front spar.
must the placed on the forward side of the stabilizer attach bolts at the rear spar.
55-10-00
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
d. Connect the elevator tab cables, accessi- f. Install the applicable elevator. Refer to
ble through the left side fuselage access openings. ELEVATOR INSTALLATION in Chapter 27-21-00.
e. Install the access panels.
"END"
55-10-00
Page 2
Oct 16/92 Ale
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
When the elevator control surface is being repainted, c. A support spindle similar to the illustration
suspend it by the trailing edge so that excess paint and leveling blocks, as required ~blocks spindle
will drain toward the leading edge. AFTER ANY tare).
REPAINTING OR REPAIR, THE FINISHED SURFACE
SHOULD BE CHECK BALANCED TO ENSURE THAT d. A straightedge, ruler and spirit level.
ITS STATIC MOMENT ABOUT THE HINGE LINE IS
WITHIN THE MANUFACTURER’S PRESCRIBED LIM-
Balancing Procedure Force Measurement Method
ITS. The complete painted elevator assembly, includ-
ing the control arm and the tab control rod should not
Locate the chord line by placing a straightedge at the
be tail-heavy over a maximum moment of 7.8 inch- inboard end of the elevator so that one end is aligned
pounds. The static moment is the total unbalanced with the center of the torque tube and the other end
weight of the elevator control surface multiplied by is centered on the trailing edge. Mark the chord line
the perpendicular distance from its hinge centerline
by grease pencil or other means on the rib. Remove
to the center of gravity, when the chord line is hor-
the straightedge. Fit correct size bolts in the outboard
izontally level. The weight is measured in pounds and and center hinge brackets and mount the elevator on
the distance in inches. The static moment of a 100
the knife edges. Ensure that it is free to rotate about
percent balanced elevator control surface is 0.0 Ib. A the hinge line. Support the trailing edge behind the
tail-heavy surface exhibits static underbalance. A center hinge point with a spindle resting on a leveled
nose-heavy surface exhibits static overbalance. beam balance platform as illustrated. The spindle
must be vertical throughout the balancing procedure.
CHECKING BALANCE
Hold a spirit level against the marked chord line and
level it by extending or contracting the spindle.
The elevator balance must be checked in a draft-free
Measure the perpendicular distance from the hinge
area with the elevator completely assembled in fiying centerline to the point supported by the spindle.
condidtion. ALL PAINTING, INCLUDING STRIPES AND
Ensure that the spirit level and rule are removed from
TOUCH-UP, MUST BE COMPLETED. The tab, tab th, surface and read the reaction on the beam bal-
pushrod, static wicks, and hinge bolts must be ance.
attached. The chord line must be horizontally level
and the hinge line must be
properly supported when Calculate the static underbalance moment "M" from
the static moment is measured. Although many dif-
th, formula:
ferent methods of check balancing exist, they can be
categorized under the following two headings:
M D(R-T) inch-pounds where,
a. Actual Force Measurement- Measurement
D Perpendicular distance from the hinge center-
of the force applied by the elevator surface on a sin-
line to the spindle point (inches).
gle support at a known distance from the centerline
of thehinge.
R Reaction (pounds)read from the beam balance.
55-20-00
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
YAIIJTENANCE #ANUAL
COUNTERBALANCING
MASKING TAPE
(PLACE NEAR ELEVATOR
HINGE LINE)
CONTAINER
VIEW,A-A
TOP FORWARD SCREW
MASKING TAPE
’CONTAINER
DETAIL B
MASKING TAPE
(TO SECURE 7AB
IN NEUTRAL)
~r´•
ELEVATOR
HINGE
CLEVIS i
KNIFE EDGE
D-----~t
55-1528
JIG MUST BE HORIZONTALLY~LEVEL
55-20-00
Page 2
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
c. Approximately 2 pounds of lead shot.
Since any weighing error is magnified by
d. A certified beam balance weighing device the distance "D", weighing is most impor-
calibrated in units of.Ol pound or lesS. tant and must be done carefully on scales
that are certified for accuracy.
55-20-00
Page 3
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Coat the weight with a corrosion preven- The equipment required to perform the check balance
tive material such as zinc chromate primer by force measurement is as follows:
(20, Chart 1, 91-00-00) to insulate the dis-
similar metals. Replace the elevator horn A stand with
a. knife-edge supports as illus-
cover and recheck the balance. trated in Figure 1. The knife edges should be in the
same horizontal plane.
BALANCING THE RUDDERVATOR (0-10097,
0-10120 AND AFTER) b. A certified beam balance calibrated in
(Figure 1) units of.Ol Ib. or less. The balance should have a flat
weighing platform and its capacity should equal tare
When the ruddervator control surface is being
plus 2.0 Ibs. minimum.
repainted, suspend it by the trailing edge so that
excess paint will drain toward the leading edge. A
c. support spindle similar to the illustration
AFTER ANY REPAINTING OR REPAIR, THE FINISHED
and leveling blocks, as required (blqcks spindle
SURFACE SHOULD BE CHECK BALANCED TO
tare).
ENSURE THAT ITS STATIC MOMENT ABOUT THE
HINGE LINE IS WITHIN THE MANUFACTURER’S PRE-
d. A straightedge, ruler and spirit level.
SCRIBED LIMITS. The complete painted
rudddervator assembly, including the control arm and
the tab control cable attach bolt, nut and washer for
Balancing Procedure Force Measurement Method
a. Actual Force Measurement Measurement D Perpendicular distance from the hinge center-
of the force applied by the ruddervator surface on a line to the spindle point (inches).
single support at a known distance from the center-
line of the hinge. R Reaction (pounds)read from the beam balance.
b. Counterbalancing The application of a T Tare, i.e. spindle plus leveling blocks or shims
known force or weight at a measured distance from on the scale platform (pounds).
the hinge line to counter the unbalance moment of
the ruddervator assembly. The following is an example:
5120-00
Page 4
Oct 16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
M 13.5 (2.26 -1.00); M 17.0 inch-pounds. Be certain the forward top screw on the
ruddervator leading edge tip is secured
M is within the range which is satisfactory, after the ruddervator has been balanced.
a. A stand with knife-edge supports as illus- Remove the cup, contents, and
g. string, then
trated in Figure 1. The knife edges must be in the weigh them.
same horizontal plane.
NOTE
b. A paper cup or similar lightweight contain-
er.
Since any weighing error is magnified by
the distance "D", weighing is most impor-
c. Approximately 3.5 pounds of lead shot.
tant and must be done carefully on scales
that are certified for accuracy.
d. A certified beam balance weighing device
calibrated in units of.Ol pound or less.
h. Calculate the static balance as follows:
e. A straightedge, ruler, and a spirit level. 1. The weight of the cup and contents is
designated by "W".
Balancing Procedure Counterbalancing Method
2. The over or underbalance moment is
a. Locate the chord line by placing a´•
b. Secure the trim tab in its neutral position Assume the ruddervator was underbalance (tail-
with a small piece of masking tape, heavy) and the paper cup was suspended from the
leading edg’e. If the ruddervator balances with the
c. Fit the correct size bolts in the hinge clev- chord line level as "W 2.83 pounds" and "D 6.0
ises and mount the ruddervator on the knife-edge inches", then:
supports. Ascertain that the ruddervator is free to
rotate about the hinge line. M 2.83 x 6.0
d. To determine if weight should be added or M 17.0 inch-pounds. The product of "W x D". In this
removed, if the balance is tail-down: instance, "M" is within the required static balance
range and is therefore acceptable.
On the ruddervator leading edge tip, slightly loosen
the forward top screw. Suspend a paper cup on the i. The complete painted ruddervator assem-
inboard side of the tip and wrap the string around the bly, including the control and the tab
control
arm
screw. Secure the string to the surface with a small cable attach bolt, nut and washer for both sides of the
piece of masking tape aft of the forward top screw tab, should not be tail-heavy over a maximum of 14.4
and near the hinge centerline as shown in Figure 1. to 17.4 inch-pounds. If the static balance does not
The cup must be free to hang vertically. comply, remove the ruddervator horn cover and add
55-20-00
Page 5
Ale Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
or remove solder to bring the ruddervator balance (20, Chart 1, 91-00-00) to insulate the dis-
within the required limits. similar metals. Replace the ruddervator
horn cover and recheck the balance.
NOTE
"END"
5120-00
Page 6
Oct16/92 A16
BEECHCRAFT
EIONAEUA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
VERTICAL STABILIZER MAINTENANCE e. Pull the stabilizer straight up to remove it from the
PRACTICES fuselage.
"END"
55-3040
Page 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
leading edge. After any repainting or repair, the finished the trailing edge. by grease pencil or
Mark the chord line
surface must be check balanced to ensure that its static other means on the rib. Remove the straight edge. Fit
moment about the hinge line is within the manufacturers correct size bolts in the outboard and center hinge brackets
prescribed limits. The complete painted rudder assembly, and mount the rudder on the knife edges. Ensure that it is
including the control arm should not be tail-heavy over a free to rotate about the hinge line. Support the trailing edge
maximum of 8.4 inch-pounds. The static moment of the behind the center hinge point with a spindle resting on a
rudder is determined by multiplying the unbalanced weight levelled beam balance platform as illustrated. The spindle
of the rudder assembly times the perpendicular distance must be vertical throughout the balancing procedure. Hold a
from the hinge center line to the center of gravity when the spirit level against the marked chord line and level it by
chord line ishorizontally level. The weight is measured in extending or contracting the spindle, or by using blocks and
pounds and the distance in inches. The static moment of a shims under the spindle. Measure the perpendicular
100 percent balanced rudder assembly is 0.0 inch-pounds. distance from the hinge center line to the point supported by
Tail heaviness indicates static underbalance while nose the spindle. Ensure that the spirit level and rule are removed
heaviness indicates static overbalance, from the surface and read the reaction on the beam
balance. Calculate the static underbalance moment "M"
from the formula:
CHECKING BALANCE
M D(R-T) inch-pounds where,
The rudder balance must be checked in a draft free area D Perpendicular distance from the hinge center line to
with the rudder completely assembled in flying condition. All the spindle point (inches).
and touch-up, must be completed. R Reaction (Pounds) read from the beam balance.
painting, including stripes
the tab, static wicks, and hinge bolts must be attached. The T Tare, i.e. spindle plus levelling blocks or shims on the
chord line must be horizontally level and the hinge line must scale platform (Pounds).
be properly supported when the static moment is measured.
Although many different methods of check balancing exist, The following is an example:
they can be categorized under the following two headings:
D is 13.8 inches, R 1.49 Ib. and T is 1.00 Ib.
a.Actual Force Measurement Measurement of the M 13.8 (1.49 1.00); M 6.8 inch-pounds.
force applied by the rudder surface on a single support at a M is within the range which is satisfactory.
known distance from the center Ilne of the hinge. If M is not within the prescribed range, refer to step h, under
b. Counterbalancing The application of a known BALANCING PROCEDURE COUNTEABALANCING
force weight at a measured distance from the hinge line
or METHOD.
to counter the unbalance moment of the rudder assembly.
a. A stand with knife edge supports as illustrated in Figure 1. The knife edges must be in the same horizontal
Ib. or less. The balance should have a flat weighing platform d. A certified beam balance weighing device
and its capacityshould equal tare plus 2.0 Ibs. minimum. calibrated in units of .01 pound or less.
c. A support spindle similar to the illustration and a. A straight edge, ruler, and spirit level.
55-40-00
Page 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
NIAINTENANCE MANUAL
MASKING TAPE
A,C IPLPICI NEAR RUDDER HINGE LINT)
r
CONTAINER
B, DETAIL C
CONTAINER
B
KNIFE EDGE
D
1‘ Iii
NTAINER
CONTAINER
VIEW A-A
55-40-00
Pega 2
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
tail-down. Use a short length of small diameter string M inch-pounds. In this instance,
8.1 "M" is
secured to the surface with a small piece of masking tape within the required static balance range and is
as illustrated in Figure 1. The cup must be free to hang therefore acceptable.
vertically.
d. Add small quantities of lead shot to the cup until h. Thecomplete painted rudder assembly, including
the rudder balances with the chord line level. Check this by the control be tail-heavy over a maximum of
arm must not
holding a spirit level aligned with the marked chord line. 8.4 inch-pounds. If the static balance does not comply,
a. The distance "D" must be perpendicular to the remove the weight in the rudder horn and add or remove
hinge line. Measure "D" from the hinge line to the solder to bring the rudder balance within required limits.
suspension point of the cup.
f. Remove the cup, contents, and string, then weigh
them.
NOTE
NOTE
Coat the weight with a corrosion preventative
Since any weighing error is magnified by the material such as zinc chromate primer to
distance "D", weighing is most important and insulate the dissimilar metals. Replace the
must be done carefully on scales that are weight in the rudder horn and recheck the
certified for accuracy. rudder balance.
"END"
55-40´•00
Page 3
May 9/80
CHAPTER
VVINDOVVS
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 56 WINDOWS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
r~
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
GENERAL 56-00-00
Description and Operation ......1
Maintenance Practices ......1
Cleaning Plastic Windows ......1
CABIN .56-20-00
Maintenance Practices .´•´•´•´•´•´•´•´•I ......1
Openable Window Removal ..........I .......f
Openable Window Installation .......1
Utility Dears Window Removal (E-llll, E-1241
and after; EA-I and after) .......j .......1
Utility Doors Window Installation (E-llll, E-1241
and after; EA-1 and after) ..........i .......1
Windows Aft of Openable Windows Removal ..........I .......1
Windows Aft of Openable Windows Installation ..........i; :......1
"END"
S&CONTENTS
Page 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 56
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
"END"
5&EFFECTIVITY
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE
GENERAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION moist chamois. Do not rub the plastic window with a
dry cloth because this will cause an electrostatic
The windshield and windows for the Bonanza Series charge which attracts dust.
airplanes are made of cast acrylic plexiglass.
Remove oil and grease with a cloth moistened with
The flight compartment of each airplane is equipped kerosene (58, Chart 1, 91-00-00), aliphatic naphtha
with a windshield, cabin door window, and a left cabin (26, Chart 1, 91-00-00) or hexane ~59, Chart 1,
window with an enclosed storm window. The cabin 91-00-00), then rinse the window with clear water.
area of the airplane contains
openable window on
an
"END"
56-00-00
Page 1
A16 Oct 16/92
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WINDSHIELD REMOVAL
(Figure I)
DEFROSTER GLARESHIELD
a. Remove the glareshield. Refer to GLARESHIELD \DU/CT,
REMOVAL, Chapter 39-10-00.
b. Remove the attaching screws from the defroster
duct and move the duct to clear the lower row of rivets on the
windshield.
c. Mark the position of the three giareshield supports
attached to the inside of the windshield frame. Y
d. Mark the location and remove the headliner trim j
strips and lower the headliner to permit the windshield to be
WINDSHIELD
removed. ,s.l,o-?5
FRAME
e. Remove any necessary molding that covers the
window frame to facilitate windshield removal.
f. Remove the rivets from around the windshield. Windshield
g. Remove the windshield. Figure 1
f. Remove the windshield, burr all holes and apply 91-00-00). Touch up any scratches or bare metal with zinc
(17, Chart 1, 91-00-00) to the windshield
Presstite 576 sealer chromate primer (20, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
frame where it makes contact with the canopy section, b. Place the window in position and mark the area
g. Place the windshield in position and cleco in place. where material must be removed from the window frame to
h. Using rivets, secure the windshield to the canopy obtain a proper fit.
sectionmaking sure the glareshield supports are installed in c. Remove the window and trim off the excess
the same position as they were removed. material determined in step "b".
as
i. Clean off the excess Presstite 576 sealer from the d. Place the window in position and cleco in place
outside of the window frame. using the pilot holes provided.
j. Place a narrow bead of EC1814 sealer (18, Chart e. Back drill the window frame using the existing
1, 91-00-00) to the outside window frame where the frame holes in the canopy section as a guide.
meets the canopy section. Remove excess sealer. f. Remove the window, burr all holes; and apply
56-1090
Page 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i Presstite 576 sealer (17, Chart 1, 91-00-00) to an area c. Remove the trim strip around the inside of the
approximately 1/2 inch wide on the canopy section where the window.
old sealer was removed, d. To facilitate reinstallation, mark the location of the
g. Place the window in position and cleco in place. trim strip clips.
Using rivets, secure the window to the canopy
h. e. Remove the rivets around the window retainer.
sectionmaking sure the trim strip clips are reinstalled in the f. Remove the window.
same position as removed.
a. Install the two internally threaded hinge pins at the When riveting the window in place, install the
bottom of the storm window. trimstrip clips in the same locations as marked in
b. Close the latch mechanism at the top of the storm step "d" of the window removal procedure.
window.
"END"
56-10-00.
Page2
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i CABIN MAINTENANCE PRACTICES PR1221B1/2 sealer (22, Chart 1, 91-00-00) to the area of the
window located in step "d".
OPENABLE WINDOW REMOVAL f. Place the window in position and rivet the retaining
strips in place.
a. Remove the emergency release pin.
b. Remove the hinge pin.
NOTE
OPENABLE WINDOW INSTALLATION Connect the latch link rod if the forward window
is being replaced.
a. Install the hinge pin.
b. Install the emergency release pin.
g. Clean excess sealer from the outside of the
window edge and install the interior window molding.
UTILIN DOORS WINDOW REMOVAL
(E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1 and altar)
WINDOWS AFT OF OPENABLE WINDOWS
a. Remove the window molding trim. REMOVAL
b. Remove the rivets from the window retaining
strips. a. Remove the upholstery panels as required to gain
access to the window frame.
b. Remove the trim strip from around the inside of the
NOTE i window.
c. Remove the rivets (Model A36 series airplanes),
When removing the rivets from the retainers on or screws from the window retaining strips,
the fon~vard window, remove the latch link rod so d. Remove the window.
that all the rivets are accessible.
UTILIN DOORS WINDOW INSTALLATION a. Clean the sealer from the cabin section where the
(E-llll, E-1241 and after; EA-1 and aHer) old window was removed using toluol (19, Chart 1, 91-00-
primer (20, Chart 1, 91-00-00). where the old sealer was removed.
b. If retaining strips are required, dimple the rivet
new c. Place the window in position and install the
holes in the retaining strips with a 5/16 inch dimpler. window retaining strips to the cabin section with screws. On
c. Place the window in position and cleco the the Model A36 series airplanes only, the retaining strips are
retaining strips in place. secured with screws on the top retainer and rivets on the
d. Tape the entire outside surface of the window, then side and bottom retainers.
trim the excess tape away from the area that overlaps the d. Clean excess sealer from the outside of the
door frame. This procedure locates the area that the new window edge and install the trim strips to the inside of the
sealer is to be applied. window.
e. Remove the retaining strips and window. Apply e. install the upholstery panels.
"END"
56-20-00
Page 1~
May 9/80
C H A PT E R
VVINGS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 57 WINGS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
57-00-00
WingTip Removal.
WingTip Installation
Wing Removal.
Removalof Leading Edgeand Main Spar ...............3
Wing Installation
Adjusting the Wings
Wing Boltand Fitting Inspection ´•10
57-30-00
57-40-00
57-50-00
Balancing Procedure.
Counterbalancing Method -1
1
57-CONTENTS Sep 30/04Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 57 WINGS
1
A26 57-LOEP Sep 30/04Page
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The all metal wing group consists of the front and rear spars, leading edge, wing tips, flaps, ailerons, and fuel tanks.
The wing tips, flaps, and aiierons are readily removable. The forward wing attaching point is located at FS 83.00
while the rear wing attaching point is located at FS 118.00 on all Model 33, 35 and 36 series airplanes. An optional
remote compass is located in the left wing tip on all serials except CJ-149 and After. I
1
57-00-00Page
Ibytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENAN~E MANUAL
c. Disconnect the remote compass at the left wing tip (if installed).
a. Connect the remote compass at the left wing tip (if installed).
c. Place the wing tip in position and secure it to the wing with screws.
WING REMOVAL
d. Remove the wing mounting bolt access plates from the top and bottom of the wing.
e. Place the airplane on jacks and raise the airplane until the wheels are clear of the ground. Refer to Chapter
7-00-00 for jacking instructions. A three point jack should be used because of the unbalanced condition of the
airplane after the wing is removed.
g. Operate the landing gear switch until the inboard landing gear doors are fully open.
h. Disconnect the inboard door actuator rod from the control horn.
i. Disconnect the landing gear uplock cable at the inboard connection in the wheel well.
j. Disconnect the landing gear actuator rod from the V-brace in the wheel well.
k. Disconnect and cap the fuel lines between the wing root rib and the fuselage.
i. Disconnect and cap the pitot line at the left wing root in the wheel well.
n. Disconnect and identify the aileron cables at the turnbuckles located inside the cabin, forward of the rear spar
below the floorboards.
p. Cradlethe wing.
q. Place a wing stand under the wing not being removed and place a stand under the tail.
r. Outline the position of the wing on the fuselage as a guide for reinstallation.
CAUTION: There should be no bolt binding during removal. Should binding occur, adjust the wing position until the
bolt disengages freely. Do not screw or drive a bolt in or out of the fittings.
s. Remove the mounting nuts, bolts and washers from the wing.
WARNING: A bushing is installed in the lower front spar attach fitting. This bushing should not be removed
when the wing is removed, and must be in place when the wing is reinstalled.
NOTE: Discard the mounting nuts. Install new mounting nuts when installing the wing.
Discard the special soft aluminum washer used on the wing upper mounting bolts. Install new aluminum
washers when installing the wing.
t. Disconnect the cold air flex duct at the wing leading edge.
The wing must be removed from the airplane before the leading edge or main spar can be removed. Remove the
attaching screws at the wing tip and wing butts. Access to the screws at the main spar root is through the wheel well.
Pull the hinge pins which attach the leading edge, disconnect the landing gear and remove the main spar.
NOTE: Support the landing gear to avoid damaging the aft spar gear connection or remove the gear at both
connections.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to spin the hinge pin in with a drill motor. Heat and expansion may cause the wire to seize
or break.
3
57-00-00 SepPa39~Page
Ra~hMm nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
+*EB-126 NUT
(EXTERNAL WRENCHING)
131790-1 BOLT
WING FITTING
t+MS20002-12WASHER
FUSELAGE FITTING
DRAIN 105090A032-12K WASHER
HOLE
WET BOLT TORQUE: 2480 TO 2600 INCH-POUNDS. COAT THE COMPLETE BOLT, NUT,
WASHER, WING FITTING BOLT BORES, AND EXPOSED BOLT THREADS WITH MIL-C-1617~,
GRADE 2 CORROSION PREVENTIVE COMPOUND.
MS20002--12 WASHERS MAY BE USED AS REQUIRED BETWEEN THE NUT AND 95-110025-1
WASHER TO PROVIDE A PROPER BOLT GRIP ADJUSTMENT.
USED CD-928 AND AFTER, CJ-156 AND AFTER, D-10353 AND AFTER,
E-1758 AND AFTER AND EA-150 AND AFTER.
NOTE
NOTE
SEE CHART 2 FOR CONCURRENT WITH THE SCHEDULED
TOOLS TORQUE CHECK, INSPECT THE UPPER
WING BOLT
WING ATTACH FITTINGS TO ASSURE THAT
THE DRAIN HOLES ARE CLEAR.
EF157B
oo314iaa
105090A032-105
WASHER 35-105111-3 WASHER
95-110025-7 WASHER
(POSITION WIM COUNTERSINK
(CHECK FOR A SMOOTH COMPLETE RADIUS) TOWARDS BOLT HEAD)
(POSITION RADIUS TOWARD THE FITTING)
12NB108 NUT
1309098103
BOLT
WET BOLT TORQUE: 1,180 TO 1,3M) INCH-POUNDS. COAT THE COMPLETE BOLT, NUT,
WASHERS, WING FITTING BOLT BORES, AND EXPOSED BOLT THREADS WITH MIL-C-16173,
GRADE 2 CORROSION PREVENTIVE COMPOUND.
USED CE-935 AND AFTER; CJ-156 AND AFTER; D-10359 AND AFTER;
8-1791 AND AFTER; EA-177 AND AFTER.
MS20002-10 WASHER
(ONE OR TWO MS20002-10 WASHERS NOTE
MAY BE USED BETWEEN THE NUT
SEE CHART 2 FOR
AND THE FITTING TO PROVIDE
WING BOLT TOOLS
PROPER BOLT GRIP ADJUSTMENT.
NOTE
CONCURRENT WITH ME SCHEDULED TORQUE
CHECK, INSPECT THE UPPER WING ATTACH
FlmNGS TO ENSURE THAT THE DRAIN
HOLES ARE UNOBSTRUCTED.
A E~578
Page 5
A26 57-00 00 Sep 36/04
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
12NB126
NUT
INTERNAL O
WRENCHING
I’
DETAIL A
50-105011 WASHER NOTE: BUSHING NOT USED
(REPLACES THE MS20002-12 EA-242, EA-273 AND AFTER
WASHER ON AIRPLANE SERIALS
EA-242, EA-273 AND AFTER) ~131790-2 BOLT
1317903 BOLi
WING FITTI
MS20002-12 WASHER
FUSELAGE FITTING
WET BOLT TORQUE: 2, 480 TO 2, 600 INCH-POUNDS (ALL SERIALS EXCEPT EA-242,
EA-273 AND AFTER), 2,880 TO 3,000 INCH-POUNDS (EA-242, EA-273 AND AFTER).
COAT THE COMPLETE BOLT, NUT, WASHER, WING FITTING BOLT BORES, AND
EXPOSED THREADS WITH MIL-C-16173, GRADE 2 CORROSION PREVENTIVE COMPOUND.
CHECK WASHER FOR A SMOOTH CONTINUOUS OUTER RADIUS AND POSITION WITH RADIUS
TOWARD BOLT HEAD.
~X USED CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; CJ-149 AND AFTER; E-llll, E-1241 AND AFTER;
D-10097, D-10120 AND AFTER; EA-1 THRU EA-272 EXCEPT EA-242.
WASHER NOT USED UNDER BOLT HEAD EA-242, EA-273 AND AFTER.
PRIOR TO D-10353; CE-928; CJ-156; E-1758; EA-150.
USED D-10353 AND AFTER, CE-928 AND AFTER; CJ-156 AND AFTER; E-1758 AND
AFTER; EA-150 THRU EA-272, EXCEPT EA-242.
EF(57B
01
DETAIL A
130909B274 BOLT
12NB108 NUT
NOTE
SEE CHART 2 FOR (CHECK FOR A SMOOTH COMPLETE
WING BOLT TOOLS RADIUS)(POSITION RADIUS TOWARD
FITTING AS SHOWN)
WET BOLT TORQUE: 1,180 TO 1.300 INCH-POUNDS. COAT THE COMPLETE BOLT, NUT,
WASHERS~ WING FITTING BOLT BORES, AND EXPOSED BOLT THREADS WITH MIL-
C-16173, GRADE 2 CORROSION PREVENTIVE COMPOUND.
USED CE-935 FIND AFTER; CJ-156 AND AFTER; D-10359 AND AFTER; E-1791 AND
AFTER; EA-177 AND AFTER.
EF~578
oa3143ns
7
A26 57-00-00 Sep 30/04Page
RBYtheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
WING INSTALLATION
NOTE: When replacing wing bolts make sure that the replacement bolts have been properly inspected using the
magnetic particle process. Bolts must be magnetically inspected before installation as wing bolts. Bolts may
be acquired through Raytheon Aircraft Parts Inventory and Distribution (RAPID). The individual placing the
order must stipulate the need to have the bolts inspected before shipment.
a. Using a nonmetallic brush and solvent (26 or 31, Chart 1, 91-00-00), clean all wing attach fittings and hardware
(bolts, washers and nuts). Inspect the wing attach fittings, bolts, washers, and nuts instructed under WING
I BOLT AND FITTING INSPECTION.
as
WARNING: Wing bolts that have reached their life limit (10 years after the initial inspection) must not be
reused. The mounting nuts must be replaced at each inspection interval.
b. Coat the fitting bolt bores and bearing faces, bolts, washers and nuts with corrosion preventive compound
(5, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
WARNING: The bushing installed in the lower forward spat attach fitting must be in place prior to
installation of the wing attach bolts.
c. Move the wing into position, align the wing fittings with the carry-through fittings, and insert the bolts.
CAUTION: Each bolt must be inserted by hand without binding. If a bolt cannot be easily inserte;d, reposition the
wing until the bolt moves freely through fittings. Do not drive or screw bolt into the fittings. Bolts and nuts
must be oriented as shown in applicable illustration for each location (Figure 1, 2, 3, and 4).
d. Start the nuts on the upper fomard and aft bolts. Rotate the wing trailing edge until the wing is aligned with the
outline on the fuselage. After alignment is established, verify that the lower forward bolt is not binding in the bolt
bore. If bolt binding is encountered, adjust the wing position until the bolt moves freely.
CAUTION: When torquing wing nuts, assure that the wrenches do not bottom out on wing attach fittings. Such an
occurrence could cause false torque readings and damage to fittings. After torquing the upper forward
wing attach nut, remove the holding force from the wing cradle and torque the remaining three nuts.
CAUTION: Before the lower aft nut is torqued, a slight gap may be evident between the fittings. This gap should not
exceed 0.060 in width. No gap should remain after the nut is torqued. Torque the wing attach bolts at
the nut end, do not rotate the bolt in the bolt bore.
g. Coat the bolt threads that protrude through the nut with corrosion preventive compound (5, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
8
Sep 30/4Page 57-00-00
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
r. At the first scheduled inspection after the wing has been installed, check the attaching bolts for proper torque.
Check the drain ports to assure that they are unobstructed.
After the wing has been installed or repaired, flight tests may show the wing to be chronically heavy or light. This
condition may be corrected by rotating the wing to lower the trailing edge of a heavy wing or raise the trailing edge
of a light wing or by a combination of adjusting both wings. The aluminum washers between the upper wing fittings
must be replaced each time the position of the wing is changed. If both wings have been removed, install the right
wing with the trailing edge at the highest point of the adjustment travel and the left wing 1/16 inch down from the
highest point of travel. The total adjustment on each wing is approximately 1/8 inch. The following steps should be
implemented when adjusting the wings:
a. Using a grease pencil, outline the position of the wing on the fuselage.
b. Place the airplane on a three point jack and raise until the wheels are clear. Refer to Chapter 7-00-00 for jacking
instructions. Place a suitable cradle under the wing being adjusted and a wing stand under the opposite wing.
A tail stand will also be required to assure stability.
c. Loosen the nuts on the lower wingattach bolts’ and remove the bolts and nuts from the upper wing attach fittings.
Coat the bearing faces and bolt bores of the fittings, the complete bolt, washers, and nut with corrosion
preventive compound (5, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Install new soft aluminum washers between the upper wing attach
fittings. Install the bolts, washers, and nuts into the fittings. Raise or lower the trailing edge as required and
torque the wing attach nuts in the following order: upper forward, upper aft, lower forward, and lower aft. There
should be no gap between the fittings after the last nut is torqued. Torque each nut to the wet torque value shown
in the appropriate illustration (Figure 1, 2, 3, and 4). Coat the exposed threads that protrude through the nuts
with corrosion preventive compound (5, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
NOTE: After torquing the upper forward wing attach nut, remove the holding force from the wing cradle prior to
torquing the remaining three nuts.
d. Remove the wing and tail stands, remove the airplane from the jack, and test fly the airplane.
e. At the first scheduled inspection after the wing has been adjusted, check for correct wing bolt torque. Check the
drain ports in the upper wing attach fittings to assure that they are unobstructed.
9
57-00-00Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE: Read the entire section before removing any wing bolts.
WARNING: The wing bolts installed in the Bonanza series airplanes five years old or older must be removed
and inspected. If the bolts prove to be free of all damage, they may be reinstalled for an
additional five year period. At the end of this period the bolts must again be removed and
inspected. Ten years after the initial inspection, all wing bolts must be replaced with new
hardware. The mounting nuts must be replaced at each inspection interval. Render
unserviceable all components removed in compliance with this warning. See Chart 1 for the
inspection and replacement cycle of the wing bolts.
a. Before removing any wing bolt, draw an outline of the wing position on the fuselage with a grease pencil. If wing
bolt binding is encountered and the wing must be shifted, the outline will be helpful in returning the wing to its
original position.
WARNING: Use only the components specified in the applicable illustrations. DO NOT INSTALL THE BLACK
p/N H-20 NUTS, these nuts have been dry film lubricated with molybdenum disulfide. When
MIL-C-16173 Grade II corrosion preventive compound is added to these nuts, the additional
lubrication may cause improper preload in the bolt when It is torqued.
CAUTION: There should be no wing bolt binding during removal or installation of bolts. Do not screw or drive a bolt
in or out of the
fittings. If wing bolt binding is encountered, place the airplane on a three pointjack and
raise until the wheels are clear (see Chapter 7-00-00 forjacking instructions). Place a wing stand under
each wing and a tail stand under the ah fuselage. Defuel the wing, loosen the remaining three bolts and
rotate the wing until the binding bolt moves freely through the fittings. Replace the soft aluminum
washers between the upper wing attach fittings and torque the bolts as instructed under WING
INSTALLATION. If bolt binding is not encountered and the wing has not shifted, replacement of soft
aluminum washers between the upper wing attach fittings is not required.
NOTE: Raytheon Aircraft Company supplies wing attach hardware that has been given an additional magnetic
particle inspection since manufacture. These components may be identified by the green dye on the head
of the bolt and on some portion of the nut.
b. Starting at the lower wing attach point on each side, remove, inspect and torque one bolt at a time until the
complete set of eight bolts and nuts have been inspected.
c. Using a nonmetallic brush, thoroughly clean the bolt, washers and with solvent (26 or 31, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
CAUTION: Assure that the 95-110025-1 (Ref. Figure 1~ the 50-105011 (Ref. Figure 3), and the 95-110025-7 (Ref.
I Figures 2 and 4) washers have a complete radius with no sharp edges that could damage the wing
fittings.
I d. If the bolts do not exceed the life limit shown in Chart 1, visually inspect each bolt with a 10-power or stronger
magnifying glass; inspect for corrosion, cracks, and mechanical damage. The cadmium plating may display
areas that appear rubbed, discolored, or polished. These areas are usually the result of prevailing installation
procedures and are of no significance. A bolt should not be rejected because of cadmium plating deterioration;
however, any component that is cracked, corroded or has mechanical damage must be replaced.
I e. Using the magnetic particle inspection process described in this chapter, check each bolt for circumferential
crack indications. If the bolts prove to be free of all damage (corrosion, cracks, and mechanical damage), they
may be reused after demagnetization and cleaning.
f. Clean the spar fitting bolt bores with naphtha or methyl propyl ketone (26 or 31 Chart 1, 91-00-00). Do not strip
the epoxy paint from this area. Inspect the surface condition of each fitting; focus special attention on the washer
seat and bolt bore area. If scoring, corrosion pitting or washer impressions are discovered in this area, contact
Raytheon Aircraft Technical Support. If the fitting is satisfactory, coat the bolt bore and bearing faces of the fitting
with Alodine 1200, 1200S or 1201 (53, Chart 1, 91-00-00). Allow the coating to remain on the surface for
approximately five minutes. When the time has elapsed, wash the coated areas with water and blow dry (do not
wipe dry). Paint the treated areas with zinc chromate primer (20, Chart 1, 91-00-00) and allow to dry.
g. Coat the bearing faces and bolt bores of the fittings, the complete bolt, washers, and nut with corrosion
preventive compound (5, Chart 1,91-00-00).
CAUTION: Ensure that the wing bolt wrenches do not bottom out on the fittings when torquing the nut. This could
result in damage to the wing fittings and erroneous torque readings.
i. Torque the nut to the wet torque value shown in the appropriate illustration (Ref. Figures 1, 2, 3, and 4). When
a torque wrench adapter is used, the length of the adapter must be added to the length of the torque wrench
and the proper torque value computed as detailed in Chapter 20-00-00.
j. Coat the exposed threads that protrude through the nut with corrosion preventive compound
(5, Chart 1, 91-00-00).
k. Check that the decal shown in Figure 5 is affixed to the appropriate locations on the airplane. When the
corrosion preventive compound has been applied to the wing bolts, affix the decal to the following locations:
1. On the side of the fuselage immediately above the RH forward and aft wing bolt covers.
2. On the wing immediately forward of the LH forward and aft wing bolt covers.
3. On the wing immediately forward of the lower forward wing bolt covers on both sides.
4. On the wing immediately aft of the lower ah wing bolt covers on both sides.
I. Check the drain ports in the upper wing attach fittings to ensure that they are unobstructed and free to drain.
m. At the first scheduled inspection after the wing bolts have been inspected or replaced, check for proper bolt
torque.
Chart 1
Wing Bolt And Nut Inspection And Replacement Cycle
57-00-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 2
Wing Bolt Wrenches And Torque Adapters
POSITION BOLT PART WRENCH NUT PART NUMBER NUT TORQUE
NUMBER PART ADAPTER
NUMBER
NOTICE
WHEN THE CORROSION PREVENTIVE COMPOUND HAS BEEN APPLIED TO THE WING BOLTS.
AFFIX THE ABOVE DECAL TO THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS:
I. ON THE SIDE OF THE FUSELAGE IMMEDIATELY ABOVE THE RH FORWARD AND AFT WING BOLT COVERS.
ON THE WING IMMEDIATELY FORWARD OF THE LH FORWARD AND AFT WING BOLT COVERS.
3. ON THE WING IMMEDIATELY FORWARD OF THE LOWER FORWARD WING BOLT COVERS ON BOTH SIDES.
4. ON THE WING IMMEDIATELY AFT OF THE LOWER AFT WING BOLT COVERS ON BOTH SIDES.
THI iB
992996**
MAGNETIC-PARTICLE INSPECTION
Magnetic-Particle Inspection is a method for locating surface and subsurface discontinuities in ferromagnetic
materials (i.e. materials capable of being magnetized); consequently, nonferromagnetic materials (such as
aluminum alloys, magnesium alloys, copper alloys, lead, titanium alloys, pickle base alloys and many stainless steel
alloys) cannot be inspected by this method. Magnetic-Particle Inspection is based upon the principle that any
discontinuities lying in a direction generally transverse to the direction of the magnetic field of the part magnetized
for the test will cause a leakage field to be formed at and above the surface of the part. The presence of the leakage
field denoting the discontinuity is detected by the use of finely divided ferromagnetic particles over the surface of the
part. Some of the particles are magnetically gathered and held by the leakage field to form an outline indicating the
location, size, shape and extent of the discontinuity. In general, magnetic particle inspection utilizes a variety of
types of equipment for magnetization as well as several methods for application of ferromagnetic particles to the test
part. Additionally, the ferromagnetic particles are available in a selection of colors (including fluorescent) and particle
shapes. Magnetic particle inspections required by this manual can best be accomplished utilizing the wet continuous
method on the standard wet horizontal type equipment with either visible or fluorescent magnetic particles
suspended in a petroleum base vehicle (normally kerosene). Since magnetic particle indications are best obtained
when the discontinuity lies in a direction transverse to the magnetic field, the following procedures are recommended
for optimum detection of discontinuities in bolts.
WARNING: Improper operation of the particle inspection, because of faulty equipment or untrained
operators, can jeopardize the airworthiness of parts being tested. Minute electrical are burns
caused during inspection by improper operation of the test equipment can result in eventual
failure of the part.
13
A26 57-00-00 Sep 30/ 4Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Bolts: Inspection of a bolt is accomplished by longitudinal magnetization in a multiturn low-fill factor coil (i.e. the inner
diameter of the coil greatly exceeds the bolt diameter). For proper magnetization the bolt is positioned close to the
coil inside wall with the bolt length´•perpendicular to the winding direction. The magnetic particle suspension is flowed
on the bolt and the appropriate current is applied to achieve adequate field strength. Using the described procedure,
laboratory testing has indicated that the ampere turn values listed in Chart 3 provide for optimum detection of
discontinuities perpendicular to the bolt axis.
After magnetic particle inspection, the parts must be carefully demagnetized and cleaned of the ferromagnetic
particles. Examine parts for any possible evidence of electric are burn that may have occurred during the inspection.
Chart 3
Magnetic-Particle Inspection
(Steel Bolts)
BOLT DIAMETER TOTAL BOLT LENGTH INCLUDING AMPERE
HEAD TO NEAREST 1/4 INCH TURNS’
Amperage requirement is the ampere turns value divided by the number of tums on the coil. For example:
x &inch long bolt tested on a 5-turn coil would require 6,300
A i-inch diameter 5, or 1,260 amps.
Chart 4
Magnetic-Particle Inspection
(Steel Nuts)
NUT SIZE CENTRAL AMPERAGE
CONDUCTOR SIZE
The outboard wing main spar cap must be inspected annually for corrosion.
WARNING: All areas of the spar cap from the wing attach fitting to the outboard end of the spar cap must
be inspected.
NOTE: Special emphasis should be placed on airplanes that have been operated or stored for extended periods (5
years or longer) where geographical locations or atmospheric conditions are highly conducive to corrosion.
Inspection of the upper and lower spar cap should be accomplished in the following manner:
a. Examine the forward and aft sides of the spar cap where it meets the skin. If a whitish, salt-like, nonmetallic
substance is noted in these areas, a thorough inspection should be performed to determine if corrosion has
occurred. Wax or paint trapped between the edge of the skin and the exposed section of the spar cap should
not be misinterpreted as corrosion.
b. Wash all exposed areas of the upper and lower spar cap.
c. Visually inspect all areas of the upper and lower spar caps for irregularities, such as paint blisters,
exposed
raised or uneven areas, and cracks. The exposed areas of the spar cap are extruded flat and irregularities could
indication of corrosion. Investigate all irregularities to determine if any damage has occurred (Ref. Figure
6).be an
I
NOTE: Uneven or raised areas on the spar caps may be detected by sliding the fingers over the sitrface, by moving
-a straight edge over the surface or by sighting down the length of the par cap surface.
If unusual conditions are encountered that cannot be resolved locally, contact Raytheon Aircraft Technical Support
for evaluation and determination of corrective action that may be required.
15
A26 57-00-00
RaYtRetttt Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SPAR CAP,
-~o RAISED AREAS
CRACKS~’
o
o
\´•’’~O
o
O Z
c
\o
O
\b~c0 O
",~o
o o\;
o
C99-35-23
WING
lpFe5aLEFT WINGS TOP VIEW RIGHT WING
10
9 a ij Q
sZ 11
RIGHT V~ING
WINGS BOTTOY VIEW
LEFT WING 11
38(3-(4
1. Upper fuel cell and transmiiter access 8. Lower aft wing attach bolt
3. Upper aft wing attach bolt 10. Fuel drain (EA-242, EA-273 and after)
4. Optional remote compass (Except CJ-149 and after) 11. Fuel vent float valve, flame anestor, vent and
vacuum refill valve (EA-2;42, EA-273 and~after)
5. Lower fuel cell access
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MAN~AL
8 s 5 5 5 8 s
-I-
4 3
LH UPPER 4 a ~j i 3 ti RH UPPER
8 3 5 5 1 2 5 5 2 1 5 5 3 8
6 4
RH LOWER 4 1 i 3 j j 5 5 j j j 2 LH LOWER
THICKNESS
NUMBER MATERIAL IN INCHES
11.12
ii
1 2024-7 .016
2 2024-73 .016
3 2024-73 .020
4 2024-73 .025
WING TIP EA-242, EA-213 AND AFTER
5 2024-73 .032
NUMBER MATERIAL THICKNESS
6 6061 -T6 .016 IN INCHES
35-12-10
"END"
87-28-88
Page 2
Jan 20/82 A4
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ATTACH FITTINGS MAINTENANCE PRACTICES landing gear support brace and landing gear doors. Minor
fittings include brackets to support cable pulleys, bell cranks,
The major fittings in each wing are the supporting structures and similar components. If the landing gear hinge bolt fittings
adjacent to the attachment points for the flap actuator, flap are cracked or if the spar is warped or buckled, replacement
tracks and flap, aileron hinge brackets and hinges, main is necessary.
"END"
57-401)0
Page 1
May 9/80
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
When the aileron control surface is being repainted, suspend it by the trailing edge so that excess paint will drain
toward the leading edge.
NOTE: After any repainting or repair, the finished surface must be check balanced to ensure that its static moment
about the hinge line is within the prescribed limits.
The painted aileron assembly must be nose-heavy by 0.2 to 1.5 in.-lbs. The static moment of the aileron is I
determined by multiplying the unbalanced weight of the aileron assembly times the perpendicular distance from the
hinge center line to the center of gravity when the chord line is horizontally level. The weight is measured in pounds
and the distance in inches. The static moment of a 100 percent balanced control surface is 0.0 in.-lbs. A tail-heavy
surface exhibits static underbalance. A nose-heavy surface exhibits static overbalance.
CHECKING BALANCE
The aileron balance must be checked in a draft-free with the aileron completely assembled in flying condition.
I
area
a. Counterbalancing The application of a known force or weight at a measured distance from the hinge line to
counter the unbalance moment of the aileron assembly.
b. Actual Force Measurement Measurement of the force applied by the aileron surface on a single support at a
known distance from the center line of the hinge.
a. A stand with knife edge supports as illustrated in Figure 1.The knife edges must be in the same horizontal plane.
BALANCING PROCEDURE
COUNTERBALANCING METHOD
a. Locate the chord line by placing a straight edge at the inboard end of the aileron assembly so that one end is
on the trailing edge and the other end is centered on the
leading edge. Mark the chord line with a suitable
marker, such as a grease pencil, then remove the straight edge.
b. Fit the correct size bolts in the hinge brackets and mount the aileron on the knife edge supports. Ascertain that
the aileron is free to rotate about the hinge line.
57-50-00
Ray~heon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
c. To determine if weight should be added or removed, suspend a paper cup from a point near the center of the
aileron
trailing edge. Use a short length of small diameter string secured to the surface with a small piece of
masking tape as illustrated in Figure 1.The cup must be free to hang vertically.
d. Add small quantities of lead shot to the cup until the aileron balances with the chord line level. Check this by
holding thespirit level aligned with the marked chord line.
e. The distance D must be perpendicular to the hinge line. Meagure D from the hinge line to the suspension point
of the cup.
NOTE: Since any weighing error is magnified by the distance D, weighing is most important and must be done
carefully on scales that are certified for accuracy.
3. M=WxD
4. The following is a typical example of a balancing calculation: Assume the aileron is overbalance
(nose-heavy) and the paper cup was suspended from the trailing edge. Assume that the aileron balances
with the chord line level at W 0.150 Ib and D 10.0 in., then...
M 0.150 x 10.0
M 1.50 in.-lbs. The product of W x D. In this instance, M is within the required static balance range and is
therefore acceptable.
CAUTION: When a lead rod is added to obtain correct balance, it must be installed securely with rivets. A loosely
installed rod will vibrate and may cause an undesirable vibration of the surface.
I h. The center of gravity of the aileron is forward of the hinge center line causing the surface to be nose-heavy.
Proper aileron balance is obtained by adding or removing lead rod at the leading edge of the aileron. The rod is
15/32 in, diameter and is installed in brackets attached to the leading edge of the aileron. When adding
I additional lead rod the maximum total of the length of the rod to be added is not to exceed 5 in. over the entire
length of the aileron and would be installed at the center brackets.
A
B
KNIFE EDGE
DEtAIL B
36(6(-1~
3
A26 57-50-00
C H;9 PT E R
PROPELLERS/
PROPU LSO RS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
SUBJEC T PA GE
61-10-00
Propellers
Propeller Removal.
Propeller installation
Propeller Adjustment.
Minor Propeller Repair
61-20-00
n27 61-CONTENTS
Raytheon Aircraft tompany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 61 PROPELLERS
1
A27
61-LOEP Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
PROPELLERS
The Bonanza airplanes are equipped with a two-blade or three-blade McCauley propeller or a three-blade Hartzell
propeller as indicated in Chart 1. I
Chart 1
Propellers I
McCauley I Hartzell
CE-748, CE-772 thru CE-912, CE-917, CE-919, I CE-913 thru CE-916, CE-918,
CE-998 and After. I CE-920 thru CE-977.
E-lll, E-1241 thru E-1715, E-1932 thru E-3220. 1 E-1716 thru E-1931, E-3221 and After.
EA-11 thru EA-105, EA-107, EA-108, EA-110, EA-106, EA-109, EA-111 thru EA-117,
EA-118, EA-242, EA-273 thru EA-631. I EA-119 thru EA-241, EA-243 thru
236-AE,272-AE
and After.
These units are single-acting propellers in which the centrifugal twisting moment of the rotating blades is opposed
by hydraulic pressure in the cylinder land spring force in the McCauley propellers) to obtain the correct pitch for the
engine load. Governor (engine driven) controls the amount and pressure of oil passing through the propeller shaft
to the power piston in the propeller hub. An increase in engine power output causes oil to enter the piston, thus
increasing propeller pitch. A decrease in engine power output results in oil leaving the piston, thus decreasing pitch.
PROPELLER REMOVAL
WARNING: To avoid possible injury, ensure that the ignition switch is in the OFF position before working
on the propeller.
a. Remove the six propeller attach nuts from the studs attaching the propeller to the engine crankshaft flange.
NOTE: When propeller deice is installed, it is necessary to tape the brushes in place before the propeller is removed.
b. Place a drain trough under the attaching point of the propeller to the crankshaft, to prevent oil draining into the
engine cowl.
d. Use clean shop rags to plug the center of the engine crankshaft and the propeller hub.
1
n27 61-~0-00
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Lubricate the O-ring that is installed in the circular groove of the propeller hub with engine oil (2, Chart 1, 91-00-
00) before installating the propeller.
b. Two blade propeller: Place the No. 1 propeller blade directly over the TIC mark on the crankshaft Range.
Three blade propeller: (F33A, A36 and Optional for B36TC). Install propeller on engine flange. Refer to
Figure
1 for indexing of propeller to engine crankshaft flange.
NOTE: Due to the close tolerance fit of the prop hub bore to the pilot on the crankshaft, the hub must be placed
square on the engine shaft and seated evenly to the crankshaft flange.
c. On McCauley propellers liberally apply grease, A-1637-16 (PN of McCauley), or grease (70, Chart 1,
91-00-00) only to threads of studs and face of nuts.
d. Snug the six propeller attach nuts down evenly in a diagonal pattern. Torque the attach nuts in a diagonal pattern
to 45-50foot-pounds for McCauley propellers, and 70 to 80 foot-pounds on Hartzell propellers.
f. It may be necessary to check the alignment of the deicer brushes to the slip ring as noted in Chapter 30-60-00.
e BLADE
’7/C" STEEL STAMPED
ON EDGE OF
CRANKSHAFT FLANGE
j,.
PROP STUDS
JA´• G PLACES
BLADE
PROPDOWELPIN
2 PLACES
~o T
‘1=
30"
#1 BLADE
VIEW A-A
Indexing Propeller
Figure 1
Page
raM2
31105 61-10-00 A27
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
PROPELLER ADJUSTMENT
For adjustments, service, overhaul and maintenance procedures, refer to the applicable FAA Approved Propeller
Manual and or Approved Propeller Overhaul Shop Manual. All pitch measurements are made at the 30 inch station.
For McCauley propeller adjustments refer to Chart 2. For Hartzell propeller adjustments refer to Chart 3.
Chart 2
McCauley Propeller Adjustment
HublBlade Part Number Low Pitch High Pitch
TWO-BLADE PROPELLERS
Hub: 2A36C23
13.3" 0.2" 29.7" 0.5"
Blade: 84B-0
THREE-BLADE PROPELLERS
Hub: 3A32C406 X
13.3" 0.3" 29.0" 0.5"
Blade: X 82NDB-2
Hub: 3A32C76
13.3" 0.2" 29.0" 0.5"
Blade: 82NB-2
Hub: 3A32C76-U
15.0" 0.2" 34.5"~0.1"
Blade: 82NB-2
Hub: 3A32C406 X
15.8" 0.3" 34.9" 0.5"
Blade: X 82NDB-4
Hub: 3A32C409-X
13.7" 0.3" 28.8" 0.5"
Blade: 82NDB-2
Chart 3
Hartzell Propeller Adjustment
HublBlade Part Number Low Pitch High Pitch
THREE-BLADE PROPELLERS
Hub: PHC-C3YF-1RF
13.0" 0.2" 36.0" 1.0"
Blade: F8468A-8R
3
A27 61-10-00 Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Minor nicks, dents, and gouges may be dressed out by qualified personnel only. Blend any nicks or gouges into the
leading edge with smooth curves and generous radii (Ref. Figure 2). Re-anodize reworked area by the chromic acid
process only.
Ifshortening of the propeller is necessary for repair, care should be taken that the blades are not shortened to a
length less than the minimum amount specified. When shortening a propeller to repair the tip(s) all of the blades
must be shortened an equal amount and the tips have identical shapes.
The specified diameters for McCauley two-blade and three-blade propellers are provided in Chart 4. The specified
diameters for Hartzell three-blade propellers are provided in Chart 5.
j
i
61-10-00 A27
RaytPleon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 4
McCauley Propellers Diameter Specifications
Maximum Minimum
HublBlade Part Number Inches Inches
TWO-BLADE PROPELLERS
Hub: 2A36C23
84 82
Blade: 84B-0
THREE-BLADE PROPELLERS
Hub: 3A32C406 X
80 78 1/2
Blade: 82NDB-2
Hub: 3A32C76
80 78 1/2
Blade: 82NB-2
Hub: 3A32C76U
80 78 1/2
Blade: 82NB-2
Hub: 3A32C406 X
78 77
Blade: 82NDB-4
Hub: D3A32C409 X
80 79
Blade: 82NDB-2
Chart 5
Hartzell Propellers Diameter Specifications
Maximum Minimum
HublBlade Part Number Inches Inches
THREE-BLADE PROPELLERS
Hub: PHC-C3YF-1RF
80 78
Blade: F8468A-6R
Hub: PHC-C3YF-1RF
78 77
Blade: F8468A-8R
5
A27 61-~0-00 Mar 31/05Page
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
NOTE
PROPELLER GOVERNOR ADJUSTMENT
Care should be taken not to loosen the jam nut
on the control rod end which could alter the The propeller governor can be adjusted for a high rpm
setting of the control rod. setting. The high rpm adjustment must be checked while the
airplane is in flight. For instructions on adjustment of the low
rpm setting, refer to IDLE SPEED AND MIXTURE
c. Remove the four mounting nuts and pull the ADJUSTMENT, Chapter 71-00-00.
governor from the engine.
d. Cover the governor base and engine pad to HIGH RPM ADJUSTMENT
protect them.
The high rpm adjustment must be checked while the
airplane is in flight. Observe the take-off rpm to see if it
PROPELLER GOVERNOR INSTALLATION exceeds the redline figure. If excessive rpm is observed,
adjust the high rpm screw inward to reduce the rpm. The
a. Remove the cover from the governor base and propeller governor adjustment screw is located on the
wipe the base clean. governor, facing outward from the engine. One complete
b. Install a new governor mounting gasket on the revolution of the screw reduces the propeller rpm by
governor, ensuring that the protruding gasket screen is approximately 25-30 revolutions.
"END"
61-20-00
Page 1
May 9180
C H A PT E R
POVVERPLANT
Ray~heon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJEC T PA GE
71-00-00
Engine Removal (CE-748, CE-772 and After; CJ-149 and After; D-10097, D-10120 and After; E-llll,
E-1241 thru E-2110)
Engine Installation (CE-748, CE-772 and After; CJ-149 and After; 0-10097, 0-10120 and After; E-llll,
E-1241 thru E-2110) ................._ ................._ ................._
71-10-00
1
A27 71-CONTENTS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINiENANCE MANUAL
1
A27 7I-LOEP Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
IO-520-BA, IO-520-BB ENGINE (CE-748, CE- 772 AND AFTER; CJ- 49 AND AFTER; D- 009 7 1
0-10120 AND AFTER; E-l I E-1241 THRU E-2110, EXCEPT E-1946 AND E-2104)
The above Bonanza serial airplanes are equipped with IO-520-BA Continental engines until the following serials, at
which time they equipped with IO-520-BB engines: CE-816 and After; CJ-149 and After; D-10179 and After, and
are
E-1371 thru E-2110, except E-1946 and E-2104. The IO-520-BB engine differs from the previous engines in that it
has an improved crankshaft and other changes related to the improved crankshaft. The engine is a fuel injected,
direct-drive, air-cooled, horizontally opposed, Gcylinder, 520 cubic-inch displacement, 285horsepower engine. The
engine crankshaft rotates in the clockwise direction. Recommended fuel for the engine is Aviation Gasoline 100LL
(blue), or 100/130 (green) minimum grade. The oil capacity for the engine is 12.0 quarts of oil conforming to
Continental Motors Bulletin MHS-24B. For overhaul of the engine, refer to Continental 10-520 Series Aircraft
Engines Overhaul Manual, FORM X-30039A.
On certain airplanes, as designated by Factory Work Order, a Quiet Bonanza is made. A red line of 2,550 rpm is
established for the tachometer and the throttle system is set to produce 2,550 rpm. A propeller governor set to 2,550
rpm along with a propeller that matches the governor and the engine is installed.
The engine crankshaft rotates in the clockwise direction. Recommended fuel for the engine is Aviation Gasoline
100LL (blue), or 100/130 (9reen) minimum grade. The oil capacity for the engine is 12.0 quarts of oil conforming to
Continental Motors Bulletin MHS-24B. For overhaul of the engine, refer to Continental 10-550 Series Aircraft
Engines Overhaul Manual, FORM X-30568.
The turbocharger is located beneath and to the left rear of the engine and is driven by exhaust gases. The
turbocharger is lubricated by engine oil and is dependent upon the engine oil pump for its lubrication. For this reason
the engine should be allowed to run at idle for a short period of time (4 to 5 minutes) before it is shut down. This idle
time will allow the turbocharger to slow down and cool before its oil supply is shut off. The turbocharger can obtain
maximum continuous speeds of 96,000 rpm tin an overspeed condition it must not exceed 1 15,000 rpm) and run for
1 to 2 minutes after the engine has been shut down. This 1 to 2 minutes of turbocharger operation occurs without
oil pressure because the engine oil pump is not running. Therefore it is important that the turbocharger be allowed
to slow down before the engine is shut down.
The engine is designed to operate with a maximum manifold pressure of 36 in. Hg, and isprotected from overboost
by automatic pressure relief valve. This valve is located downstream from the
an turbocharger and will relieve
pressure if the system reaches an overboost condition of 39.5 in. Hg.
For specific information regarding the turbocharger system, refer to Chapter 81-00-00.
nzl 71-00-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Engine induction air is available from two sources, primary and alternate air. The primary air source is supplied
through an intake duct, located on the fcMlard cowling below the propeller. The primary air passes through an air
filter and then into the induction system.
NOTE: If, after cleaning, the surfaces of the air filter show metallic wires through the remaining flocking material, the
filter is no longer effective and should be replaced.
If the primary source of ram air is obstructed, the induction system low pressure opens an Alternate Air Source door
and permits the required volume of air flow for normal engine performance. The alternate air door is located just aft
of the air filter and on the left side of the intake duct.
Page
22’3:, , 71-00-00 A,
RBytheOn nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
GENERAL- TROUBLESHOOTING
Chart 1
Troubleshooting the Engine I
INDICATION PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
1. Enginewill notstart. a. No fuel gage pressure No a. Check fuel control for proper position,
fuel to engine. auxiliary pump ON and operating, fuel
2. Engine starts but fails to keep a. Inadequate fuel to fuel a. Set fuel control in FULL RICH position,
running. manifold valve. turn auxiliary pump ON check to be sure
n27 71-00-00
RayMheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Troubleshooting the Engine (Continued)
INDICATION PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
5. Engine runs rough at speeds a. Improper fuel-air mixture. a. Check manifold connections for leaks.
above idle. Tighten loose connections. Check fuel
control and linkage for setting and
adjustment. Check fuel filters and screens
for dirt. Check for proper pump pressure,
and replace pump if defective.
c. Ignition system and spark c. Clean and regap spark plugs. Check
plugs defective. ignition cables for defects. Replace
defective components.
6. Engine lacks power, reduction a.Incorrectly adjusted throttle a. Check movement of linkage by moving
in maximum manifold pressure control, sticky linkage or dirty air control from idle to full throttle. Make
or critical altitude. cleaner, proper adjustments and replace worn
c. Loose damaged
or intake c.Inspect entire manifold system for
manifolding. possible leakage at connections. Replace
damaged components, tighten all
connections and clamps.
7. Lowfuel pressure. a. Restricted flow to fuel a. Check mixture control for full travel.
metering valve. Check for restrictions in fuel filters and
lines, adjust control and clean filters.
Replace damaged parts.
b. Fuel control lever, b. Check operation of throttle control and
forpossible contact with cooling shroud.
Adjust as required to obtain correct
operation.
c. Incorrect fuel injector pump c.Check and adjust using appropriate
adjustment and operation, equipment. Replace defective pumps.
d. Defective fuel injector pump d. Replace pump.
relief valve.
Page
471-00-00 n27
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Troubleshooting the Engine (Continued)
INDICATION PROBABLE CAUSE REMARKS
8. High fuel pressure. a. Restricted flow beyond fuel a. Check for restricted fuel nozzles or fuel
control assembly. manifold valve. Clean or replace nozzles.
Replace defective fuel manifold valve.
b. Defective relief valve b. Replace fuel injector pump.
operation in fuel injector.
c. Restricted re-circulation c. Replace pump.
passage in fuel injector pump.
9. Fluctuating fuel pressure. a. Vapor in fuel system, excess a. Normally operating the auxiliary pump
fuel temperature. will clear system. Operate auxiliary pump
and purge system.
b. Fuel gage line leak or air in b. Drain gage line and tighten
gage line, connections.
11. Poor engine idle cut-off, a. Engine getting fuel, a.Check fuel control for being in full IDLE
CUT-OFF position. Check auxiliary pump
for being OFF. Check for leaking fuel
manifold valve. Replace defective
components.
5
7 ’1-00-00Page
Ral~beon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
ENGINE REMOVAL (CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; CJ-149 AND AFTER; D10097, 0-10120
AND AFTER; E-?lll, E-1241 AND AFTER)
CA UTION: Care should be taken when removing and installing the engine that no dirt or foreign objects, be allowed
to enter the induction system. Be careful not to damage duct work when removing and installing the
engine.
WARNING: To be safe, treat all magnetos as hot. To ground the magneto, disconnect the ignition switch
lead wire at the capacitor and ground the capacitor pole. If this is impractical, remove the
ignition harness on the magneto or disconnect the spark plug leads.
e. Disconnect and identify the ducts, engine controls, plumbing and wiring harness. Cap all open lines and fittings.
g. Place the engine hoist in position and attach to the lifting eyes on the engine.
h. Hoist the engine sufficiently to remove the tension from the shock mount bolts.
NOTE: It is recommended that the shock mounts be replaced at each engine change. Replace the mounts as a
complete set. All the shock mounts on a particular engine should be of the same manufacturer.
j. Position the engine slightly nose down and hoist slowly, making certain that the engine crankshaft flange clears
the nose cowl.
CAUTION: As the engine is hoisted away from the cowl, check to make sure that all wires, hoses and lines have
been disconnected.
ENGINE INSTALLATION (CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; CJ-149 AND AFTER; D10097,
0-10120 AND AFTER; E-Il?l, E-1241 AND AFTER)
a. Observe the WARNINGS, CAUTIONS, and NOTES as noted in ENGINE REMOVAL.
b. Position the engine hoist and attach the hoisting sling to the engine.
c. Move the hoist into position in front of the airplane. Position the engine slightly nose down and lower slowly,
making certain the engine crankshaft flange clears the nose cowl.
d. Align the shock mount bolt holes and install the shock mounts and bonding strap. Torque the four engine mount
bolts 300 to 350 in-lbs.
e. Disconnect the hoisting sling and move the hoist clear of the airplane.
f. Uncap all lines and fittings and connect the ducts, engine controls, plumbing and wiring harness.
7 L1 100100 A27
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
g. Adjustall enginecontrols.
NOTE: If a new or newly overhauled engine has been installed, the engine must be depreserved and serviced.
b. Remove the upper portion of the nose bug by removing the screws and hinge pins.
e. Remove the air induction tubing between the air box and the turbocharger inlet.
g. Disconnect the engine controls, plumbing, and wiring harness. Tag and label all items for reinstallation. Be sure
to cap all open tubing.
i. Place the engine hoist in position and attach to the lifting eyes on the engine.
j. Hoist the engine sufficiently to remove the tension from the shock mount bolts.
k. Remove the two front and the right rear shock mount bolts. Remove the six bolts attaching the left rear engine
mount to the wheel well.
CAUTION: As the engine is hoisted away from the airplane, check to make ce~tain that all wires, hoses and lines
have been disconnected.
c. Install the remaining three shock mount bolts and torque to 300 to 350 in-lbs. Install the six bolts securing the
left rear mount to the wheel well. Torque these bolts to 100 to 105 in-lbs.
7
nz7 71100-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANGE MANUAL
g. Install the induction tubing between the air box and turbocharger.
ENGINE BUILD-UP
Engine build-up consists of the removal of accessories and equipment from the old engine and installing them on
the new engine. Refer to the Continental Aircraft Engine Manuals for the proper torque values.
NOTE: Tag or identify all hoses, washers, nuts, electrical connectors, and note harness clamp locations for
reinstallation on the new engine. Cap all open hoses and engine ports to prevent contamination.
NOTE: All plumbing from the intake filter to the pump and on the outlet side of the pressure pump must be thoroughly
cleaned, and all the filters replaced when the pressure pump is installed or replaced.
a. Access to the air pressure pump is gained through the left hand cowl door.
c. Remove the four attaching nuts and washers and pull the pump straight out.
CAUTION: Neverjam or force the pump onto the engine mounting pad.
b. Position the pump on the mounting pad and install the attaching nuts and washers.
d. Start the engine and check for leakage at the mounting flange, and check for proper operation and pressure
readings.
a. Access to the engine-driven fuel pump is gained through the left upper cowling.
b. The fuel pump is located at the rear, in the center of the engine.
c. Disconnect the fuel plumbing and drain the fuel from the pump.
Page
82e,LS 71100100 A27
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel pump drive is removed with the pump.
a. Install the fuel pump with a new gasket and tighten the two retaining nuts.
CAUTION: Make sure the fuel pump drive is installed with the pump.
NOTE: The engine should be pre-oiled prior to starting, with spark plugs removed to relieve the starter load. To pre-
oil, connect the auxiliary power unit and crank with the starter, (not to exceed 45 seconds) until slight oil
pressure is detected on the gage. Reinstall the spark plugs.
The engine cowl flaps should be open during all ground operation.
CAUTION: After starting the engine, an oil pressure indication of ?0 psi should be noted within 30 seconds in warm
weather and 60 seconds in cold weather. If no pressure is noted within the specified time, stop the
engine and investigate the cause. Normal oil pressure at maximum rpm should be 30-60 psi and ?0 psi
at idle.
b. Start engine and maintain the engine speed at approximately 900 to 1,000 rpm for at least one minute in warm
weather, and as required during cold weather to prevent cavitation in the pressure oil pump, and to assure
adequate lubrication.
c. Advance the throttle to a setting of 1,200 rpm or slightly above and cycle the propeller two or three times to
ensure lubrication of the oil transfer collar assembly and propeller governor. Use 1,200 rpm for the rest of the I
warm-up procedure.
d. Operate the engine on the ground with the propeller blade set at the minimum angle thigh rpm) setting.
Maintain the cylinder head temperature between 200 to 460"F (93 to 238"0). Never allow the cylinder head
I
e.
f. Extended periods of idling at low rpm may result in fouled spark plugs.
g. The mixture control should remain in the FULL RICH position unless leaning is required during the checkout.
IDLE SPEED AND MIXTURE ADJUSTMENT (CE-748, CE-772, AND AFTER; CJ-149 AND
AFTER; D- 009 7 D- 1 0120 AND AFTER; E- 1 E-124 THRU E-2 1 1 O, EXCEPT E- 946 AND
E-2104)
NOTE: Fuel flow values and procedures are referenced in Teledyne Continental ~otors 97-3 and
Motors SID 97J subsequent
A2~ 71-00-00
RayHH?on Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. Start and run the engine according to the warm up procedures in this chapter. Place mixture control in full rich.
I b. Proceed to check the magnetos. Refer to MAGNETO DROP-OFF CHECK in Chapter 74-00-00. Maximum drop
off differential should not exceed 50 rpm. If the differential is within limitations, proceed with the idle adjustment.
Slowly retard the throttle lever to the idle position. The engine tachometer should indicate 600 rpm (normal idle
setting). To adjust, turn the idle speed adjusting screw at the throttle lever stop until the desired rpm is reached
(Ref. Figure
d. Set the pump pressure at idle rpm (Ref. Chart 2), using the relief valve adjustment screw on the aft centerline
of theengine fuel pump (Ref. Figure 2). Turn the screw clockwise to increase pressure and counterclockwise
to decrease pressure.
e. When the idle setting has been stabilized, move the cockpit mixture control lever with a smooth steady pull into
the IDLE CUT-OFF position. Observe the rpm during the leaning out process. Adjust the idle mixture to obtain
approximately 25/50 rpm gain in the idle speed as the mixture control is slowly moved toward the IDLE
CUT-OFF. (If the mixture is set too lean, the idle speed will drop under the same conditions.) The idle mixture
adjustment is the locknut at the metering valve end of the linkage between the metering valve and air throttle
levers. Tightening the nut to shorten the linkage provides a richer mixture. A leaner mixture is obtained by
backing off the nut to lengthen the linkage.
f. After each idle mixture adjustment change, clear the engine by running it up to 2,000 rpm before making a
mixture check.
g. If the idle setting does not remain stable, check the idle linkage; any looseness in this linkage will cause erratic
idling. In all cases, allowance should be for this effect of weather conditions upon idling adjustments.
Page
1071100100 A27
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
UP
STOP PIN
O
36-282-14
ENGINE
DRIVEN
FUEL PUMP
UP
FWD
11
A27
71-00-00 Mar 31 05Page
RBylheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FULL THROTTLE ADJUSTMENT (CE-748, CE-772 AND AFTER; CJ-149 AND AFTER;
D- 1 0097 D- 1 0120 AND AFTER; E- 1 1 1 E- 124 1 THRUE-2 1 1 O, EXCEPT E- 1 946 AND E-2 1 04)
NOTE: Fuel flow values and procedures are referenced in Teledyne Continental Motors SID 97-3 and subsequent
I
revisions.
a. Complete the IDLE SPEED AND MIXTURE ADJUSTMENT before proceeding with this procedure.
b. With the mixture control at full rich, advance the throttle to full rated engine (2,700) rpm to check the fuel flow.
NOTE: Fuel flow values may be monitored by the fuel flow gage in the airplane or a pressure gage attached to the
manifold valve.
(10-520-BE) To obtain the specified values of noule pressure or fuel flow at full throttle and rated rpm, turn the
I
c.
variable orifice adjusting screw (located on the side of the pump) clockwise to increase pressure and
NOTE: If the rated rpm cannot be achieved at full throttle during static run-up, adjust nozzle pressure or fuel flow
slightly below limits, making certain specified values are achieved when rated rpm is achieved during takeoff
roll.
IDLE SPEED AND MIXTURE ADJUSTMENT (E- 1946, E-2104, E-211 1 AND AFTER)
(IO-550-B ENGINE)
a. Install a pressure gage in the fuel line between the engine driven fuel pump and the metering unit. The gage will
be used to monitor fuel pump idle pressure (also called unmetered pressure).
b. Start and run the engine until normal operating temperatures are attained. Refer to Pilot’s Operating Handbook.
Move the mixture control to full rich. The idle speed should be 625 to 650 rpm. If the engine is not idling within
the specified range, change the idle-speed adjustment screw as required to obtain the proper idle speeb (Ref.
I Figure 1). Turn the idle speed adjustment screw clockwise to increase rpm and counterclockwise to decrease
rpm.
The fuel pump pressure should read 9.00 to 11.00 psig (Ref. Chart 2). If adjustment is required
engine-driven
I c.
to achieve proper fuel pump pressure, turn the relief valve adjustment screw clockwise to increase pressure and
I counterclockwise to decrease pressure (Ref. Figure 3).
d. Maintain the specified idle rpm and the fuel pump pressure. Adjust the idle mixture to attain a momentary gain
of 25 to 50 rpm when the mixture control is moved toward the idle cutoff position. If the mixture is too lean, the
rpm will drop. If it is too rich, the gain will be greater than 50 rpm. If an idle mixture adjustment is required, turn
the idle mixture nut as necessary (tighten the nut to enrich the mixture or loosen the nut to lean the mixture) to
NOTE: After each idle mixture adjustment, clear the engine by running up to approximately 2,000 rpm before making
the next mixture check.
Page
raM21
31/05 71-00-00 n27
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 2
Fuel Flow Chart I
Unmetered Metered
or Pump or Nozzle
Propeller Pressure pressure Fuel Flow Fuel Flow
Engine (RPM) (psi) (psi) (LbslHr) (GallHr)
All top end values are shown for rated RPM and manifold pressure. I
CE-748, CE-772 and After; 600 9-11 2.3 3.0
CJ-149 and After; D-10097,
IO-520-B, 2,700 28-31´• 14.9- 17.2 136-146 23.2-24.9
D-10120 and After; E-llll,
BA or BE
E-1241 thru E-2110, except
E-1946 and E-2104
IO-550-B
thru E-3099 with Quiet
tion)
Op-
2550 1- I Ref. Figure4 I
(E-3100 and After without 600 700 9-11 3.9 4.5
QuietOption)
2,700 29.2- 36.2 16.5-18.4 146-156 24.9-26.6 I
(E-3100andAfterwith Quiet 600-700 9-11 3.9 -4.5
Option)
2,550 25.2-32.2 15.4- 17.2 136-146 23.2- 24.9 I
’These values taken from Teledyne Continental Motors SID 97-3. 1
13
A27 71-00-00 Mar 31/05Page
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
VALVE
ADJUSTMENT SCREW
(USED TO SET PUMP
IDLE PRESSURE)
ANEROID STEM
(00 NOT TURN)
UP
,,tt
BYPASS ADJUSTMENT SCREW (USED TO SET
FULL THROTTLE PUMP PRESSURE)
ENGINE DRIVEN
FUEL PUMP
ADJUSTABLE ORIFICE
(USED TO SET FULL
THROTTLE PUMP
PRESSURE)
i33b II
FUEL OUTLET
(UNMETERED
FUEL PRESSURE)
Page
raM41
31105 71-00-00 A27
Raylheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FULL THROTTLE ADJUSTMENT (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 AND AFTER) (IO-550-B ENGINE)
NOTE: Fuel flow values and
and procedures
procedures are
are reierenced in Te
referenced in Teledyne SID 87-5
Motors SID
edyne Continental Motors 97-3 and
and subsequenl
I
a. a pressure gage in the line between the
Install engine fuel flow transducer and the manifold valve to read
metered fuel pressure.
NOTE: The pressure gage should be vented to the atmosphere and mounted at approximately the same level as
b. Run the engine until normal engine operating temperatures are attained.
c. With the mixture control in the full rich position, advance the throttle control to full throttle and maximum static
engine rpm (2,550 for auiet Bonanza installation) (Ref. Chart 2). Check the metered fuel pressure versus engine I
manifold pressure.
NOTE: This fuel pump adjustment procedure is NOT a complete procedure, but a starting point. For the complete
procedure FUEL FLOW CALIBRATION AND CORRECTION (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 AND AFTER) MUST
also be completed.
AP~ 71-00-00
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
20.0
19.0
C I~
OPERATING CONDITIONS
~j 18.0 FULL THROTTLE
STATIC
w FULL RICH
(I
17.0
Is.o
Is.o
w
r ETERED PRES
TO VALUE SHOWN
+.3 PSIG
14.0 H
THE POINTS A, B, AND C WHICH ARE SHOWN ARE AN EXAMPLE. THE ACTUAL
POINTS A, B, AND C WILL VARY WITH ALTITUDE AND FROM AIRPLANE TO
AIRPLANE.
Page
raM61
31/05 71-00-00 nz7
RBYtheO~ Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
FUEL FLOW SYSTEIW CALIBRATION AND CORRECTION (E-1946, E-2104, E-211 1 AND
AFTER)
values and
NOTE: Fuel flow values and procedures
procedures are referenced in
reterenced in Teledyne Continental Motors
Teiedyne Motors SID
SID 973
97-3 and
and subsequent
I
are
A fuel flow system calibration and correction should be obtained from the following procedure.
I
a.
North, Kansas City, MO 64116 equivalent flow meter, at a point between the fuel flow transducer and the
or
engine fuel distributor valve. (The Fisher Porter Flow Rater must be installed in a straight vertical position in
order to provide the most accurate reading.) Return the fuel from the flow rater back to the airplane fuel system
through the wing filler port.
NOTE: Use an external power supply capable of providing 28.25 0.25 volts for the source of electrical power.
NOTE: The throttle and mixture levers must be in the full forward position. Use the adjustable valve to adjust the
fuel flow as necessary (Ref. Figure 5). 1
c. Adjust the flow rater (using the adjustable valve) to the test readings in Chart 3 and record the airplane fuel flow
(gph) from the fuel flow indicator on a copy of Chart 3.
d. Once an error in the airplane fuel flow hardware has been determined, determine the system correction as in
the following example:
EXAMPLE:
At the 80pph flow rate with the fuel temperature at 40"F (4"C), an airplane fuel flow indicator reads 13.0 gph. Using
a density of 5.9, Chart 3 shows the indicator should be reading 13.5 gph. Therefore, the instrument error is 0.5
fuel
gph low. When the airplane indicator is reading 13.0 gph, add 0.5 gph for system correction.
NOTE: This fuel flow indicator check, should be made at all six flow rates as the system error may vary as the flow
rate changes.
The FULL THROTTLE ADJUSTMENT (E-1946, E-2104, E-2111 and After) procedure MUST be completed
before proceeding.
e. Remove the installed flow rater and restore airplane including a leak check of the disturbed fuel lines.
WARNING: Comply with standard FAA regulations for oxygen usage when performing this test. I
f. Flight check for proper engine fuel schedule. Establish a climb at 110 kias (knots indicated air speed)
´•Throttle.......... ..........._
Full Forward
Prop............. ..........._.._
.2,700 rpm (2,550 rpm for Quiet Bonanza installation)
g. Record the fuel flow at all pressure altitudes (altimeter set at 29.92 in. Hg) shown in Chart 4.
17
n27 71-00-00Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
h. While in flight at 8,000 feet, set power to 20.5 in. manifold pressure, prop to 2,300 rpm, and mixture control to
full rich. The EGT margin should be 68"F (20"C) rich of peak or greater. Next lean mixture from peak to engine
roughness. The margin should be 68"F (20"C) lean of peak or greater.
i. If the corrected fuel flow does not fall within the required fuel flow limits (refer to Chart 4) or if the rich of peak
margin is not obtained, readjust the metered engine fuel pressure. Refer to FULL THROTTLE ADJUSTMENT
(E-2104, E-2111 and After), Step d.. Turn the engine-driven fuel pump bypass adjustment screw as necessary,
clockwise to increase pressure (fuel flow) or counterclockwise to decrease pressure (fuel flow) (Ref. Figure 3).
One psi is approximately equal to one gph.
AIRPLANE FUEL
FILLER PORT
FLOW RATOR
(MUST BE IN A STRAIGHT
VERTICAL POSITION)
ADJUSTABLE VALVE
AIRPLANE WING
281-43
page
raM81
31/05 71-00-00 A27
Raytheon Aircrait Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 3
Fuel Flow Testing
TEMPERATURE WHEN FUEL FLOW IS CHECKED (FUEL TEMPERATURE) DEGREES F.
Flow 80 pph gph gph gph gph (13.0 gph in example) (+0.5 gph in example)
13.3 13.5 13.8 14.0
19
A27
71-00-00 Mar 31~05Page
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 4
Fuel Flow Limits
I NOTE: Fuel Flow values and.snoisiver)RETFA procedures are referenced in Teledyne Continental Motors SID 97-3 and subsequent
The engine fuel system senses turbocharger deck pressure and any change in deck pressure or manifold pressure
will be accompanied by a change in fuel flow. During an overboost condition with cold oil where manifold pressure
may increase 1 to 2 in. Hg over redline, a corresponding enrichment in fuel flow will be observed. This is a normal
characteristic of the fuel system and is desirable to maintain mixture strength. The correct procedure is to retard the
throttle to 36.0 in. Hg which will provide a corresponding decrease in fuel flow.
The fuel system on the Continental TSIO-520-U or TSIO-520-UB engines may be adjusted as follows:
a. Install a calibrated fuel pressure gage in the fuel line between the fuel pump and metering unit to monitor pump
outlet pressures. This gage must be vented to atmosphere.
b. Start and engine to bring cylinder head temperatures up to approximately 250"F (121"C).
I
run
c. Using throttle lever, set engine idle speed at approximately 600 rpm.
d. Set pump pressure at idle rpm to 5.3 to 6.5 psi using the relief adjustment screw (4) on the centerline of the fuel
I pump (Ref. Figure 6). Turn screw CW to increase pressure, and CCW to decrease pressure.
NOTE: After each mixture adjustment change, clear the engine by running it up to 2,000 rpm before making a
mixture check.
Page
2071100100 A27
Raytkeon Airrraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
e. Maintain the idle rpm and idle pump pressure specified above (reset as required); adjust the idle mixture screw
(1) on the metering unit to obtain the desirable fuel-air ratio which will result in 25 to 50 rpm rise when the engine I
is leaned to best power setting with the mixture control. Turn the adjustment screw CW to lean the mixture and
CCW to richen.
drain hose to the right hand cowling flap opening with sufficient clearance to prevent rubbing
or chafing. Insure maxim um clearance between the hose and the turbochargerlexhaust system.
Airplanes EA-147 and After have a small tray or shield assembly beneath the throttle body and
fuel metering assem bly (Ref. Figures 7 and 8). Check that the hose (approximately 2 in, long) is
attached over the mixture control screw housing boss and drains into the shield assembly.
Insure that a fuel drain hose(s) is attached to the shield assembly and routed to the right hand
cow\ flap opening with sufficient clearance to prevent rubbing or chafing. Insure maximum
clearance between the hose(s) and the turbochargerlexhaust system.
NOTE: Cylinder head temperature must be 200 to 250"F (93 to 121"C) each time rpm rise is checked. Otherwise I
the results will be inconsistent.
g. After completion of item f., recheck items c., d. and e. Readjust as required.
h. When fuel system is accurately adjusted, set engine idle speed to approximately 600 rpm with the idle speed
adjustment screw, CW to increase, CCW to decrease (Ref. Figure 9).
i. When setting up full throttle fuel flow on a hot day (above 60"F, 15.5"C) the system should be set toward the
lower flow limit. On a cold day (below 60"F, 15.5"C) the system should be set toward the higher flow limit.
important that manifold pressure and fuel flow be within the prescribed limitations simultaneously during a
It is
maximum power run-up. Incorrect manifold pressure settings will cause erroneous fuel Row readings. It is also
important to note the propeller speed when setting the fuel flow. If the fuel system is adjusted to the prescribed limits
with 2,650 rpm during ground static run-up, an enrichment will occur when 2,700 rpm is obtained with forward aircraft
speed.
j. Flythe airplane at high power settings for 10 to 15 minutes or more., then land and check the fuel flow at
maximum power settings before shutting down the engine. Readjust the fuel flow to (195 to 205 pounds per
hour) 33.2 to 33.9 gallons per hour with the variable orifice adjusting screw (3) as required.
NOTE: It has been observed that fuel flow may increase up to 2 gallons per hour above the redline as the airplane
approaches critical altitude. This is a normal characteristic of the Continental engine fuel system as long as
the fuel flow does not exceed 36.5 gallons per hour. The correct procedure is to adjust the mixture to 34.0
gallons per hour. If the fuel flow does exceed 36.5 gallons per hour, the engine-driven fuel pump pressure
should be readjusted.
nzl 71-00-00
RayHleon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b
O
O
SHIELD BRACKET AND
MOUNTING BOLT
THROTTLE BODY
S)IPPORT BRACE
SCREW
NUT
WASHER
DETAIL A
SHIELD ASSEMBLY
DETAIL B
C9100180
Page
raM2
31/05 71-00-00 A27
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
THROTTLE BODY
~n .1 14~LB
SCREW
NVT THROTTLE BODY
WASHER SUPPORT BRACE
DETAIL A
SHIELD ASSEMBLY
DETAIL B
C910(1179
23
A27 71-00-00 Mar 31 05Page
Ralfheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
1 2 3 4
iiF- P-"il
hd
~J
/Ilnnrm
JTi
O~IVT-T11 2~9
INDEX
IDLE SPEED
2. IDLE MIXTURE
3. FULL POWER FUEL PUMP PRESSURE
4. IDLE FUEL PUMP PRESSURE
Fuel Adjustment
(EA-11 and After)
Figure 8
71-00-00 azr
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
VARIABLE ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE CONTROLLER
CONTROLLER LEVER
MANIFOLD PRESSURE ((N MAX. THROTTLE POSITION)
ADJUSTMENT SCREW
(O.S" HSITURN)
GAP /O
O
JAM NUT
CAM
CONNECTING LINKAGE
STOP NUTS
STOP PIN
L
THROTTLE BODY IDLE MIXTURE ADJUSTMENT
SCREW
IDLE SPEED ADJUST´•
MENT
THROTTLE PLATE
AAM
A36TC-282-12
LOOKING AFT
25
A27 71-00-00 Mar 31/05Page
RayYheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The waste gate is controlled by engine oil pressure which is regulated by the variable absolute pressure controller.
For this manifold pressure is quite sensitive to oil pressure and temperature as well as ambient
reason
temperatures. It has been determined that the manifold pressure will vary: (1) 0.2 in. Hg per 10"F (-12"C) change in
oil temperature, (2) 0.3 in. Hg per 10 psig in oil pressure and (3) 0.05 in. Hg per 10"F (-12"C) change in ambient
temperature. The best time to make adjustments is shortly after the airplane has been flown under the conditions
described in Step c., the manifold pressure should be 36 in. Hg.
a. Locate the absolute variable pressure controller mounted the top of the throttle body in the left side of the engine
accessory compartment.
1. Position the controller lever to allow full travel. Ensure that the throttle push-pull cable will allow full travel.
I c. Start and run the engine to bring the engine oil temperature up to 160 to 180"F (71 to 82"C). Adjust the oil
pressure to 40 to 50 psig (45 psig preferred) at 2,600 to 2,700 rpm.
d. After engine warm-up, advance the throttle (without turning the vernier control cable knob) to it’s maximum
position of 2,600 to 2,700 propeller rpm and full rich mixture. Check and (if required) adjust the manifold
pressure adjustment screw on the absolute variable controller. Loosen the jam nut and rotate the adjustment
screw counterclockwise to increase, or clockwise to decrease manifold pressure, then retighten the jam nut.
consideration when manifold pressure adjustments are made. It is important that manifold pressure and fuel
flow be within the prescribed limitations simultaneously during a maximum power run up. Incorrect manifold
pressure settings will cause erroneous fuel flow readings.
e. Fly the airplane 10 to 15 minutes or more at the high power settings, land and check the manifold pressure at
maximum power settings before shutting off the engine. Readjust to 36.0 in. Hg as required.
I The oil pressure adjustment screw is located approximately 3 inches below the oil filter housing (Ref. Figure 10). To
adjust, turn the adjusting screw clockwise to increase or counterclockwise to decrease the oil pressure. The oil
pressure should be between 30 and 60 psi at maximum operating rpm and temperature, 50 psi at cruise rpm and
10 psi minimum at idle rpm.
Page
2671-00-00 n27
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
i3
27
nz7
71-00-00Page
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
.MAIHTENANCE MANUAL
COWUNG MAINTENANCE PRACTICES d. Secure the hook pins in this position with the jam
nuts.
COWLING REEAOVAL e. Fully latch the cowling. There should be slight
tension on the latch as it is moved from the pre-latched to the
a. Check to be sure that the engine magneto switch is´• fully latched position, thus snugging down the upper cowl.
in the OFF position. The pull down tension should not be enough to bow the two
b. Disconnect the necessary electrical wiring from the link rods.
engine cowling. f. Final adjusiment on the latch mechanism is
c. Remove the bolts, spacers, and nuts at each end _! accomli;iishedbyraising‘oi’~ lowering the hook
of the center cowling angle, and carefully remove the Irequired to secure the abovetension.
’cowling. g. Secure the hook pins in the proper position with the
jam nuts, and safety wire the jam nuts together.
COWLING INSTALLATION
COWLING LA TCH RIGGING a. Attach the flap control rod end to the flap.
b.Position the control arm, attached to the wheel well
The latch assembly on each side of the cowling consists of cover, up and forward so that the flap control~rod parallels the
an outside mal;ter latch; two link rods, and two auxiliary control arm. Connect the rod to the control arm.
latches located on the inside oflthel.lowe! .cowl; and two c. Adjust the control rod linkage so that the door pulls
bracketsi each contaii~ing a hook’. pinl on’’th$’id~side of the in snug against the opening.
upper cowling. Actuating the outside latch’ moves each link
rod to operate’its respective latch. The fore and ah inside
latches each incorporate a set of jaws which are open only NOTE
when the outside latch is placed in the fully unlatched
position. The jaws remain closed in both the latched and the When adjusting the rod end linkage, insure
pre-latched positions. To rig the latches, proceed as follows: proper rod end engagement by observing
threads in the sight hole of the control end.
a Loosenthe fore and ah inside Hartwell latches on
their brackets and position the latches so that when the upper
cowl door is lowered, the hook pin falls directly over the Set the push-pull control iiJ the pilot’s compartment
d;
center of the latch. Secure the latch making sure the latch is to the closed
position.
.vertically straight. e. Rig the push-pull control arm assembly, at the
b. Open the outside latch and HOLD the latch in wheel well cover (right hand side), in the forward position so
fully unlatched position. Thelink rods should hold both sets of that the control rod will center over the arm hinge. .00 to .06
auxiliary latch jaws fully open in this position; if not, loosen inch overcenter is needed to prevent the cowl flaps from
the connecting points of the two link rods and position the creeping open in fight. An amdunt greater than this
rods to fully openeach jaw with the outside latch held fully maximum may cause the control to override center and lock.
open. Tighten the connecting points of the two link rods. i. Atiacti the control rod ~ball joint linkto the~ arm
c. Hold the latch fully open and-lower the top cowl assembly and pull the control tothe full oljen position. The
until the latch jaws are;between th8"shoulder ~f.the Rook pins flap should open approximately 4 inches measured at the ah
and the lip directly above the point. to the inboard end of the flap to the face of the exhaust stack flame
pre-latched position. shield.
"END"
71-10QO
Pagel
May 9/80
C H A PT E R
ENGINES
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 72
CHAP~R
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
CHAPTER 72 ENGINE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT( PAGE
INTROOUCT1ON
GENERAL DESCRIPTlON
DISASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
ASSEMBLY OF SUBASSEMBLIES
LIST OF TABLES
NOTE
For detailed information on the above subjects, refer to the Continental 10-520 Series
Aircraft Engines Overhaul Manual, FORM X-30039A or TSIO-520 Series Aircraft Engines
Overhaul Manual, FORM X-30042 or 10-550-8 Series Aircraft Engine Overhaul Manual,
FORM X-30568.
CAUTlON
necessary, all part numbers be verified to ensure that the proper part has been obtained
for replacement. Incorrect part replacement may result in extensive damage to the engine.
"END"
72-ErrECT1VITYICONTENTS
Page 1
A6 Oct 7/83
C HA PT E R
ENGINE FUEL
AND CONTROL
Raytheon nircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
73-30´•00
Transducer Removal.
Transducer Installation
1
nz4 73-CONTENTS
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAlrJT~i\i;ANCE MANUAL
1
A24 73-LOEP Sep 30/03Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
On the fuel flow systems prior to CE-929; CJ-156; D-10354; E-1766, and EA-159, the indicator in the instrument I
panel is teed into the fuel supply line down stream from the throttle servo. In this system the indicator converts fuel
pressure to readout in fuel flow of gallons per hour.
On serials CE-929 and After; CJ-156 and After; D-10354 and After; E-1766 and After; EA-159 and After, the fuel
flow system does not rely on fuel pressure to indicate fuel flow (Ref. Figure 1). In this system fuel flowing through a
transducer modulates an electric signal which is directed to the fuel flow indicator in the instrument panel. The fuel
flow indicator gives a readout in gallons per hour. The major components of the system are the transducer and the
indicator.Engine fuel flows through the transducer then to the engine fuel distributor valve. The transducer is
attached to the top of the engine crankcase, near the fonnrard end on the center line of the engine. The indicator has
dual pointers, one for fuel flow and one for manifold pressure. The circuit breaker for the fuel flow system is located
in the subpanel in front of the copilot.
FUEL FLOW INDICATING MAINTENANCE PRACTICES (CE-929 AND AFTER; CJ-l 56 AND
AFTER; D-10354 AND AFTER; E-1766 AND AFTER; EA-159 AND AFTER)
TRANSDUCER REMOVAL
a. Removeelectrical power.
d. Disconnect and cap the two fuel lines (8, 3) and cap the openings on the transducer to prevent contamination.
TRANSDUCER INSTALLATION
a. Slide the transducer in place and tighten the clamps (6) (Ref. Figure 2).
b. Uncap and connect the two fuel lines (8, 3) to transducer (5).
73-30-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
28 VDC
12 VDC F
PULSED SIGNAL~ H
GROUND D
TRANSDUCER
GAGE
EFi73B
031701AA
i. CYLINDER
2. FUEL DISTRIBUTOR VALVE
3. OUT FUEL LINE
4. ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR
5. TRANSDUCER
6. CLAMPS
7. BRACKIET
8. IN FUEL LINE
9. ALTERNATOR
~s
~a
8 7 6 5 3 2
V1743
032509FW
Transducer RemovaVlnstallation
Figure 2
IGNITION
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 74 IGNITION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
GENERAL 74-00-00
Description and Operation .........,,_.
´•.....1
CE-748, CE-772 and after, CJ-149 and after;
D-10097, D-10120 and after, E-llll, E-1241 and after) ......1
EA-1 thru EA-439 ..........1 ......1
EA-440 and after ......1
DISTRIBUTION 74-20-00
Maintenance Practices .......1
"END"
74-CONTENTS
Page 1
A12 Aug 28/87
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 74 IGNITION
74-Contents
1 Aug 28/87
74-00-00
1 Sep 27/84
2 Sep 27/84
3 Sep 27/84
4 Aug 28/87
4A Aug 28/87
5 Sep 27/84
6 Sep 27/84
74-20-00
1 May 9/80
74-Effectivity
Page 1
A17 Nov16/94
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANAUL
GENERAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION coupled, pressurized magnetos. Pressurizing the magnetos
will prevent internal arcing which may occur in
CE-748, CE-772 and after; CJ-149 and after; D- unpressurized magnetos while flying at high altitudes. The
10097 0-10120 and after; E-llll, E-1241 and after air to pressurize the magnetos is taken from the throttle
body, and should be at or near sea level pressure at all
The engine is equipped with two 8endix S6RN-1225 times. After the pressurizing air leaves the throttle body, it
magnetos. Each magneto incorporates an impulse coupler. passes through a filter on the way to the magnetos. This
At starter cranking speeds the impulse coupler automatically filter should be checked every 50 hours and replaced as
retards the spark for starting purposes. Centrifugal force required. If the filter is white it may be continued in service,
disengages the impulse coupling prior to reaching engine but if it is red or contaminated the filter should be replaced.
idle speed. The impulse coupler then acts as a straight drive
and the magnetos fire at the normal firing position of the
engine.
is
the left magneto while the
grounded.
TROUBLESHOOTING
IGNITION SYSTEM
1. Engine fails to start. a. Spark plugs loose, wet, a. Clean or replace defective spark plugs.
fouled, or defective.
e. Internal trouble with e. Turn engine over and check spark jump.
magnetos. Replace magneto if there is no spark or if
spark is weak.
75-00-00
Pagel
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECMCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAIMENANCE MANAUL
TROUBLESHOOTING
IGNITION SYSTEM (Cont’d)
3. Rough running engine, a. Spark plugs loose or fouled, a. Clean and regap spark plugs.
4. Low power. a. Burned or defective ignition a. Check continuity of harness and replace ii
harness. necessary.
spark.
74-~0-00
Page 2
Sep n184 A9
BEECHCRAFF
BONANZA SERIES
YAINTENANCE MANAUL
74-00-00
Page3
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
b. Cover the lower spark plug hole TIMING THE MAGNETOS TO THE ENGINE
of No. 1 cylinder with the thumb and turn
the crankshaft until pressure is felt on a. Remove the top spark plug from
the thumb, each cylinder.
c. Remove the
plug in front of No. 6 b. Remove the plug in front of No. 6
cylinder observe the timing marks on
an cylinder and observe the timing marks on
the alternator drive gear as the the alternator drive gear as the
crankshaft is rotated. There are 2 marks; crankshaft is rotated. There are 2 marks;
1 at the 200 ETC position, and 1 at the 1 at the 200 ETC position, and 1 at the
240 ETC position. When a position halfway 240 ETC position. When a position halfway
between these marks is centered in the between these marks is centered in the
viewing hole, No. 1 cylinder is at the 220 viewing hole, No.l cylinder is at the 220
ETC position of the compression stroke. ETC position of the compression stroke.
74-00-00
Page 4
Aug 28/87 A12
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
e. Turn the crankshaft in the normal 4. Rotate the magneto until the
direction of rotation until the light goes light just goes out.
out. If 220 ETC is indicated by the timing
marks on the alternator drive gear, the 5. Tighten the magneto mounting
magneto is correctly timed. nuts.
f. Repeat steps "d" and "e" for the INSTALLATION AND TIMING OF
left magneto. MAGNETOS (WITH A TIMING DISC AND
POINTER)
g. If the magnetos are not correctly
timed, proceed as follows: Even though the engines have
Continental
factory installed timing marks,a positive
i. Install the timing light on top dead center (TDC) locator and timing
the magneto which is not properly timed, disc similar to that provided with the
"Universal Engine Timing Indicator" may
2. SetNo. 1 cylinder at 220 ETC be used to time the magneto to the engine
as indicated in,steps "c" through "e" or to check the accuracy of the engine
timing marks. The engine should be timed
3. Loosen the magneto mounting to fire at 220 +00 -20 before top center
nuts. (BTC).
74-00-00
Page 4A
A12 Aug 28/87
BEECHCRAFT
BONANtA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
a. To locate the compression stroke of number one should not be necessary until the magnetos are installed.
cylinder, remove the lower spark plugs from each cylinder
except number one cylinder. Remove the top plug from
number one cylinder. NOTE
b. Place thumb of one hand over the number one
cylinder spark plug hole and rotate the crankshaft in the Without turning the magneto coupling, hold the
direction of normal rotation until the compression stroke is magneto in the position ~it will occupy when
indicated by positive pressure inside the cylinder lifting the installed on the encline and check alignment of
thumb off the spark plug hole. engine drive coupling slot and magneto
c. After locating the compression stroke of number 1 impulse coupling lu!as. If not aligned, pull engine
cylinder, locate the advanced firing position of number 1 gear out of mesh (but not out of the oil seal) and
cylinder by the use of a timing disc and pointer or the factory turn to alignment. Push gear back into mesh.
installed timing marks on the engine.
NOTE
NOTE
The magnetos were prepared for installation, to
On 10-520, TSIO-520 and 10-550 series fire number 1 cylinder, in PREPARING THE
engines the timing marks are located on the MAGNETO FOR INSTALLATION ON THE
alternator drive gear. Remove the plug in front ENGINE in this chapter.
of number 6 cylinder to observe the TDC and
advance timing marks.
n. Place new magneto flanges and install
gaskets on
the magnetos carefully so drive
coupling lugs mate with
’In all cases, it must be
definitely determined that the number slots of engine drive coupling. Install holding washers,
one cylinder is at the correct firing position on the lockwashers and nuts, but tighten only enough to permit
compression stroke, after the crankshaft is turned in its turning the magnetos for final timing, without looseness.
normal direction of rotation, o. Install timing lights on the magnetos.
p. With the engine still positioned to fire number 1
d. If a universal timing disc and pointer is to be used, cylinder at the specified ETC rotate the right magneto in the
install the TDC locator in the top spark plug hole of number direction necessary to cause the points to just break open
1 cylinder, as indicated by the timing light.
e. Slowly rotate the engine in the normal direction of q. Secure the right magneto.
74-00-00
Page5
A9 Sep 27/84
BEECHCRATT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
r. Repeat steps "p" and "o" on the left magneto. same time, that the magneto points opened.
s. Recheck the magneto setting to confirm the O" u. If the timing lights do not respond at the same
2" has not been exceeded. time, loosen the magneto that is either early or late and
t. Turn the engine crankshaft a degrees in the
few repeat the process outlined in step "p".
opposite direction to normal rotation and bring it back again v. Remove the timing lights and reinstall the
until the advance timing mark is under the pointer on timing electrical leads to the magnetos.
disc. At this point both timing lights should indicate, at the
"END"
7e00M)
Page6
A9
Sep 27/84
BEECHCRAFF
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
IGNITION SWITCH
"END"
7620-00
Pager
May 9/80
CHAPTER
ENGINE
INDICATING
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
77-00-00
1
U6 77-CONTENTS ,5:~Page
RBYtheO´• Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
A26 77-LOEP
RByCheO´• Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTEWANCE MANUAL
TIT calibration is manditory because the engine or turbocharger may be damaged by operating at excessive
temperatures (operation at above a TIT of 1,650"F (900"C) is limited to 60 seconds).
CAUTION: Damage to the turbocharger turbine blades, excessive turbine coking and excessive oil consumption
may be caused by turbine inlet temperatures above 1,650"F(900"C).
To prevent a turbine inlet over-temperature condition due to an inaccurate TIT indicator reading, the indicator should
be checked every 100 hours and calibrated if required.
The following procedure may be used to check and calibrate the TIT indicator:
a. Remove the TIT probe from the turbocharger intake manifold. (Do not disconnect the wires from the probe.)
1. On airplanes EA-320, EA-389 and After, install a ground jumper between the probe body and the engine or
airframe.
b. Using the AICal test equipment, heat the probe to 1,650"F (900"C).
c. If the TIT indicator reads 1,650"F(900"C) the indicator is properly calibrated. If the TIT indicator reading is not
1,650"F (900"C) the calibration screw must be adjusted (Ref. Figure 1 and 2).
1. On airplanes EA-11 thru EA-388, except EA-320, the calibration screw is located on the face of the TlT
instrument.
2. On airplanes EA-320, EA-389 and After, the calibration screw is located on the back of the CHTTTIT
instrument.
d. If the seal was broken on the calibration screw (front mounted), reseal by applying a small amount of torque
seal to the calibration screw.
TIT ,i
25’ F/DIV
WIBRITION
SCREW
TIT Indicator
(EA-11 thru EA-388, except EA-320)
Figure 1
\U~
ALCH
CALIBRATION
SCREW
TIT Indicator
(EA-320, EA-389 and Atter)
Figure 2
OIL
BEECHCRATT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 79
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
CHAPTER 79 OIL
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER i
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
GENERAL 79-00-00
Oescription and Operation ........1
Maintenance Practices :.......1
OilSystem
High Oil Temperature ..............1
Oil Cooler Removal ..............1
Oil Cooler Installation ..............1
Break-in Engine Oil ..............1
Recommended Oil Grades for Engines .........2
"END"
79ErrECTIVrTYICONTENfS
Fags 1
Oct 7183
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
The engine oil system is a full-pressure, wet sump type and Oil temperature is controlled by a spring loaded\lernatherm
has a 12-quart capacity. The oil system consists of an oil oil cooler control valve.’Refer to the Engine Overhaul
radiator and automatic thermostat bypass control, oil Manual for Vernatherm oil cooler control valve
temperature indicator, oil pressure indicator, oil pressure specifications. This valve will operate property if the oil has
relief valve, oil drain in the sump and an oil pump
engine not become contaminated with dirt or other foreign particles.
which is an integral part of the engine. The oil system If indications are that the valve is not operating properly
operating temperatures are controlled by the automatic remove the valve and clean it in solvent (16, Chart 1, 91-00-
thermostat bypass control. The bypass control will limit oil 00). Also inspect the valve seat for damage. No repairs can
flow throughthe cooler when operating temperatures are be made to this valve and readjustments are not
below normal and will permit the oil to bypass the cooler, recommended since special testing equipment is required.
should it become clogged. The travel of the valve can be checked by immersing the
OIL SYSTEM
OIL COOLER REMOVAL
Servicing the engine oil system primarily involves
maintaining the oil at the proper level and changing the oil a. Access tq the oil cooler may be gained through
and filter at the recommended intervals. Under normal the left cowl door.
operating conditions, the recommended number of b. Disconnect the oil temperature wire and the oil
operating hours between oil changes is 100 hours. When pressure line.
operating under adverse weather conditions, the oil should c. Remove the nine bolts and washers securing the
be changed more frequently. The engines should be baming to the oil cooler.
warmed up to operating temperature to assure complete d. Remove the five attaching nuts and washers, (two
draining of the oil. The engine oil drain plug is secured with at the top of the oil cooler, and three~at the oil cooler inlet).
lock wire. To remove and install the engine oil filter, refer to Remove the oil cooler.
OIL FILTER REMOVAL and OIL FILTER INSTALLATION in
Chapter 12-10-00. When changing the oil and filter, always
check for metal contamination in the used oil. OIL COOLER INSTALLA 7/ON
replacement would also warrant engine removed at the proper time, varnish may form in the engine.
investigation. Oil conforming to MlL-L-6082 may be added to the Rustband
79-00-00
Pagel
A6 Oct 7/83
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
oil
as necessary. After removing the Rustband oil, refill with RECOIWMENDED OIL G~ADES FOFI ENGINES
MIL-L-6082 mineral oil which should be used until oil
consumption has stabilized. After oil consumption has
stabilized an ashless
dispersant oil. complying with
Continental Motors’ Specification MHS-24Ba‘nd
Mll-L-22851, must be used. For several suitable engine oils, AMBIENT AIR RECOMMENDED
both break-in and after break-in, see the Consumable TEMPERATURE VISCOSITY
Materials Chart, Item 2, in Chapter 91-00-00.
Above 40oF SAE-50
10W30
It is recommended to use a 75% power setting
during the break-in period. Avoid over cooling All temperatures 15W50
caused by long power-dff and/or rapid descents. 20W50
"END"
79-00-00
Page2
Oct 7/83 A6
C H A PT E R
STARTING
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 80
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PAGE DATE
CHAPTER 80 STARTING
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT SUBJECT PAGE
CRANKING 80-10-00
Description and Operation .......t
i
Troubleshooting Starter System .........I .......1
Maintenance Practices ........1
’’’’’’’’’i
Starter Removal ,.......1
Starter Installation ........1
Starter Overhaul ........1
Starter Lubrication ........1
Starter Brushes ........2
"END"
80-EFFECflVITYICONTENTS
Page 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONA~ZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CRANKING DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION drive gear. The starter is located on the right ah side of the
engine.
CRANKING MAINTENANCE PRACTICES i. Start the engine to check for oil seepage at the
b. Position the starter on the mounting pad. time of overhaul. Soak bearings in SAE 20 oil (2, Chart
new
c. Install the attaching nuts and torque the nuts to 1, 91-00-00) before installation. Saturate the felt oiling pad in
150-180 inch-pounds. the commutator end head with SAE 20 oil. Allow excess oil to
d. Secure the attaching nuts with "palnuts". drain out before installing end head on motor. Put a light film
e. Connect the electrical wiring to the starter, of Lubriplate 1;
shaft before assembling the motor.
NOTE
80-1 0-00
Pagel
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
STARTER BRUSHES replaced when they have worn to 1/4 inch or less. Proper
brush spring tension with new brushes installed is 32-40
ounces. This tension is measured with a scale hooked under
The starter brushes should slide in the holder and the brush spring near the’ brush and the reading taken just as
make full contact on the commutato!,‘rhe brusheS~Should be~ the spring leaves the brush.
"END"
80-1(M0’
Page2
May 9/80
CHAPTER
TURBINES
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 81 TURBINES
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER i
SECTION
I PAGE
SUBJECT SUBJECT
GENERAL 81-00-00
;.......1
Description and Operation
........1
Turbocharger System (EA-1 and after)
........2
Troubleshooting Turbocharger System
Maintenance Practices ........5
"END"
B1-CONTENTS
Psg´• 1
Jan 28/81
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SEFIIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER St
CHAPTER
SECTION
SUBJECT PACE DATE
"END"
B1-ERECnVln
Page 1
A4 Jan 20/82
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
GENERAL DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION controller, the wastegate actuator and engine oil pressure.
Engine oil is supplied to the inlet port of the actuator which
TURBOCHARGER SYS7;EM (EA-1 and afte~ is permanently restricted by a capillary tube. The actuator is
a hydraulic cylinder with oil pressure acting against spring
The turbocharger is fully automatic, requiring no additional tension. The piston inside the cylinder with an actuating rod
controls in the cockpit, and is designed to increase the attached, is heavily spring loaded in the up, or retracted
power output and efficiency of the engine by supplying position. As the oil pressure increases within the chamber
compressed air to the engine intake manifold. The power to an expander-type seal on the piston seals the upper oil
drive the turbocharger is drawn from the exhaust gases chamber from the lower chamber, forcing the piston down,
passing through the turbine housing and over the turbine against spring tension, extending the actuator rod which
wheel to spin the shaft which is connected to the moves the attached wastegate butterfly toward the closed
compressor. Ambient, filtered, air is then drawn in through position. A decrease in oil pressure allows spring tension to
the air inlet duct to the compressor where it is compressed return the piston, retracting the actuating rod, and retuming
and delivered to the throttle. As the engine power output the wastegate butterfly to the open position. Oil from the
increases, the flow of exhaust gases increases resulting in a outlet oil port of the actuator is not restricted at the actuator
proportionate increase in speed of the rotating assembly but is pressure controlled by the variable absolute pressure
and turbocharger output. The turbocharger system (see controller which contains an aneroid bellows sensitive to
Figure 1) consists of an exhaust driven turbine and pressure changes in the induction manifold. As the pressure
centrifugal compressor mounted on a common shaft. The it senses decreases, it expands, extending a metering pin
center section of the unit contains the bearings and which reduces the flow of oil through the body of the unit
lubrication passages and supports the turbine and and increases the pressure across the actuator diaphragm
compressor housing. Lubrication to the center section is forcing the piston down and moving the wastegate toward
supplied by regulated engine oil pressure at the oil cooler the closed position. The lower chamber of the controller
providing a constant oil flow over the bearings. The oil then equipped with an adjustable cam is linked to the throttle
drains by gravity into the sump tank located at the lowest valve and is designed so that the controller setting is varied
point in the system and is returned by scavenge pump to proportionally to the amount of power the pilot selects with
the engine sump. Exhaust headers, crossover pipe, turbine the throttle by moving the metering pin seat. The
inlet plenum, wastegate, exhaust by-pass duct, and tail pipe compressor output is automatically controlled at a constant
make up the exhaust system. pressure by the variable absolute pressure controller
providing the engine fuel pump and injector noules with the
required flow and pressure at altitudes they are referenced
Automatic control of the system is supplied by three to. me fuel flow gage diaphragm is also referenced to this
principal components; the variable absolute pressure pressure to prevent an erroneous reading.
81-00-00
Rage 1
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANUA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CYL 5 3 1 ENGINE
OIL
INDUCTION COOLER
"Y"
THROTTLE
INJECTOR NOZZLE SHROUDS mt v CONNECTED
CYL. 2 VARIABLE
6. 4
CONTROLLER
TO FUEL PRESSURE
I: II
VENT PORT
INTAKE III 11 FUEL
ALTERNATEAIR ENGINEINTAKE MANIFOLD CONTROL
AMBIENT
SOURCE ~n n ~n 14 PRESSURE
I
LINE
TO
INTAKE ENGINE--~t7 CHECK
DRIVEN ~I VALVE
Al~ FILTER
SCAVENGE
PUMP EXHAUST
BELLOWS
RETURN TO
I’ I L~IU F~ U~--’Y\ II 11 II1 CRANKCASE
j
ENGINE EXHAUST
TANK~! i: ~-WASTEGATE
VENT
ONE WAY
CHECK VALVE
EXHAUST
i: I L TAILPIPE
i II ACTUATOR OVERBOOST
VALVE
CONTROL SYSTEM VENT
SUMP TANK OVERBOARD
A36-603-27
Turbocharger Schematic
Figure 1
d. Metering jet in actuator inlet d. Backflush with PD680 solvent (16, Chart
blocked. i, 91-00-00), 50 psi.
81-00-00
11.8981 _
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
81-00-00
Page 3
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MA1NTENAEICE MANUAL
8. High fuel pressure at altitude, a. Leak in pressure reference a. Eliminate any -leaks.
line at fuel pressure line.
9. Low fuel pressure at altitude, a. Leak in pressure reference a. Eliminate any leaks.
line at fuel pump.
11. Excessive noise or vibration, a. Improper bearing lubrication, a. Clean or replace oil line; clean oil strainer,
and supply oil pressure. If trouble still
persists, overhaul turbocharger.
12. Engine will not deliver rated a. Clogged manifold system. a. Clear ail ducting.
power.
81-00-00.
Page 4
May 9/80
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
12. Engine will not deliver rated b. Foreign material lodged in b. Disassemble and clean.
.power. (Continued) compressor turbine or
impeller.
GENERAL MAINTENANCE PRACTICES d. After engine warm-ub, advance the throttle to its
maximum position of 2600 2700 propeller rpm and full
rich mixture. Check and (if required) adjust the manifold
MANIFOLD PRESSURE ADJUSTiMENT~ pressure adjustment screw on the absolute variable
pressure controller. Loosen the jam nut and rotate the
The wastegate is controlled by engine oil pressure, which adjustment screw counterclockwise to.increase, or
isregulated by the variableabsolute pressure controller. ´•clockwise to decrease manifold pressure, then retighten
For this reasonmanifold pressure is quite sensitive to oil the jam nut.
pressure and.temperatureas ~.well .as ambie,nt....-
temperatures. It has been determined that the manifold NOTE
pressure will vary: (1) 0.2 in. Hg. per 10oF change in oil
temperature; (2) 0.3 in. Hg per 10 psig in oil pressure and If the manifold pressure is adjusted with engine
(3) 0.05 in. Hg per 10oF change in ambient temperature. oil temperature at (1000F) 380C rather than the
The best time to make adjustments is shortly after the 719 to 820C (160" to 180"F) recommended, a
airplane has been flown. Under the conditions described in decrease in manifold pressure will occur when
step "c", the manifold, pressure should be 36 in, of Hg. the oil temperature increases to the normal
operating range, Under these conditions, a
a,Locate the absolute variable pressure controller decrease in manifold pressure of 1 to 2 in, of
mounted on the top´•of the throttle body in the left side of’ Hg below the rated 36 in, of Hg will occur
the engine accessory compartment. along with a corresponding decrease in fuel
b. Check the controller-td-throttle linkage for proper flow. t~e other hand, the manifold
If, on
stop pin, adju~t the connecting linkage stop nuts to a also occur since the full rich schedule is a
position allowing 0.01 to 0.02 inch gap between the cam function of both deck pressureand RPM.
arm and the controller maximum stop (see Figure 2). On a These characteristics must be taken into
new engine this adjustment should already be made’by consideration when manifold pressure
Continental~ Motors. adjustments are made. It is´•important that
manifold pressure and fuel flow be within the
c. Start and run’the engine to bring the engine oil prescribed limitations simultaneously during a
temperature up to (1600 to 180oF) 71" to 82"C. Adjust the maximum:power run-up. Incorrectmanifold
oil pressure to 40 to 50 psig (45 psigpreferred) at 2600 to pressure settings will cause erroneous. fuel flow
2700 rpm, readings.
81-00-00
Page 5
Jan 28/81
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAIN’TENANCE MANUAL
VARIABLE ABSOLUTE
PRESSURE CONTROLLER‘
CONTROLLER LEVER
MANIFOLD PRESSURE ((N MAX. THROTTLE POSITION)
ADJUSTMENT SCREW
(6.SI, MS/TURN)
.01
GAP /O
O
JAM NUT
CAM ARM
CONNECTING LINKAGE
STOP NUTS
STOP PIN
A36TC-282-12
VIEW LOOKING AFT
sl-bo-oo
Page6
Jan 28/81
BEECHCRAF~
BONANZA SEBIES
MAINfENANCE MANUAL
c’
protective barrier on the seal surfaces. Although these access opening on the left side of the airplane.
deposits do restrict, and even stops shaft rotation, they are b. Install the bolts which secure the turbocharger to
not harmful to subsequent turbocharger operation once they the mounting bracket.
are removed sufficiently to give free shaft movement, c. Install the gaskets and the turbo inlet assembly on
the turbocharger.
When this condition is noted, remove the exhaust discharge d. Install the inlet to the heater exhaust system.
stack and apply WO-40 penetrating oil or Mouse Milk (40, e. Remove the dust covers from the oil lines and oil
Chart i, 91-00-00), liberallyto the area behind the wheel ports. Install the oil lines.
around the turbine shaft seal. After a few minutes, attempt, f.Install the tail pipe. Tighten the V-band coupling to
to tum the shaft. A light tap on the shaft end with a soft 40 inch-pounds. Tap the periphery of the band to distribute
mallet will often assist in freeing the shaft. Once the shaft is tension, then torque to 40 inch-pounds.
free, the engine can be started and a power check made to g. Install the turbocharger air inlet duct and tighten
confirm turbocharger output either on the ground or in flight, the flex duct clamps.
h. Install the heat shield over the turbocharger.
i. Connect’the red and yellow TIT wires.
TURBOCHARGER REMOVAL i. Install the induction tube which contains the relief
valve. Install and tighten the clamps.
a. Open the engine cowl on the left side of the k. Install the heater ram air inlet duct.
airplane. I. Install the two louvered
access openings on the
b. Remove the two louvered access openings on the left side of the engine compartment.
left side of the engine compartment. m. Close the cowling on the engine compartment.
c. Remove the heater ram air inlet duct.
d. Remove the induction tube with the relief valve, TURBOCHARGER CONTROLLER REMOVAL
by removing the clamps and lifting the tube away from the
engine. a. Remove the linkage to the throttle.
e. Disconnect the red and yellow TIT wires, b. Remove the linkage to the butterfly.
i. f. Remove the heat shield from over the c. Re~bve.the manifold pressure reference line.
turbocharger. d. Remove the oil lines. Install dust covers.
g. Loosen the flex ducts on the turbocharger air inlet e. Remove ihe safety wire on the two larger
duct, and remove the air inlet duct, mounting bolts.
h. Remove the tail pipe by removing the clamp and f. Remove the three mounting bolts.
bolt. g. Remove the turbocharger controller.
i. Remove the oil lines from the turbocharger. Install
dust covers.
"END"
I)1-MUHI
Page8
Jan 20/82 A4
BEECHCRAFT
BONANZA SERIES
MAINTENANCE MANUAL
81-00-00
Page 7
Jan 28/81
CHAPTER
CHARTS
Ray~heon Aircraft tompany
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 91 CHARTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
SUBJECT PAGE
91-00-00
Charts....................................................................................1
Consumable Materials ........._._._._
1
A28 91 -CONTENTS Aug
31 05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
CHAPTER 91 CHARTS
CHARTS
CONSUMABLE MA TERIALS
The recommended materials listed in Chart 1 as meeting federal, military or supplier specifications are provided for
Chart 1
Consumable Materials
2. EngineOils SAE J 1966 Exxon Aviation Oil 100 Exxon Mobil L and S
(BREAK-IN) 3225 Gallows Rd.
Any approved aircraft Fairfax, VA 22037
engine oil graded at 1100
(First 20 to 30 hours of a Castrolaero 113 Castrol Oil Canada Ltd.,
(SAE 50) or 1065 (SAE 30)
new or remanufactured (Grade 1065) P.O. Box 3,
engine) New Toronto Postal
Multiviscosity oil not
Station,
recommended
Toronto, Ontario
Castrol Aviator S Air BP Lubricants
Div. of BP Prod. N.A.
Parsippany, NJ 07054
CAUTION: Do not mix oils of different brands or oils of different types produced by the same manufacturer.
1
nns 91-00-00 Aug
31 05Page
Raytheon AiKraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
2
Aug 3105Page 91-00-00 A28
RBytheOn Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
3. Corrosion Preventive MIL-C-6529 Type II I Anti-Corrode No. 205 Cities Service Oil Co.,
Compound (Engine 60 Wall Tower,
Oil) New York, NY
Rust Foil No. 652-2 Franklin Oil Corp.,
Bedford, OH 44146
Kendex No. 7038 Kendall Refining Co.,
1177 Kendall Ave.,
Bradford, PA 16701
4. Preservative Oil MIL-P-46002, Grade I Nude Oil 105 Daubert Chemical Co.,
4700 S. Central Ave.,
Chicago, IL 60638
Protect VA Penreco
106 S. Main St.
Butler, PA 16001
3
A28 91-00-00
Raylheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
4
Aug 3105Page 91-00-00 A28
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
16. Solvent or White PD680 Type III or British Stoddard Solvents Obtain Locally.
Spirits Stoddard Solvents (Mineral Spirits)
17. Sealer Presstite 576 Presstite-Keystone
Engineering Co.,
3900 Choteau Ave.,
St. Louis, MO 63110
5
A28 91-00-00
Ray~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
28. Deleted
6
Aug 3105Page 91-00-00 nzB
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANU~ SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
7
A28 91-00-00
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
8
Aug 31/05Page 91-00-00 A28
Ral~heon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
9
A28 91-00-00 Aug 31 05Page
Raytheon Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
Advanced Chemistry 8
Technology,
950 Kingsland Ave.,
St. Louis, MO 63130
Aug
31105~3:5, 91-00-00 A28
RBI~LOMI Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
Chart 1
Consumable Materials (Continued)
MATERIAL SPECIFICATION PRODUCT SUPPLIER
11
A28 91-00-00 Aug 31405Page
BaldNa(Hl Aircraft Company
BONANZA SERIES MAINTENANCE MANUAL
When installing flare fittings, make they properly lubricated in accordance with Chart 3. Tighten the fittings
I
sure are
in accordance with the FLARED FITTING TORQUE CHART (Refer Chapter 20-06-00, Chart 1). Do not overtighten.
Chart 2
Flared Fitting Torque Chart (in-lbs)
Chart 2 moved. Refer to Chapter 20-06-00, Chart 1.
Chart 3
Thread Lubricants
Hydraulic MIL-H-5606
Loctite 545
Straight None
Straight None
NOTE: Lubricate engine fittings only with the fluid that will flow through the lines. Air lines are not to be lubricated.
Chart 4
Torquing Coarse Threaded Bolts Loaded in Shear
Chart 5
Fine Threaded Series, Class 3, Cadmium Plated
and Non Lubricated (except as noted)